update copyright year range in GDB files
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1239 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1240 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1241 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1242 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1243 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1244
1245 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1246 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1247 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1248 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1249 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1250 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1251
1252 @item -write
1253 @cindex @code{--write}
1254 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1255 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1256 (@pxref{Patching}).
1257
1258 @item -statistics
1259 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1260 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1261 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1262
1263 @item -version
1264 @cindex @code{--version}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1266 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1267
1268 @item -configuration
1269 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1271 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1272 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1273
1274 @end table
1275
1276 @node Startup
1277 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1278 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1279
1280 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1281
1282 @enumerate
1283 @item
1284 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1285 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1286
1287 @item
1288 @cindex init file
1289 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1290 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1291 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1292 that file.
1293
1294 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1295 @item
1296 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1297 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1298 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1302 @item
1303 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1304 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1305 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1306 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1307 gets loaded.
1308
1309 @item
1310 Processes command line options and operands.
1311
1312 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1313 @item
1314 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1315 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1316 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1317 This is only done if the current directory is
1318 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1319 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1320 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1321 @value{GDBN}.
1322
1323 @item
1324 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1325 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1326 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1327 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1328
1329 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1330 you must do something like the following:
1331
1332 @smallexample
1333 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1334 @end smallexample
1335
1336 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1337 off too late.
1338
1339 @item
1340 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1341 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1342 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1346 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1347 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1348 @end enumerate
1349
1350 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1351 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1352 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1353 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1354 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1355 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1356
1357 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1358 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1359
1360 @cindex init file name
1361 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1362 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1363 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1364 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1365 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1366 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1367 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1368 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1369
1370
1371 @node Quitting GDB
1372 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1373 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1374 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1375
1376 @table @code
1377 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1378 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1379 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1380 @itemx q
1381 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1382 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1383 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1384 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1385 error code.
1386 @end table
1387
1388 @cindex interrupt
1389 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1390 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1391 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1392 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1393 until a time when it is safe.
1394
1395 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1396 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1397 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1398
1399 @node Shell Commands
1400 @section Shell Commands
1401
1402 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1403 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1404 just use the @code{shell} command.
1405
1406 @table @code
1407 @kindex shell
1408 @kindex !
1409 @cindex shell escape
1410 @item shell @var{command-string}
1411 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1412 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1413 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1414 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1415 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1416 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1417 @end table
1418
1419 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1420 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1421 @value{GDBN}:
1422
1423 @table @code
1424 @kindex make
1425 @cindex calling make
1426 @item make @var{make-args}
1427 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1428 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1429 @end table
1430
1431 @node Logging Output
1432 @section Logging Output
1433 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1434 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1435
1436 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1437 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1438
1439 @table @code
1440 @kindex set logging
1441 @item set logging on
1442 Enable logging.
1443 @item set logging off
1444 Disable logging.
1445 @cindex logging file name
1446 @item set logging file @var{file}
1447 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1448 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1449 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1450 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1451 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1452 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1453 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1454 @kindex show logging
1455 @item show logging
1456 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1457 @end table
1458
1459 @node Commands
1460 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1461
1462 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1463 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1464 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1465 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1466 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1467
1468 @menu
1469 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1470 * Completion:: Command completion
1471 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1472 @end menu
1473
1474 @node Command Syntax
1475 @section Command Syntax
1476
1477 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1478 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1479 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1480 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1481 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1482 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1483
1484 @cindex abbreviation
1485 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1486 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1487 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1488 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1489 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1490 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1491 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1492
1493 @cindex repeating commands
1494 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1495 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1496 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1497 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1498 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1499 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1500 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1501
1502 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1503 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1504 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1505
1506 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1507 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1508 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1509 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1510 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1511
1512 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1513 @cindex comment
1514 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1515 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1516 Files,,Command Files}).
1517
1518 @cindex repeating command sequences
1519 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1520 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1521 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1522 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1523 for editing.
1524
1525 @node Completion
1526 @section Command Completion
1527
1528 @cindex completion
1529 @cindex word completion
1530 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1531 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1532 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1533 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1534
1535 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1536 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1537 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1538 enter it). For example, if you type
1539
1540 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1541 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1542 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1543 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1544 @smallexample
1545 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1546 @end smallexample
1547
1548 @noindent
1549 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1550 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1551
1552 @smallexample
1553 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1554 @end smallexample
1555
1556 @noindent
1557 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1558 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1559 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1560 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1561 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1562 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1563
1564 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1565 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1566 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1567 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1568 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1569 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1570 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1571 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1572 example:
1573
1574 @smallexample
1575 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1576 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1577 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1578 make_abs_section make_function_type
1579 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1580 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1581 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1583 @end smallexample
1584
1585 @noindent
1586 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1587 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1588 command.
1589
1590 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1591 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1592 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1593 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1594 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1595
1596 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1597 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1598 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1602 main
1603 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1604 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1605 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1606 @end smallexample
1607
1608 @noindent
1609 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1610
1611 @table @code
1612 @kindex set max-completions
1613 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1614 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1615 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1616 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1617 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1618 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1619 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1620 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1621 completion slow.
1622 @kindex show max-completions
1623 @item show max-completions
1624 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1625 during completion.
1626 @end table
1627
1628 @cindex quotes in commands
1629 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1630 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1631 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1632 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1633 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1634 @value{GDBN} commands.
1635
1636 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1637 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1638 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1639 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1640 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1641 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1642 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1643 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1644 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1645 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1646 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1650 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1651 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1652 @end smallexample
1653
1654 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1655 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1656 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1657 place:
1658
1659 @smallexample
1660 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1661 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1662 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @noindent
1666 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1667 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1668 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1669
1670 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1671 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1672 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1673 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1674
1675 @cindex completion of structure field names
1676 @cindex structure field name completion
1677 @cindex completion of union field names
1678 @cindex union field name completion
1679 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1680 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1681 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1682 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1683 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1684 left-hand-side:
1685
1686 @smallexample
1687 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1688 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1689 to_data to_isatty to_write
1690 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1691 to_flush to_read
1692 @end smallexample
1693
1694 @noindent
1695 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1696 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1697 follows:
1698
1699 @smallexample
1700 struct ui_file
1701 @{
1702 int *magic;
1703 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1704 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1705 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1706 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1707 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1708 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1709 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1710 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1711 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1712 void *to_data;
1713 @}
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716
1717 @node Help
1718 @section Getting Help
1719 @cindex online documentation
1720 @kindex help
1721
1722 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1723 using the command @code{help}.
1724
1725 @table @code
1726 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1727 @item help
1728 @itemx h
1729 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1730 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1731
1732 @smallexample
1733 (@value{GDBP}) help
1734 List of classes of commands:
1735
1736 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1737 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1738 data -- Examining data
1739 files -- Specifying and examining files
1740 internals -- Maintenance commands
1741 obscure -- Obscure features
1742 running -- Running the program
1743 stack -- Examining the stack
1744 status -- Status inquiries
1745 support -- Support facilities
1746 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1747 stopping the program
1748 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1749
1750 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1751 commands in that class.
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1758
1759 @item help @var{class}
1760 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1761 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1762 help display for the class @code{status}:
1763
1764 @smallexample
1765 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1766 Status inquiries.
1767
1768 List of commands:
1769
1770 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1771 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1772 info -- Generic command for showing things
1773 about the program being debugged
1774 show -- Generic command for showing things
1775 about the debugger
1776
1777 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1778 documentation.
1779 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1780 (@value{GDBP})
1781 @end smallexample
1782
1783 @item help @var{command}
1784 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1785 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1786
1787 @kindex apropos
1788 @item apropos @var{args}
1789 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1790 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1791 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1792
1793 @smallexample
1794 apropos alias
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 results in:
1799
1800 @smallexample
1801 @c @group
1802 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1803 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1804 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1805 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1806 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1807 @c @end group
1808 @end smallexample
1809
1810 @kindex complete
1811 @item complete @var{args}
1812 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1813 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1814 command you want completed. For example:
1815
1816 @smallexample
1817 complete i
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @noindent results in:
1821
1822 @smallexample
1823 @group
1824 if
1825 ignore
1826 info
1827 inspect
1828 @end group
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1832 @end table
1833
1834 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1835 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1836 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1837 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1838 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1839 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1840 Index}.
1841
1842 @c @group
1843 @table @code
1844 @kindex info
1845 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1846 @item info
1847 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1848 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1849 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1850 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1851 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1852 @w{@code{help info}}.
1853
1854 @kindex set
1855 @item set
1856 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1857 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1858 @code{set prompt $}.
1859
1860 @kindex show
1861 @item show
1862 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1863 @value{GDBN} itself.
1864 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1865 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1866 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1867 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1868
1869 @kindex info set
1870 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1871 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1872 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1873 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1874 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1875 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1876 @end table
1877 @c @end group
1878
1879 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1880 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1881
1882 @table @code
1883 @kindex show version
1884 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1885 @item show version
1886 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1887 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1888 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1889 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1890 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1891 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1892 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1893 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1894 @value{GDBN}.
1895
1896 @kindex show copying
1897 @kindex info copying
1898 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1899 @item show copying
1900 @itemx info copying
1901 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903 @kindex show warranty
1904 @kindex info warranty
1905 @item show warranty
1906 @itemx info warranty
1907 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1908 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1909
1910 @kindex show configuration
1911 @item show configuration
1912 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1913 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1914 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1915 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1916 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1917 your report.
1918
1919 @end table
1920
1921 @node Running
1922 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1923
1924 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it.
1926
1927 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1928 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1929 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1930 kill a child process.
1931
1932 @menu
1933 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1934 * Starting:: Starting your program
1935 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1936 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1937
1938 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1939 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1940 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1941 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1942
1943 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1944 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1945 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1946 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1947 @end menu
1948
1949 @node Compilation
1950 @section Compiling for Debugging
1951
1952 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1953 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1954 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1955 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1956 and addresses in the executable code.
1957
1958 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1959 the compiler.
1960
1961 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1962 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1963 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1964 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1965 executables containing debugging information.
1966
1967 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1968 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1969 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1970 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1971 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1972
1973 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1974 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1975 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1976
1977 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1978 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1979 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1980 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1981 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1982 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1983
1984 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1985 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1986 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1987
1988 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1989 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1990 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1991 format in @value{GDBN}.
1992
1993 @need 2000
1994 @node Starting
1995 @section Starting your Program
1996 @cindex starting
1997 @cindex running
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex run
2001 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2002 @item run
2003 @itemx r
2004 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2005 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2006 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2007 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2008 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2009
2010 @end table
2011
2012 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2013 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2014 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2015 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2016 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2017 message like this one:
2018
2019 @smallexample
2020 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2021 Try "help target" or "continue".
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2026 first (@pxref{load}).
2027
2028 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2029 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2030 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2031 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2032 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2033 divided into four categories:
2034
2035 @table @asis
2036 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2037 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2038 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2039 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2040 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2041 the arguments.
2042 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2043 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2044 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2045 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2046 below for details).
2047
2048 @item The @emph{environment.}
2049 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2050 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2051 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2052 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2053
2054 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2055 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2056 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2057 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2060 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2061 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2062 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2063 set a different device for your program.
2064 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2065
2066 @cindex pipes
2067 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2068 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2069 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2070 wrong program.
2071 @end table
2072
2073 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2074 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2075 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2076 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2077 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2078
2079 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2080 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2081 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2082 your current breakpoints.
2083
2084 @table @code
2085 @kindex start
2086 @item start
2087 @cindex run to main procedure
2088 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2089 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2090 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2091 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2092 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2093 procedure, depending on the language used.
2094
2095 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2096 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2097 the @samp{run} command.
2098
2099 @cindex elaboration phase
2100 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2101 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2102 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2103 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2104 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2105 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2106 will remain to halt execution.
2107
2108 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2109 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2110 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2111 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2112 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2113
2114 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2115 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2116 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2117 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2118 elaboration code before running your program.
2119
2120 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2121 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2122 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2123 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2124 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2125 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2126 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2127 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2128 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2129 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2130 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2131 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2132
2133 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2134 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2135 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2136 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2137
2138 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2139 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2140 environment:
2141
2142 @smallexample
2143 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2144 (@value{GDBP}) run
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2148 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2149
2150 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2151 @item set startup-with-shell
2152 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2153 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2154 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2155 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2156 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2157 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2158 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2159 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2160 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2161 startup failures such as:
2162
2163 @smallexample
2164 (@value{GDBP}) run
2165 Starting program: ./a.out
2166 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2167 @end smallexample
2168
2169 @noindent
2170 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2171 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2172 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2173 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2174 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2175 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2176
2177 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2178 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2179 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2180 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2181 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2182 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2183
2184 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2185 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2186 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2187 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2188 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2189 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2190
2191 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2192 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2193 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2194
2195 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2196 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) run
2200 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2204 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2205
2206 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2207 @code{target native} command. For example,
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2211 (@value{GDBP}) run
2212 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2213 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2214 (@value{GDBP}) run
2215 Starting program: ./a.out
2216 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2220 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2221 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2222 disconnect.
2223
2224 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2225 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2226 proc}, @code{info os}.
2227
2228 @kindex set disable-randomization
2229 @item set disable-randomization
2230 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2231 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2232 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2233 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2234 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2235
2236 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2237 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2238
2239 @smallexample
2240 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2241 @end smallexample
2242
2243 @item set disable-randomization off
2244 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2245 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2246 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2247 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2248 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2249 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2250
2251 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2252 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2253 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2254 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2255 a code at its expected addresses.
2256
2257 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2258 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2259 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2260 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2261 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2262 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2263 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2264 a randomly chosen address.
2265
2266 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2267 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2268 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2269 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2270 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2271
2272 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2273 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2274
2275 @item show disable-randomization
2276 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2277 the virtual address space of the started program.
2278
2279 @end table
2280
2281 @node Arguments
2282 @section Your Program's Arguments
2283
2284 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2285 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2286 @code{run} command.
2287 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2288 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2289 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2290 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2291 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2292
2293 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2294 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2295 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2296 the program, not by the shell.
2297
2298 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2299 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2300
2301 @table @code
2302 @kindex set args
2303 @item set args
2304 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2305 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2306 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2307 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2308 it again without arguments.
2309
2310 @kindex show args
2311 @item show args
2312 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2313 @end table
2314
2315 @node Environment
2316 @section Your Program's Environment
2317
2318 @cindex environment (of your program)
2319 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2320 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2321 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2322 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2323 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2324 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2325 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2326
2327 @table @code
2328 @kindex path
2329 @item path @var{directory}
2330 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2331 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2332 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2333 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2334 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2335 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2336 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2337
2338 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2339 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2340 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2341 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2342 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2343 @var{directory} to the search path.
2344 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2345 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2346
2347 @kindex show paths
2348 @item show paths
2349 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2350 environment variable).
2351
2352 @kindex show environment
2353 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2354 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2355 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2356 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2357 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2358
2359 @kindex set environment
2360 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2361 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2362 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2363 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2364 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2365 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2366 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2367 null value.
2368 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2369 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2370
2371 For example, this command:
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 set env USER = foo
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2379 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2380 are not actually required.)
2381
2382 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2383 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2384 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2385 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2386 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2387
2388 @kindex unset environment
2389 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2390 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2391 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2392 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2393 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2394 @end table
2395
2396 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2397 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2398 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2399 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2400 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2401 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2402 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2403 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2404 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2405 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2406
2407 @node Working Directory
2408 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2409
2410 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2411 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2412 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2413 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2414 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2415 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2416
2417 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2418 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2419 Specify Files}.
2420
2421 @table @code
2422 @kindex cd
2423 @cindex change working directory
2424 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2425 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2426 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2427
2428 @kindex pwd
2429 @item pwd
2430 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2434 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2435 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2436 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2437 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2438 current working directory of the debuggee.
2439
2440 @node Input/Output
2441 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2442
2443 @cindex redirection
2444 @cindex i/o
2445 @cindex terminal
2446 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2447 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2448 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2449 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2450 running your program.
2451
2452 @table @code
2453 @kindex info terminal
2454 @item info terminal
2455 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2456 program is using.
2457 @end table
2458
2459 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2460 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2461
2462 @smallexample
2463 run > outfile
2464 @end smallexample
2465
2466 @noindent
2467 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2468
2469 @kindex tty
2470 @cindex controlling terminal
2471 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2472 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2473 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2474 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2475 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2476
2477 @smallexample
2478 tty /dev/ttyb
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2483 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2484 that as their controlling terminal.
2485
2486 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2487 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2488 terminal.
2489
2490 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2491 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2492 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2493 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2494
2495 @cindex inferior tty
2496 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2497 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2498 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2499 program.
2500
2501 @table @code
2502 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2503 @kindex set inferior-tty
2504 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2505 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2506 @value{GDBN}.
2507
2508 @item show inferior-tty
2509 @kindex show inferior-tty
2510 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2511 @end table
2512
2513 @node Attach
2514 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2515 @kindex attach
2516 @cindex attach
2517
2518 @table @code
2519 @item attach @var{process-id}
2520 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2521 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2522 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2523 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2524 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2525
2526 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2527 executing the command.
2528 @end table
2529
2530 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2531 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2532 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2533 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2534
2535 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2536 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2537 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2538 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2539 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2540 Specify Files}.
2541
2542 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2543 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2544 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2545 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2546 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2547 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2548 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2549
2550 @table @code
2551 @kindex detach
2552 @item detach
2553 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2554 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2555 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2556 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2557 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2558 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2559 executing the command.
2560 @end table
2561
2562 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2563 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2564 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2565 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2566 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2567 Messages}).
2568
2569 @node Kill Process
2570 @section Killing the Child Process
2571
2572 @table @code
2573 @kindex kill
2574 @item kill
2575 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2576 @end table
2577
2578 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2579 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2580 is running.
2581
2582 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2583 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2584 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2585 outside the debugger.
2586
2587 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2588 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2589 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2590 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2591 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2592 breakpoint settings).
2593
2594 @node Inferiors and Programs
2595 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2596
2597 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2598 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2599 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2600 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2601 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2602 from multiple executables.
2603
2604 @cindex inferior
2605 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2606 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2607 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2608 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2609 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2610 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2611 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2612 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2613 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2614 threads running in it.
2615
2616 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2617 inferiors}}:
2618
2619 @table @code
2620 @kindex info inferiors
2621 @item info inferiors
2622 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2623
2624 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2625
2626 @enumerate
2627 @item
2628 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2629
2630 @item
2631 the target system's inferior identifier
2632
2633 @item
2634 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2635
2636 @end enumerate
2637
2638 @noindent
2639 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2640 indicates the current inferior.
2641
2642 For example,
2643 @end table
2644 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2645
2646 @smallexample
2647 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2648 Num Description Executable
2649 2 process 2307 hello
2650 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2651 @end smallexample
2652
2653 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2654
2655 @table @code
2656 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2657 @item inferior @var{infno}
2658 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2659 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2660 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2661 @end table
2662
2663 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2664 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2665 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2666 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2667 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2668 information on convenience variables.
2669
2670 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2671 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2672 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2673 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2674 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2675 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2676
2677 @table @code
2678 @kindex add-inferior
2679 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2680 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2681 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2682 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2683 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2684 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2685
2686 @kindex clone-inferior
2687 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2688 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2689 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2690 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2691 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2692
2693 @smallexample
2694 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2695 Num Description Executable
2696 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2697 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2698 Added inferior 2.
2699 1 inferiors added.
2700 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2701 Num Description Executable
2702 2 <null> helloworld
2703 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2704 @end smallexample
2705
2706 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2707
2708 @kindex remove-inferiors
2709 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2710 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2711 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2712 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2713
2714 @end table
2715
2716 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2717 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2718 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2719 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2720
2721 @table @code
2722 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2723 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2724 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2725 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2726 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2727 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2728
2729 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2730 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2731 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2732 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2733 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2734 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2735 @end table
2736
2737 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2738 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2739 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2740 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2741
2742
2743 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2744 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2745
2746 @table @code
2747 @kindex set print inferior-events
2748 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2749 @item set print inferior-events
2750 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2751 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2752 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2753 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2754 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2755 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2756
2757 @kindex show print inferior-events
2758 @item show print inferior-events
2759 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2760 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2761 @end table
2762
2763 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2764 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2765 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2766
2767
2768 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2769 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2770 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2771 info program-spaces}} command.
2772
2773 @table @code
2774 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2775 @item maint info program-spaces
2776 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2777 @value{GDBN}.
2778
2779 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2780
2781 @enumerate
2782 @item
2783 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2784
2785 @item
2786 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2787 the @code{file} command.
2788
2789 @end enumerate
2790
2791 @noindent
2792 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2793 indicates the current program space.
2794
2795 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2796 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2797 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2798
2799 @smallexample
2800 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2801 Id Executable
2802 * 1 hello
2803 2 goodbye
2804 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2805 @end smallexample
2806
2807 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2808 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2809 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2810 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2811 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2812
2813 @smallexample
2814 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2815 Id Executable
2816 * 1 vfork-test
2817 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2818 @end smallexample
2819
2820 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2821 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2822 @end table
2823
2824 @node Threads
2825 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2826
2827 @cindex threads of execution
2828 @cindex multiple threads
2829 @cindex switching threads
2830 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2831 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2832 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2833 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2834 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2835 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2836 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2837
2838 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2839 programs:
2840
2841 @itemize @bullet
2842 @item automatic notification of new threads
2843 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2844 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2845 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2846 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2847 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2848 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2849 messages on thread start and exit.
2850 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2851 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2852 isn't compatible with the program.
2853 @end itemize
2854
2855 @cindex focus of debugging
2856 @cindex current thread
2857 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2858 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2859 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2860 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2861 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2862
2863 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2864 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2865 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2866 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2867 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2868 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2869 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2870 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2871 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2872 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2873
2874 @smallexample
2875 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2876 @end smallexample
2877
2878 @noindent
2879 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2880 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2881 further qualifier.
2882
2883 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2884 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2885 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2886 @c program?
2887 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2888 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2889 @c threads ab initio?
2890
2891 @anchor{thread numbers}
2892 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2893 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2894 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2895 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2896 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2897 between threads of different inferiors.
2898
2899 @cindex qualified thread ID
2900 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2901 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2902 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2903 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2904 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2905 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2906 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2907 inferior.
2908
2909 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2910 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2911 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2912 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2913
2914 @anchor{thread ID lists}
2915 @cindex thread ID lists
2916 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2917 argument. A list element can be:
2918
2919 @enumerate
2920 @item
2921 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2922 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2923 @samp{1}.
2924
2925 @item
2926 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
2927 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
2928 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
2929
2930 @item
2931 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
2932 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
2933 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
2934 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
2935 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
2936
2937 @end enumerate
2938
2939 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
2940 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
2941 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
2942 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
2943 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
2944 7.1}.
2945
2946
2947 @anchor{global thread numbers}
2948 @cindex global thread number
2949 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
2950 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
2951 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
2952 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
2953 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
2954 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
2955
2956 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
2957 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
2958 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
2959
2960 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2961 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
2962 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
2963 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
2964 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
2965 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
2966 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
2967 general information on convenience variables.
2968
2969 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
2970 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
2971 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
2972
2973 @smallexample
2974 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
2975 @end smallexample
2976
2977 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
2978
2979 @smallexample
2980 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
2981 @end smallexample
2982
2983 @table @code
2984 @kindex info threads
2985 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
2986
2987 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
2988 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
2989 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
2990 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
2991
2992 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2993
2994 @enumerate
2995 @item
2996 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2997
2998 @item
2999 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3000 option was specified
3001
3002 @item
3003 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3004
3005 @item
3006 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3007 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3008 program itself.
3009
3010 @item
3011 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3012 @end enumerate
3013
3014 @noindent
3015 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3016 indicates the current thread.
3017
3018 For example,
3019 @end table
3020 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3021
3022 @smallexample
3023 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3024 Id Target Id Frame
3025 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3026 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3027 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3028 at threadtest.c:68
3029 @end smallexample
3030
3031 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3032 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3033 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3034
3035 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3036 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3037
3038 @smallexample
3039 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3040 Id GId Target Id Frame
3041 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3042 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3043 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3044 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3045 @end smallexample
3046
3047 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3048 Solaris-specific command:
3049
3050 @table @code
3051 @item maint info sol-threads
3052 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3053 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3054 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3055 @end table
3056
3057 @table @code
3058 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3059 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3060 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3061 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3062 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3063 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3064
3065 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3066 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3067
3068 @smallexample
3069 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3070 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3071 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3072 8 printf ("hello\n");
3073 @end smallexample
3074
3075 @noindent
3076 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3077 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3078 threads.
3079
3080 @kindex thread apply
3081 @cindex apply command to several threads
3082 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3083 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3084 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3085 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3086 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3087 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3088 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3089 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3090
3091
3092 @kindex thread name
3093 @cindex name a thread
3094 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3095 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3096 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3097 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3098
3099 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3100 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3101 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3102 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3103 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3104
3105 @kindex thread find
3106 @cindex search for a thread
3107 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3108 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3109 matches the supplied regular expression.
3110
3111 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3112 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3113 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3114 is the LWP id.
3115
3116 @smallexample
3117 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3118 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3119 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3120 Id Target Id Frame
3121 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3122 @end smallexample
3123
3124 @kindex set print thread-events
3125 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3126 @item set print thread-events
3127 @itemx set print thread-events on
3128 @itemx set print thread-events off
3129 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3130 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3131 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3132 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3133 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3134
3135 @kindex show print thread-events
3136 @item show print thread-events
3137 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3138 have started and exited.
3139 @end table
3140
3141 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3142 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3143 programs with multiple threads.
3144
3145 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3146 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3147
3148 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3149 @table @code
3150 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3151 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3152 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3153 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3154 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3155 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3156 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3157 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3158 macro.
3159
3160 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3161 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3162 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3163 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3164 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3165 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3166
3167 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3168 refers to the default system directories that are
3169 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3170 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3171 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3172
3173 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3174 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3175 was loaded in the inferior process.
3176
3177 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3178 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3179 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3180 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3181 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3182 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3183 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3184
3185 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3186 only on some platforms.
3187
3188 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3189 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3190 Display current libthread_db search path.
3191
3192 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3193 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3194 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3195 @item set debug libthread-db
3196 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3197 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3198 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3199 @end table
3200
3201 @node Forks
3202 @section Debugging Forks
3203
3204 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3205 @cindex multiple processes
3206 @cindex processes, multiple
3207 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3208 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3209 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3210 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3211 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3212 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3213 will cause it to terminate.
3214
3215 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3216 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3217 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3218 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3219 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3220 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3221 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3222 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3223 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3224 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3225
3226 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3227 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3228 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3229 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3230
3231 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3232 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3233 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3234
3235 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3236 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3237
3238 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3239 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3240
3241 @table @code
3242 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3243 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3244 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3245 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3246 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3247
3248 @table @code
3249 @item parent
3250 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3251 unimpeded. This is the default.
3252
3253 @item child
3254 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3255 unimpeded.
3256
3257 @end table
3258
3259 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3260 @item show follow-fork-mode
3261 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3262 @end table
3263
3264 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3265 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3266 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3267
3268 @table @code
3269 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3270 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3271 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3272 retain debugger control over them both.
3273
3274 @table @code
3275 @item on
3276 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3277 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3278 independently. This is the default.
3279
3280 @item off
3281 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3282 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3283 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3284 is held suspended.
3285
3286 @end table
3287
3288 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3289 @item show detach-on-fork
3290 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3291 @end table
3292
3293 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3294 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3295 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3296 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3297 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3298 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3299
3300 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3301 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3302 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3303 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3304 and Programs}.
3305
3306 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3307 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3308 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3309 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3310 the child process's @code{main}.
3311
3312 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3313 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3314
3315 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3316 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3317 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3318 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3319 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3320 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3321 command.
3322
3323 @table @code
3324 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3325 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3326
3327 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3328 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3329
3330 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3331
3332 @table @code
3333 @item new
3334 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3335 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3336 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3337 original inferior.
3338
3339 For example:
3340
3341 @smallexample
3342 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3343 (gdb) info inferior
3344 Id Description Executable
3345 * 1 <null> prog1
3346 (@value{GDBP}) run
3347 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3348 Program exited normally.
3349 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3350 Id Description Executable
3351 1 <null> prog1
3352 * 2 <null> prog2
3353 @end smallexample
3354
3355 @item same
3356 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3357 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3358 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3359 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3360 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3361
3362 For example:
3363
3364 @smallexample
3365 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3366 Id Description Executable
3367 * 1 <null> prog1
3368 (@value{GDBP}) run
3369 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3370 Program exited normally.
3371 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3372 Id Description Executable
3373 * 1 <null> prog2
3374 @end smallexample
3375
3376 @end table
3377 @end table
3378
3379 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3380 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3381
3382 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3383 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3384 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3385
3386 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3387 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3388
3389 @cindex checkpoint
3390 @cindex restart
3391 @cindex bookmark
3392 @cindex snapshot of a process
3393 @cindex rewind program state
3394
3395 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3396 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3397 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3398 later.
3399
3400 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3401 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3402 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3403 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3404 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3405
3406 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3407 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3408 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3409 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3410 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3411 start again from there.
3412
3413 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3414 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3415
3416 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3417
3418 @table @code
3419 @kindex checkpoint
3420 @item checkpoint
3421 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3422 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3423 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3424
3425 @kindex info checkpoints
3426 @item info checkpoints
3427 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3428 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3429 listed:
3430
3431 @table @code
3432 @item Checkpoint ID
3433 @item Process ID
3434 @item Code Address
3435 @item Source line, or label
3436 @end table
3437
3438 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3439 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3440 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3441 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3442 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3443 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3444 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3445
3446 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3447 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3448 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3449 the debugger.
3450
3451 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3452 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3453 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3454
3455 @end table
3456
3457 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3458 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3459 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3460 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3461 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3462 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3463 previously read data can be read again.
3464
3465 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3466 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3467 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3468 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3469 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3470 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3471
3472 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3473 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3474 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3475 different execution path this time.
3476
3477 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3478 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3479 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3480 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3481 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3482 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3483 potentially pose a problem.
3484
3485 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3486
3487 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3488 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3489 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3490 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3491 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3492 next.
3493
3494 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3495 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3496 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3497 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3498 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3499
3500 @node Stopping
3501 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3502
3503 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3504 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3505 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3506
3507 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3508 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3509 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3510 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3511 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3512 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3513 explicitly request this information at any time.
3514
3515 @table @code
3516 @kindex info program
3517 @item info program
3518 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3519 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3520 @end table
3521
3522 @menu
3523 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3524 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3525 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3526 Skipping over functions and files
3527 * Signals:: Signals
3528 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3529 @end menu
3530
3531 @node Breakpoints
3532 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3533
3534 @cindex breakpoints
3535 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3536 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3537 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3538 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3539 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3540 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3541 program.
3542
3543 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3544 the executable is run.
3545
3546 @cindex watchpoints
3547 @cindex data breakpoints
3548 @cindex memory tracing
3549 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3550 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3551 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3552 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3553 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3554 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3555 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3556 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3557 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3558 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3559 same commands.
3560
3561 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3562 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3563 Automatic Display}.
3564
3565 @cindex catchpoints
3566 @cindex breakpoint on events
3567 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3568 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3569 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3570 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3571 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3572 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3573 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3574
3575 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3576 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3577 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3578 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3579 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3580 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3581 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3582 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3583 enable it again.
3584
3585 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3586 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3587 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3588 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3589 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3590 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3591 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3592
3593 @menu
3594 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3595 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3596 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3597 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3598 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3599 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3600 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3601 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3602 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3603 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3604 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3605 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3606 @end menu
3607
3608 @node Set Breaks
3609 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3610
3611 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3612 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3613 @c
3614 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3615
3616 @kindex break
3617 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3618 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3619 @cindex latest breakpoint
3620 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3621 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3622 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3623 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3624 convenience variables.
3625
3626 @table @code
3627 @item break @var{location}
3628 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3629 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3630 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3631 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3632 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3633
3634 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3635 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3636 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3637 that situation.
3638
3639 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3640 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3641 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3642
3643 @item break
3644 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3645 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3646 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3647 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3648 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3649 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3650 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3651 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3652 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3653 inside loops.
3654
3655 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3656 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3657 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3658 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3659 existed when your program stopped.
3660
3661 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3662 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3663 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3664 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3665 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3666 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3667 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3668
3669 @kindex tbreak
3670 @item tbreak @var{args}
3671 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3672 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3673 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3674 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3675
3676 @kindex hbreak
3677 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3678 @item hbreak @var{args}
3679 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3680 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3681 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3682 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3683 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3684 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3685 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3686 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3687 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3688 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3689 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3690 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3691 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3692 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3693 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3694 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3695 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3696 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3697
3698 @kindex thbreak
3699 @item thbreak @var{args}
3700 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3701 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3702 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3703 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3704 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3705 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3706 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3707 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3708
3709 @kindex rbreak
3710 @cindex regular expression
3711 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3712 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3713 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3714 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3715 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3716 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3717 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3718 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3719 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3720
3721 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3722 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3723 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3724 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3725 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3726 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3727
3728 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3729 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3730 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3731 classes.
3732
3733 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3734 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3735 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3736
3737 @smallexample
3738 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3739 @end smallexample
3740
3741 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3742 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3743 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3744 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3745 every function in a given file:
3746
3747 @smallexample
3748 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3749 @end smallexample
3750
3751 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3752 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3753
3754 @kindex info breakpoints
3755 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3756 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3757 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3758 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3759 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3760 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3761 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3762
3763 @table @emph
3764 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3765 @item Type
3766 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3767 @item Disposition
3768 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3769 @item Enabled or Disabled
3770 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3771 that are not enabled.
3772 @item Address
3773 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3774 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3775 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3776 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3777 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3778 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3779 @item What
3780 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3781 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3782 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3783 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3784 @end table
3785
3786 @noindent
3787 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3788 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3789 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3790 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3791 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3792 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3793
3794 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3795 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3796 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3797 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3798
3799 @noindent
3800 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3801 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3802 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3803 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3804 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3805
3806 @noindent
3807 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3808 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3809 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3810 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3811 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3812 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3813
3814 @noindent
3815 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3816 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3817
3818 @end table
3819
3820 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3821 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3822 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3823 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3824
3825 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3826 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3827 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3828 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3829
3830 @itemize @bullet
3831 @item
3832 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3833
3834 @item
3835 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3836 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3837
3838 @item
3839 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3840 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3841
3842 @item
3843 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3844 several places where that function is inlined.
3845 @end itemize
3846
3847 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3848 the relevant locations.
3849
3850 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3851 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3852 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3853 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3854 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3855 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3856 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3857
3858 For example:
3859
3860 @smallexample
3861 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3862 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3863 stop only if i==1
3864 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3865 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3866 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3867 @end smallexample
3868
3869 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3870 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3871 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3872 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3873 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3874 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3875 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3876 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3877 that belong to that breakpoint.
3878
3879 @cindex pending breakpoints
3880 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3881 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3882 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3883 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3884 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3885 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3886 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3887 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3888 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3889 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3890 is not yet resolved.
3891
3892 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3893 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3894 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3895 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3896 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3897 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3898
3899 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3900 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3901 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3902 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3903
3904 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3905 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3906 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3907
3908 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3909 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3910 address specification to an address:
3911
3912 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3913 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3914 @table @code
3915 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3916 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3917 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3918
3919 @item set breakpoint pending on
3920 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3921 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3922
3923 @item set breakpoint pending off
3924 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3925 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3926 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3927
3928 @item show breakpoint pending
3929 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3930 @end table
3931
3932 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3933 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3934 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3935
3936 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3937 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3938 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3939 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3940 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3941 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3942 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3943 breakpoints.
3944
3945 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3946
3947 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3948 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3949 @table @code
3950 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3951 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3952 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3953 breakpoint must be used.
3954
3955 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3956 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3957 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3958 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3959 @end table
3960
3961 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3962 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3963 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3964 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3965 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3966 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3967 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3968 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3969 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3970
3971 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3972 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3973 @table @code
3974 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3975 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3976 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3977 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3978
3979 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3980 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3981 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3982 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3983 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3984 @end table
3985
3986 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3987 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3988 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3989
3990 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3991 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3992
3993 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3994
3995 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3996 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3997 @table @code
3998 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3999 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4000 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4001 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4002 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4003
4004 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4005 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4006 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4007 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4008 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4009 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4010 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4011 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4012 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4013 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4014 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4015 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4016 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4017
4018 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4019 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4020 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4021 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4022 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4023 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4024 @end table
4025
4026
4027 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4028 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4029 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4030 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4031 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4032 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4033 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4034 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4035
4036
4037 @node Set Watchpoints
4038 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4039
4040 @cindex setting watchpoints
4041 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4042 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4043 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4044 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4045 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4046
4047 @itemize @bullet
4048 @item
4049 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4050
4051 @item
4052 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4053 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4054 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4055
4056 @item
4057 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4058 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4059 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4060 @end itemize
4061
4062 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4063 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4064 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4065 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4066 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4067 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4068 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4069 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4070 the expression changes.
4071
4072 @cindex software watchpoints
4073 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4074 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4075 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4076 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4077 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4078 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4079 culprit.)
4080
4081 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4082 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4083 slow down the running of your program.
4084
4085 @table @code
4086 @kindex watch
4087 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4088 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4089 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4090 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4091 to watch the value of a single variable:
4092
4093 @smallexample
4094 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4095 @end smallexample
4096
4097 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4098 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4099 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4100 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4101 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4102 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4103
4104 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4105 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4106 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4107 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4108 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4109 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4110 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4111 error.
4112
4113 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4114 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4115 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4116 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4117 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4118 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4119 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4120 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4121 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4122 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4123 Examples:
4124
4125 @smallexample
4126 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4127 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4128 @end smallexample
4129
4130 @kindex rwatch
4131 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4132 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4133 by the program.
4134
4135 @kindex awatch
4136 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4137 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4138 or written into by the program.
4139
4140 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4141 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4142 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4143 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4144 @end table
4145
4146 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4147 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4148 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4149 a never-changing value:
4150
4151 @smallexample
4152 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4153 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4154 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4155 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4156 @end smallexample
4157
4158 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4159 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4160 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4161 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4162 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4163 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4164
4165 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4166 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4167 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4168 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4169 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4170 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4171 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4172 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4173
4174 @table @code
4175 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4176 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4177 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4178
4179 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4180 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4181 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4182 @end table
4183
4184 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4185 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4186 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4187
4188 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4189
4190 @smallexample
4191 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4192 @end smallexample
4193
4194 @noindent
4195 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4196
4197 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4198 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4199 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4200 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4201 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4202 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4203 will print a message like this:
4204
4205 @smallexample
4206 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4207 @end smallexample
4208
4209 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4210 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4211 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4212 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4213 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4214 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4215 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4216 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4217
4218 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4219 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4220 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4221 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4222 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4223 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4224
4225 @smallexample
4226 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4227 @end smallexample
4228
4229 @noindent
4230 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4231
4232 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4233 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4234 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4235 expression with separately allocated resources.
4236
4237 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4238 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4239 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4240
4241 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4242 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4243 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4244 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4245 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4246 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4247 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4248 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4249 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4250
4251 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4252 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4253 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4254 watched expression from every thread.
4255
4256 @quotation
4257 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4258 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4259 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4260 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4261 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4262 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4263 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4264 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4265 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4266 @end quotation
4267
4268 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4269
4270 @node Set Catchpoints
4271 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4272 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4273 @cindex exception handlers
4274 @cindex event handling
4275
4276 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4277 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4278 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4279
4280 @table @code
4281 @kindex catch
4282 @item catch @var{event}
4283 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4284
4285 @table @code
4286 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4287 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4288 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4289 @kindex catch throw
4290 @kindex catch rethrow
4291 @kindex catch catch
4292 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4293 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4294
4295 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4296 regular expression will be caught.
4297
4298 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4299 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4300 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4301 exception being thrown.
4302
4303 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4304 @value{GDBN}:
4305
4306 @itemize @bullet
4307 @item
4308 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4309 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4310 supported.
4311
4312 @item
4313 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4314 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4315 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4316 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4317 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4318 built.
4319
4320 @item
4321 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4322 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4323
4324 @item
4325 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4326 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4327 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4328 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4329
4330 @item
4331 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4332 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4333 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4334 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4335 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4336 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4337 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4338 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4339 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4340
4341 @item
4342 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4343
4344 @item
4345 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4346 @end itemize
4347
4348 @item exception
4349 @kindex catch exception
4350 @cindex Ada exception catching
4351 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4352 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4353 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4354 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4355 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4356
4357 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4358 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4359 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4360 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4361 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4362 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4363 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4364 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4365
4366 @item exception unhandled
4367 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4368 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4369
4370 @item assert
4371 @kindex catch assert
4372 A failed Ada assertion.
4373
4374 @item exec
4375 @kindex catch exec
4376 @cindex break on fork/exec
4377 A call to @code{exec}.
4378
4379 @item syscall
4380 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4381 @kindex catch syscall
4382 @cindex break on a system call.
4383 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4384 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4385 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4386 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4387 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4388 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4389 will be caught.
4390
4391 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4392 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4393 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4394 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4395
4396 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4397 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4398 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4399 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4400
4401 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4402 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4403 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4404 available choices.
4405
4406 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4407 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4408 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4409 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4410 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4411 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4412 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4413 behind the OS upgrades).
4414
4415 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4416 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4417 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4418 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4419 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4420 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4421 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4422 syscall groups available on your environment.
4423
4424 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4425 arguments to it:
4426
4427 @smallexample
4428 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4429 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4430 (@value{GDBP}) r
4431 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4432
4433 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4434 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4435 (@value{GDBP}) c
4436 Continuing.
4437
4438 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4439 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4440 (@value{GDBP})
4441 @end smallexample
4442
4443 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4444
4445 @smallexample
4446 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4447 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4448 (@value{GDBP}) r
4449 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4450
4451 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4452 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4453 (@value{GDBP}) c
4454 Continuing.
4455
4456 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4457 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4458 (@value{GDBP})
4459 @end smallexample
4460
4461 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4462 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4463 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4464
4465 @smallexample
4466 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4467 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4468 (@value{GDBP}) r
4469 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4470
4471 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4472 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4473 (@value{GDBP}) c
4474 Continuing.
4475
4476 Program exited normally.
4477 (@value{GDBP})
4478 @end smallexample
4479
4480 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4481
4482 @smallexample
4483 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4484 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4485 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4486 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4487 (@value{GDBP}) r
4488 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4489
4490 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4491 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4492
4493 (@value{GDBP}) c
4494 Continuing.
4495 @end smallexample
4496
4497 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4498 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4499 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4500 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4501
4502 @smallexample
4503 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4504 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4505 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4506 (@value{GDBP})
4507 @end smallexample
4508
4509 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4510 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4511 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4512 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4513 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4514 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4515
4516 @smallexample
4517 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4518 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4519 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4520 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4521 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4522 (@value{GDBP})
4523 @end smallexample
4524
4525 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4526
4527 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4528 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4529
4530 @smallexample
4531 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4532 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4533 @end smallexample
4534
4535 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4536
4537 @item fork
4538 @kindex catch fork
4539 A call to @code{fork}.
4540
4541 @item vfork
4542 @kindex catch vfork
4543 A call to @code{vfork}.
4544
4545 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4546 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4547 @kindex catch load
4548 @kindex catch unload
4549 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4550 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4551 matches one of the affected libraries.
4552
4553 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4554 @kindex catch signal
4555 The delivery of a signal.
4556
4557 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4558 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4559 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4560
4561 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4562 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4563 signal names.
4564
4565 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4566 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4567 will be caught.
4568
4569 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4570 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4571 catchpoint.
4572
4573 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4574 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4575 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4576 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4577 commands.
4578
4579 @end table
4580
4581 @item tcatch @var{event}
4582 @kindex tcatch
4583 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4584 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4585
4586 @end table
4587
4588 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4589
4590
4591 @node Delete Breaks
4592 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4593
4594 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4595 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4596 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4597 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4598 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4599 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4600
4601 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4602 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4603 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4604 their breakpoint numbers.
4605
4606 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4607 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4608 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4609
4610 @table @code
4611 @kindex clear
4612 @item clear
4613 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4614 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4615 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4616 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4617
4618 @item clear @var{location}
4619 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4620 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4621 most useful ones are listed below:
4622
4623 @table @code
4624 @item clear @var{function}
4625 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4626 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4627
4628 @item clear @var{linenum}
4629 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4630 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4631 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4632 @end table
4633
4634 @cindex delete breakpoints
4635 @kindex delete
4636 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4637 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4638 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4639 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4640 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4641 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4642 @end table
4643
4644 @node Disabling
4645 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4646
4647 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4648 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4649 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4650 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4651 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4652
4653 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4654 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4655 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4656 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4657 do not know which numbers to use.
4658
4659 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4660 affects all of its locations.
4661
4662 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4663 different states of enablement:
4664
4665 @itemize @bullet
4666 @item
4667 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4668 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4669 @item
4670 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4671 @item
4672 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4673 disabled.
4674 @item
4675 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4676 N times, then becomes disabled.
4677 @item
4678 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4679 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4680 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4681 @end itemize
4682
4683 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4684 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4685
4686 @table @code
4687 @kindex disable
4688 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4689 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4690 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4691 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4692 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4693 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4694 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4695
4696 @kindex enable
4697 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4698 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4699 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4700
4701 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4702 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4703 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4704
4705 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4706 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4707 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4708 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4709 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4710 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4711 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4712
4713 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4714 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4715 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4716 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4717 @end table
4718
4719 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4720 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4721 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4722 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4723 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4724 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4725 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4726 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4727 Stepping}.)
4728
4729 @node Conditions
4730 @subsection Break Conditions
4731 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4732 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4733
4734 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4735 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4736 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4737 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4738 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4739 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4740 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4741 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4742
4743 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4744 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4745 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4746 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4747 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4748
4749 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4750 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4751 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4752 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4753 one.
4754
4755 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4756 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4757 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4758 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4759 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4760 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4761 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4762 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4763 conditions for the
4764 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4765 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4766
4767 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4768 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4769 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4770 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4771 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4772 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4773
4774 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4775 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4776 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4777 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4778 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4779
4780 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4781 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4782 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4783 with the @code{condition} command.
4784
4785 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4786 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4787 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4788 catchpoint.
4789
4790 @table @code
4791 @kindex condition
4792 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4793 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4794 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4795 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4796 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4797 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4798 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4799 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4800 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4801 prints an error message:
4802
4803 @smallexample
4804 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4805 @end smallexample
4806
4807 @noindent
4808 @value{GDBN} does
4809 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4810 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4811 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4812
4813 @item condition @var{bnum}
4814 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4815 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4816 @end table
4817
4818 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4819 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4820 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4821 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4822 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4823 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4824 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4825 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4826 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4827 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4828 your program reaches it.
4829
4830 @table @code
4831 @kindex ignore
4832 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4833 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4834 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4835 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4836 takes no action.
4837
4838 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4839 a count of zero.
4840
4841 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4842 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4843 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4844 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4845
4846 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4847 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4848 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4849
4850 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4851 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4852 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4853 Variables}.
4854 @end table
4855
4856 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4857
4858
4859 @node Break Commands
4860 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4861
4862 @cindex breakpoint commands
4863 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4864 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4865 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4866 enable other breakpoints.
4867
4868 @table @code
4869 @kindex commands
4870 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4871 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4872 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4873 @itemx end
4874 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4875 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4876 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4877
4878 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4879 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4880
4881 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4882 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4883 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4884 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4885 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4886 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4887 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4888 Expressions}).
4889 @end table
4890
4891 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4892 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4893
4894 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4895 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4896 that resumes execution.
4897
4898 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4899 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4900 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4901 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4902 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4903
4904 @kindex silent
4905 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4906 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4907 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4908 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4909 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4910 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4911
4912 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4913 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4914 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4915
4916 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4917 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4918
4919 @smallexample
4920 break foo if x>0
4921 commands
4922 silent
4923 printf "x is %d\n",x
4924 cont
4925 end
4926 @end smallexample
4927
4928 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4929 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4930 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4931 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4932 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4933 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4934 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4935
4936 @smallexample
4937 break 403
4938 commands
4939 silent
4940 set x = y + 4
4941 cont
4942 end
4943 @end smallexample
4944
4945 @node Dynamic Printf
4946 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4947
4948 @cindex dynamic printf
4949 @cindex dprintf
4950 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4951 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4952 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4953 having to recompile it.
4954
4955 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4956 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4957 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4958 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4959 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4960 redirects to files and so forth.
4961
4962 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4963 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4964 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4965 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4966 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4967 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4968 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4969
4970 @table @code
4971 @kindex dprintf
4972 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4973 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4974 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4975 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4976
4977 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4978 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4979 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4980 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4981 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4982 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4983
4984 @item gdb
4985 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4986 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4987
4988 @item call
4989 @kindex dprintf-style call
4990 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4991 @code{printf}).
4992
4993 @item agent
4994 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4995 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4996 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4997 support running commands on the target.
4998
4999 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5000 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5001 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5002 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5003 command.
5004
5005 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5006 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5007 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5008 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5009 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5010 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5011
5012 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5013 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5014 you could do the following:
5015
5016 @example
5017 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5018 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5019 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5020 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5021 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5022 (gdb) info break
5023 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5024 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5025 continue
5026 (gdb)
5027 @end example
5028
5029 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5030 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5031 the variable settings.
5032
5033 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5034 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5035 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5036 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5037 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5038 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5039
5040 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5041 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5042 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5043
5044 @end table
5045
5046 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5047 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5048 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5049 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5050 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5051 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5052
5053 @node Save Breakpoints
5054 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5055
5056 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5057 breakpoints}} command.
5058
5059 @table @code
5060 @kindex save breakpoints
5061 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5062 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5063 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5064 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5065 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5066 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5067 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5068 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5069 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5070 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5071 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5072 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5073 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5074 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5075 that can no longer be recreated.
5076 @end table
5077
5078 @node Static Probe Points
5079 @subsection Static Probe Points
5080
5081 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5082 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5083 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5084 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5085 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5086
5087 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5088 ELF-compatible systems:
5089
5090 @itemize @bullet
5091
5092 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5093 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5094 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5095 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5096 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5097 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5098 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5099 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5100
5101 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5102 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5103 C@t{++} languages.
5104 @end itemize
5105
5106 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5107 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5108 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5109 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5110 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5111 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5112 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5113 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5114 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5115
5116 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5117 probes}, with optional arguments:
5118
5119 @table @code
5120 @kindex info probes
5121 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5122 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5123 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5124 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5125
5126 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5127 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5128 probes from all providers are listed.
5129
5130 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5131 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5132 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5133
5134 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5135 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5136 given, all object files are considered.
5137
5138 @item info probes all
5139 List the available static probes, from all types.
5140 @end table
5141
5142 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5143 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5144 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5145 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5146 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5147
5148 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5149 commands, with optional arguments:
5150
5151 @table @code
5152 @kindex enable probes
5153 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5154 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5155 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5156 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5157
5158 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5159 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5160 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5161
5162 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5163 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5164 given, all object files are considered.
5165
5166 @kindex disable probes
5167 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5168 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5169 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5170 @end table
5171
5172 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5173 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5174 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5175 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5176 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5177 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5178 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5179 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5180 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5181 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5182 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5183 at the current probe point.
5184
5185 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5186 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5187 an error message.
5188
5189
5190 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5191 @node Error in Breakpoints
5192 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5193
5194 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5195 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5196
5197 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5198 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5199 @smallexample
5200 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5201 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5202 @end smallexample
5203
5204 @noindent
5205 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5206 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5207 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5208
5209 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5210 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5211
5212 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5213 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5214 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5215
5216 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5217 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5218 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5219 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5220
5221 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5222 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5223 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5224 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5225 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5226 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5227 first in the bundle.
5228
5229 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5230 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5231 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5232 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5233 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5234 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5235 is hit.
5236
5237 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5238 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5239
5240 @smallexample
5241 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5242 @end smallexample
5243
5244 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5245 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5246 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5247 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5248 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5249 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5250 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5251 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5252
5253 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5254 adjusted breakpoints:
5255
5256 @smallexample
5257 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5258 to 0x00010410.
5259 @end smallexample
5260
5261 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5262 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5263 frequently than expected.
5264
5265 @node Continuing and Stepping
5266 @section Continuing and Stepping
5267
5268 @cindex stepping
5269 @cindex continuing
5270 @cindex resuming execution
5271 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5272 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5273 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5274 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5275 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5276 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5277 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5278 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5279 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5280 handlers}).)
5281
5282 @table @code
5283 @kindex continue
5284 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5285 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5286 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5287 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5288 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5289 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5290 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5291 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5292 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5293 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5294
5295 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5296 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5297 @code{continue} is ignored.
5298
5299 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5300 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5301 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5302 @code{continue}.
5303 @end table
5304
5305 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5306 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5307 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5308 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5309
5310 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5311 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5312 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5313 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5314 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5315 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5316
5317 @table @code
5318 @kindex step
5319 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5320 @item step
5321 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5322 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5323 abbreviated @code{s}.
5324
5325 @quotation
5326 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5327 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5328 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5329 @c distinction here.
5330 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5331 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5332 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5333 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5334 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5335 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5336 below.
5337 @end quotation
5338
5339 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5340 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5341 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5342 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5343 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5344 called within the line.
5345
5346 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5347 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5348 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5349 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5350 was any debugging information about the routine.
5351
5352 @item step @var{count}
5353 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5354 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5355 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5356
5357 @kindex next
5358 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5359 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5360 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5361 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5362 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5363 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5364 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5365 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5366
5367 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5368
5369
5370 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5371 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5372 @c
5373 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5374 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5375 @c function are executed without stopping.
5376
5377 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5378 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5379 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5380
5381 @kindex set step-mode
5382 @item set step-mode
5383 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5384 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5385 @itemx set step-mode on
5386 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5387 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5388 information rather than stepping over it.
5389
5390 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5391 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5392 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5393
5394 @item set step-mode off
5395 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5396 debug information. This is the default.
5397
5398 @item show step-mode
5399 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5400 source line debug information.
5401
5402 @kindex finish
5403 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5404 @item finish
5405 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5406 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5407 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5408
5409 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5410 ,Returning from a Function}).
5411
5412 @kindex until
5413 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5414 @cindex run until specified location
5415 @item until
5416 @itemx u
5417 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5418 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5419 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5420 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5421 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5422 than the address of the jump.
5423
5424 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5425 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5426 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5427 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5428 through the next iteration.
5429
5430 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5431 stack frame.
5432
5433 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5434 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5435 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5436 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5437 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5438
5439 @smallexample
5440 (@value{GDBP}) f
5441 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5442 206 expand_input();
5443 (@value{GDBP}) until
5444 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5445 @end smallexample
5446
5447 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5448 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5449 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5450 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5451 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5452 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5453 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5454
5455 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5456 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5457 argument.
5458
5459 @item until @var{location}
5460 @itemx u @var{location}
5461 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5462 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5463 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5464 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5465 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5466 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5467 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5468 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5469 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5470 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5471 invocations have returned.
5472
5473 @smallexample
5474 94 int factorial (int value)
5475 95 @{
5476 96 if (value > 1) @{
5477 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5478 98 @}
5479 99 return (value);
5480 100 @}
5481 @end smallexample
5482
5483
5484 @kindex advance @var{location}
5485 @item advance @var{location}
5486 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5487 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5488 @ref{Specify Location}.
5489 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5490 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5491 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5492 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5493
5494
5495 @kindex stepi
5496 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5497 @item stepi
5498 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5499 @itemx si
5500 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5501
5502 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5503 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5504 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5505 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5506
5507 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5508
5509 @need 750
5510 @kindex nexti
5511 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5512 @item nexti
5513 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5514 @itemx ni
5515 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5516 proceed until the function returns.
5517
5518 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5519
5520 @end table
5521
5522 @anchor{range stepping}
5523 @cindex range stepping
5524 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5525 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5526 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5527 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5528 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5529 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5530 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5531 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5532 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5533 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5534 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5535 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5536 if necessary:
5537
5538 @table @code
5539 @kindex set range-stepping
5540 @kindex show range-stepping
5541 @item set range-stepping
5542 @itemx show range-stepping
5543 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5544
5545 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5546 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5547 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5548 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5549 default is @code{on}.
5550
5551 @end table
5552
5553 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5554 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5555 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5556
5557 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5558 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5559 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5560 a particular file when stepping.
5561
5562 For example, consider the following C function:
5563
5564 @smallexample
5565 101 int func()
5566 102 @{
5567 103 foo(boring());
5568 104 bar(boring());
5569 105 @}
5570 @end smallexample
5571
5572 @noindent
5573 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5574 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5575 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5576 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5577
5578 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5579 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5580 is called from many places.
5581
5582 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5583 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5584 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5585 @code{foo}.
5586
5587 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5588 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5589 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5590
5591 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5592 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5593 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5594 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5595 the underlying system.
5596 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5597 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5598
5599 @table @code
5600 @kindex skip
5601 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5602 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5603 that specify what to skip.
5604 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5605
5606 @table @code
5607 @item -file @var{file}
5608 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5609 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5610
5611 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5612 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5613 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5614 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5615 over when stepping.
5616
5617 @smallexample
5618 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5619 @end smallexample
5620
5621 @item -function @var{linespec}
5622 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5623 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5624 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5625 @xref{Specify Location}.
5626
5627 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5628 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5629 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5630 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5631
5632 This form is useful for complex function names.
5633 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5634 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5635 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5636 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5637 regular expression makes this easier.
5638
5639 @smallexample
5640 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5641 @end smallexample
5642
5643 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5644 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5645
5646 @smallexample
5647 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5648 @end smallexample
5649 @end table
5650
5651 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5652 will be skipped.
5653
5654 @kindex skip function
5655 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5656 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5657 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5658 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5659
5660 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5661 will be skipped.
5662
5663 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5664 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5665
5666 @kindex skip file
5667 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5668 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5669 will be skipped over when stepping.
5670
5671 @smallexample
5672 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5673 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5674 @end smallexample
5675
5676 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5677 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5678 @end table
5679
5680 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5681 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5682
5683 @table @code
5684 @kindex info skip
5685 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5686 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5687 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5688 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5689
5690 @table @emph
5691 @item Identifier
5692 A number identifying this skip.
5693 @item Enabled or Disabled
5694 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5695 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5696 @item Glob
5697 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5698 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5699 @item File
5700 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5701 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5702 @item RE
5703 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5704 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5705 @item Function
5706 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5707 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5708 @end table
5709
5710 @kindex skip delete
5711 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5712 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5713 skips.
5714
5715 @kindex skip enable
5716 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5717 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5718 skips.
5719
5720 @kindex skip disable
5721 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5722 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5723 skips.
5724
5725 @end table
5726
5727 @node Signals
5728 @section Signals
5729 @cindex signals
5730
5731 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5732 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5733 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5734 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5735 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5736 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5737 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5738 requested an alarm).
5739
5740 @cindex fatal signals
5741 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5742 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5743 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5744 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5745 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5746 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5747
5748 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5749 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5750 signal.
5751
5752 @cindex handling signals
5753 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5754 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5755 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5756 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5757 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5758
5759 @table @code
5760 @kindex info signals
5761 @kindex info handle
5762 @item info signals
5763 @itemx info handle
5764 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5765 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5766 the defined types of signals.
5767
5768 @item info signals @var{sig}
5769 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5770
5771 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5772
5773 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5774 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5775 for details about this command.
5776
5777 @kindex handle
5778 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5779 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5780 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5781 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5782 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5783 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5784 say what change to make.
5785 @end table
5786
5787 @c @group
5788 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5789 Their full names are:
5790
5791 @table @code
5792 @item nostop
5793 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5794 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5795
5796 @item stop
5797 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5798 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5799
5800 @item print
5801 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5802
5803 @item noprint
5804 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5805 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5806
5807 @item pass
5808 @itemx noignore
5809 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5810 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5811 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5812
5813 @item nopass
5814 @itemx ignore
5815 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5816 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5817 @end table
5818 @c @end group
5819
5820 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5821 program until you
5822 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5823 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5824 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5825 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5826 program sees that signal when you continue.
5827
5828 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5829 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5830 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5831 erroneous signals.
5832
5833 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5834 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5835 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5836 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5837 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5838 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5839 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5840 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5841 Program a Signal}.
5842
5843 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5844 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5845
5846 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5847 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5848 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5849 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5850 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5851 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5852 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5853 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5854 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5855 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5856 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5857 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5858 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5859
5860 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5861
5862 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5863 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5864 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5865 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5866
5867 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5868 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5869 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5870 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5871
5872 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5873 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5874
5875 @smallexample
5876 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5877 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5878 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5879 (@value{GDBP}) c
5880 Continuing.
5881
5882 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5883 main () sigusr1.c:28
5884 28 p = 0;
5885 (@value{GDBP}) si
5886 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5887 9 @{
5888 @end smallexample
5889
5890 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5891 program to receive the signal first:
5892
5893 @smallexample
5894 (@value{GDBP}) n
5895 28 p = 0;
5896 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5897 (@value{GDBP}) si
5898 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5899 9 @{
5900 (@value{GDBP})
5901 @end smallexample
5902
5903 @cindex extra signal information
5904 @anchor{extra signal information}
5905
5906 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5907 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5908 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5909 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5910 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5911 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5912 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5913 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5914 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5915 system header.
5916
5917 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5918 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5919
5920 @smallexample
5921 @group
5922 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5923 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5924 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5925 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5926 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5927 type = struct @{
5928 int si_signo;
5929 int si_errno;
5930 int si_code;
5931 union @{
5932 int _pad[28];
5933 struct @{...@} _kill;
5934 struct @{...@} _timer;
5935 struct @{...@} _rt;
5936 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5937 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5938 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5939 @} _sifields;
5940 @}
5941 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5942 type = struct @{
5943 void *si_addr;
5944 @}
5945 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5946 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5947 @end group
5948 @end smallexample
5949
5950 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5951
5952 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
5953 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
5954 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
5955 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
5956 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
5957 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
5958 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
5959 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
5960 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
5961 information is displayed.
5962
5963 The usual output of a segfault is:
5964 @smallexample
5965 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5966 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5967 68 value = *(p + len);
5968 @end smallexample
5969
5970 While a bound violation is presented as:
5971 @smallexample
5972 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5973 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
5974 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
5975 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5976 68 value = *(p + len);
5977 @end smallexample
5978
5979 @node Thread Stops
5980 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5981
5982 @cindex stopped threads
5983 @cindex threads, stopped
5984
5985 @cindex continuing threads
5986 @cindex threads, continuing
5987
5988 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5989 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5990 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5991 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5992 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5993 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5994 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5995 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5996 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5997
5998 @menu
5999 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6000 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6001 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6002 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6003 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6004 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6005 @end menu
6006
6007 @node All-Stop Mode
6008 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6009
6010 @cindex all-stop mode
6011
6012 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6013 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6014 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6015 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6016 underfoot.
6017
6018 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6019 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6020 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6021
6022 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6023 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6024 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6025 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6026 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6027 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6028 stops.
6029
6030 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6031 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6032 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6033 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6034
6035 @cindex automatic thread selection
6036 @cindex switching threads automatically
6037 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6038 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6039 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6040 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6041 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6042 thread.
6043
6044 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6045 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6046
6047 @table @code
6048 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6049 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6050 @cindex lock scheduler
6051 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6052 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6053 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6054 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6055 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6056 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6057 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6058 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6059 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6060 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6061 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6062 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6063 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6064 @code{on} in replay mode.
6065
6066 @item show scheduler-locking
6067 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6068 @end table
6069
6070 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6071 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6072 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6073 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6074 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6075 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6076 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6077 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6078 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6079 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6080 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6081 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6082 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6083 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6084
6085 @table @code
6086 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6087 @item set schedule-multiple
6088 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6089 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6090 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6091 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6092 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6093 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6094
6095 @item show schedule-multiple
6096 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6097 multiple processes.
6098 @end table
6099
6100 @node Non-Stop Mode
6101 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6102
6103 @cindex non-stop mode
6104
6105 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6106 @c with more details.
6107
6108 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6109 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6110 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6111 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6112 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6113 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6114
6115 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6116 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6117 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6118 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6119 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6120 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6121 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6122 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6123 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6124 independently and simultaneously.
6125
6126 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6127 or attach to your program:
6128
6129 @smallexample
6130 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6131 set pagination off
6132
6133 # Finally, turn it on!
6134 set non-stop on
6135 @end smallexample
6136
6137 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6138
6139 @table @code
6140 @kindex set non-stop
6141 @item set non-stop on
6142 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6143 @item set non-stop off
6144 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6145 @kindex show non-stop
6146 @item show non-stop
6147 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6148 @end table
6149
6150 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6151 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6152 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6153 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6154 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6155 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6156 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6157 default.
6158
6159 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6160 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6161 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6162
6163 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6164 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6165 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6166 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6167 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6168
6169 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6170 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6171 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6172 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6173 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6174
6175 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6176
6177 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6178 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6179 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6180 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6181 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6182 previously current thread.
6183
6184 @node Background Execution
6185 @subsection Background Execution
6186
6187 @cindex foreground execution
6188 @cindex background execution
6189 @cindex asynchronous execution
6190 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6191
6192 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6193 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6194 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6195 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6196 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6197 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6198
6199 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6200 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6201
6202 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6203 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6204 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6205 are:
6206
6207 @table @code
6208 @kindex run&
6209 @item run
6210 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6211
6212 @item attach
6213 @kindex attach&
6214 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6215
6216 @item step
6217 @kindex step&
6218 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6219
6220 @item stepi
6221 @kindex stepi&
6222 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6223
6224 @item next
6225 @kindex next&
6226 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6227
6228 @item nexti
6229 @kindex nexti&
6230 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6231
6232 @item continue
6233 @kindex continue&
6234 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6235
6236 @item finish
6237 @kindex finish&
6238 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6239
6240 @item until
6241 @kindex until&
6242 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6243
6244 @end table
6245
6246 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6247 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6248 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6249 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6250 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6251 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6252
6253 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6254 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6255
6256 @table @code
6257 @kindex interrupt
6258 @item interrupt
6259 @itemx interrupt -a
6260
6261 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6262 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6263 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6264 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6265 @end table
6266
6267 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6268 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6269
6270 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6271 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6272 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6273
6274 @table @code
6275 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6276 @cindex thread breakpoints
6277 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6278 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6279 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6280 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6281 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6282 specify some source line.
6283
6284 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6285 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6286 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6287 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6288 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6289
6290 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6291 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6292 program.
6293
6294 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6295 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6296 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6297
6298 @smallexample
6299 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6300 @end smallexample
6301
6302 @end table
6303
6304 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6305 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6306 thread list. For example:
6307
6308 @smallexample
6309 (@value{GDBP}) c
6310 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6311 @end smallexample
6312
6313 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6314 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6315 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6316 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6317 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6318 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6319 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6320 command.
6321
6322 @node Interrupted System Calls
6323 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6324
6325 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6326 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6327 @cindex premature return from system calls
6328 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6329 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6330 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6331 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6332 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6333 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6334 stop execution.
6335
6336 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6337 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6338 style anyways.
6339
6340 For example, do not write code like this:
6341
6342 @smallexample
6343 sleep (10);
6344 @end smallexample
6345
6346 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6347 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6348
6349 Instead, write this:
6350
6351 @smallexample
6352 int unslept = 10;
6353 while (unslept > 0)
6354 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6355 @end smallexample
6356
6357 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6358 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6359 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6360 @value{GDBN}.
6361
6362 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6363 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6364 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6365 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6366
6367 @node Observer Mode
6368 @subsection Observer Mode
6369
6370 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6371 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6372 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6373 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6374 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6375
6376 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6377 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6378 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6379 mode.
6380
6381 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6382 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6383 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6384 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6385 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6386
6387 @table @code
6388
6389 @kindex observer
6390 @item set observer on
6391 @itemx set observer off
6392 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6393 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6394 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6395 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6396
6397 @item show observer
6398 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6399
6400 @kindex may-write-registers
6401 @item set may-write-registers on
6402 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6403 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6404 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6405 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6406
6407 @item show may-write-registers
6408 Show the current permission to write registers.
6409
6410 @kindex may-write-memory
6411 @item set may-write-memory on
6412 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6413 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6414 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6415 defaults to @code{on}.
6416
6417 @item show may-write-memory
6418 Show the current permission to write memory.
6419
6420 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6421 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6422 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6423 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6424 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6425 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6426
6427 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6428 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6429
6430 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6431 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6432 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6433 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6434 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6435 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6436 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6437
6438 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6439 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6440
6441 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6442 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6443 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6444 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6445 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6446 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6447 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6448
6449 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6450 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6451
6452 @kindex may-interrupt
6453 @item set may-interrupt on
6454 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6455 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6456 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6457 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6458 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6459
6460 @item show may-interrupt
6461 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6462
6463 @end table
6464
6465 @node Reverse Execution
6466 @chapter Running programs backward
6467 @cindex reverse execution
6468 @cindex running programs backward
6469
6470 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6471 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6472 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6473 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6474
6475 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6476 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6477 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6478 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6479 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6480 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6481
6482 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6483 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6484 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6485 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6486 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6487 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6488 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6489 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6490 prior values@footnote{
6491 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6492 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6493 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6494
6495 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6496 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6497 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6498 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6499 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6500 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6501 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6502 }.
6503
6504 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6505 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6506
6507 @table @code
6508 @kindex reverse-continue
6509 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6510 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6511 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6512 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6513 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6514 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6515 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6516
6517 @kindex reverse-step
6518 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6519 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6520 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6521 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6522
6523 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6524 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6525 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6526 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6527 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6528 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6529
6530 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6531 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6532
6533 @kindex reverse-stepi
6534 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6535 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6536 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6537 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6538 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6539 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6540 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6541
6542 @kindex reverse-next
6543 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6544 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6545 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6546 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6547 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6548 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6549 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6550 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6551 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6552 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6553
6554 @kindex reverse-nexti
6555 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6556 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6557 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6558 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6559 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6560 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6561 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6562 frame) is reached.
6563
6564 @kindex reverse-finish
6565 @item reverse-finish
6566 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6567 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6568 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6569 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6570
6571 @kindex set exec-direction
6572 @item set exec-direction
6573 Set the direction of target execution.
6574 @item set exec-direction reverse
6575 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6576 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6577 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6578 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6579 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6580 @item set exec-direction forward
6581 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6582 This is the default.
6583 @end table
6584
6585
6586 @node Process Record and Replay
6587 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6588 @cindex process record and replay
6589 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6590
6591 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6592 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6593 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6594
6595 @cindex replay mode
6596 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6597 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6598 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6599 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6600 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6601 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6602 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6603 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6604 execution log.
6605
6606 @cindex record mode
6607 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6608 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6609 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6610 for future replay.
6611
6612 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6613 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6614 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6615 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6616 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6617 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6618
6619 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6620 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6621 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6622 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6623
6624 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6625 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6626
6627 @table @code
6628 @kindex target record
6629 @kindex target record-full
6630 @kindex target record-btrace
6631 @kindex record
6632 @kindex record full
6633 @kindex record btrace
6634 @kindex record btrace bts
6635 @kindex record btrace pt
6636 @kindex record bts
6637 @kindex record pt
6638 @kindex rec
6639 @kindex rec full
6640 @kindex rec btrace
6641 @kindex rec btrace bts
6642 @kindex rec btrace pt
6643 @kindex rec bts
6644 @kindex rec pt
6645 @item record @var{method}
6646 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6647 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6648 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6649 recording methods are available:
6650
6651 @table @code
6652 @item full
6653 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6654 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6655 execution.
6656
6657 @item btrace @var{format}
6658 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6659 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6660 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6661 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6662 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6663 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6664 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6665
6666 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6667 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6668 formats are available:
6669
6670 @table @code
6671 @item bts
6672 @cindex branch trace store
6673 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6674 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6675 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6676
6677 @item pt
6678 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6679 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6680 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6681 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6682
6683 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6684 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6685 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6686
6687 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6688 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6689 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6690 buffer-size with care.
6691 @end table
6692
6693 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6694 @end table
6695
6696 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6697 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6698 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6699 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6700
6701 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6702 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6703 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6704 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6705 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6706
6707 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6708 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6709 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6710 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6711 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6712 does not support these two modes.
6713
6714 @kindex record stop
6715 @kindex rec s
6716 @item record stop
6717 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6718 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6719 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6720
6721 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6722 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6723 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6724 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6725 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6726
6727 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6728 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6729 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6730 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6731 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6732
6733 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6734 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6735
6736 @kindex record goto
6737 @item record goto
6738 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6739 ways to specify the location to go to:
6740
6741 @table @code
6742 @item record goto begin
6743 @itemx record goto start
6744 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6745
6746 @item record goto end
6747 Go to the end of the execution log.
6748
6749 @item record goto @var{n}
6750 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6751 @end table
6752
6753 @kindex record save
6754 @item record save @var{filename}
6755 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6756 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6757 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6758
6759 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6760
6761 @kindex record restore
6762 @item record restore @var{filename}
6763 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6764 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6765
6766 @kindex set record full
6767 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6768 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6769 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6770 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6771
6772 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6773 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6774 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6775 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6776 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6777 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6778 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6779 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6780
6781 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6782 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6783 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6784
6785 @kindex show record full
6786 @item show record full insn-number-max
6787 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6788 recording method.
6789
6790 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6791 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6792 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6793 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6794 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6795 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6796 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6797 oldest one to be deleted.
6798
6799 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6800 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6801
6802 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6803 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6804
6805 @item set record full memory-query
6806 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6807 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6808 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6809 case.
6810
6811 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6812 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6813 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6814 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6815 results.
6816
6817 @item show record full memory-query
6818 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6819
6820 @kindex set record btrace
6821 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6822 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6823 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6824 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6825 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6826 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6827 You can use the following command for that:
6828
6829 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6830 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6831 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6832 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6833 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6834 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6835 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6836 position.
6837
6838 @kindex show record btrace
6839 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6840 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6841
6842 @kindex set record btrace bts
6843 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6844 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6845 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6846 format. Default is 64KB.
6847
6848 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6849 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6850 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6851 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6852 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6853 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6854 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6855
6856 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6857 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6858
6859 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6860 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6861
6862 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6863 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6864 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6865
6866 @kindex set record btrace pt
6867 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6868 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6869 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6870 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6871
6872 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6873 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6874 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6875 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6876 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6877 actual buffer size for each thread.
6878
6879 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6880 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6881
6882 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6883 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6884
6885 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6886 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6887 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6888
6889 @kindex info record
6890 @item info record
6891 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6892 method:
6893
6894 @table @code
6895 @item full
6896 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6897 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6898
6899 @itemize @bullet
6900 @item
6901 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6902 @item
6903 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6904 @item
6905 Highest recorded instruction number.
6906 @item
6907 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6908 @item
6909 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6910 @item
6911 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6912 @end itemize
6913
6914 @item btrace
6915 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6916
6917 @itemize @bullet
6918 @item
6919 Recording format.
6920 @item
6921 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6922 @item
6923 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6924 instructions.
6925 @item
6926 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6927 @end itemize
6928
6929 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6930 @itemize @bullet
6931 @item
6932 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6933 @end itemize
6934
6935 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6936 @itemize @bullet
6937 @item
6938 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6939 @end itemize
6940 @end table
6941
6942 @kindex record delete
6943 @kindex rec del
6944 @item record delete
6945 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6946 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6947 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6948 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6949
6950 @kindex record instruction-history
6951 @kindex rec instruction-history
6952 @item record instruction-history
6953 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6954 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6955 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6956 are printed in execution order.
6957
6958 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
6959 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
6960 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
6961
6962 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
6963 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
6964 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
6965 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
6966 @code{/p} modifier.
6967
6968 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
6969 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
6970 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
6971
6972 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
6973 feature is not available for all recording formats.
6974
6975 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
6976 disassemble:
6977
6978 @table @code
6979 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6980 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6981 @var{insn}.
6982
6983 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6984 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6985 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6986 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6987 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6988 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6989
6990 @item record instruction-history
6991 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6992
6993 @item record instruction-history -
6994 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6995
6996 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
6997 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6998 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6999 number @var{end} is included.
7000 @end table
7001
7002 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7003
7004 @kindex set record
7005 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7006 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7007 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7008 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7009 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7010
7011 @kindex show record
7012 @item show record instruction-history-size
7013 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7014 instruction-history} command.
7015
7016 @kindex record function-call-history
7017 @kindex rec function-call-history
7018 @item record function-call-history
7019 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7020 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7021 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7022 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7023 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7024 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7025 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7026 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7027 given together.
7028
7029 @smallexample
7030 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7031 1 void foo (void)
7032 2 @{
7033 3 @}
7034 4
7035 5 void bar (void)
7036 6 @{
7037 7 ...
7038 8 foo ();
7039 9 ...
7040 10 @}
7041 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7042 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7043 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7044 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7045 @end smallexample
7046
7047 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7048 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7049 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7050 to print:
7051
7052 @table @code
7053 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7054 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7055
7056 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7057 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7058 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7059 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7060 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7061
7062 @item record function-call-history
7063 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7064
7065 @item record function-call-history -
7066 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7067
7068 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7069 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7070 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7071 @end table
7072
7073 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7074
7075 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7076 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7077 Define how many lines to print in the
7078 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7079 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7080
7081 @item show record function-call-history-size
7082 Show how many lines to print in the
7083 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7084 @end table
7085
7086
7087 @node Stack
7088 @chapter Examining the Stack
7089
7090 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7091 stopped and how it got there.
7092
7093 @cindex call stack
7094 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7095 is generated.
7096 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7097 the arguments of the call,
7098 and the local variables of the function being called.
7099 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7100 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7101 stack}.
7102
7103 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7104 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7105
7106 @cindex selected frame
7107 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7108 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7109 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7110 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7111 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7112 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7113
7114 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7115 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7116 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7117
7118 @menu
7119 * Frames:: Stack frames
7120 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7121 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7122 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7123 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7124
7125 @end menu
7126
7127 @node Frames
7128 @section Stack Frames
7129
7130 @cindex frame, definition
7131 @cindex stack frame
7132 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7133 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7134 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7135 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7136 which the function is executing.
7137
7138 @cindex initial frame
7139 @cindex outermost frame
7140 @cindex innermost frame
7141 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7142 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7143 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7144 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7145 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7146 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7147 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7148 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7149
7150 @cindex frame pointer
7151 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7152 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7153 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7154 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7155 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7156 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7157
7158 @cindex frame number
7159 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7160 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7161 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7162 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7163 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7164
7165 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7166 @c underflow problems.
7167 @cindex frameless execution
7168 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7169 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7170 @smallexample
7171 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7172 @end smallexample
7173 generates functions without a frame.)
7174 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7175 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7176 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7177 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7178 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7179 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7180 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7181
7182 @node Backtrace
7183 @section Backtraces
7184
7185 @cindex traceback
7186 @cindex call stack traces
7187 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7188 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7189 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7190 stack.
7191
7192 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7193 @table @code
7194 @kindex backtrace
7195 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7196 @item backtrace
7197 @itemx bt
7198 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7199 frames in the stack.
7200
7201 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7202 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7203
7204 @item backtrace @var{n}
7205 @itemx bt @var{n}
7206 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7207
7208 @item backtrace -@var{n}
7209 @itemx bt -@var{n}
7210 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7211
7212 @item backtrace full
7213 @itemx bt full
7214 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7215 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7216 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7217 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7218
7219 @item backtrace no-filters
7220 @itemx bt no-filters
7221 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7222 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7223 @itemx bt no-filters full
7224 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7225 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7226 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7227 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7228 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7229 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7230 support.
7231 @end table
7232
7233 @kindex where
7234 @kindex info stack
7235 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7236 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7237
7238 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7239 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7240 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7241 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7242 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7243 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7244 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7245 multi-threaded program.
7246
7247 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7248 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7249 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7250 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7251 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7252 line number.
7253
7254 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7255 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7256
7257 @smallexample
7258 @group
7259 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7260 at builtin.c:993
7261 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7262 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7263 at macro.c:71
7264 (More stack frames follow...)
7265 @end group
7266 @end smallexample
7267
7268 @noindent
7269 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7270 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7271 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7272
7273 @noindent
7274 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7275 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7276 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7277 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7278 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7279
7280 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7281 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7282 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7283 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7284 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7285 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7286 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7287 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7288 such a backtrace might look like:
7289
7290 @smallexample
7291 @group
7292 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7293 at builtin.c:993
7294 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7295 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7296 at macro.c:71
7297 (More stack frames follow...)
7298 @end group
7299 @end smallexample
7300
7301 @noindent
7302 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7303 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7304
7305 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7306 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7307 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7308
7309 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7310 @cindex program entry point
7311 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7312 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7313 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7314 @code{main}@footnote{
7315 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7316 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7317 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7318 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7319 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7320 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7321
7322 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7323 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7324
7325 @table @code
7326 @item set backtrace past-main
7327 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7328 @kindex set backtrace
7329 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7330
7331 @item set backtrace past-main off
7332 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7333 default.
7334
7335 @item show backtrace past-main
7336 @kindex show backtrace
7337 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7338
7339 @item set backtrace past-entry
7340 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7341 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7342 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7343 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7344
7345 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7346 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7347 application. This is the default.
7348
7349 @item show backtrace past-entry
7350 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7351
7352 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7353 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7354 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7355 @cindex backtrace limit
7356 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7357 or zero means unlimited levels.
7358
7359 @item show backtrace limit
7360 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7361 @end table
7362
7363 You can control how file names are displayed.
7364
7365 @table @code
7366 @item set filename-display
7367 @itemx set filename-display relative
7368 @cindex filename-display
7369 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7370
7371 @item set filename-display basename
7372 Display only basename of a filename.
7373
7374 @item set filename-display absolute
7375 Display an absolute filename.
7376
7377 @item show filename-display
7378 Show the current way to display filenames.
7379 @end table
7380
7381 @node Selection
7382 @section Selecting a Frame
7383
7384 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7385 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7386 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7387 of the stack frame just selected.
7388
7389 @table @code
7390 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7391 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7392 @item frame @var{n}
7393 @itemx f @var{n}
7394 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7395 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7396 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7397 @code{main}.
7398
7399 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7400 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7401 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7402 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7403 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7404 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7405 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7406 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7407
7408 @kindex up
7409 @item up @var{n}
7410 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7411 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7412 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7413
7414 @kindex down
7415 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7416 @item down @var{n}
7417 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7418 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7419 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7420 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7421 @end table
7422
7423 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7424 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7425 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7426 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7427
7428 @need 1000
7429 For example:
7430
7431 @smallexample
7432 @group
7433 (@value{GDBP}) up
7434 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7435 at env.c:10
7436 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7437 @end group
7438 @end smallexample
7439
7440 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7441 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7442 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7443 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7444 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7445 for details.
7446
7447 @table @code
7448 @kindex select-frame
7449 @item select-frame
7450 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7451 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7452 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7453 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7454
7455 @kindex down-silently
7456 @kindex up-silently
7457 @item up-silently @var{n}
7458 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7459 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7460 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7461 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7462 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7463 distracting.
7464 @end table
7465
7466 @node Frame Info
7467 @section Information About a Frame
7468
7469 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7470 stack frame.
7471
7472 @table @code
7473 @item frame
7474 @itemx f
7475 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7476 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7477 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7478 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7479 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7480
7481 @kindex info frame
7482 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7483 @item info frame
7484 @itemx info f
7485 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7486 including:
7487
7488 @itemize @bullet
7489 @item
7490 the address of the frame
7491 @item
7492 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7493 @item
7494 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7495 @item
7496 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7497 @item
7498 the address of the frame's arguments
7499 @item
7500 the address of the frame's local variables
7501 @item
7502 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7503 @item
7504 which registers were saved in the frame
7505 @end itemize
7506
7507 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7508 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7509 the usual conventions.
7510
7511 @item info frame @var{addr}
7512 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7513 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7514 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7515 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7516 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7517 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7518
7519 @kindex info args
7520 @item info args
7521 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7522
7523 @item info locals
7524 @kindex info locals
7525 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7526 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7527 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7528
7529 @end table
7530
7531 @node Frame Filter Management
7532 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7533 @cindex managing frame filters
7534
7535 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7536 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7537
7538 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7539 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7540
7541 @table @code
7542 @kindex info frame-filter
7543 @item info frame-filter
7544 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7545 their name, priority and enabled status.
7546
7547 @kindex disable frame-filter
7548 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7549 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7550 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7551 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7552 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7553 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7554 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7555 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7556 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7557 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7558 may be enabled again later.
7559
7560 @kindex enable frame-filter
7561 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7562 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7563 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7564 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7565 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7566 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7567 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7568 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7569 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7570
7571 Example:
7572
7573 @smallexample
7574 (gdb) info frame-filter
7575
7576 global frame-filters:
7577 Priority Enabled Name
7578 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7579 100 Yes Reverse
7580
7581 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7582 Priority Enabled Name
7583 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7584
7585 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7586 Priority Enabled Name
7587 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7588
7589 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7590 (gdb) info frame-filter
7591
7592 global frame-filters:
7593 Priority Enabled Name
7594 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7595 100 Yes Reverse
7596
7597 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7598 Priority Enabled Name
7599 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7600
7601 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7602 Priority Enabled Name
7603 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7604
7605 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7606 (gdb) info frame-filter
7607
7608 global frame-filters:
7609 Priority Enabled Name
7610 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7611 100 Yes Reverse
7612
7613 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7614 Priority Enabled Name
7615 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7616
7617 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7618 Priority Enabled Name
7619 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7620 @end smallexample
7621
7622 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7623 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7624 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7625 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7626 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7627 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7628 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7629
7630 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7631 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7632 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7633 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7634 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7635 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7636 dictionary resides.
7637
7638 Example:
7639
7640 @smallexample
7641 (gdb) info frame-filter
7642
7643 global frame-filters:
7644 Priority Enabled Name
7645 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7646 100 Yes Reverse
7647
7648 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7649 Priority Enabled Name
7650 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7651
7652 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7653 Priority Enabled Name
7654 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7655
7656 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7657 (gdb) info frame-filter
7658
7659 global frame-filters:
7660 Priority Enabled Name
7661 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7662 50 Yes Reverse
7663
7664 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7665 Priority Enabled Name
7666 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7667
7668 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7669 Priority Enabled Name
7670 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7671 @end smallexample
7672 @end table
7673
7674 @node Source
7675 @chapter Examining Source Files
7676
7677 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7678 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7679 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7680 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7681 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7682 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7683 source files by explicit command.
7684
7685 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7686 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7687 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7688
7689 @menu
7690 * List:: Printing source lines
7691 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7692 * Edit:: Editing source files
7693 * Search:: Searching source files
7694 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7695 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7696 @end menu
7697
7698 @node List
7699 @section Printing Source Lines
7700
7701 @kindex list
7702 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7703 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7704 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7705 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7706 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7707
7708 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7709
7710 @table @code
7711 @item list @var{linenum}
7712 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7713 current source file.
7714
7715 @item list @var{function}
7716 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7717 @var{function}.
7718
7719 @item list
7720 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7721 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7722 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7723 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7724 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7725
7726 @item list -
7727 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7728 @end table
7729
7730 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7731 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7732 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7733
7734 @table @code
7735 @kindex set listsize
7736 @item set listsize @var{count}
7737 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7738 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7739 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7740 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7741
7742 @kindex show listsize
7743 @item show listsize
7744 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7745 @end table
7746
7747 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7748 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7749 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7750 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7751 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7752
7753 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7754 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7755 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7756 to specify some source line.
7757
7758 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7759
7760 @table @code
7761 @item list @var{location}
7762 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7763
7764 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7765 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7766 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7767 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7768 the same source file as the first location.
7769
7770 @item list ,@var{last}
7771 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7772
7773 @item list @var{first},
7774 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7775
7776 @item list +
7777 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7778
7779 @item list -
7780 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7781
7782 @item list
7783 As described in the preceding table.
7784 @end table
7785
7786 @node Specify Location
7787 @section Specifying a Location
7788 @cindex specifying location
7789 @cindex location
7790 @cindex source location
7791
7792 @menu
7793 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7794 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7795 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7796 @end menu
7797
7798 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7799 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7800 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7801 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7802 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7803
7804 @node Linespec Locations
7805 @subsection Linespec Locations
7806 @cindex linespec locations
7807
7808 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7809 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7810 specifying a linespec:
7811
7812 @table @code
7813 @item @var{linenum}
7814 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7815
7816 @item -@var{offset}
7817 @itemx +@var{offset}
7818 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7819 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7820 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7821 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7822 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7823 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7824 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7825 linespec.
7826
7827 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7828 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7829 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7830 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7831 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7832 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7833 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7834
7835 @item @var{function}
7836 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7837 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7838
7839 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7840 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7841
7842 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7843 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7844 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7845 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7846 functions in different source files.
7847
7848 @item @var{label}
7849 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7850 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7851 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7852 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7853
7854 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7855 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7856 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7857 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7858 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7859 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7860
7861 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7862 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7863 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7864 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7865 each one of those probes.
7866 @end table
7867
7868 @node Explicit Locations
7869 @subsection Explicit Locations
7870 @cindex explicit locations
7871
7872 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7873 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7874
7875 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7876 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7877 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7878 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7879 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7880
7881 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7882 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7883 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7884 the symbol table to know.
7885
7886 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7887 following table:
7888
7889 @table @code
7890 @item -source @var{filename}
7891 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7892 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7893 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7894 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7895 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7896
7897 @item -function @var{function}
7898 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7899 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7900 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7901 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7902
7903 @item -label @var{label}
7904 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7905 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7906 selected stack frame.
7907
7908 @item -line @var{number}
7909 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7910 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7911 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7912 relative to the current line.
7913 @end table
7914
7915 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7916 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7917
7918 @node Address Locations
7919 @subsection Address Locations
7920 @cindex address locations
7921
7922 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
7923 the generalized form *@var{address}.
7924
7925 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7926 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
7927 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7928 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7929 source files.
7930
7931 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7932 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7933 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7934 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7935 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
7936 of @var{address}:
7937
7938 @table @code
7939 @item @var{expression}
7940 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7941
7942 @item @var{funcaddr}
7943 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7944 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7945 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7946 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7947 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7948 (although the Pascal form also works).
7949
7950 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7951 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7952
7953 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7954 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7955 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7956 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7957 functions with identical names in different source files.
7958 @end table
7959
7960 @node Edit
7961 @section Editing Source Files
7962 @cindex editing source files
7963
7964 @kindex edit
7965 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7966 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7967 The editing program of your choice
7968 is invoked with the current line set to
7969 the active line in the program.
7970 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7971 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7972
7973 @table @code
7974 @item edit @var{location}
7975 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7976 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7977 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7978 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7979 command most commonly used:
7980
7981 @table @code
7982 @item edit @var{number}
7983 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7984
7985 @item edit @var{function}
7986 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7987 @end table
7988
7989 @end table
7990
7991 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7992 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7993 @footnote{
7994 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7995 following command-line syntax:
7996 @smallexample
7997 ex +@var{number} file
7998 @end smallexample
7999 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8000 the file where to start editing.}.
8001 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8002 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8003 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8004 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8005 @smallexample
8006 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8007 export EDITOR
8008 gdb @dots{}
8009 @end smallexample
8010 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8011 @smallexample
8012 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8013 gdb @dots{}
8014 @end smallexample
8015
8016 @node Search
8017 @section Searching Source Files
8018 @cindex searching source files
8019
8020 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8021 regular expression.
8022
8023 @table @code
8024 @kindex search
8025 @kindex forward-search
8026 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8027 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8028 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8029 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8030 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8031 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8032 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8033 @code{fo}.
8034
8035 @kindex reverse-search
8036 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8037 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8038 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8039 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8040 this command as @code{rev}.
8041 @end table
8042
8043 @node Source Path
8044 @section Specifying Source Directories
8045
8046 @cindex source path
8047 @cindex directories for source files
8048 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8049 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8050 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8051 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8052 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8053 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8054 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8055
8056 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8057 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8058 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8059 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8060 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8061 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8062 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8063 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8064 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8065 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8066 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8067
8068 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8069 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8070 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8071 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8072 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8073 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8074
8075 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8076 source files.
8077
8078 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8079 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8080 each line is in the file.
8081
8082 @kindex directory
8083 @kindex dir
8084 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8085 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8086 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8087
8088 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8089 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8090
8091 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8092 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8093 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8094 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8095 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8096 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8097 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8098 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8099 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8100 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8101 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8102 name to look up the sources.
8103
8104 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8105 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8106 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8107 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8108 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8109 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8110 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8111 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8112
8113 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8114 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8115 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8116 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8117 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8118 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8119 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8120
8121 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8122 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8123 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8124 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8125 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8126 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8127 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8128 command.
8129
8130 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8131 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8132 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8133 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8134 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8135 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8136 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8137
8138 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8139 @cindex default source path substitution
8140 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8141 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8142 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8143 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8144 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8145 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8146 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8147 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8148 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8149 together.
8150
8151 @table @code
8152 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8153 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8154 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8155 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8156 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8157 part of absolute file names) or
8158 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8159 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8160
8161 @kindex cdir
8162 @kindex cwd
8163 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8164 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8165 @cindex compilation directory
8166 @cindex current directory
8167 @cindex working directory
8168 @cindex directory, current
8169 @cindex directory, compilation
8170 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8171 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8172 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8173 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8174 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8175 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8176
8177 @item directory
8178 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8179
8180 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8181 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8182
8183 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8184 @kindex set directories
8185 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8186 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8187
8188 @item show directories
8189 @kindex show directories
8190 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8191
8192 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8193 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8194 @kindex set substitute-path
8195 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8196 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8197 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8198
8199 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8200 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8201
8202 @smallexample
8203 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8204 @end smallexample
8205
8206 @noindent
8207 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8208 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8209 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8210
8211 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8212 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8213 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8214 the substitution.
8215
8216 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8217
8218 @smallexample
8219 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8220 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8221 @end smallexample
8222
8223 @noindent
8224 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8225 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8226 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8227 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8228
8229
8230 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8231 @kindex unset substitute-path
8232 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8233 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8234 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8235
8236 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8237
8238 @item show substitute-path [path]
8239 @kindex show substitute-path
8240 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8241 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8242
8243 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8244 rules.
8245
8246 @end table
8247
8248 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8249 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8250 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8251
8252 @enumerate
8253 @item
8254 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8255
8256 @item
8257 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8258 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8259 directories in one command.
8260 @end enumerate
8261
8262 @node Machine Code
8263 @section Source and Machine Code
8264 @cindex source line and its code address
8265
8266 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8267 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8268 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8269 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8270 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8271 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8272 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8273 well as hex.
8274
8275 @table @code
8276 @kindex info line
8277 @item info line @var{location}
8278 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8279 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8280 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8281 @end table
8282
8283 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8284 the object code for the first line of function
8285 @code{m4_changequote}:
8286
8287 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8288 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8289 @smallexample
8290 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8291 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8292 @end smallexample
8293
8294 @noindent
8295 @cindex code address and its source line
8296 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8297 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8298 @smallexample
8299 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8300 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8301 @end smallexample
8302
8303 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8304 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8305 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8306 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8307 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8308 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8309 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8310 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8311 Variables}).
8312
8313 @table @code
8314 @kindex disassemble
8315 @cindex assembly instructions
8316 @cindex instructions, assembly
8317 @cindex machine instructions
8318 @cindex listing machine instructions
8319 @item disassemble
8320 @itemx disassemble /m
8321 @itemx disassemble /s
8322 @itemx disassemble /r
8323 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8324 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8325 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8326 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8327 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8328 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8329 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8330 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8331 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8332 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8333
8334 @table @code
8335 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8336 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8337 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8338 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8339 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8340 @end table
8341
8342 @noindent
8343 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8344 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8345
8346 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8347 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8348
8349 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8350 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8351 @end table
8352
8353 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8354 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8355
8356 @smallexample
8357 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8358 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8359 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8360 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8361 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8362 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8363 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8364 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8365 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8366 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8367 End of assembler dump.
8368 @end smallexample
8369
8370 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8371 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8372 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8373
8374 @smallexample
8375 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8376 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8377 5 @{
8378 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8379 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8380 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8381 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8382 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8383
8384 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8385 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8386 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8387
8388 7 return 0;
8389 8 @}
8390 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8391 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8392 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8393
8394 End of assembler dump.
8395 @end smallexample
8396
8397 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8398 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8399 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8400 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8401 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8402 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8403 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8404 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8405 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8406
8407 @file{foo.h}:
8408
8409 @smallexample
8410 int
8411 foo (int a)
8412 @{
8413 if (a < 0)
8414 return a * 2;
8415 if (a == 0)
8416 return 1;
8417 return a + 10;
8418 @}
8419 @end smallexample
8420
8421 @file{foo.c}:
8422
8423 @smallexample
8424 #include "foo.h"
8425 volatile int x, y;
8426 int
8427 main ()
8428 @{
8429 x = foo (y);
8430 return 0;
8431 @}
8432 @end smallexample
8433
8434 @smallexample
8435 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8436 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8437 5 @{
8438
8439 6 x = foo (y);
8440 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8441 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8442
8443 7 return 0;
8444 8 @}
8445 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8446 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8447 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8448 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8449
8450 End of assembler dump.
8451 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8452 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8453 foo.c:
8454 5 @{
8455 6 x = foo (y);
8456 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8457
8458 foo.h:
8459 4 if (a < 0)
8460 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8461 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8462
8463 6 if (a == 0)
8464 7 return 1;
8465 8 return a + 10;
8466 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8467 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8468 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8469 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8470
8471 foo.c:
8472 6 x = foo (y);
8473 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8474
8475 7 return 0;
8476 8 @}
8477 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8478 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8479
8480 foo.h:
8481 5 return a * 2;
8482 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8483 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8484 End of assembler dump.
8485 @end smallexample
8486
8487 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8488
8489 @smallexample
8490 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8491 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8492 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8493 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8494 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8495 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8496 End of assembler dump.
8497 @end smallexample
8498
8499 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8500 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8501 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8502 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8503
8504 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8505 mnemonics or other syntax.
8506
8507 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8508 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8509 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8510 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8511 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8512
8513 @table @code
8514 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8515 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8516 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8517 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8518 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8519 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8520
8521 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8522 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8523 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8524 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8525
8526 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8527 @item show disassembly-flavor
8528 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8529 @end table
8530
8531 @table @code
8532 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8533 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8534 @item set disassemble-next-line
8535 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8536 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8537 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8538 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8539 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8540 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8541 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8542 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8543 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8544 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8545 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8546 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8547 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8548 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8549 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8550 instruction.
8551 @end table
8552
8553
8554 @node Data
8555 @chapter Examining Data
8556
8557 @cindex printing data
8558 @cindex examining data
8559 @kindex print
8560 @kindex inspect
8561 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8562 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8563 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8564 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8565 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8566 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8567
8568 @table @code
8569 @item print @var{expr}
8570 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8571 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8572 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8573 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8574 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8575 Formats}.
8576
8577 @item print
8578 @itemx print /@var{f}
8579 @cindex reprint the last value
8580 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8581 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8582 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8583 @end table
8584
8585 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8586 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8587 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8588
8589 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8590 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8591 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8592 Table}.
8593
8594 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8595 @kindex explore
8596 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8597 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8598 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8599 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8600 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8601 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8602 embedded in the higher level data types.
8603
8604 @table @code
8605 @item explore @var{arg}
8606 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8607 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8608 @end table
8609
8610 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8611 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8612 C program as
8613
8614 @smallexample
8615 struct SimpleStruct
8616 @{
8617 int i;
8618 double d;
8619 @};
8620
8621 struct ComplexStruct
8622 @{
8623 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8624 int arr[10];
8625 @};
8626 @end smallexample
8627
8628 @noindent
8629 followed by variable declarations as
8630
8631 @smallexample
8632 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8633 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8634 @end smallexample
8635
8636 @noindent
8637 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8638 @code{explore} command as follows.
8639
8640 @smallexample
8641 (gdb) explore cs
8642 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8643 the following fields:
8644
8645 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8646 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8647
8648 Enter the field number of choice:
8649 @end smallexample
8650
8651 @noindent
8652 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8653 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8654 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8655 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8656 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8657 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8658 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8659 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8660
8661 @smallexample
8662 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8663 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8664 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8665 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8666
8667 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8668 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8669
8670 Press enter to return to parent value:
8671 @end smallexample
8672
8673 @noindent
8674 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8675 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8676 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8677 to explore.
8678
8679 @smallexample
8680 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8681 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8682
8683 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8684
8685 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8686
8687 Press enter to return to parent value:
8688 @end smallexample
8689
8690 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8691 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8692 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8693 level data structure).
8694
8695 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8696 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8697 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8698 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8699 same example as above, your can explore the type
8700 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8701 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8702
8703 @smallexample
8704 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8705 @end smallexample
8706
8707 @noindent
8708 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8709 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8710 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8711 example.
8712
8713 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8714 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8715 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8716 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8717 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8718
8719 @table @code
8720 @item explore value @var{expr}
8721 @cindex explore value
8722 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8723 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8724 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8725 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8726 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8727
8728 @item explore type @var{arg}
8729 @cindex explore type
8730 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8731 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8732 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8733 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8734 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8735 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8736 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8737 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8738 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8739 @end table
8740
8741 @menu
8742 * Expressions:: Expressions
8743 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8744 * Variables:: Program variables
8745 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8746 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8747 * Memory:: Examining memory
8748 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8749 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8750 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8751 * Value History:: Value history
8752 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8753 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8754 * Registers:: Registers
8755 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8756 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8757 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8758 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8759 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8760 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8761 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8762 character set than GDB does
8763 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8764 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8765 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
8766 @end menu
8767
8768 @node Expressions
8769 @section Expressions
8770
8771 @cindex expressions
8772 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8773 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8774 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8775 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8776 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8777 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8778 @ref{Compilation}.
8779
8780 @cindex arrays in expressions
8781 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8782 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8783 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8784 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8785 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8786 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8787
8788 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8789 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8790 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8791 languages.
8792
8793 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8794 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8795
8796 @cindex casts, in expressions
8797 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8798 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8799 at that address in memory.
8800 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8801
8802 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8803 to programming languages:
8804
8805 @table @code
8806 @item @@
8807 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8808 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8809
8810 @item ::
8811 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8812 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8813
8814 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8815 @cindex type casting memory
8816 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8817 @cindex casts, to view memory
8818 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8819 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8820 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8821 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8822 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8823 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8824 @end table
8825
8826 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8827 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8828 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8829
8830 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8831 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8832 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8833 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8834 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8835 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8836 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8837
8838 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8839 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8840 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8841 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8842 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8843 as well.
8844
8845 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8846 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8847 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8848 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8849 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8850 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8851 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8852 choices.
8853
8854 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8855 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8856 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8857
8858 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8859 @smallexample
8860 @group
8861 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8862 [0] cancel
8863 [1] all
8864 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8865 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8866 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8867 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8868 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8869 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8870 > 2 4 6
8871 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8872 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8873 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8874 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8875 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8876 breakpoints.
8877 (@value{GDBP})
8878 @end group
8879 @end smallexample
8880
8881 @table @code
8882 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8883 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8884 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8885
8886 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8887 is ambiguous.
8888
8889 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8890 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8891 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8892 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8893 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8894 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8895 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8896 in the use of the menu.
8897
8898 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8899 when an ambiguity is detected.
8900
8901 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8902 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8903
8904 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8905 @item show multiple-symbols
8906 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8907 @end table
8908
8909 @node Variables
8910 @section Program Variables
8911
8912 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8913 in your program.
8914
8915 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8916 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8917
8918 @itemize @bullet
8919 @item
8920 global (or file-static)
8921 @end itemize
8922
8923 @noindent or
8924
8925 @itemize @bullet
8926 @item
8927 visible according to the scope rules of the
8928 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8929 @end itemize
8930
8931 @noindent This means that in the function
8932
8933 @smallexample
8934 foo (a)
8935 int a;
8936 @{
8937 bar (a);
8938 @{
8939 int b = test ();
8940 bar (b);
8941 @}
8942 @}
8943 @end smallexample
8944
8945 @noindent
8946 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8947 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8948 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8949 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8950
8951 @cindex variable name conflict
8952 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8953 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8954 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8955 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8956 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8957 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8958 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8959
8960 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8961 @ifnotinfo
8962 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8963 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8964 @end ifnotinfo
8965 @smallexample
8966 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8967 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8968 @end smallexample
8969
8970 @noindent
8971 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8972 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8973 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8974 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8975
8976 @smallexample
8977 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8978 @end smallexample
8979
8980 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8981 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8982 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8983 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8984 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8985
8986 @smallexample
8987 void
8988 foo (int a)
8989 @{
8990 if (a < 10)
8991 bar (a);
8992 else
8993 process (a); /* Stop here */
8994 @}
8995
8996 int
8997 bar (int a)
8998 @{
8999 foo (a + 5);
9000 @}
9001 @end smallexample
9002
9003 @noindent
9004 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9005 here is what you might see
9006 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9007
9008 @smallexample
9009 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9010 $1 = 10
9011 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9012 $2 = 5
9013 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9014 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9015 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9016 $3 = 5
9017 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9018 $4 = 0
9019 @end smallexample
9020
9021 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9022 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9023 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9024 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9025 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9026
9027 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9028 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9029 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9030 @code{some_global}.
9031
9032 @smallexample
9033 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9034 $1 = 23
9035 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9036 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9037 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9038 $2 = 27
9039 @end smallexample
9040
9041 @cindex wrong values
9042 @cindex variable values, wrong
9043 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9044 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9045 @quotation
9046 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9047 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9048 scope, and just before exit.
9049 @end quotation
9050 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9051 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9052 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9053 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9054 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9055 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9056 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9057 variable definitions may be gone.
9058
9059 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9060 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9061 when compiling.
9062
9063 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9064 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9065 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9066 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9067 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9068 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9069 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9070
9071 @smallexample
9072 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9073 @end smallexample
9074
9075 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9076 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9077 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9078 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9079 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9080
9081 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9082 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9083 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9084 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9085
9086 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9087 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9088 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9089 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9090 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9091
9092 @smallexample
9093 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9094 29 i++;
9095 (gdb) next
9096 30 e (i);
9097 (gdb) print i
9098 $1 = 31
9099 (gdb) print i@@entry
9100 $2 = 30
9101 @end smallexample
9102
9103 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9104 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9105 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9106 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9107 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9108 For program code
9109
9110 @smallexample
9111 char var0[] = "A";
9112 signed char var1[] = "A";
9113 @end smallexample
9114
9115 You get during debugging
9116 @smallexample
9117 (gdb) print var0
9118 $1 = "A"
9119 (gdb) print var1
9120 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9121 @end smallexample
9122
9123 @node Arrays
9124 @section Artificial Arrays
9125
9126 @cindex artificial array
9127 @cindex arrays
9128 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9129 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9130 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9131 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9132 program.
9133
9134 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9135 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9136 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9137 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9138 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9139 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9140 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9141 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9142 example. If a program says
9143
9144 @smallexample
9145 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9146 @end smallexample
9147
9148 @noindent
9149 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9150
9151 @smallexample
9152 p *array@@len
9153 @end smallexample
9154
9155 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9156 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9157 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9158 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9159 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9160
9161 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9162 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9163 The value need not be in memory:
9164 @smallexample
9165 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9166 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9167 @end smallexample
9168
9169 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9170 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9171 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9172 @smallexample
9173 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9174 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9175 @end smallexample
9176
9177 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9178 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9179 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9180 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9181 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9182 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9183 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9184 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9185 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9186 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9187
9188 @smallexample
9189 set $i = 0
9190 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9191 @key{RET}
9192 @key{RET}
9193 @dots{}
9194 @end smallexample
9195
9196 @node Output Formats
9197 @section Output Formats
9198
9199 @cindex formatted output
9200 @cindex output formats
9201 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9202 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9203 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9204 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9205 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9206
9207 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9208 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9209 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9210 letters supported are:
9211
9212 @table @code
9213 @item x
9214 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9215 hexadecimal.
9216
9217 @item d
9218 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9219
9220 @item u
9221 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9222
9223 @item o
9224 Print as integer in octal.
9225
9226 @item t
9227 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9228 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9229 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9230 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9231
9232 @item a
9233 @cindex unknown address, locating
9234 @cindex locate address
9235 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9236 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9237 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9238
9239 @smallexample
9240 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9241 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9242 @end smallexample
9243
9244 @noindent
9245 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9246 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9247
9248 @item c
9249 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9250 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9251 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9252 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9253
9254 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9255 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9256 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9257 data.
9258
9259 @item f
9260 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9261 using typical floating point syntax.
9262
9263 @item s
9264 @cindex printing strings
9265 @cindex printing byte arrays
9266 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9267 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9268 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9269 natural types.
9270
9271 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9272 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9273 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9274 array.
9275
9276 @item z
9277 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9278 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9279 to the size of the integer type.
9280
9281 @item r
9282 @cindex raw printing
9283 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9284 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9285 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9286 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9287 pretty-printer which might exist.
9288 @end table
9289
9290 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9291
9292 @smallexample
9293 p/x $pc
9294 @end smallexample
9295
9296 @noindent
9297 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9298 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9299
9300 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9301 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9302 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9303
9304 @node Memory
9305 @section Examining Memory
9306
9307 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9308 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9309
9310 @cindex examining memory
9311 @table @code
9312 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9313 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9314 @itemx x @var{addr}
9315 @itemx x
9316 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9317 @end table
9318
9319 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9320 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9321 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9322 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9323 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9324
9325 @table @r
9326 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9327 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9328 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9329 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9330 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9331 @c 4.1.2.
9332
9333 @item @var{f}, the display format
9334 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9335 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9336 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9337 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9338 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9339
9340 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9341 The unit size is any of
9342
9343 @table @code
9344 @item b
9345 Bytes.
9346 @item h
9347 Halfwords (two bytes).
9348 @item w
9349 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9350 @item g
9351 Giant words (eight bytes).
9352 @end table
9353
9354 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9355 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9356 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9357 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9358 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9359 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9360 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9361 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9362 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9363 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9364 be altered.
9365
9366 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9367 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9368 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9369 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9370 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9371 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9372 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9373 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9374 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9375 a value from memory).
9376 @end table
9377
9378 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9379 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9380 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9381 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9382 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9383
9384 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9385 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9386 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9387
9388 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9389 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9390 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9391 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9392 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9393
9394 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9395 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9396 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9397 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9398 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9399 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9400 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9401 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9402 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9403
9404 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9405 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9406 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9407 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9408 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9409 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9410
9411 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9412 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9413 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9414 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9415 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9416 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9417 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9418
9419 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9420 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9421
9422 @smallexample
9423 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9424 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9425 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9426 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9427 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9428 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9429 @end smallexample
9430
9431 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9432 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9433 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9434 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9435 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9436 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9437 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9438 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9439 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9440
9441 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9442 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9443 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9444
9445 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9446 @cindex addressable memory unit
9447 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9448 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9449 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9450 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9451 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9452 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9453 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9454 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9455 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9456
9457 @cindex remote memory comparison
9458 @cindex target memory comparison
9459 @cindex verify remote memory image
9460 @cindex verify target memory image
9461 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9462 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9463 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9464 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9465 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9466 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9467
9468 @table @code
9469 @kindex compare-sections
9470 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9471 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9472 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9473 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9474 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9475 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9476
9477 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9478 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9479 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9480 @end table
9481
9482 @node Auto Display
9483 @section Automatic Display
9484 @cindex automatic display
9485 @cindex display of expressions
9486
9487 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9488 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9489 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9490 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9491 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9492 The automatic display looks like this:
9493
9494 @smallexample
9495 2: foo = 38
9496 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9497 @end smallexample
9498
9499 @noindent
9500 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9501 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9502 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9503 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9504 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9505 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9506
9507 @table @code
9508 @kindex display
9509 @item display @var{expr}
9510 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9511 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9512
9513 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9514
9515 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9516 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9517 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9518 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9519 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9520
9521 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9522 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9523 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9524 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9525 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9526 @end table
9527
9528 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9529 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9530 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9531
9532 @table @code
9533 @kindex delete display
9534 @kindex undisplay
9535 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9536 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9537 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9538 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9539 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9540 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9541 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9542
9543 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9544 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9545
9546 @kindex disable display
9547 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9548 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9549 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9550 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9551 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9552 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9553 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9554 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9555
9556 @kindex enable display
9557 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9558 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9559 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9560 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9561 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9562 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9563 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9564
9565 @item display
9566 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9567 done when your program stops.
9568
9569 @kindex info display
9570 @item info display
9571 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9572 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9573 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9574 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9575 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9576 @end table
9577
9578 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9579 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9580 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9581 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9582 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9583 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9584 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9585 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9586 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9587 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9588 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9589
9590 @node Print Settings
9591 @section Print Settings
9592
9593 @cindex format options
9594 @cindex print settings
9595 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9596 and symbols are printed.
9597
9598 @noindent
9599 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9600
9601 @table @code
9602 @kindex set print
9603 @item set print address
9604 @itemx set print address on
9605 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9606 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9607 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9608 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9609 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9610 @code{set print address on}:
9611
9612 @smallexample
9613 @group
9614 (@value{GDBP}) f
9615 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9616 at input.c:530
9617 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9618 @end group
9619 @end smallexample
9620
9621 @item set print address off
9622 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9623 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9624
9625 @smallexample
9626 @group
9627 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9628 (@value{GDBP}) f
9629 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9630 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9631 @end group
9632 @end smallexample
9633
9634 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9635 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9636 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9637 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9638
9639 @kindex show print
9640 @item show print address
9641 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9642 @end table
9643
9644 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9645 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9646 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9647 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9648 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9649 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9650 it prints a symbolic address:
9651
9652 @table @code
9653 @item set print symbol-filename on
9654 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9655 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9656 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9657 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9658
9659 @item set print symbol-filename off
9660 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9661 default.
9662
9663 @item show print symbol-filename
9664 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9665 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9666 @end table
9667
9668 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9669 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9670 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9671
9672 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9673 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9674
9675 @table @code
9676 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9677 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9678 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9679 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9680 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9681 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9682 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9683 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9684
9685 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9686 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9687 symbolic address.
9688 @end table
9689
9690 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9691 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9692 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9693 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9694 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9695 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9696 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9697 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9698
9699 @smallexample
9700 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9701 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9702 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9703 @end smallexample
9704
9705 @quotation
9706 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9707 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9708 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9709 @end quotation
9710
9711 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9712 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9713
9714 @table @code
9715 @item set print symbol on
9716 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9717 one exists.
9718
9719 @item set print symbol off
9720 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9721 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9722 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9723
9724 @item show print symbol
9725 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9726 address.
9727 @end table
9728
9729 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9730
9731 @table @code
9732 @item set print array
9733 @itemx set print array on
9734 @cindex pretty print arrays
9735 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9736 but uses more space. The default is off.
9737
9738 @item set print array off
9739 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9740
9741 @item show print array
9742 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9743 arrays.
9744
9745 @cindex print array indexes
9746 @item set print array-indexes
9747 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9748 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9749 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9750 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9751
9752 @item set print array-indexes off
9753 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9754
9755 @item show print array-indexes
9756 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9757 arrays.
9758
9759 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9760 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9761 @cindex number of array elements to print
9762 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9763 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9764 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9765 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9766 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9767 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9768 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9769 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9770
9771 @item show print elements
9772 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9773 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9774
9775 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9776 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9777 @cindex printing frame argument values
9778 @cindex print all frame argument values
9779 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9780 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9781 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9782 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9783 values are:
9784
9785 @table @code
9786 @item all
9787 The values of all arguments are printed.
9788
9789 @item scalars
9790 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9791 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9792 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9793 only scalar arguments are shown:
9794
9795 @smallexample
9796 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9797 at frame-args.c:23
9798 @end smallexample
9799
9800 @item none
9801 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9802 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9803
9804 @smallexample
9805 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9806 at frame-args.c:23
9807 @end smallexample
9808 @end table
9809
9810 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9811 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9812 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9813 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9814 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9815 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9816 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9817 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9818 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9819 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9820
9821 @item show print frame-arguments
9822 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9823
9824 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9825 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9826
9827 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9828 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9829 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9830 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9831 This is the default.
9832
9833 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9834 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9835
9836 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9837 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9838 @kindex set print entry-values
9839 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9840 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9841 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9842 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9843 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9844
9845 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9846 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9847 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9848 @code{no} setting.
9849
9850 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9851 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9852 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9853 this information.
9854
9855 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9856
9857 @table @code
9858 @item no
9859 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9860 point.
9861 @smallexample
9862 #0 equal (val=5)
9863 #0 different (val=6)
9864 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9865 #0 born (val=10)
9866 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9867 @end smallexample
9868
9869 @item only
9870 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9871 values are never printed.
9872 @smallexample
9873 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9874 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9875 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9876 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9877 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9878 @end smallexample
9879
9880 @item preferred
9881 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9882 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9883 value for such parameter.
9884 @smallexample
9885 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9886 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9887 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9888 #0 born (val=10)
9889 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9890 @end smallexample
9891
9892 @item if-needed
9893 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9894 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9895 parameter.
9896 @smallexample
9897 #0 equal (val=5)
9898 #0 different (val=6)
9899 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9900 #0 born (val=10)
9901 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9902 @end smallexample
9903
9904 @item both
9905 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9906 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9907 optimizations.
9908 @smallexample
9909 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9910 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9911 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9912 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9913 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9914 @end smallexample
9915
9916 @item compact
9917 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9918 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9919 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9920 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9921 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9922 @smallexample
9923 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9924 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9925 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9926 #0 born (val=10)
9927 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9928 @end smallexample
9929
9930 @item default
9931 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9932 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9933 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9934 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9935 @smallexample
9936 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9937 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9938 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9939 #0 born (val=10)
9940 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9941 @end smallexample
9942 @end table
9943
9944 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9945 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9946
9947 @item show print entry-values
9948 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9949 entry.
9950
9951 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9952 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9953 @cindex repeated array elements
9954 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9955 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9956 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9957 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9958 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9959 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9960 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9961 is 10.
9962
9963 @item show print repeats
9964 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9965 elements.
9966
9967 @item set print null-stop
9968 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9969 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9970 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9971 contain only short strings.
9972 The default is off.
9973
9974 @item show print null-stop
9975 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9976 @sc{null} character.
9977
9978 @item set print pretty on
9979 @cindex print structures in indented form
9980 @cindex indentation in structure display
9981 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9982 per line, like this:
9983
9984 @smallexample
9985 @group
9986 $1 = @{
9987 next = 0x0,
9988 flags = @{
9989 sweet = 1,
9990 sour = 1
9991 @},
9992 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9993 @}
9994 @end group
9995 @end smallexample
9996
9997 @item set print pretty off
9998 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9999
10000 @smallexample
10001 @group
10002 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10003 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10004 @end group
10005 @end smallexample
10006
10007 @noindent
10008 This is the default format.
10009
10010 @item show print pretty
10011 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10012
10013 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10014 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10015 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10016 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10017 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10018 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10019 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10020 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10021
10022 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10023 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10024 international character sets, and is the default.
10025
10026 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10027 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10028
10029 @item set print union on
10030 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10031 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10032 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10033
10034 @item set print union off
10035 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10036 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10037 instead.
10038
10039 @item show print union
10040 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10041 structures and other unions.
10042
10043 For example, given the declarations
10044
10045 @smallexample
10046 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10047 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10048 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10049 Bug_forms;
10050
10051 struct thing @{
10052 Species it;
10053 union @{
10054 Tree_forms tree;
10055 Bug_forms bug;
10056 @} form;
10057 @};
10058
10059 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10060 @end smallexample
10061
10062 @noindent
10063 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10064
10065 @smallexample
10066 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10067 @end smallexample
10068
10069 @noindent
10070 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10071
10072 @smallexample
10073 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10074 @end smallexample
10075
10076 @noindent
10077 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10078 and in Pascal.
10079 @end table
10080
10081 @need 1000
10082 @noindent
10083 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10084
10085 @table @code
10086 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10087 @item set print demangle
10088 @itemx set print demangle on
10089 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10090 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10091 linkage. The default is on.
10092
10093 @item show print demangle
10094 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10095
10096 @item set print asm-demangle
10097 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10098 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10099 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10100 The default is off.
10101
10102 @item show print asm-demangle
10103 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10104 or demangled form.
10105
10106 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10107 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10108 @kindex set demangle-style
10109 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10110 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10111 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10112
10113 @table @code
10114 @item auto
10115 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10116 This is the default.
10117
10118 @item gnu
10119 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10120
10121 @item hp
10122 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10123
10124 @item lucid
10125 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10126
10127 @item arm
10128 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10129 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10130 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10131 require further enhancement to permit that.
10132
10133 @end table
10134 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10135
10136 @item show demangle-style
10137 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10138
10139 @item set print object
10140 @itemx set print object on
10141 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10142 @cindex display derived types
10143 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10144 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10145 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10146 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10147 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10148 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10149 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10150
10151 @item set print object off
10152 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10153 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10154
10155 @item show print object
10156 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10157
10158 @item set print static-members
10159 @itemx set print static-members on
10160 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10161 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10162
10163 @item set print static-members off
10164 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10165
10166 @item show print static-members
10167 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10168
10169 @item set print pascal_static-members
10170 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10171 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10172 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10173 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10174
10175 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10176 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10177
10178 @item show print pascal_static-members
10179 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10180
10181 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10182 @item set print vtbl
10183 @itemx set print vtbl on
10184 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10185 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10186 @cindex VTBL display
10187 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10188 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10189 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10190
10191 @item set print vtbl off
10192 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10193
10194 @item show print vtbl
10195 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10196 @end table
10197
10198 @node Pretty Printing
10199 @section Pretty Printing
10200
10201 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10202 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10203 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10204
10205 @menu
10206 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10207 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10208 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10209 @end menu
10210
10211 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10212 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10213
10214 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10215 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10216 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10217
10218 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10219 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10220 pretty-printers with their names.
10221 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10222 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10223 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10224 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10225
10226 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10227 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10228 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10229 do anything special.
10230
10231 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10232
10233 @itemize @bullet
10234 @item
10235 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10236 all inferiors.
10237
10238 @item
10239 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10240 when debugging that program.
10241 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10242
10243 @item
10244 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10245 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10246 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10247 @end itemize
10248
10249 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10250 pretty-printers are selected,
10251
10252 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10253 for new types.
10254
10255 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10256 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10257
10258 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10259
10260 @smallexample
10261 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10262 $1 = @{
10263 static npos = 4294967295,
10264 _M_dataplus = @{
10265 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10266 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10267 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10268 @},
10269 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10270 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10271 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10272 @}
10273 @}
10274 @end smallexample
10275
10276 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10277
10278 @smallexample
10279 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10280 $2 = "abcd"
10281 @end smallexample
10282
10283 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10284 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10285 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10286
10287 @table @code
10288 @kindex info pretty-printer
10289 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10290 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10291 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10292
10293 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10294 whose pretty-printers to list.
10295 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10296 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10297 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10298 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10299 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10300
10301 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10302 to list.
10303
10304 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10305 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10306 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10307 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10308
10309 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10310 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10311 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10312 @end table
10313
10314 Example:
10315
10316 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10317 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10318 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10319 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10320
10321 @smallexample
10322 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10323 library1.so:
10324 foo
10325 library2.so:
10326 bar
10327 bar1
10328 bar2
10329 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10330 library2.so:
10331 bar
10332 bar1
10333 bar2
10334 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10335 1 printer disabled
10336 2 of 3 printers enabled
10337 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10338 library1.so:
10339 foo [disabled]
10340 library2.so:
10341 bar
10342 bar1
10343 bar2
10344 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10345 1 printer disabled
10346 1 of 3 printers enabled
10347 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10348 library1.so:
10349 foo [disabled]
10350 library2.so:
10351 bar
10352 bar1 [disabled]
10353 bar2
10354 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10355 1 printer disabled
10356 0 of 3 printers enabled
10357 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10358 library1.so:
10359 foo [disabled]
10360 library2.so:
10361 bar [disabled]
10362 bar1 [disabled]
10363 bar2
10364 @end smallexample
10365
10366 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10367 as can each individual subprinter.
10368
10369 @node Value History
10370 @section Value History
10371
10372 @cindex value history
10373 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10374 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10375 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10376 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10377 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10378 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10379 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10380 symbol table.
10381
10382 @cindex @code{$}
10383 @cindex @code{$$}
10384 @cindex history number
10385 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10386 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10387 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10388 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10389 history number.
10390
10391 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10392 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10393 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10394 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10395 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10396 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10397 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10398
10399 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10400 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10401
10402 @smallexample
10403 p *$
10404 @end smallexample
10405
10406 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10407 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10408
10409 @smallexample
10410 p *$.next
10411 @end smallexample
10412
10413 @noindent
10414 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10415 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10416
10417 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10418 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10419
10420 @smallexample
10421 print x
10422 set x=5
10423 @end smallexample
10424
10425 @noindent
10426 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10427 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10428
10429 @table @code
10430 @kindex show values
10431 @item show values
10432 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10433 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10434 values} does not change the history.
10435
10436 @item show values @var{n}
10437 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10438
10439 @item show values +
10440 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10441 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10442 @end table
10443
10444 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10445 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10446
10447 @node Convenience Vars
10448 @section Convenience Variables
10449
10450 @cindex convenience variables
10451 @cindex user-defined variables
10452 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10453 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10454 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10455 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10456 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10457
10458 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10459 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10460 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10461 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10462 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10463
10464 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10465 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10466 For example:
10467
10468 @smallexample
10469 set $foo = *object_ptr
10470 @end smallexample
10471
10472 @noindent
10473 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10474 @code{object_ptr}.
10475
10476 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10477 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10478 value with another assignment at any time.
10479
10480 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10481 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10482 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10483 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10484
10485 @table @code
10486 @kindex show convenience
10487 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10488 @item show convenience
10489 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10490 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10491 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10492
10493 @kindex init-if-undefined
10494 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10495 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10496 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10497 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10498 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10499 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10500 override default values used in a command script.
10501
10502 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10503 any side-effects do not occur.
10504 @end table
10505
10506 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10507 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10508 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10509
10510 @smallexample
10511 set $i = 0
10512 print bar[$i++]->contents
10513 @end smallexample
10514
10515 @noindent
10516 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10517
10518 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10519 values likely to be useful.
10520
10521 @table @code
10522 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10523 @item $_
10524 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10525 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10526 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10527 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10528 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10529 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10530 to the type of @code{$__}.
10531
10532 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10533 @item $__
10534 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10535 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10536 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10537
10538 @item $_exitcode
10539 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10540 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10541 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10542 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10543
10544 @item $_exitsignal
10545 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10546 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10547 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10548 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10549
10550 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10551 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10552 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10553 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10554 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10555
10556 @smallexample
10557 #include <signal.h>
10558
10559 int
10560 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10561 @{
10562 raise (SIGALRM);
10563 return 0;
10564 @}
10565 @end smallexample
10566
10567 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10568 or signalled would be:
10569
10570 @smallexample
10571 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10572 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10573 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10574 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10575 >echo The program has exited\n
10576 >else
10577 >echo The program has signalled\n
10578 >end
10579 >end
10580 (@value{GDBP}) run
10581 Starting program:
10582
10583 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10584 The program no longer exists.
10585 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10586 The program has signalled
10587 @end smallexample
10588
10589 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10590 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10591 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10592 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10593
10594 @smallexample
10595 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10596 The program has exited
10597 @end smallexample
10598
10599 @item $_exception
10600 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10601 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10602
10603 @item $_probe_argc
10604 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10605 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10606
10607 @item $_sdata
10608 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10609 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10610 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10611 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10612 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10613
10614 @item $_siginfo
10615 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10616 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10617 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10618 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10619 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10620
10621 @item $_tlb
10622 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10623 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10624 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10625 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10626 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10627 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10628
10629 @item $_inferior
10630 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10631 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10632
10633 @item $_thread
10634 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10635
10636 @item $_gthread
10637 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10638
10639 @end table
10640
10641 @node Convenience Funs
10642 @section Convenience Functions
10643
10644 @cindex convenience functions
10645 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10646 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10647 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10648 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10649 @value{GDBN}.
10650
10651 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10652 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10653
10654 @table @code
10655
10656 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10657 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10658 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10659 returns zero.
10660
10661 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10662 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10663 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10664 it is @code{void}:
10665
10666 @smallexample
10667 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10668 $1 = void
10669 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10670 $2 = 1
10671 (@value{GDBP}) run
10672 Starting program: ./a.out
10673 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10674 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10675 $3 = 0
10676 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10677 $4 = 0
10678 @end smallexample
10679
10680 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10681 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10682 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10683 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10684 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10685 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10686 anymore.
10687
10688 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10689 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10690
10691 @smallexample
10692 void
10693 foo (void)
10694 @{
10695 @}
10696 @end smallexample
10697
10698 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10699
10700 @smallexample
10701 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10702 $1 = void
10703 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10704 $2 = 1
10705 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10706 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10707 $3 = void
10708 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10709 $4 = 1
10710 @end smallexample
10711
10712 @end table
10713
10714 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10715 @code{Python} support.
10716
10717 @table @code
10718
10719 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10720 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10721 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10722 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10723 Otherwise it returns zero.
10724
10725 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10726 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10727 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10728 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10729 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10730 regular expression support.
10731
10732 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10733 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10734 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10735 Otherwise it returns zero.
10736
10737 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10738 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10739 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10740
10741 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10742 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10743 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10744 Otherwise it returns zero.
10745
10746 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10747 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10748 The default is 1.
10749
10750 Example:
10751
10752 @smallexample
10753 (gdb) backtrace
10754 #0 bottom_func ()
10755 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10756 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10757 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10758 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10759 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10760 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10761 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10762 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10763 $1 = 1
10764 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10765 $1 = 1
10766 @end smallexample
10767
10768 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10769 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10770 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10771 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10772
10773 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10774 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10775 The default is 1.
10776
10777 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10778 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10779 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10780 Otherwise it returns zero.
10781
10782 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10783 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10784 The default is 1.
10785
10786 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10787 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10788 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10789 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10790
10791 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10792 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10793 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10794 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10795
10796 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10797 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10798 The default is 1.
10799
10800 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10801 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10802 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10803 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10804
10805 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
10806 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
10807 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
10808
10809 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
10810 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
10811 an enumerated type:
10812
10813 @smallexample
10814 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
10815 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
10816 @end smallexample
10817
10818 @end table
10819
10820 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10821 convenience functions.
10822
10823 @table @code
10824 @item help function
10825 @kindex help function
10826 @cindex show all convenience functions
10827 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10828 @end table
10829
10830 @node Registers
10831 @section Registers
10832
10833 @cindex registers
10834 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10835 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10836 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10837 your machine.
10838
10839 @table @code
10840 @kindex info registers
10841 @item info registers
10842 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10843 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10844
10845 @kindex info all-registers
10846 @cindex floating point registers
10847 @item info all-registers
10848 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10849 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10850
10851 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10852 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10853 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10854 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10855 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10856 @end table
10857
10858 @anchor{standard registers}
10859 @cindex stack pointer register
10860 @cindex program counter register
10861 @cindex process status register
10862 @cindex frame pointer register
10863 @cindex standard registers
10864 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10865 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10866 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10867 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10868 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10869 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10870 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10871 you could print the program counter in hex with
10872
10873 @smallexample
10874 p/x $pc
10875 @end smallexample
10876
10877 @noindent
10878 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10879
10880 @smallexample
10881 x/i $pc
10882 @end smallexample
10883
10884 @noindent
10885 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10886 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10887 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10888 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10889 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10890 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10891 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10892
10893 @smallexample
10894 set $sp += 4
10895 @end smallexample
10896
10897 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10898 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10899 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10900 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10901 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10902 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10903 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10904
10905 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10906 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10907 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10908 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10909 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10910 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10911 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10912
10913 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10914 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10915 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10916 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10917 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10918 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10919 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10920 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10921 prints the data in both formats.
10922
10923 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10924 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10925 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10926 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10927 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10928 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10929 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10930
10931 @smallexample
10932 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10933 $1 = @{
10934 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10935 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10936 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10937 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10938 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10939 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10940 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10941 @}
10942 @end smallexample
10943
10944 @noindent
10945 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10946 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10947 value to a @code{struct} member:
10948
10949 @smallexample
10950 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10951 @end smallexample
10952
10953 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10954 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10955 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10956 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10957 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10958 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10959
10960 @cindex caller-saved registers
10961 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10962 @cindex volatile registers
10963 @cindex <not saved> values
10964 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10965 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10966 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10967 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10968 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10969 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10970 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10971 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10972 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10973 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10974 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10975 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10976 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10977 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10978 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10979 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10980 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10981 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10982 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10983 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10984 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10985 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10986 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10987
10988 @node Floating Point Hardware
10989 @section Floating Point Hardware
10990 @cindex floating point
10991
10992 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10993 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10994
10995 @table @code
10996 @kindex info float
10997 @item info float
10998 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10999 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11000 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11001 the ARM and x86 machines.
11002 @end table
11003
11004 @node Vector Unit
11005 @section Vector Unit
11006 @cindex vector unit
11007
11008 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11009 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11010
11011 @table @code
11012 @kindex info vector
11013 @item info vector
11014 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11015 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11016 @end table
11017
11018 @node OS Information
11019 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11020 @cindex OS information
11021
11022 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11023 you debug your program.
11024
11025 @cindex auxiliary vector
11026 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11027 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11028 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11029 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11030 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11031 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11032 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11033 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11034 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11035 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11036 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11037 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11038
11039 @table @code
11040 @kindex info auxv
11041 @item info auxv
11042 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11043 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11044 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11045 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11046 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11047 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11048 an unrecognized tag.
11049 @end table
11050
11051 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11052 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11053 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11054 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11055 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11056 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11057 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11058
11059 @table @code
11060 @kindex info os
11061 @item info os @var{infotype}
11062
11063 Display OS information of the requested type.
11064
11065 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11066
11067 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11068 @table @code
11069 @kindex info os cpus
11070 @item cpus
11071 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11072 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11073 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11074 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11075 kernel initialization.
11076
11077 @kindex info os files
11078 @item files
11079 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11080 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11081 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11082 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11083
11084 @kindex info os modules
11085 @item modules
11086 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11087 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11088 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11089 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11090 in memory.
11091
11092 @kindex info os msg
11093 @item msg
11094 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11095 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11096 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11097 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11098 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11099 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11100 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11101 the message queue was last changed.
11102
11103 @kindex info os processes
11104 @item processes
11105 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11106 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11107 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11108 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11109 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11110 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11111
11112 @kindex info os procgroups
11113 @item procgroups
11114 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11115 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11116 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11117 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11118 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11119 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11120 and the process group leader is listed first.
11121
11122 @kindex info os semaphores
11123 @item semaphores
11124 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11125 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11126 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11127 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11128 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11129
11130 @kindex info os shm
11131 @item shm
11132 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11133 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11134 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11135 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11136 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11137 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11138 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11139
11140 @kindex info os sockets
11141 @item sockets
11142 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11143 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11144 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11145 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11146 connection.
11147
11148 @kindex info os threads
11149 @item threads
11150 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11151 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11152 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11153 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11154 process is not listed.
11155 @end table
11156
11157 @item info os
11158 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11159 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11160 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11161 types, this command will report an error.
11162 @end table
11163
11164 @node Memory Region Attributes
11165 @section Memory Region Attributes
11166 @cindex memory region attributes
11167
11168 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11169 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11170 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11171 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11172 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11173 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11174 user can override the fetched regions.
11175
11176 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11177 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11178 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11179 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11180 all memory.
11181
11182 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11183 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11184
11185 @table @code
11186 @kindex mem
11187 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11188 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11189 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11190 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11191 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11192 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11193
11194 @item mem auto
11195 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11196 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11197
11198 @kindex delete mem
11199 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11200 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11201 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11202
11203 @kindex disable mem
11204 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11205 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11206 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11207 It may be enabled again later.
11208
11209 @kindex enable mem
11210 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11211 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11212
11213 @kindex info mem
11214 @item info mem
11215 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11216 for each region:
11217
11218 @table @emph
11219 @item Memory Region Number
11220 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11221 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11222 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11223
11224 @item Lo Address
11225 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11226
11227 @item Hi Address
11228 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11229
11230 @item Attributes
11231 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11232 @end table
11233 @end table
11234
11235
11236 @subsection Attributes
11237
11238 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11239 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11240 write accesses to a memory region.
11241
11242 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11243 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11244 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11245
11246 @table @code
11247 @item ro
11248 Memory is read only.
11249 @item wo
11250 Memory is write only.
11251 @item rw
11252 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11253 @end table
11254
11255 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11256 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11257 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11258 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11259 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11260
11261 @table @code
11262 @item 8
11263 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11264 @item 16
11265 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11266 @item 32
11267 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11268 @item 64
11269 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11270 @end table
11271
11272 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11273 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11274 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11275 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11276 @c
11277 @c @table @code
11278 @c @item hwbreak
11279 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11280 @c @item swbreak (default)
11281 @c @end table
11282
11283 @subsubsection Data Cache
11284 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11285 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11286 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11287 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11288 registers.
11289
11290 @table @code
11291 @item cache
11292 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11293 @item nocache
11294 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11295 @end table
11296
11297 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11298 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11299 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11300 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11301 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11302
11303 @table @code
11304 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11305 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11306 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11307 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11308 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11309 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11310 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11311 The default value is @code{on}.
11312 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11313 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11314 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11315 @end table
11316
11317
11318 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11319 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11320 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11321 @c
11322 @c @table @code
11323 @c @item verify
11324 @c @item noverify (default)
11325 @c @end table
11326
11327 @node Dump/Restore Files
11328 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11329 @cindex dump/restore files
11330 @cindex append data to a file
11331 @cindex dump data to a file
11332 @cindex restore data from a file
11333
11334 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11335 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11336 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11337 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11338 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11339 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11340 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11341
11342 @table @code
11343
11344 @kindex dump
11345 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11346 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11347 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11348 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11349
11350 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11351 @table @code
11352 @item binary
11353 Raw binary form.
11354 @item ihex
11355 Intel hex format.
11356 @item srec
11357 Motorola S-record format.
11358 @item tekhex
11359 Tektronix Hex format.
11360 @item verilog
11361 Verilog Hex format.
11362 @end table
11363
11364 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11365 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11366 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11367 form.
11368
11369 @kindex append
11370 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11371 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11372 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11373 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11374 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11375
11376 @kindex restore
11377 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11378 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11379 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11380 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11381 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11382
11383 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11384 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11385 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11386 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11387 from that location.
11388
11389 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11390 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11391 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11392 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11393
11394 @end table
11395
11396 @node Core File Generation
11397 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11398 @cindex dump core from inferior
11399
11400 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11401 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11402 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11403 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11404 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11405 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11406 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11407
11408 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11409 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11410 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11411
11412 @table @code
11413 @kindex gcore
11414 @kindex generate-core-file
11415 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11416 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11417 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11418 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11419 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11420 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11421
11422 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11423 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11424
11425 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11426 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11427 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11428
11429 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11430 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11431 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11432 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11433 Enable or disable the use of the file
11434 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11435 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11436 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11437 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11438
11439 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11440 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11441 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11442 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11443 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11444 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11445 about the bits that can be set in the
11446 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11447 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11448
11449 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11450 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11451 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11452 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11453 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11454 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11455 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11456 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11457 @end table
11458
11459 @node Character Sets
11460 @section Character Sets
11461 @cindex character sets
11462 @cindex charset
11463 @cindex translating between character sets
11464 @cindex host character set
11465 @cindex target character set
11466
11467 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11468 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11469 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11470 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11471 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11472 @dfn{target character set}.
11473
11474 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11475 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11476 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11477 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11478 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11479 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11480 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11481 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11482 character and string literals in expressions.
11483
11484 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11485 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11486 target-charset} command, described below.
11487
11488 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11489 support:
11490
11491 @table @code
11492 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11493 @kindex set target-charset
11494 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11495 list of supported target character sets, type
11496 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11497
11498 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11499 @kindex set host-charset
11500 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11501
11502 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11503 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11504 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11505 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11506 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11507
11508 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11509 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11510 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11511
11512 @item set charset @var{charset}
11513 @kindex set charset
11514 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11515 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11516 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11517 for both host and target.
11518
11519 @item show charset
11520 @kindex show charset
11521 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11522
11523 @item show host-charset
11524 @kindex show host-charset
11525 Show the name of the current host character set.
11526
11527 @item show target-charset
11528 @kindex show target-charset
11529 Show the name of the current target character set.
11530
11531 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11532 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11533 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11534 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11535 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11536 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11537
11538 @item show target-wide-charset
11539 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11540 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11541 @end table
11542
11543 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11544 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11545 @file{charset-test.c}:
11546
11547 @smallexample
11548 #include <stdio.h>
11549
11550 char ascii_hello[]
11551 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11552 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11553 char ibm1047_hello[]
11554 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11555 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11556
11557 main ()
11558 @{
11559 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11560 @}
11561 @end smallexample
11562
11563 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11564 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11565 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11566
11567 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11568
11569 @smallexample
11570 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11571 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11572 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11573 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11574 @dots{}
11575 (@value{GDBP})
11576 @end smallexample
11577
11578 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11579 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11580 strings:
11581
11582 @smallexample
11583 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11584 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11585 (@value{GDBP})
11586 @end smallexample
11587
11588 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11589 initial character set:
11590 @smallexample
11591 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11592 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11593 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11594 (@value{GDBP})
11595 @end smallexample
11596
11597 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11598 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11599 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11600 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11601 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11602
11603 @smallexample
11604 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11605 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11606 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11607 $2 = 72 'H'
11608 (@value{GDBP})
11609 @end smallexample
11610
11611 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11612 literals you use in expressions:
11613
11614 @smallexample
11615 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11616 $3 = 43 '+'
11617 (@value{GDBP})
11618 @end smallexample
11619
11620 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11621 character.
11622
11623 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11624 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11625 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11626
11627 @smallexample
11628 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11629 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11630 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11631 $5 = 200 '\310'
11632 (@value{GDBP})
11633 @end smallexample
11634
11635 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11636 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11637
11638 @smallexample
11639 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11640 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11641 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11642 @end smallexample
11643
11644 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11645 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11646 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11647 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11648 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11649
11650 @smallexample
11651 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11652 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11653 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11654 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11655 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11656 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11657 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11658 $7 = 72 '\110'
11659 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11660 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11661 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11662 $9 = 200 'H'
11663 (@value{GDBP})
11664 @end smallexample
11665
11666 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11667 string literals you use in expressions:
11668
11669 @smallexample
11670 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11671 $10 = 78 '+'
11672 (@value{GDBP})
11673 @end smallexample
11674
11675 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11676 character.
11677
11678 @node Caching Target Data
11679 @section Caching Data of Targets
11680 @cindex caching data of targets
11681
11682 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11683 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11684 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11685 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11686 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11687 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11688 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11689 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11690 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11691 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11692 is executing.
11693 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11694 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11695 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11696 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11697 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11698 in the code segment.
11699 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11700 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11701
11702 @table @code
11703 @kindex set remotecache
11704 @item set remotecache on
11705 @itemx set remotecache off
11706 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11707 with old scripts.
11708
11709 @kindex show remotecache
11710 @item show remotecache
11711 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11712
11713 @kindex set stack-cache
11714 @item set stack-cache on
11715 @itemx set stack-cache off
11716 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11717 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11718
11719 @kindex show stack-cache
11720 @item show stack-cache
11721 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11722
11723 @kindex set code-cache
11724 @item set code-cache on
11725 @itemx set code-cache off
11726 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11727 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11728 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11729
11730 @kindex show code-cache
11731 @item show code-cache
11732 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11733 accesses.
11734
11735 @kindex info dcache
11736 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11737 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11738 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11739 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11740 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11741 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11742
11743 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11744 printed in hex.
11745
11746 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11747 @cindex dcache size
11748 @kindex set dcache size
11749 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11750
11751 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11752 @cindex dcache line-size
11753 @kindex set dcache line-size
11754 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11755 Must be a power of 2.
11756
11757 @item show dcache size
11758 @kindex show dcache size
11759 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11760
11761 @item show dcache line-size
11762 @kindex show dcache line-size
11763 Show default size of dcache lines.
11764
11765 @end table
11766
11767 @node Searching Memory
11768 @section Search Memory
11769 @cindex searching memory
11770
11771 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11772 @code{find} command.
11773
11774 @table @code
11775 @kindex find
11776 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11777 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11778 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11779 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11780 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11781 @end table
11782
11783 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11784 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11785
11786 @table @r
11787 @item @var{s}, search query size
11788 The size of each search query value.
11789
11790 @table @code
11791 @item b
11792 bytes
11793 @item h
11794 halfwords (two bytes)
11795 @item w
11796 words (four bytes)
11797 @item g
11798 giant words (eight bytes)
11799 @end table
11800
11801 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11802 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11803 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11804
11805 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11806 value's type in the current language.
11807 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11808 pattern as a mixture of types.
11809 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11810 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11811 which is typically four bytes.
11812
11813 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11814 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11815 @end table
11816
11817 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11818 (@code{"}).
11819 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11820 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11821
11822 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11823 number of matches found.
11824
11825 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11826 @samp{$_}.
11827 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11828
11829 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11830
11831 @smallexample
11832 void
11833 hello ()
11834 @{
11835 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11836 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11837 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11838 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11839 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11840 @}
11841 @end smallexample
11842
11843 @noindent
11844 you get during debugging:
11845
11846 @smallexample
11847 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11848 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11849 1 pattern found
11850 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11851 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11852 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11853 2 patterns found
11854 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11855 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11856 1 pattern found
11857 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11858 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11859 1 pattern found
11860 (gdb) print $numfound
11861 $1 = 1
11862 (gdb) print $_
11863 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11864 @end smallexample
11865
11866 @node Value Sizes
11867 @section Value Sizes
11868
11869 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
11870 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
11871 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
11872 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
11873 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
11874
11875 @table @code
11876 @kindex set max-value-size
11877 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
11878 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
11879 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
11880 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
11881 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
11882
11883 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
11884 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
11885
11886 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
11887 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
11888 currently 16 bytes.
11889
11890 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
11891 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
11892 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
11893 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
11894 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
11895 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
11896 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
11897 size is less than @var{bytes}.
11898
11899 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
11900
11901 @kindex show max-value-size
11902 @item show max-value-size
11903 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
11904 allocate for the contents of a value.
11905 @end table
11906
11907 @node Optimized Code
11908 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11909 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11910 @cindex debugging optimized code
11911
11912 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11913 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11914 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11915 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11916 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11917 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11918 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11919
11920 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11921 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11922 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11923 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11924
11925 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11926 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11927 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11928 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11929 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11930 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11931
11932 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11933 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11934 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11935 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11936 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11937
11938 @menu
11939 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11940 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11941 @end menu
11942
11943 @node Inline Functions
11944 @section Inline Functions
11945 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11946
11947 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11948 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11949 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11950 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11951 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11952 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11953 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11954 @code{info frame} command.
11955
11956 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11957 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11958 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11959 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11960 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11961 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11962 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11963 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11964 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11965 local variables in the caller.
11966
11967 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11968 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11969 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11970 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11971 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11972 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11973 instructions are executed.
11974
11975 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11976 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11977 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11978 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11979
11980 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11981 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11982
11983 @itemize @bullet
11984 @item
11985 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11986 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11987 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11988 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11989 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11990 or inside the inlined function instead.
11991
11992 @item
11993 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11994 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11995 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11996 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11997
11998 @end itemize
11999
12000 @node Tail Call Frames
12001 @section Tail Call Frames
12002 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12003
12004 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12005 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12006 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12007 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12008 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12009
12010 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12011 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12012 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12013 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12014 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12015 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12016 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12017
12018 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12019 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
12020 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12021 this information.
12022
12023 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12024 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12025
12026 @smallexample
12027 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12028 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12029 (gdb) info frame
12030 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12031 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12032 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12033 source language c++.
12034 Arglist at unknown address.
12035 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12036 @end smallexample
12037
12038 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12039 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12040 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12041 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12042 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12043 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12044
12045 @table @code
12046 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12047 @item set debug entry-values
12048 @kindex set debug entry-values
12049 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12050 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12051 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12052 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12053 result.
12054
12055 @item show debug entry-values
12056 @kindex show debug entry-values
12057 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12058 values at function entry and tail calls.
12059 @end table
12060
12061 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12062 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12063 reference by variable @code{x}):
12064
12065 @smallexample
12066 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12067 void (*x) (void) = c;
12068 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12069 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12070 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12071
12072 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
12073 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
12074 a () at t.c:3
12075 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12076 (gdb) bt
12077 #0 a () at t.c:3
12078 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12079 @end smallexample
12080
12081 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12082
12083 @smallexample
12084 int i;
12085 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12086 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12087 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12088 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12089 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12090 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12091 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12092 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12093
12094 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12095 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12096 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12097 (gdb) bt
12098 #0 f () at t.c:2
12099 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12100 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12101 @end smallexample
12102
12103 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12104 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12105
12106 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12107 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12108 @set ARROW @click{}
12109 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12110 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12111 @end ifset
12112 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12113 @set ARROW ->
12114 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12115 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12116 @end ifclear
12117
12118 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12119 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12120 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12121
12122 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12123 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12124 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12125 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12126 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12127 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12128
12129 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12130 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12131 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12132 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12133 omitted.
12134
12135 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12136 entry may fail:
12137
12138 @smallexample
12139 int v;
12140 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12141 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12142 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12143 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12144 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12145 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12146
12147 (gdb) bt
12148 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12149 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
12150 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12151 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12152 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12153 @end smallexample
12154
12155 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12156 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12157 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12158 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12159 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12160
12161 @node Macros
12162 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12163
12164 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12165 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12166 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12167 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12168 where it was defined.
12169
12170 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12171 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12172 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12173 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12174
12175 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12176 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12177 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12178 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12179 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12180 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12181 see @ref{List}.
12182
12183 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12184 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12185 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12186
12187 @table @code
12188
12189 @kindex macro expand
12190 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12191 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12192 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12193 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12194 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12195 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12196 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12197 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12198 it can be any string of tokens.
12199
12200 @kindex macro exp1
12201 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12202 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12203 @cindex expand macro once
12204 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12205 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12206 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12207 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12208 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12209 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12210 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12211 can be any string of tokens.
12212
12213 @kindex info macro
12214 @cindex macro definition, showing
12215 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12216 @cindex macros, from debug info
12217 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12218 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12219 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12220 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12221 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12222 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12223
12224 @kindex info macros
12225 @item info macros @var{location}
12226 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12227 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12228 command-line where those definitions were established.
12229
12230 @kindex macro define
12231 @cindex user-defined macros
12232 @cindex defining macros interactively
12233 @cindex macros, user-defined
12234 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12235 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12236 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12237 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12238 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12239 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12240 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12241 @var{arglist}.
12242
12243 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12244 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12245 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12246 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12247 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12248
12249 @kindex macro undef
12250 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12251 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12252 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12253 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12254 in the program being debugged.
12255
12256 @kindex macro list
12257 @item macro list
12258 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12259 @end table
12260
12261 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12262 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12263 show our source files:
12264
12265 @smallexample
12266 $ cat sample.c
12267 #include <stdio.h>
12268 #include "sample.h"
12269
12270 #define M 42
12271 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12272
12273 main ()
12274 @{
12275 #define N 28
12276 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12277 #undef N
12278 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12279 #define N 1729
12280 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12281 @}
12282 $ cat sample.h
12283 #define Q <
12284 $
12285 @end smallexample
12286
12287 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12288 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12289 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12290 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12291 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12292 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12293 information.
12294
12295 @smallexample
12296 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12297 $
12298 @end smallexample
12299
12300 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12301
12302 @smallexample
12303 $ gdb -nw sample
12304 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12305 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12306 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12307 (@value{GDBP})
12308 @end smallexample
12309
12310 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12311 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12312 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12313
12314 @smallexample
12315 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12316 3
12317 4 #define M 42
12318 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12319 6
12320 7 main ()
12321 8 @{
12322 9 #define N 28
12323 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12324 11 #undef N
12325 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12326 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12327 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12328 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12329 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12330 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12331 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12332 #define Q <
12333 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12334 expands to: (42 + 1)
12335 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12336 expands to: once (M + 1)
12337 (@value{GDBP})
12338 @end smallexample
12339
12340 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12341 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12342 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12343 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12344
12345 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12346 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12347
12348 @smallexample
12349 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12350 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12351 (@value{GDBP}) run
12352 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12353
12354 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12355 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12356 (@value{GDBP})
12357 @end smallexample
12358
12359 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12360
12361 @smallexample
12362 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12363 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12364 #define N 28
12365 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12366 expands to: 28 < 42
12367 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12368 $1 = 1
12369 (@value{GDBP})
12370 @end smallexample
12371
12372 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12373 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12374 thereof) in force at each point:
12375
12376 @smallexample
12377 (@value{GDBP}) next
12378 Hello, world!
12379 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12380 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12381 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12382 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12383 (@value{GDBP}) next
12384 We're so creative.
12385 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12386 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12387 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12388 #define N 1729
12389 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12390 expands to: 1729 < 42
12391 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12392 $2 = 0
12393 (@value{GDBP})
12394 @end smallexample
12395
12396 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12397 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12398 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12399 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12400
12401 @smallexample
12402 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12403 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12404 -D__STDC__=1
12405 (@value{GDBP})
12406 @end smallexample
12407
12408
12409 @node Tracepoints
12410 @chapter Tracepoints
12411 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12412 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12413
12414 @cindex tracepoints
12415 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12416 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12417 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12418 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12419 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12420 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12421 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12422
12423 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12424 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12425 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12426 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12427 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12428 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12429 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12430 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12431 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12432 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12433 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12434
12435 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12436 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12437 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12438 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12439 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12440 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12441 Packets}.
12442
12443 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12444 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12445 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12446
12447 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12448
12449 @menu
12450 * Set Tracepoints::
12451 * Analyze Collected Data::
12452 * Tracepoint Variables::
12453 * Trace Files::
12454 @end menu
12455
12456 @node Set Tracepoints
12457 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12458
12459 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12460 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12461 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12462 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12463 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12464 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12465 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12466
12467 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12468 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12469 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12470 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12471 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12472 tracepoint was hit.
12473
12474 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12475 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12476 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12477 either.
12478
12479 @cindex fast tracepoints
12480 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12481 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12482 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12483
12484 @cindex static tracepoints
12485 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12486 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12487 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12488 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12489 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12490 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12491 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12492 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12493 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12494 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12495 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12496 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12497 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12498 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12499 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12500 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12501 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12502 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12503 static tracepoint marker.
12504
12505 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12506 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12507
12508 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12509 conditions and actions.
12510
12511 @menu
12512 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12513 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12514 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12515 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12516 * Trace State Variables::
12517 * Tracepoint Actions::
12518 * Listing Tracepoints::
12519 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12520 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12521 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12522 @end menu
12523
12524 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12525 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12526
12527 @table @code
12528 @cindex set tracepoint
12529 @kindex trace
12530 @item trace @var{location}
12531 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12532 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12533 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12534 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12535 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12536 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12537 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12538 in tracing}).
12539 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12540 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12541 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12542 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12543 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12544 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12545 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12546 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12547 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12548 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12549 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12550 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12551
12552 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12553
12554 @smallexample
12555 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12556
12557 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12558
12559 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12560
12561 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12562
12563 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12564 @end smallexample
12565
12566 @noindent
12567 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12568
12569 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12570 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12571 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12572 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12573 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12574 information on tracepoint conditions.
12575
12576 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12577 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12578 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12579 @kindex ftrace
12580 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12581 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12582 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12583 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12584 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12585 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12586 message.
12587
12588 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12589 @code{trace}.
12590
12591 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12592 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12593 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12594 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12595 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12596 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12597 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12598 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12599
12600 @example
12601 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12602 @end example
12603
12604 @noindent
12605 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12606 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12607
12608 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12609 @cindex set static tracepoint
12610 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12611 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12612 @kindex strace
12613 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12614 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12615 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12616 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12617 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12618
12619 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12620 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12621 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12622 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12623 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12624 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12625 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12626 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12627 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12628 tracing engine:
12629
12630 @smallexample
12631 main ()
12632 @{
12633 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12634 @}
12635 @end smallexample
12636
12637 @noindent
12638 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12639 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12640
12641 @smallexample
12642 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12643 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12644 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12645 Data: "str %s"
12646 [etc...]
12647 @end smallexample
12648
12649 @noindent
12650 so you may probe the marker above with:
12651
12652 @smallexample
12653 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12654 @end smallexample
12655
12656 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12657 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12658 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12659 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12660 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12661 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12662 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12663 the @samp{Data:} field.
12664
12665 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12666 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12667 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12668
12669 @vindex $tpnum
12670 @cindex last tracepoint number
12671 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12672 @cindex tracepoint number
12673 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12674 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12675
12676 @kindex delete tracepoint
12677 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12678 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12679 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12680 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12681 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12682
12683 Examples:
12684
12685 @smallexample
12686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12687
12688 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12689 @end smallexample
12690
12691 @noindent
12692 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12693 @end table
12694
12695 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12696 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12697
12698 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12699
12700 @table @code
12701 @kindex disable tracepoint
12702 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12703 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12704 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12705 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12706 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12707 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12708 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12709 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12710 next trace experiment.
12711
12712 @kindex enable tracepoint
12713 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12714 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12715 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12716 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12717 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12718 next time a trace experiment is run.
12719 @end table
12720
12721 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12722 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12723
12724 @table @code
12725 @kindex passcount
12726 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12727 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12728 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12729 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12730 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12731 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12732 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12733 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12734 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12735 user.
12736
12737 Examples:
12738
12739 @smallexample
12740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12741 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12742
12743 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12744 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12746 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12747 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12748 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12749 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12751 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12752 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12753 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12754 @end smallexample
12755 @end table
12756
12757 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12758 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12759 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12760 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12761
12762 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12763 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12764 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12765 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12766 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12767 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12768 is true.
12769
12770 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12771 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12772 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12773 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12774 just as with breakpoints.
12775
12776 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12777 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12778 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12779 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12780 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12781 accesses, and so forth.
12782
12783 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12784 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12785 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12786 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12787 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12788 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12789 search through.
12790
12791 @smallexample
12792 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12793 @end smallexample
12794
12795 @node Trace State Variables
12796 @subsection Trace State Variables
12797 @cindex trace state variables
12798
12799 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12800 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12801 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12802 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12803 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12804 integers.
12805
12806 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12807 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12808 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12809 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12810
12811 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12812 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12813 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12814 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12815 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12816 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12817 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12818 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12819 variable with the same name.
12820
12821 @table @code
12822
12823 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12824 @kindex tvariable
12825 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12826 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12827 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12828 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12829 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12830 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12831 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12832 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12833 value. The default initial value is 0.
12834
12835 @item info tvariables
12836 @kindex info tvariables
12837 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12838 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12839 currently running.
12840
12841 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12842 @kindex delete tvariable
12843 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12844 are specified.
12845
12846 @end table
12847
12848 @node Tracepoint Actions
12849 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12850
12851 @table @code
12852 @kindex actions
12853 @cindex tracepoint actions
12854 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12855 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12856 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12857 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12858 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12859 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12860 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12861 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12862 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12863 @code{while-stepping}.
12864
12865 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12866 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12867 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12868
12869 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12870 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12871 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12872
12873 @smallexample
12874 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12875
12876 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12877
12878 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12879 @end smallexample
12880
12881 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12882 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12883 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12884 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12885 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12886 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12887 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12888 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12889
12890 @smallexample
12891 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12892 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12893 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12894 > collect bar,baz
12895 > collect $regs
12896 > while-stepping 12
12897 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12898 > end
12899 end
12900 @end smallexample
12901
12902 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12903 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12904 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12905 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12906 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12907 special arguments are supported:
12908
12909 @table @code
12910 @item $regs
12911 Collect all registers.
12912
12913 @item $args
12914 Collect all function arguments.
12915
12916 @item $locals
12917 Collect all local variables.
12918
12919 @item $_ret
12920 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12921 of a backtrace.
12922
12923 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
12924 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
12925 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
12926 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
12927 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
12928 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
12929
12930 @item $_probe_argc
12931 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12932 tracepoint is located.
12933 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12934
12935 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12936 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12937 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12938 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12939
12940 @item $_sdata
12941 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12942 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12943 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12944 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12945 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12946 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12947 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12948 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12949 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12950
12951 @smallexample
12952 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12953 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12954 @end smallexample
12955
12956 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12957 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12958 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12959 @value{GDBN}.
12960 @end table
12961
12962 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12963 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12964 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12965
12966 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12967 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12968 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12969 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12970 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12971 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12972 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12973 @samp{mystr}.
12974
12975 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12976 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12977
12978 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12979 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12980 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12981 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12982 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12983 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12984 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12985 action were used.
12986
12987 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12988 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12989 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12990 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12991 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12992 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12993
12994 @smallexample
12995 > while-stepping 12
12996 > collect $regs, myglobal
12997 > end
12998 >
12999 @end smallexample
13000
13001 @noindent
13002 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13003 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13004 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13005 @code{stepping}.
13006
13007 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13008 @kindex set default-collect
13009 @cindex default collection action
13010 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13011 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13012 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13013 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13014 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13015 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13016
13017 @item show default-collect
13018 @kindex show default-collect
13019 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13020 tracepoint hit.
13021
13022 @end table
13023
13024 @node Listing Tracepoints
13025 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13026
13027 @table @code
13028 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13029 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13030 @cindex information about tracepoints
13031 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13032 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13033 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13034 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13035 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13036 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13037
13038 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13039 tracing:
13040
13041 @itemize @bullet
13042 @item
13043 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13044
13045 @item
13046 the state about installed on target of each location
13047 @end itemize
13048
13049 @smallexample
13050 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13051 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13052 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13053 while-stepping 20
13054 collect globfoo, $regs
13055 end
13056 collect globfoo2
13057 end
13058 pass count 1200
13059 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13060 collect $eip
13061 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13062 installed on target
13063 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13064 installed on target
13065 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13066 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13067 not installed on target
13068 (@value{GDBP})
13069 @end smallexample
13070
13071 @noindent
13072 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13073 @end table
13074
13075 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13076 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13077
13078 @table @code
13079 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13080 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13081 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13082 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13083 program.
13084
13085 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13086
13087 @table @emph
13088 @item Count
13089 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13090 stable identifier.
13091 @item ID
13092 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13093 @item Enabled or Disabled
13094 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13095 that are not enabled.
13096 @item Address
13097 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13098 @item What
13099 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13100 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13101 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13102 will be left blank.
13103 @end table
13104
13105 @noindent
13106 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13107
13108 @table @emph
13109 @item Data
13110 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13111 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13112 marker call.
13113 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13114 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13115 @end table
13116
13117 @smallexample
13118 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13119 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13120 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13121 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13122 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13123 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13124 Data: str %s
13125 (@value{GDBP})
13126 @end smallexample
13127 @end table
13128
13129 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13130 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13131
13132 @table @code
13133 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13134 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13135 @cindex collected data discarded
13136 @item tstart
13137 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13138 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13139 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13140 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13141 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13142 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13143 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13144 information, and so forth.
13145
13146 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13147 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13148 @item tstop
13149 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13150 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13151 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13152 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13153 needs to be stopped quickly.
13154
13155 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13156 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13157 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13158
13159 @kindex tstatus
13160 @cindex status of trace data collection
13161 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13162 @item tstatus
13163 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13164 collection.
13165 @end table
13166
13167 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13168
13169 @smallexample
13170 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13171 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13172 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13173 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13174 > while-stepping 11
13175 > collect $regs
13176 > end
13177 > end
13178 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13179 [time passes @dots{}]
13180 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13181 @end smallexample
13182
13183 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13184 @cindex disconnected tracing
13185 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13186 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13187 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13188 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13189 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13190 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13191 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13192 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13193
13194 @table @code
13195 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13196 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13197 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13198 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13199 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13200 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13201 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13202 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13203
13204 @item show disconnected-tracing
13205 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13206 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13207
13208 @end table
13209
13210 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13211 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13212 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13213 it will continue after reconnection.
13214
13215 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13216 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13217 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13218 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13219 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13220 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13221 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13222 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13223 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13224 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13225
13226 @cindex circular trace buffer
13227 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13228 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13229 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13230 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13231 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13232 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13233 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13234 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13235 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13236 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13237 the next run.
13238
13239 @table @code
13240 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13241 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13242 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13243 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13244 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13245 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13246 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13247
13248 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13249 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13250 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13251 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13252 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13253 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13254
13255 @end table
13256
13257 @table @code
13258 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13259 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13260 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13261 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13262 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13263 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13264 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13265 likes. This is also the default.
13266
13267 @item show trace-buffer-size
13268 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13269 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13270 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13271 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13272 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13273 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13274 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13275 @end table
13276
13277 @table @code
13278 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13279 @kindex set trace-user
13280
13281 @item show trace-user
13282 @kindex show trace-user
13283
13284 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13285 @kindex set trace-notes
13286 Set the trace run's notes.
13287
13288 @item show trace-notes
13289 @kindex show trace-notes
13290 Show the trace run's notes.
13291
13292 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13293 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13294 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13295 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13296 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13297
13298 @item show trace-stop-notes
13299 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13300 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13301
13302 @end table
13303
13304 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13305 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13306
13307 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13308 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13309 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13310 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13311 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13312 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13313 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13314 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13315 mentioned here.
13316
13317 @itemize @bullet
13318
13319 @item
13320 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13321 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13322 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13323 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13324 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13325 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13326 cannot be collected either.
13327
13328 @item
13329 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13330 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13331 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13332 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13333 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13334 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13335 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13336 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13337 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13338 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13339
13340 @item
13341 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13342 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13343 in a misleading way.
13344
13345 @item
13346 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13347 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13348 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13349 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13350 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13351 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13352 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13353 by @code{ptr}.
13354
13355 @item
13356 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13357 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13358 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13359 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13360 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13361 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13362 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13363 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13364 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13365 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13366 invalid address.
13367
13368 @item
13369 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13370 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13371 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13372 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13373 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13374 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13375 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13376 it to zero.
13377
13378 @end itemize
13379
13380 @node Analyze Collected Data
13381 @section Using the Collected Data
13382
13383 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13384 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13385 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13386 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13387 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13388 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13389 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13390 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13391 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13392 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13393 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13394 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13395 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13396 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13397 the buffer will fail.
13398
13399 @menu
13400 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13401 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13402 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13403 @end menu
13404
13405 @node tfind
13406 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13407
13408 @kindex tfind
13409 @cindex select trace snapshot
13410 @cindex find trace snapshot
13411 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13412 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13413 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13414 snapshot is selected.
13415
13416 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13417
13418 @table @code
13419 @item tfind start
13420 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13421 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13422
13423 @item tfind none
13424 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13425
13426 @item tfind end
13427 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13428
13429 @item tfind
13430 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13431 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13432
13433 @item tfind -
13434 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13435 retracing earlier steps.
13436
13437 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13438 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13439 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13440 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13441 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13442
13443 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13444 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13445 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13446 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13447 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13448
13449 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13450 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13451 addresses (exclusive).
13452
13453 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13454 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13455 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13456
13457 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13458 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13459 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13460 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13461 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13462 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13463 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13464 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13465 @end table
13466
13467 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13468 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13469 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13470 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13471 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13472 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13473 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13474 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13475 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13476 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13477 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13478 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13479 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13480 tracepoint as the current one.
13481
13482 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13483 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13484 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13485 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13486 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13487
13488 @smallexample
13489 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13490 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13491 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13492 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13493 > tfind
13494 > end
13495
13496 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13497 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13498 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13499 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13500 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13501 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13502 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13503 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13504 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13505 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13506 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13507 @end smallexample
13508
13509 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13510 the buffer:
13511
13512 @smallexample
13513 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13514 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13515 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13516 > tfind line
13517 > end
13518
13519 Frame 0, X = 1
13520 Frame 7, X = 2
13521 Frame 13, X = 255
13522 @end smallexample
13523
13524 @node tdump
13525 @subsection @code{tdump}
13526 @kindex tdump
13527 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13528 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13529
13530 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13531 the current trace snapshot.
13532
13533 @smallexample
13534 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13535 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13536 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13537 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13538 > end
13539
13540 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13541
13542 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13543 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13544 at gdb_test.c:444
13545 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13546
13547 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13548 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13549 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13550 d1 0x18 24
13551 d2 0x80 128
13552 d3 0x33 51
13553 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13554 d5 0x22 34
13555 d6 0xe0 224
13556 d7 0x380035 3670069
13557 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13558 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13559 a2 0x100 256
13560 a3 0x322000 3284992
13561 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13562 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13563 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13564 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13565 ps 0x0 0
13566 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13567 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13568 fpstatus 0x0 0
13569 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13570 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13571 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13572 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13573 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13574 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13575 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13576 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13577 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13578
13579 (@value{GDBP})
13580 @end smallexample
13581
13582 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13583 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13584 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13585 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13586
13587 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13588 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13589 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13590 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13591 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13592 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13593 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13594 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13595 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13596 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13597
13598 @node save tracepoints
13599 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13600 @kindex save tracepoints
13601 @kindex save-tracepoints
13602 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13603
13604 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13605 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13606 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13607 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13608 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13609 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13610
13611 @node Tracepoint Variables
13612 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13613 @cindex tracepoint variables
13614 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13615
13616 @table @code
13617 @vindex $trace_frame
13618 @item (int) $trace_frame
13619 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13620 snapshot is selected.
13621
13622 @vindex $tracepoint
13623 @item (int) $tracepoint
13624 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13625
13626 @vindex $trace_line
13627 @item (int) $trace_line
13628 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13629
13630 @vindex $trace_file
13631 @item (char []) $trace_file
13632 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13633
13634 @vindex $trace_func
13635 @item (char []) $trace_func
13636 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13637 @end table
13638
13639 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13640 use @code{output} instead.
13641
13642 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13643 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13644 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13645 which are managed by the target.
13646
13647 @smallexample
13648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13649
13650 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13651 > output $trace_file
13652 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13653 > tfind
13654 > end
13655 @end smallexample
13656
13657 @node Trace Files
13658 @section Using Trace Files
13659 @cindex trace files
13660
13661 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13662 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13663 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13664 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13665 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13666
13667 @table @code
13668
13669 @kindex tsave
13670 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13671 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13672 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13673 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13674 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13675 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13676 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13677 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13678 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13679 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13680 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13681 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
13682 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13683 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13684 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13685
13686 @kindex target tfile
13687 @kindex tfile
13688 @kindex target ctf
13689 @kindex ctf
13690 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13691 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13692 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13693 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13694 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13695 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13696 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13697 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13698 the host.
13699
13700 @smallexample
13701 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13702 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13703 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13704 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13705 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13706 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13707 i = 0
13708 a = 0
13709 b = 1 '\001'
13710 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13711 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13712 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13713 $1 = 1
13714 @end smallexample
13715
13716 @end table
13717
13718 @node Overlays
13719 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13720 @cindex overlays
13721
13722 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13723 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13724 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13725 use overlays.
13726
13727 @menu
13728 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13729 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13730 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13731 mapped by asking the inferior.
13732 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13733 @end menu
13734
13735 @node How Overlays Work
13736 @section How Overlays Work
13737 @cindex mapped overlays
13738 @cindex unmapped overlays
13739 @cindex load address, overlay's
13740 @cindex mapped address
13741 @cindex overlay area
13742
13743 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13744 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13745 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13746 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13747 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13748
13749 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13750 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13751 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13752 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13753 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13754 largest overlay as well.
13755
13756 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13757 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13758 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13759 there.
13760
13761 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13762 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13763 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13764
13765 @smallexample
13766 @group
13767 Data Instruction Larger
13768 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13769 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13770 | | | | | |
13771 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13772 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13773 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13774 | and heap | | | | | |
13775 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13776 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13777 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13778 | | | | | |
13779 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13780 address | | | | | |
13781 | overlay | <-' | | |
13782 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13783 | | <---. | | load address
13784 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13785 | | | |
13786 +-----------+ | |
13787 +-----------+
13788 | |
13789 +-----------+
13790
13791 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13792 @end group
13793 @end smallexample
13794
13795 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13796 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13797 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13798 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13799 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13800 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13801 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13802 program and the overlay area.
13803
13804 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13805 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13806 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13807 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13808 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13809 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13810 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13811
13812 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13813 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13814 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13815
13816 @itemize @bullet
13817
13818 @item
13819 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13820 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13821 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13822 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13823
13824 @item
13825 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13826 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13827 your program's performance.
13828
13829 @item
13830 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13831 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13832 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13833 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13834 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13835 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13836 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13837
13838 @item
13839 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13840 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13841 instruction and data spaces.
13842
13843 @end itemize
13844
13845 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13846 improved in many ways:
13847
13848 @itemize @bullet
13849
13850 @item
13851 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13852 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13853 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13854 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13855 area in the usual way.
13856
13857 @item
13858 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13859 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13860
13861 @item
13862 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13863 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13864 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13865 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13866 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13867 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13868 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13869
13870 @end itemize
13871
13872
13873 @node Overlay Commands
13874 @section Overlay Commands
13875
13876 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13877 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13878 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13879 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13880 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13881 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13882
13883 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13884 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13885
13886 @table @code
13887 @item overlay off
13888 @kindex overlay
13889 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13890 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13891 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13892 overlay support is disabled.
13893
13894 @item overlay manual
13895 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13896 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13897 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13898 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13899 commands described below.
13900
13901 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13902 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13903 @cindex map an overlay
13904 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13905 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13906 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13907 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13908 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13909 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13910
13911 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13912 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13913 @cindex unmap an overlay
13914 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13915 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13916 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13917 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13918
13919 @item overlay auto
13920 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13921 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13922 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13923 Overlay Debugging}.
13924
13925 @item overlay load-target
13926 @itemx overlay load
13927 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13928 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13929 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13930 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13931 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13932 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13933
13934 @item overlay list-overlays
13935 @itemx overlay list
13936 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13937 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13938 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13939
13940 @end table
13941
13942 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13943 of the function the address falls in:
13944
13945 @smallexample
13946 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13947 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13948 @end smallexample
13949 @noindent
13950 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13951 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13952 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13953 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13954
13955 @smallexample
13956 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13957 No sections are mapped.
13958 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13959 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13960 @end smallexample
13961 @noindent
13962 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13963 name normally:
13964
13965 @smallexample
13966 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13967 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13968 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13969 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13970 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13971 @end smallexample
13972
13973 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13974 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13975 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13976 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13977 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13978
13979 @itemize @bullet
13980 @item
13981 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13982 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13983 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13984 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13985 @item
13986 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13987 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13988 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13989 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13990 breakpoints properly.
13991 @end itemize
13992
13993
13994 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13995 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13996 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13997
13998 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13999 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14000 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14001 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14002 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14003 current state of the overlays.
14004
14005 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14006 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14007
14008 @table @asis
14009
14010 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14011 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14012
14013 @smallexample
14014 struct
14015 @{
14016 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14017 unsigned long vma;
14018
14019 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14020 unsigned long size;
14021
14022 /* The overlay's load address. */
14023 unsigned long lma;
14024
14025 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14026 zero otherwise. */
14027 unsigned long mapped;
14028 @}
14029 @end smallexample
14030
14031 @item @code{_novlys}:
14032 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14033 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14034
14035 @end table
14036
14037 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14038 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14039 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14040 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14041 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14042 currently mapped.
14043
14044 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14045 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14046 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14047 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14048 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14049 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14050 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14051 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14052 are not being executed.
14053
14054 @node Overlay Sample Program
14055 @section Overlay Sample Program
14056 @cindex overlay example program
14057
14058 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14059 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14060 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14061 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14062 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14063 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14064 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14065
14066 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14067 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14068 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14069 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14070
14071 @table @file
14072 @item overlays.c
14073 The main program file.
14074 @item ovlymgr.c
14075 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14076 @item foo.c
14077 @itemx bar.c
14078 @itemx baz.c
14079 @itemx grbx.c
14080 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14081 @item d10v.ld
14082 @itemx m32r.ld
14083 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14084 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14085 @end table
14086
14087 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14088 cross-compiler like this:
14089
14090 @smallexample
14091 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14092 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14093 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14094 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14095 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14096 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14097 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14098 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14099 @end smallexample
14100
14101 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14102 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14103 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14104
14105
14106 @node Languages
14107 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14108 @cindex languages
14109
14110 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14111 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14112 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14113 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14114 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14115 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14116
14117 @cindex working language
14118 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14119 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14120 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14121 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14122 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14123 language}.
14124
14125 @menu
14126 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14127 * Show:: Displaying the language
14128 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14129 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14130 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14131 @end menu
14132
14133 @node Setting
14134 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14135
14136 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14137 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14138 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14139 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14140 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14141 are printed, etc.
14142
14143 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14144 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14145 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14146 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14147 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14148 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14149 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14150 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14151 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14152 Displaying the Language}.
14153
14154 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14155 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14156 another language. In that case, make the
14157 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14158 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14159 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14160
14161 @menu
14162 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14163 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14164 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14165 @end menu
14166
14167 @node Filenames
14168 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14169
14170 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14171 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14172
14173 @table @file
14174 @item .ada
14175 @itemx .ads
14176 @itemx .adb
14177 @itemx .a
14178 Ada source file.
14179
14180 @item .c
14181 C source file
14182
14183 @item .C
14184 @itemx .cc
14185 @itemx .cp
14186 @itemx .cpp
14187 @itemx .cxx
14188 @itemx .c++
14189 C@t{++} source file
14190
14191 @item .d
14192 D source file
14193
14194 @item .m
14195 Objective-C source file
14196
14197 @item .f
14198 @itemx .F
14199 Fortran source file
14200
14201 @item .mod
14202 Modula-2 source file
14203
14204 @item .s
14205 @itemx .S
14206 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14207 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14208 @end table
14209
14210 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14211 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14212
14213 @node Manually
14214 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14215
14216 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14217 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14218 your program.
14219
14220 @kindex set language
14221 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14222 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14223 a language, such as
14224 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14225 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14226
14227 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14228 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14229 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14230 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14231 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14232 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14233 command such as:
14234
14235 @smallexample
14236 print a = b + c
14237 @end smallexample
14238
14239 @noindent
14240 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14241 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14242 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14243 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14244
14245 @node Automatically
14246 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14247
14248 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14249 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14250 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14251 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14252 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14253 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14254 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14255 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14256 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14257
14258 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14259 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14260 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14261 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14262 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14263
14264 @node Show
14265 @section Displaying the Language
14266
14267 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14268 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14269
14270 @table @code
14271 @item show language
14272 @anchor{show language}
14273 @kindex show language
14274 Display the current working language. This is the
14275 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14276 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14277
14278 @item info frame
14279 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14280 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14281 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14282 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14283 information listed here.
14284
14285 @item info source
14286 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14287 Display the source language of this source file.
14288 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14289 information listed here.
14290 @end table
14291
14292 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14293 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14294 with a language explicitly:
14295
14296 @table @code
14297 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14298 @kindex set extension-language
14299 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14300 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14301
14302 @item info extensions
14303 @kindex info extensions
14304 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14305 @end table
14306
14307 @node Checks
14308 @section Type and Range Checking
14309
14310 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14311 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14312 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14313 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14314 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14315 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14316 errors when your program is running.
14317
14318 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14319 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14320 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14321 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14322
14323 @menu
14324 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14325 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14326 @end menu
14327
14328 @cindex type checking
14329 @cindex checks, type
14330 @node Type Checking
14331 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14332
14333 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14334 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14335 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14336 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14337
14338 @smallexample
14339 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14340
14341 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14342 $1 = 2
14343 @exdent but
14344 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14345 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14346 @end smallexample
14347
14348 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14349 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14350
14351 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14352 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14353 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14354 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14355 expressions like the second example above.
14356
14357 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14358 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14359 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14360 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14361 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14362 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14363
14364 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14365
14366 @kindex set check type
14367 @kindex show check type
14368 @table @code
14369 @item set check type on
14370 @itemx set check type off
14371 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14372 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14373 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14374
14375 @item show check type
14376 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14377 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14378 @end table
14379
14380 @cindex range checking
14381 @cindex checks, range
14382 @node Range Checking
14383 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14384
14385 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14386 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14387 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14388 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14389 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14390
14391 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14392 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14393 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14394 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14395
14396 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14397 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14398 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14399 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14400 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14401 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14402
14403 @smallexample
14404 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14405 @end smallexample
14406
14407 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14408 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14409 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14410
14411 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14412
14413 @kindex set check range
14414 @kindex show check range
14415 @table @code
14416 @item set check range auto
14417 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14418 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14419 each language.
14420
14421 @item set check range on
14422 @itemx set check range off
14423 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14424 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14425 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14426 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14427
14428 @item set check range warn
14429 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14430 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14431 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14432 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14433 systems).
14434
14435 @item show range
14436 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14437 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14438 @end table
14439
14440 @node Supported Languages
14441 @section Supported Languages
14442
14443 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14444 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14445 @c This is false ...
14446 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14447 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14448 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14449 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14450 language.
14451
14452 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14453 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14454 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14455 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14456 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14457 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14458 language reference or tutorial.
14459
14460 @menu
14461 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14462 * D:: D
14463 * Go:: Go
14464 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14465 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14466 * Fortran:: Fortran
14467 * Pascal:: Pascal
14468 * Rust:: Rust
14469 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14470 * Ada:: Ada
14471 @end menu
14472
14473 @node C
14474 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14475
14476 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14477 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14478
14479 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14480 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14481 together.
14482
14483 @cindex C@t{++}
14484 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14485 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14486 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14487 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14488 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14489 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14490 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14491
14492 @menu
14493 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14494 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14495 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14496 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14497 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14498 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14499 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14500 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14501 @end menu
14502
14503 @node C Operators
14504 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14505
14506 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14507
14508 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14509 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14510 often defined on groups of types.
14511
14512 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14513
14514 @itemize @bullet
14515
14516 @item
14517 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14518 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14519
14520 @item
14521 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14522 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14523
14524 @item
14525 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14526
14527 @item
14528 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14529
14530 @end itemize
14531
14532 @noindent
14533 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14534 in order of increasing precedence:
14535
14536 @table @code
14537 @item ,
14538 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14539 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14540 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14541
14542 @item =
14543 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14544 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14545
14546 @item @var{op}=
14547 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14548 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14549 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14550 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14551 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14552
14553 @item ?:
14554 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14555 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14556 should be of an integral type.
14557
14558 @item ||
14559 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14560
14561 @item &&
14562 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14563
14564 @item |
14565 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14566
14567 @item ^
14568 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14569
14570 @item &
14571 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14572
14573 @item ==@r{, }!=
14574 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14575 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14576
14577 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14578 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14579 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14580 and non-zero for true.
14581
14582 @item <<@r{, }>>
14583 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14584
14585 @item @@
14586 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14587
14588 @item +@r{, }-
14589 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14590 pointer types.
14591
14592 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14593 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14594 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14595 integral types.
14596
14597 @item ++@r{, }--
14598 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14599 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14600 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14601 operation takes place.
14602
14603 @item *
14604 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14605 @code{++}.
14606
14607 @item &
14608 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14609
14610 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14611 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14612 to examine the address
14613 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14614 stored.
14615
14616 @item -
14617 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14618 precedence as @code{++}.
14619
14620 @item !
14621 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14622 @code{++}.
14623
14624 @item ~
14625 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14626 @code{++}.
14627
14628
14629 @item .@r{, }->
14630 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14631 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14632 pointer based on the stored type information.
14633 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14634
14635 @item .*@r{, }->*
14636 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14637
14638 @item []
14639 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14640 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14641
14642 @item ()
14643 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14644
14645 @item ::
14646 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14647 and @code{class} types.
14648
14649 @item ::
14650 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14651 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14652 above.
14653 @end table
14654
14655 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14656 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14657 predefined meaning.
14658
14659 @node C Constants
14660 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14661
14662 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14663
14664 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14665 following ways:
14666
14667 @itemize @bullet
14668 @item
14669 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14670 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14671 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14672 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14673 @code{long} value.
14674
14675 @item
14676 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14677 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14678 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14679 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14680 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14681 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14682 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14683 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14684 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14685 constant.
14686
14687 @item
14688 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14689 integral equivalents.
14690
14691 @item
14692 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14693 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14694 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14695 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14696 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14697 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14698 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14699 @samp{\n} for newline.
14700
14701 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14702 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14703 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14704 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14705
14706 @item
14707 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14708 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14709 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14710 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14711 characters.
14712
14713 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14714 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14715 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14716
14717 @item
14718 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14719 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14720
14721 @item
14722 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14723 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14724 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14725 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14726 @end itemize
14727
14728 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14729 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14730
14731 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14732 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14733
14734 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14735 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14736 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14737 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14738 @quotation
14739 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14740 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14741 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14742 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14743 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14744 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14745 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14746 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14747 @end quotation
14748
14749 @enumerate
14750
14751 @cindex member functions
14752 @item
14753 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14754
14755 @smallexample
14756 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14757 @end smallexample
14758
14759 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14760 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14761 @item
14762 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14763 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14764 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14765 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14766 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14767
14768 @cindex call overloaded functions
14769 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14770 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14771 @item
14772 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14773 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14774 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14775 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14776 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14777 default arguments.
14778
14779 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14780 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14781 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14782 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14783 number of function arguments.
14784
14785 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14786 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14787 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14788
14789 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14790 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14791 @smallexample
14792 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14793 @end smallexample
14794
14795 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14796 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14797
14798 @cindex reference declarations
14799 @item
14800 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14801 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14802 dereferenced.
14803
14804 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14805 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14806 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14807 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14808 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14809
14810 @item
14811 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14812 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14813 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14814 necessary, for example in an expression like
14815 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14816 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14817 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14818
14819 @item
14820 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14821 specification.
14822 @end enumerate
14823
14824 @node C Defaults
14825 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14826
14827 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14828
14829 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14830 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14831 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14832 selects the working language.
14833
14834 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14835 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14836 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14837 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14838 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14839 for further details.
14840
14841 @node C Checks
14842 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14843
14844 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14845
14846 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14847 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14848 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14849 constants to pointers.
14850
14851 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14852 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14853 that is not itself an array.
14854
14855 @node Debugging C
14856 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14857
14858 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14859 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14860 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14861 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14862
14863 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14864 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14865 ,Expressions}.
14866
14867 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14868 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14869
14870 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14871
14872 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14873 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14874
14875 @table @code
14876 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14877 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14878 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14879 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14880 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14881 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14882
14883 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14884 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14885 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14886 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14887 classes.
14888 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14889
14890 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14891 @item catch throw
14892 @itemx catch rethrow
14893 @itemx catch catch
14894 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14895 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14896
14897 @cindex inheritance
14898 @item ptype @var{typename}
14899 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14900 @var{typename}.
14901 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14902
14903 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14904 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14905 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14906 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14907 multiple inheritance is in use.
14908
14909 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14910 @item demangle @var{name}
14911 Demangle @var{name}.
14912 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14913
14914 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14915 @item set print demangle
14916 @itemx show print demangle
14917 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14918 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14919 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14920 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14921 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14922
14923 @item set print object
14924 @itemx show print object
14925 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14926 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14927
14928 @item set print vtbl
14929 @itemx show print vtbl
14930 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14931 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14932 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14933 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14934
14935 @kindex set overload-resolution
14936 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14937 @item set overload-resolution on
14938 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14939 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14940 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14941 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14942 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14943 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14944
14945 @item set overload-resolution off
14946 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14947 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14948 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14949 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14950 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14951 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14952 argument types.
14953
14954 @kindex show overload-resolution
14955 @item show overload-resolution
14956 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14957
14958 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14959 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14960 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14961 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14962 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14963 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14964 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14965 @end table
14966
14967 @node Decimal Floating Point
14968 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14969 @cindex decimal floating point format
14970
14971 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14972 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14973 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14974 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14975
14976 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14977 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14978 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14979 configured target.
14980
14981 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14982 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14983 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14984
14985 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14986 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14987 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14988
14989 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14990 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14991 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14992
14993 @node D
14994 @subsection D
14995
14996 @cindex D
14997 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14998 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14999 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15000
15001 @node Go
15002 @subsection Go
15003
15004 @cindex Go (programming language)
15005 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15006 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15007
15008 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15009
15010 @table @code
15011 @cindex current Go package
15012 @item The current Go package
15013 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15014 specifying global variables and functions.
15015
15016 For example, given the program:
15017
15018 @example
15019 package main
15020 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15021 func main () @{
15022 // ...
15023 @}
15024 @end example
15025
15026 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15027
15028 @example
15029 (gdb) p myglob
15030 (gdb) p main.myglob
15031 @end example
15032
15033 @cindex builtin Go types
15034 @item Builtin Go types
15035 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15036 as a string.
15037
15038 @cindex builtin Go functions
15039 @item Builtin Go functions
15040 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15041 function and handles it internally.
15042
15043 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15044 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15045 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15046 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15047 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15048 @end table
15049
15050 @node Objective-C
15051 @subsection Objective-C
15052
15053 @cindex Objective-C
15054 This section provides information about some commands and command
15055 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15056 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15057 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15058
15059 @menu
15060 * Method Names in Commands::
15061 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15062 @end menu
15063
15064 @node Method Names in Commands
15065 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15066
15067 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15068 names as line specifications:
15069
15070 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15071 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15072 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15073 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15074 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15075 @itemize
15076 @item @code{clear}
15077 @item @code{break}
15078 @item @code{info line}
15079 @item @code{jump}
15080 @item @code{list}
15081 @end itemize
15082
15083 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15084
15085 @smallexample
15086 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15087 @end smallexample
15088
15089 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15090 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15091 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15092 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15093 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15094 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15095 debugged, enter:
15096
15097 @smallexample
15098 break -[Fruit create]
15099 @end smallexample
15100
15101 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15102 enter:
15103
15104 @smallexample
15105 list +[NSText initialize]
15106 @end smallexample
15107
15108 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15109 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15110 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15111 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15112
15113 @smallexample
15114 break create
15115 @end smallexample
15116
15117 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15118 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15119 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15120 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15121 none apply.
15122
15123 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15124 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15125
15126 @smallexample
15127 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15128 @end smallexample
15129
15130 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15131 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15132 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15133 @kindex print-object
15134 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15135
15136 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15137
15138 @smallexample
15139 print -[@var{object} hash]
15140 @end smallexample
15141
15142 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15143 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15144 @noindent
15145 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15146 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15147 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15148 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15149 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15150 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15151
15152 @node OpenCL C
15153 @subsection OpenCL C
15154
15155 @cindex OpenCL C
15156 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15157
15158 @menu
15159 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15160 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15161 * OpenCL C Operators::
15162 @end menu
15163
15164 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15165 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15166
15167 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15168 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15169 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15170 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15171 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15172
15173 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15174 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15175
15176 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15177 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15178 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15179 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15180
15181 @node OpenCL C Operators
15182 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15183
15184 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15185 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15186 vector data types.
15187
15188 @node Fortran
15189 @subsection Fortran
15190 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15191
15192 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15193 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15194
15195 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15196 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15197 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15198 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15199 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15200 underscore.
15201
15202 @menu
15203 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15204 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15205 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15206 @end menu
15207
15208 @node Fortran Operators
15209 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15210
15211 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15212
15213 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15214 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15215 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15216
15217 @table @code
15218 @item **
15219 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15220 of the second one.
15221
15222 @item :
15223 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15224 represent a section of array.
15225
15226 @item %
15227 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15228 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15229 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15230 union type.
15231 @end table
15232
15233 @node Fortran Defaults
15234 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15235
15236 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15237
15238 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15239 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15240 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15241 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15242
15243 @node Special Fortran Commands
15244 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15245
15246 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15247
15248 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15249 such as displaying common blocks.
15250
15251 @table @code
15252 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15253 @kindex info common
15254 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15255 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15256 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15257 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15258 printed.
15259 @end table
15260
15261 @node Pascal
15262 @subsection Pascal
15263
15264 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15265 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15266 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15267 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15268 syntax.
15269
15270 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15271 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15272 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15273
15274 @node Rust
15275 @subsection Rust
15276
15277 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15278 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15279 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15280 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15281
15282 @itemize @bullet
15283 @item
15284 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15285 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15286 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15287
15288 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15289 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15290 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15291 @samp{B}.
15292
15293 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15294 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15295
15296 @item
15297 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15298 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15299 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15300 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15301 @samp{K::x::y}.
15302
15303 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15304 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15305 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15306 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15307 scope.
15308
15309 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15310 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15311
15312 @item
15313 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15314 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15315
15316 @item
15317 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15318
15319 @item
15320 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15321 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15322 never be destroyed.
15323
15324 @item
15325 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15326 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15327 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15328
15329 @item
15330 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15331 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15332 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15333 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15334 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15335 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15336 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15337 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15338
15339 @item
15340 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15341 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15342 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15343 @itemize @bullet
15344
15345 @item
15346 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15347
15348 @item
15349 Trait objects cannot be created or inspected.
15350
15351 @item
15352 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15353
15354 @item
15355 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15356 type names.
15357
15358 @item
15359 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15360
15361 @item
15362 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15363 available in the crate.
15364 @end itemize
15365 @end itemize
15366
15367 @node Modula-2
15368 @subsection Modula-2
15369
15370 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15371
15372 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15373 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15374 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15375 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15376 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15377 table.
15378
15379 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15380 @menu
15381 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15382 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15383 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15384 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15385 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15386 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15387 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15388 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15389 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15390 @end menu
15391
15392 @node M2 Operators
15393 @subsubsection Operators
15394 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15395
15396 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15397 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15398 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15399 following definitions hold:
15400
15401 @itemize @bullet
15402
15403 @item
15404 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15405 their subranges.
15406
15407 @item
15408 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15409
15410 @item
15411 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15412
15413 @item
15414 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15415 @var{type}}.
15416
15417 @item
15418 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15419
15420 @item
15421 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15422
15423 @item
15424 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15425 @end itemize
15426
15427 @noindent
15428 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15429 increasing precedence:
15430
15431 @table @code
15432 @item ,
15433 Function argument or array index separator.
15434
15435 @item :=
15436 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15437 @var{value}.
15438
15439 @item <@r{, }>
15440 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15441 types.
15442
15443 @item <=@r{, }>=
15444 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15445 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15446 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15447
15448 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15449 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15450 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15451 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15452 comment character.
15453
15454 @item IN
15455 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15456 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15457
15458 @item OR
15459 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15460
15461 @item AND@r{, }&
15462 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15463
15464 @item @@
15465 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15466
15467 @item +@r{, }-
15468 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15469 and difference on set types.
15470
15471 @item *
15472 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15473 on set types.
15474
15475 @item /
15476 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15477 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15478
15479 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15480 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15481 precedence as @code{*}.
15482
15483 @item -
15484 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15485
15486 @item ^
15487 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15488
15489 @item NOT
15490 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15491 @code{^}.
15492
15493 @item .
15494 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15495 precedence as @code{^}.
15496
15497 @item []
15498 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15499
15500 @item ()
15501 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15502 as @code{^}.
15503
15504 @item ::@r{, }.
15505 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15506 @end table
15507
15508 @quotation
15509 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15510 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15511 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15512 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15513 @end quotation
15514
15515
15516 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15517 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15518 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15519
15520 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15521 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15522
15523 @table @var
15524
15525 @item a
15526 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15527
15528 @item c
15529 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15530
15531 @item i
15532 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15533
15534 @item m
15535 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15536 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15537 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15538
15539 @item n
15540 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15541
15542 @item r
15543 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15544
15545 @item t
15546 represents a type.
15547
15548 @item v
15549 represents a variable.
15550
15551 @item x
15552 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15553 explanation of the function for details.
15554 @end table
15555
15556 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15557
15558 @table @code
15559 @item ABS(@var{n})
15560 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15561
15562 @item CAP(@var{c})
15563 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15564 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15565
15566 @item CHR(@var{i})
15567 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15568
15569 @item DEC(@var{v})
15570 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15571
15572 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15573 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15574 new value.
15575
15576 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15577 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15578 set.
15579
15580 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15581 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15582
15583 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15584 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15585
15586 @item INC(@var{v})
15587 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15588
15589 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15590 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15591 new value.
15592
15593 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15594 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15595 there. Returns the new set.
15596
15597 @item MAX(@var{t})
15598 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15599
15600 @item MIN(@var{t})
15601 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15602
15603 @item ODD(@var{i})
15604 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15605
15606 @item ORD(@var{x})
15607 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15608 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15609 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15610 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15611
15612 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15613 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15614 variable or a type.
15615
15616 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15617 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15618
15619 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15620 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15621 variable or a type.
15622
15623 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15624 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15625 @end table
15626
15627 @quotation
15628 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15629 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15630 an error.
15631 @end quotation
15632
15633 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15634 @node M2 Constants
15635 @subsubsection Constants
15636
15637 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15638 ways:
15639
15640 @itemize @bullet
15641
15642 @item
15643 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15644 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15645 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15646 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15647
15648 @item
15649 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15650 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15651 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15652 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15653 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15654 digits.
15655
15656 @item
15657 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15658 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15659 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15660 followed by a @samp{C}.
15661
15662 @item
15663 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15664 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15665 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15666 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15667 sequences.
15668
15669 @item
15670 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15671
15672 @item
15673 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15674 @code{FALSE}.
15675
15676 @item
15677 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15678
15679 @item
15680 Set constants are not yet supported.
15681 @end itemize
15682
15683 @node M2 Types
15684 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15685 @cindex Modula-2 types
15686
15687 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15688 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15689 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15690 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15691 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15692 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15693
15694 The first example contains the following section of code:
15695
15696 @smallexample
15697 VAR
15698 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15699 r: [20..40] ;
15700 @end smallexample
15701
15702 @noindent
15703 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15704 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15705
15706 @smallexample
15707 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15708 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15709 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15710 SET OF CHAR
15711 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15712 21
15713 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15714 [20..40]
15715 @end smallexample
15716
15717 @noindent
15718 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15719
15720 @smallexample
15721 VAR
15722 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15723 @end smallexample
15724
15725 @noindent
15726 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15727
15728 @smallexample
15729 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15730 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15731 @end smallexample
15732
15733 @noindent
15734 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15735 expressions using the debugger.
15736
15737 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15738 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15739
15740 @smallexample
15741 VAR
15742 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15743 @end smallexample
15744
15745 @smallexample
15746 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15747 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15748 @end smallexample
15749
15750 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15751 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15752 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15753 above.
15754
15755 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15756
15757 @smallexample
15758 TYPE
15759 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15760 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15761 VAR
15762 s: t ;
15763 BEGIN
15764 s := blue ;
15765 @end smallexample
15766
15767 @noindent
15768 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15769 and value of a variable.
15770
15771 @smallexample
15772 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15773 $1 = blue
15774 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15775 type = [blue..yellow]
15776 @end smallexample
15777
15778 @noindent
15779 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15780 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15781 their @code{C} counterparts.
15782
15783 @smallexample
15784 VAR
15785 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15786 BEGIN
15787 s[1] := 1 ;
15788 @end smallexample
15789
15790 @smallexample
15791 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15792 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15793 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15794 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15795 @end smallexample
15796
15797 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15798 pointer types as shown in this example:
15799
15800 @smallexample
15801 VAR
15802 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15803 BEGIN
15804 NEW(s) ;
15805 s^[1] := 1 ;
15806 @end smallexample
15807
15808 @noindent
15809 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15810
15811 @smallexample
15812 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15813 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15814 @end smallexample
15815
15816 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15817 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15818 types:
15819
15820 @smallexample
15821 TYPE
15822 foo = RECORD
15823 f1: CARDINAL ;
15824 f2: CHAR ;
15825 f3: myarray ;
15826 END ;
15827
15828 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15829 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15830 VAR
15831 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15832 @end smallexample
15833
15834 @noindent
15835 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15836 below.
15837
15838 @smallexample
15839 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15840 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15841 f1 : CARDINAL;
15842 f2 : CHAR;
15843 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15844 END
15845 @end smallexample
15846
15847 @node M2 Defaults
15848 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15849 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15850
15851 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15852 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15853 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15854 selected the working language.
15855
15856 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15857 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15858 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15859 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15860
15861 @node Deviations
15862 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15863 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15864
15865 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15866 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15867
15868 @itemize @bullet
15869 @item
15870 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15871 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15872 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15873 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15874 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15875 returned a pointer.)
15876
15877 @item
15878 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15879 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15880 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15881 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15882
15883 @item
15884 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15885 argument.
15886
15887 @item
15888 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15889 @end itemize
15890
15891 @node M2 Checks
15892 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15893 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15894
15895 @quotation
15896 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15897 range checking.
15898 @end quotation
15899 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15900
15901 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15902
15903 @itemize @bullet
15904 @item
15905 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15906 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15907
15908 @item
15909 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15910 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15911 @end itemize
15912
15913 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15914 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15915
15916 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15917 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15918
15919 @node M2 Scope
15920 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15921 @cindex scope
15922 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15923 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15924 @ifinfo
15925 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15926 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15927 @end ifinfo
15928 @ifnotinfo
15929 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15930 @end ifnotinfo
15931
15932 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15933 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15934 similar syntax:
15935
15936 @smallexample
15937
15938 @var{module} . @var{id}
15939 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15940 @end smallexample
15941
15942 @noindent
15943 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15944 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15945 identifier within your program, except another module.
15946
15947 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15948 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15949 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15950 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15951
15952 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15953 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15954 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15955 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15956 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15957 @var{module}.
15958
15959 @node GDB/M2
15960 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15961
15962 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15963 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15964 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15965 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15966 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15967 analogue in Modula-2.
15968
15969 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15970 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15971 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15972 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15973 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15974 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15975
15976 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15977 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15978 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15979
15980 @node Ada
15981 @subsection Ada
15982 @cindex Ada
15983
15984 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15985 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15986 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15987 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15988 to be difficult.
15989
15990
15991 @cindex expressions in Ada
15992 @menu
15993 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15994 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15995 in @value{GDBN}.
15996 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15997 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15998 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
15999 subprograms.
16000 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16001 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16002 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16003 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16004 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16005 Profile
16006 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16007 @end menu
16008
16009 @node Ada Mode Intro
16010 @subsubsection Introduction
16011 @cindex Ada mode, general
16012
16013 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16014 syntax, with some extensions.
16015 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16016
16017 @itemize @bullet
16018 @item
16019 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16020 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16021 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16022 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16023
16024 @item
16025 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16026 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16027
16028 @item
16029 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16030 @end itemize
16031
16032 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16033 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16034 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16035 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16036 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16037
16038 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16039 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16040 was translated from an Ada source file.
16041
16042 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16043 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16044 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16045 middle (to allow based literals).
16046
16047 @node Omissions from Ada
16048 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16049 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16050
16051 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16052
16053 @itemize @bullet
16054 @item
16055 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16056
16057 @itemize @minus
16058 @item
16059 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16060 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16061
16062 @item
16063 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16064
16065 @item
16066 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16067
16068 @item
16069 @t{'Tag}.
16070
16071 @item
16072 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16073 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16074
16075 @item
16076 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16077 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16078
16079 @item
16080 @t{'Address}.
16081 @end itemize
16082
16083 @item
16084 The names in
16085 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16086 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16087 not currently available.
16088
16089 @item
16090 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16091 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16092 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16093 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16094 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16095 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16096 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16097 indeterminate values.
16098
16099 @item
16100 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16101 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16102 are not implemented.
16103
16104 @item
16105 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16106 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16107 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16108 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16109 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16110
16111 @smallexample
16112 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16113 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16114 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16115 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16116 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16117 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16118 @end smallexample
16119
16120 Changing a
16121 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16122 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16123 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16124 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16125 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16126 declared to have a type such as:
16127
16128 @smallexample
16129 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16130 Id : Integer;
16131 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16132 end record;
16133 @end smallexample
16134
16135 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16136 assignments:
16137
16138 @smallexample
16139 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16140 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16141 @end smallexample
16142
16143 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16144 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16145 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16146 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16147 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16148 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16149 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16150 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16151
16152 @item
16153 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16154
16155 @item
16156 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16157 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16158 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16159 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16160 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16161 the proper resolution.
16162
16163 @item
16164 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16165
16166 @item
16167 Entry calls are not implemented.
16168
16169 @item
16170 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16171 formats are not supported.
16172
16173 @item
16174 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16175
16176 @item
16177 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16178 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16179 context.
16180 Should your program
16181 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16182 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16183 @end itemize
16184
16185 @node Additions to Ada
16186 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16187 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16188
16189 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16190 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16191
16192 @itemize @bullet
16193 @item
16194 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16195 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16196 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16197 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16198 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16199 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16200 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16201 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16202
16203 @item
16204 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16205 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16206 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16207
16208 @item
16209 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16210 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16211
16212 @item
16213 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16214 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16215 @end itemize
16216
16217 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16218 additions specific to Ada:
16219
16220 @itemize @bullet
16221 @item
16222 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16223 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16224
16225 @smallexample
16226 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16227 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16228 @end smallexample
16229
16230 @item
16231 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16232 the value of its right-hand operand.
16233 This allows, for example,
16234 complex conditional breaks:
16235
16236 @smallexample
16237 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16238 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16239 @end smallexample
16240
16241 @item
16242 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16243 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16244 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16245 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16246 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16247 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16248 in strings. For example,
16249 @smallexample
16250 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16251 @end smallexample
16252 @noindent
16253 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16254 after each period.
16255
16256 @item
16257 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16258 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16259 to write
16260
16261 @smallexample
16262 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16263 @end smallexample
16264
16265 @item
16266 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16267 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16268 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16269 of 3 might print as
16270
16271 @smallexample
16272 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16273 @end smallexample
16274
16275 @noindent
16276 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16277 clause.
16278
16279 @item
16280 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16281 multi-character subsequence of
16282 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16283 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16284 in place of @t{a'length}.
16285
16286 @item
16287 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16288 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16289 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16290 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16291 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16292 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16293 For example,
16294 @smallexample
16295 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16296 @end smallexample
16297
16298 @item
16299 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16300 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16301 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16302 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16303 object.
16304
16305 @end itemize
16306
16307 @node Overloading support for Ada
16308 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16309 @cindex overloading, Ada
16310
16311 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16312 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16313 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16314 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16315 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16316 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16317
16318 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16319 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16320 use, for instance:
16321
16322 @smallexample
16323 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16324 Multiple matches for f
16325 [0] cancel
16326 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16327 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16328 >
16329 @end smallexample
16330
16331 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16332 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16333 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16334
16335 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16336 case:
16337
16338 @table @code
16339
16340 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16341 @item set ada print-signatures
16342 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16343 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16344 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16345
16346 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16347 @item show ada print-signatures
16348 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16349 overloads selection menu.
16350 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16351
16352 @end table
16353
16354 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16355 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16356
16357 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16358 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16359 before reaching the main procedure.
16360 As defined in the Ada Reference
16361 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16362 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16363 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16364 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16365
16366 @node Ada Exceptions
16367 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16368
16369 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16370
16371 @table @code
16372 @kindex info exceptions
16373 @item info exceptions
16374 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16375 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16376 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16377 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16378 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16379 @end table
16380
16381 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16382 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16383 argument.
16384
16385 @smallexample
16386 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16387 All defined Ada exceptions:
16388 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16389 program_error: 0x613d20
16390 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16391 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16392 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16393 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16394 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16395 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16396 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16397 @end smallexample
16398
16399 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16400 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16401
16402 @node Ada Tasks
16403 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16404 @cindex Ada, tasking
16405
16406 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16407 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16408
16409 @table @code
16410 @kindex info tasks
16411 @item info tasks
16412 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16413
16414
16415 @smallexample
16416 @iftex
16417 @leftskip=0.5cm
16418 @end iftex
16419 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16420 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16421 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16422 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16423 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16424 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16425
16426 @end smallexample
16427
16428 @noindent
16429 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16430 task currently being inspected.
16431
16432 @table @asis
16433 @item ID
16434 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16435
16436 @item TID
16437 The Ada task ID.
16438
16439 @item P-ID
16440 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16441
16442 @item Pri
16443 The base priority of the task.
16444
16445 @item State
16446 Current state of the task.
16447
16448 @table @code
16449 @item Unactivated
16450 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16451 executing.
16452
16453 @item Runnable
16454 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16455 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16456
16457 @item Terminated
16458 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16459 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16460 terminated themselves.
16461
16462 @item Child Activation Wait
16463 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16464
16465 @item Accept Statement
16466 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16467
16468 @item Waiting on entry call
16469 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16470
16471 @item Async Select Wait
16472 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16473 select statement.
16474
16475 @item Delay Sleep
16476 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16477 alternative open.
16478
16479 @item Child Termination Wait
16480 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16481 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16482 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16483
16484 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16485 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16486 finish terminating.
16487
16488 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16489 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16490 @end table
16491
16492 @item Name
16493 Name of the task in the program.
16494
16495 @end table
16496
16497 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16498 @item info task @var{taskno}
16499 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16500 the following example:
16501 @smallexample
16502 @iftex
16503 @leftskip=0.5cm
16504 @end iftex
16505 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16506 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16507 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16508 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16509 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16510 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16511 Name: task_1
16512 Thread: 0x807f378
16513 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16514 Base Priority: 15
16515 State: Runnable
16516 @end smallexample
16517
16518 @item task
16519 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16520 @cindex current Ada task ID
16521 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16522
16523 @smallexample
16524 @iftex
16525 @leftskip=0.5cm
16526 @end iftex
16527 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16528 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16529 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16530 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16531 (@value{GDBP}) task
16532 [Current task is 2]
16533 @end smallexample
16534
16535 @item task @var{taskno}
16536 @cindex Ada task switching
16537 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16538 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16539 from the current task to the given task.
16540
16541 @smallexample
16542 @iftex
16543 @leftskip=0.5cm
16544 @end iftex
16545 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16546 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16547 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16548 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16549 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16550 [Switching to task 1]
16551 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16552 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16553 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16554 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16555 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16556 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16557 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16558 @end smallexample
16559
16560 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16561 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16562 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16563 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16564 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16565 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16566 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16567 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16568 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16569
16570 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16571 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16572 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16573 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16574 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16575
16576 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16577 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16578 program.
16579
16580 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16581 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16582 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16583
16584 For example,
16585
16586 @smallexample
16587 @iftex
16588 @leftskip=0.5cm
16589 @end iftex
16590 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16591 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16592 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16593 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16594 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16595 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16596 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16597 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16598 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16599 Continuing.
16600 task # 1 running
16601 task # 2 running
16602
16603 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16604 15 flush;
16605 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16606 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16607 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16608 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16609 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16610 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16611 @end smallexample
16612 @end table
16613
16614 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16615 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16616 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16617
16618 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16619 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16620 the platform being used.
16621 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16622 switching is not supported.
16623
16624 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16625 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16626 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16627 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16628 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16629 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16630
16631 @node Ravenscar Profile
16632 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16633 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16634
16635 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16636 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16637 requirements.
16638
16639 @table @code
16640 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16641 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16642 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16643 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16644 Profile. This is the default.
16645
16646 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16647 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16648 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16649 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16650 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16651 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16652 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16653
16654 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16655 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16656 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16657 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16658
16659 @end table
16660
16661 @node Ada Glitches
16662 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16663 @cindex Ada, problems
16664
16665 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16666 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16667 @value{GDBN},
16668 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16669 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16670
16671 @itemize @bullet
16672 @item
16673 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16674 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16675
16676 @item
16677 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16678 argument lists are treated as positional).
16679
16680 @item
16681 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16682
16683 @item
16684 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16685 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16686 the host machine.
16687
16688 @item
16689 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16690 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16691 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16692 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16693 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16694 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16695 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16696 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16697 you can usually resolve the confusion
16698 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16699 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16700 @end itemize
16701
16702 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16703 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16704 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16705 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16706 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16707 enabled.
16708
16709 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16710 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16711 @table @code
16712
16713 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16714 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16715 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16716 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16717 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16718 This is the default.
16719
16720 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16721 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16722 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16723 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16724 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16725 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16726 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16727
16728 @end table
16729
16730 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16731 @cindex GNAT encoding
16732 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16733 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16734 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16735 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16736 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16737 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16738
16739 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16740 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16741 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16742 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16743 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16744 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16745 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16746 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16747
16748 @table @code
16749
16750 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16751 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16752 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16753 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16754
16755 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16756 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16757 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16758
16759 @end table
16760
16761 @node Unsupported Languages
16762 @section Unsupported Languages
16763
16764 @cindex unsupported languages
16765 @cindex minimal language
16766 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16767 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16768 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16769 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16770 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16771 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16772
16773 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16774 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16775 language.
16776
16777 @node Symbols
16778 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16779
16780 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16781 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16782 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16783 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16784 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16785 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16786 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16787
16788 @cindex symbol names
16789 @cindex names of symbols
16790 @cindex quoting names
16791 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16792 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16793 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16794 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16795 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16796 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16797 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16798 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16799
16800 @smallexample
16801 p 'foo.c'::x
16802 @end smallexample
16803
16804 @noindent
16805 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16806
16807 @table @code
16808 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16809 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16810 @kindex set case-sensitive
16811 @item set case-sensitive on
16812 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16813 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16814 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16815 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16816 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16817 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16818 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16819 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16820 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16821 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16822 case-insensitive matches.
16823
16824 @kindex show case-sensitive
16825 @item show case-sensitive
16826 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16827 lookups.
16828
16829 @kindex set print type methods
16830 @item set print type methods
16831 @itemx set print type methods on
16832 @itemx set print type methods off
16833 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16834 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16835 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16836 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16837 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16838 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16839
16840 @kindex show print type methods
16841 @item show print type methods
16842 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16843 classes.
16844
16845 @kindex set print type typedefs
16846 @item set print type typedefs
16847 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16848 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16849
16850 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16851 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16852 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16853 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16854 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16855 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16856 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16857 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16858 types.
16859
16860 @kindex show print type typedefs
16861 @item show print type typedefs
16862 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16863 printing classes.
16864
16865 @kindex info address
16866 @cindex address of a symbol
16867 @item info address @var{symbol}
16868 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16869 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16870 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16871 is always stored.
16872
16873 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16874 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16875 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16876
16877 @kindex info symbol
16878 @cindex symbol from address
16879 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16880 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16881 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16882 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16883 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16884
16885 @smallexample
16886 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16887 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16888 @end smallexample
16889
16890 @noindent
16891 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16892 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16893
16894 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16895 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16896
16897 @smallexample
16898 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16899 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16900 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16901 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16902 @end smallexample
16903
16904 @kindex demangle
16905 @cindex demangle
16906 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16907 Demangle @var{name}.
16908 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16909 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16910
16911 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16912 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16913
16914 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16915 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16916
16917 @kindex whatis
16918 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16919 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16920 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16921 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16922
16923 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16924 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16925 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16926
16927 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16928 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16929 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16930 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16931 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16932 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16933 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16934 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16935 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16936
16937 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16938 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16939 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16940 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16941 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16942 unroll it.
16943
16944 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16945 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16946 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16947
16948 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16949 Available flags are:
16950
16951 @table @code
16952 @item r
16953 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16954 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16955 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16956
16957 @item m
16958 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16959
16960 @item M
16961 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16962 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16963
16964 @item t
16965 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16966 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16967 names are substituted when printing other types.
16968
16969 @item T
16970 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16971 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16972 @end table
16973
16974 @kindex ptype
16975 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16976 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16977 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16978 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16979
16980 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16981 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16982 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16983 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16984 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16985 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16986 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16987 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16988
16989 For example, for this variable declaration:
16990
16991 @smallexample
16992 typedef double real_t;
16993 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16994 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16995 complex_t var;
16996 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16997 @end smallexample
16998
16999 @noindent
17000 the two commands give this output:
17001
17002 @smallexample
17003 @group
17004 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17005 type = complex_t
17006 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17007 type = struct complex @{
17008 real_t real;
17009 double imag;
17010 @}
17011 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17012 type = struct complex
17013 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17014 type = struct complex
17015 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17016 type = struct complex @{
17017 real_t real;
17018 double imag;
17019 @}
17020 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17021 type = real_t *
17022 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17023 type = double *
17024 @end group
17025 @end smallexample
17026
17027 @noindent
17028 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17029 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17030
17031 @cindex incomplete type
17032 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17033 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17034 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17035 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17036 given these declarations:
17037
17038 @smallexample
17039 struct foo;
17040 struct foo *fooptr;
17041 @end smallexample
17042
17043 @noindent
17044 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17045
17046 @smallexample
17047 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17048 $1 = <incomplete type>
17049 @end smallexample
17050
17051 @noindent
17052 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17053 completely specified.
17054
17055 @kindex info types
17056 @item info types @var{regexp}
17057 @itemx info types
17058 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17059 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17060 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17061 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17062 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17063 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17064 name is @code{value}.
17065
17066 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17067 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17068 lists all source files where a type is defined.
17069
17070 @kindex info type-printers
17071 @item info type-printers
17072 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17073 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17074 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17075 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17076 type printers.
17077
17078 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17079
17080 @kindex enable type-printer
17081 @kindex disable type-printer
17082 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17083 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17084 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17085
17086 @kindex info scope
17087 @cindex local variables
17088 @item info scope @var{location}
17089 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17090 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17091 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17092 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17093 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17094
17095 @smallexample
17096 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17097 Scope for command_line_handler:
17098 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17099 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17100 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17101 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17102 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17103 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17104 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17105 @end smallexample
17106
17107 @noindent
17108 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17109 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17110 collect}.
17111
17112 @kindex info source
17113 @item info source
17114 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17115 the function containing the current point of execution:
17116 @itemize @bullet
17117 @item
17118 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17119 @item
17120 the directory it was compiled in,
17121 @item
17122 its length, in lines,
17123 @item
17124 which programming language it is written in,
17125 @item
17126 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17127 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17128 @item
17129 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17130 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17131 @item
17132 whether the debugging information includes information about
17133 preprocessor macros.
17134 @end itemize
17135
17136
17137 @kindex info sources
17138 @item info sources
17139 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17140 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17141 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17142
17143 @kindex info functions
17144 @item info functions
17145 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17146
17147 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17148 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17149 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17150 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17151 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17152 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
17153 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17154 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17155
17156 @kindex info variables
17157 @item info variables
17158 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17159 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17160
17161 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17162 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17163 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17164 @var{regexp}.
17165
17166 @kindex info classes
17167 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17168 @item info classes
17169 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17170 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17171 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17172 expression.
17173
17174 @kindex info selectors
17175 @item info selectors
17176 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17177 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17178 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17179 expression.
17180
17181 @ignore
17182 This was never implemented.
17183 @kindex info methods
17184 @item info methods
17185 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17186 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17187 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17188 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17189 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17190 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17191 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17192 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17193 @end ignore
17194
17195 @cindex opaque data types
17196 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17197 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17198 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17199 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17200 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17201 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17202 another source file. The default is on.
17203
17204 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17205 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17206
17207 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17208 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17209 is printed as follows:
17210 @smallexample
17211 @{<no data fields>@}
17212 @end smallexample
17213
17214 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17215 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17216 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17217
17218 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17219 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17220 @item set print symbol-loading
17221 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17222 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17223 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17224 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17225 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17226 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17227 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17228 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17229 can be annoying.
17230 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17231 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17232 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17233 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17234
17235 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17236 @item show print symbol-loading
17237 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17238 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17239
17240 @kindex maint print symbols
17241 @cindex symbol dump
17242 @kindex maint print psymbols
17243 @cindex partial symbol dump
17244 @kindex maint print msymbols
17245 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17246 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17247 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17248 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17249 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17250 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17251 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
17252 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
17253 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
17254 that objfile.
17255 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
17256 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
17257 @code{main}.
17258 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
17259 source file.
17260
17261 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
17262 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
17263 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
17264 tables.
17265 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
17266 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
17267 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
17268 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
17269 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
17270 ``ELF symbols''.
17271
17272 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17273 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17274
17275 @kindex maint info symtabs
17276 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17277 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17278 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17279 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17280 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17281 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17282 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17283
17284 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17285 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17286 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17287 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17288 structure in more detail. For example:
17289
17290 @smallexample
17291 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17292 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17293 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17294 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17295 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17296 readin no
17297 fullname (null)
17298 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17299 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17300 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17301 dependencies (none)
17302 @}
17303 @}
17304 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17305 (@value{GDBP})
17306 @end smallexample
17307 @noindent
17308 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17309 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17310 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17311 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17312 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17313
17314 @smallexample
17315 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17316 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17317 line 1574.
17318 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17319 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17320 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17321 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17322 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17323 dirname (null)
17324 fullname (null)
17325 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17326 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17327 debugformat DWARF 2
17328 @}
17329 @}
17330 (@value{GDBP})
17331 @end smallexample
17332
17333 @kindex maint info line-table
17334 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17335 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17336 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17337
17338 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17339 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17340 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17341
17342 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17343 @cindex symbol cache size
17344 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17345 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17346 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17347 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17348 with different sizes.
17349
17350 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17351 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17352 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17353
17354 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17355 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17356 @item maint print symbol-cache
17357 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17358 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17359
17360 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17361 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17362 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17363 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17364 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17365
17366 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17367 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17368 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17369 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17370 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17371 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17372
17373 @end table
17374
17375 @node Altering
17376 @chapter Altering Execution
17377
17378 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17379 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17380 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17381 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17382 program.
17383
17384 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17385 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17386 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17387
17388 @menu
17389 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17390 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17391 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17392 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17393 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17394 * Patching:: Patching your program
17395 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17396 @end menu
17397
17398 @node Assignment
17399 @section Assignment to Variables
17400
17401 @cindex assignment
17402 @cindex setting variables
17403 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17404 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17405
17406 @smallexample
17407 print x=4
17408 @end smallexample
17409
17410 @noindent
17411 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17412 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17413 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17414 information on operators in supported languages.
17415
17416 @kindex set variable
17417 @cindex variables, setting
17418 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17419 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17420 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17421 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17422 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17423
17424 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17425 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17426 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17427 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17428 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17429 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17430 command @code{set width}:
17431
17432 @smallexample
17433 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17434 type = double
17435 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17436 $4 = 13
17437 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17438 Invalid syntax in expression.
17439 @end smallexample
17440
17441 @noindent
17442 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17443 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17444
17445 @smallexample
17446 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17447 @end smallexample
17448
17449 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17450 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17451 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17452 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17453 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17454 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17455
17456 @smallexample
17457 @group
17458 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17459 type = double
17460 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17461 $1 = 1
17462 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17463 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17464 $2 = 1
17465 (@value{GDBP}) r
17466 The program being debugged has been started already.
17467 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17468 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17469 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17470 Invalid bfd target.
17471 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17472 The current BFD target is "=4".
17473 @end group
17474 @end smallexample
17475
17476 @noindent
17477 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17478 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17479 @code{g}, use
17480
17481 @smallexample
17482 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17483 @end smallexample
17484
17485 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17486 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17487 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17488 same length or shorter.
17489 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17490 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17491
17492 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17493 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17494 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17495 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17496 and representation in memory), and
17497
17498 @smallexample
17499 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17500 @end smallexample
17501
17502 @noindent
17503 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17504
17505 @node Jumping
17506 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17507
17508 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17509 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17510 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17511
17512 @table @code
17513 @kindex jump
17514 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17515 @item jump @var{location}
17516 @itemx j @var{location}
17517 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17518 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17519 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17520 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17521 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17522
17523 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17524 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17525 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17526 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17527 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17528 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17529 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17530 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17531 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17532 @end table
17533
17534 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17535 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17536 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17537 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17538 example,
17539
17540 @smallexample
17541 set $pc = 0x485
17542 @end smallexample
17543
17544 @noindent
17545 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17546 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17547 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17548
17549 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17550 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17551 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17552 detail.
17553
17554 @c @group
17555 @node Signaling
17556 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17557 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17558
17559 @table @code
17560 @kindex signal
17561 @item signal @var{signal}
17562 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17563 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17564 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17565 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17566
17567 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17568 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17569 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17570 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17571 signal.
17572
17573 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17574 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17575 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17576 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17577 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17578 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17579 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17580 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17581
17582 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17583 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17584 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17585 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17586 passes the signal directly to your program.
17587
17588 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17589 after executing the command.
17590
17591 @kindex queue-signal
17592 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17593 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17594 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17595 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17596 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17597 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17598 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17599 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17600 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17601
17602 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17603 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17604 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17605 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17606 @code{continue} command.
17607
17608 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17609 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17610 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17611 (@pxref{Signals}).
17612 @end table
17613 @c @end group
17614
17615 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17616 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17617
17618 @node Returning
17619 @section Returning from a Function
17620
17621 @table @code
17622 @cindex returning from a function
17623 @kindex return
17624 @item return
17625 @itemx return @var{expression}
17626 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17627 command. If you give an
17628 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17629 value.
17630 @end table
17631
17632 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17633 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17634 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17635 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17636
17637 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17638 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17639 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17640 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17641 of functions.
17642
17643 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17644 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17645 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17646 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17647 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17648
17649 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17650 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17651 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17652 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17653 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17654 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17655 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17656 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17657 assignment into the right register(s).
17658
17659 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17660 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17661 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17662 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17663 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17664 into a @code{long long int}:
17665
17666 @smallexample
17667 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17668 29 return 31;
17669 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17670 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17671 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17672 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17673 (@value{GDBP})
17674 @end smallexample
17675
17676 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17677 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17678 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17679 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17680 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17681 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17682 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17683 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17684
17685 @smallexample
17686 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17687 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17688 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17689 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17690 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17691 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17692 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17693 (@value{GDBP})
17694 @end smallexample
17695
17696 @node Calling
17697 @section Calling Program Functions
17698
17699 @table @code
17700 @cindex calling functions
17701 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17702 @item print @var{expr}
17703 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17704 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17705 debugged.
17706
17707 @kindex call
17708 @item call @var{expr}
17709 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17710 returned values.
17711
17712 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17713 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17714 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17715 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17716 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17717 value history.
17718 @end table
17719
17720 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17721 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17722 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17723 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17724
17725 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17726 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17727 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17728 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17729 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17730 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17731 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17732 in that case is controlled by the
17733 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17734
17735 @table @code
17736 @item set unwindonsignal
17737 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17738 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17739 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17740 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17741 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17742 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17743 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17744 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17745 received.
17746
17747 @item show unwindonsignal
17748 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17749 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17750 @value{GDBN}.
17751
17752 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17753 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17754 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17755 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17756 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17757 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17758 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17759 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17760 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17761 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17762
17763 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17764 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17765 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17766 @value{GDBN}.
17767
17768 @end table
17769
17770 @cindex weak alias functions
17771 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17772 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17773 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17774 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17775 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17776 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17777 function instead.
17778
17779 @node Patching
17780 @section Patching Programs
17781
17782 @cindex patching binaries
17783 @cindex writing into executables
17784 @cindex writing into corefiles
17785
17786 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17787 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17788 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17789 patching your program's binary.
17790
17791 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17792 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17793 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17794 repairs.
17795
17796 @table @code
17797 @kindex set write
17798 @item set write on
17799 @itemx set write off
17800 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17801 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17802 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17803
17804 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17805 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17806 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17807
17808 @item show write
17809 @kindex show write
17810 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17811 as well as reading.
17812 @end table
17813
17814 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17815 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17816 @cindex injecting code
17817 @cindex writing into executables
17818 @cindex compiling code
17819
17820 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17821 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17822 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17823 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17824
17825 @table @code
17826 @kindex compile code
17827 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17828 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17829 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17830 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17831 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17832 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17833 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17834 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17835 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17836 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17837 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17838 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17839
17840 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17841 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17842 E.g.:
17843
17844 @smallexample
17845 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17846 @end smallexample
17847
17848 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17849 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17850 from actual source code. E.g.:
17851
17852 @smallexample
17853 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17854 @end smallexample
17855
17856 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17857 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17858 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17859 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17860 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17861 editor.
17862
17863 @smallexample
17864 compile code
17865 >printf ("hello\n");
17866 >printf ("world\n");
17867 >end
17868 @end smallexample
17869
17870 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17871 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17872 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17873 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17874 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17875 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17876 inferior symbols otherwise.
17877
17878 @kindex compile file
17879 @item compile file @var{filename}
17880 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17881 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17882
17883 @smallexample
17884 compile file /home/user/example.c
17885 @end smallexample
17886 @end table
17887
17888 @table @code
17889 @item compile print @var{expr}
17890 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
17891 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
17892 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
17893 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
17894 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
17895 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
17896 Formats}.
17897
17898 @item compile print
17899 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
17900 @cindex reprint the last value
17901 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
17902 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
17903 command without any text following the command. This will start the
17904 multiple-line editor.
17905 @end table
17906
17907 @noindent
17908 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17909
17910 @table @code
17911 @anchor{set debug compile}
17912 @item set debug compile
17913 @cindex compile command debugging info
17914 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17915 injecting the code. The default is off.
17916
17917 @item show debug compile
17918 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17919 compiling and injecting the code.
17920 @end table
17921
17922 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17923
17924 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17925 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17926 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17927 injecting process.
17928
17929 @noindent
17930 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17931
17932 @table @asis
17933 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17934 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17935 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17936 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17937
17938 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17939 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17940 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17941 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17942 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17943 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17944 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17945 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17946
17947 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17948 @end table
17949
17950 @noindent
17951 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17952
17953 @table @code
17954 @item set compile-args
17955 @cindex compile command options override
17956 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17957 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17958 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17959 compilation.
17960
17961 @item show compile-args
17962 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17963 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17964 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17965 @end table
17966
17967 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17968
17969 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17970 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17971 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17972
17973 @table @asis
17974 @item C code examples and caveats
17975 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17976 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17977 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17978 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17979 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17980
17981 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17982 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17983 much like any other normal debugging session.
17984
17985 @smallexample
17986 void function1 (void)
17987 @{
17988 int i = 42;
17989 printf ("function 1\n");
17990 @}
17991
17992 void function2 (void)
17993 @{
17994 int j = 12;
17995 function1 ();
17996 @}
17997
17998 int main(void)
17999 @{
18000 int k = 6;
18001 int *p;
18002 function2 ();
18003 return 0;
18004 @}
18005 @end smallexample
18006
18007 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18008 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18009 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18010
18011 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18012 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18013 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18014 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18015 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18016
18017 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18018 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18019 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18020 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18021 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18022 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18023 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18024 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18025 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18026 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18027
18028 @smallexample
18029 compile code k = 3;
18030 @end smallexample
18031
18032 @noindent
18033 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18034 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18035 @code{compile} command changes it.
18036
18037 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18038 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18039 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18040 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18041 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18042
18043 @smallexample
18044 compile code j = 3;
18045 @end smallexample
18046
18047 @noindent
18048 will result in a compilation error message.
18049
18050 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18051 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18052 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18053
18054 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18055 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18056 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18057 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18058
18059 @smallexample
18060 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18061 @end smallexample
18062
18063 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18064 command has completed:
18065
18066 @smallexample
18067 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18068 @end smallexample
18069
18070 @noindent
18071 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18072 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18073 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18074 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18075 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18076
18077 @smallexample
18078 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18079 @end smallexample
18080
18081 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18082 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18083 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18084 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18085 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18086 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18087 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18088 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18089
18090 @smallexample
18091 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18092 @end smallexample
18093
18094 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18095 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18096 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18097 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18098 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18099 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18100 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18101
18102 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18103 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18104 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18105 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18106 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18107 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18108
18109 @smallexample
18110 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18111 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18112 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18113 Compilation failed.
18114 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18115 42
18116 @end smallexample
18117
18118 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18119 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18120 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18121 will print to the console.
18122 @end table
18123
18124 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18125
18126 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
18127 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
18128 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
18129 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
18130 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
18131 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18132 target architecture and operating system.
18133
18134 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18135 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18136 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18137 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18138 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18139 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18140 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18141
18142 @node GDB Files
18143 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18144
18145 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18146 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18147 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18148 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18149
18150 @menu
18151 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18152 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18153 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18154 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18155 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18156 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18157 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18158 @end menu
18159
18160 @node Files
18161 @section Commands to Specify Files
18162
18163 @cindex symbol table
18164 @cindex core dump file
18165
18166 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18167 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18168 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18169 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18170
18171 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18172 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18173 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18174 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18175 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18176 new files are useful.
18177
18178 @table @code
18179 @cindex executable file
18180 @kindex file
18181 @item file @var{filename}
18182 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18183 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18184 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18185 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18186 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18187 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18188 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18189 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18190
18191 @cindex unlinked object files
18192 @cindex patching object files
18193 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18194 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18195 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18196 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18197 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18198 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18199 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18200 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18201
18202 @item file
18203 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18204 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18205
18206 @kindex exec-file
18207 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18208 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18209 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18210 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
18211 discard information on the executable file.
18212
18213 @kindex symbol-file
18214 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18215 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
18216 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18217 table and program to run from the same file.
18218
18219 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18220 program's symbol table.
18221
18222 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18223 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
18224 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18225 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18226 @value{GDBN}.
18227
18228 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18229 executing it once.
18230
18231 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18232 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18233 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18234 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18235 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18236 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18237 optimized code.
18238
18239 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18240 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18241 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
18242 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
18243 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18244
18245 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18246 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18247 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18248 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18249 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18250 Warnings and Messages}.)
18251
18252 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18253 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18254 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18255 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18256 in stabs format.
18257
18258 @kindex readnow
18259 @cindex reading symbols immediately
18260 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
18261 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18262 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18263 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18264 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18265 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18266 entire symbol table available.
18267
18268 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18269 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18270 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18271 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18272 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18273 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18274 @c files.
18275
18276 @kindex core-file
18277 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18278 @itemx core
18279 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18280 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18281 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18282 executable file itself for other parts.
18283
18284 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18285 to be used.
18286
18287 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18288 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18289 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18290 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18291 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18292
18293 @kindex add-symbol-file
18294 @cindex dynamic linking
18295 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18296 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
18297 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18298 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18299 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18300 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18301 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18302 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18303 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18304 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18305 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18306 @var{address} as an expression.
18307
18308 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18309 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18310 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18311 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18312
18313 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18314
18315 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18316 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18317 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18318 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18319 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18320 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18321 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18322 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18323 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18324
18325 @itemize @bullet
18326 @item
18327 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18328 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18329 @item
18330 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18331 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18332 @item
18333 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18334 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18335 @end itemize
18336
18337 @noindent
18338 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18339 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18340 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18341 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18342 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18343 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18344 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18345 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18346 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18347 way.
18348
18349 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18350
18351 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18352 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18353 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18354 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18355 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18356 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18357
18358 @smallexample
18359 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18360 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18361 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18362 (y or n) y
18363 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18364 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18365 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18366 (gdb)
18367 @end smallexample
18368
18369
18370 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18371
18372 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18373 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18374 @cindex load symbols from memory
18375 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18376 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18377 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18378 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18379 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18380 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18381 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18382 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18383 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18384
18385 @kindex section
18386 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18387 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18388 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18389 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18390 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18391 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18392 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18393 their addresses.
18394
18395 @kindex info files
18396 @kindex info target
18397 @item info files
18398 @itemx info target
18399 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18400 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18401 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18402 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18403 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18404 current ones.
18405
18406 @kindex maint info sections
18407 @item maint info sections
18408 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18409 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18410 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18411 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18412 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18413 may be arbitrarily combined):
18414
18415 @table @code
18416 @item ALLOBJ
18417 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18418 @item @var{sections}
18419 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18420 @item @var{section-flags}
18421 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18422 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18423 @table @code
18424 @item ALLOC
18425 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18426 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18427 @item LOAD
18428 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18429 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18430 @item RELOC
18431 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18432 @item READONLY
18433 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18434 @item CODE
18435 Section contains executable code only.
18436 @item DATA
18437 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18438 @item ROM
18439 Section will reside in ROM.
18440 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18441 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18442 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18443 Section is not empty.
18444 @item NEVER_LOAD
18445 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18446 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18447 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18448 COFF shared library information.
18449 @item IS_COMMON
18450 Section contains common symbols.
18451 @end table
18452 @end table
18453 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18454 @cindex read-only sections
18455 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18456 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18457 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18458 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18459 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18460 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18461 enhancement to debugging performance.
18462
18463 The default is off.
18464
18465 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18466 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18467 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18468 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18469
18470 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18471 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18472 @end table
18473
18474 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18475 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18476 name and remembers it that way.
18477
18478 @cindex shared libraries
18479 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18480 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18481 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18482 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18483
18484 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18485 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18486
18487 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18488 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18489 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18490 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18491 debugging a core file).
18492
18493 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18494 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18495 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18496
18497 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18498 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18499 particularly large or there are many of them.
18500
18501 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18502 commands:
18503
18504 @table @code
18505 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18506 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18507 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18508 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18509 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18510 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18511 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18512 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18513
18514 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18515 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18516 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18517 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18518 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18519 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18520 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18521 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18522 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18523
18524 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18525 @item show auto-solib-add
18526 Display the current autoloading mode.
18527 @end table
18528
18529 @cindex load shared library
18530 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18531 command:
18532
18533 @table @code
18534 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18535 @kindex info share
18536 @item info share @var{regex}
18537 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18538 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18539 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18540 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18541
18542 @kindex info dll
18543 @item info dll @var{regex}
18544 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18545
18546 @kindex sharedlibrary
18547 @kindex share
18548 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18549 @itemx share @var{regex}
18550 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18551 Unix regular expression.
18552 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18553 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18554 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18555 loaded.
18556
18557 @item nosharedlibrary
18558 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18559 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18560 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18561 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18562 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18563 discarded.
18564 @end table
18565
18566 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18567 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18568 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18569 Catchpoints}).
18570
18571 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18572 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18573 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18574 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18575
18576 @table @code
18577 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18578 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18579 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18580 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18581 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18582 shared library.
18583
18584 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18585 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18586 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18587 library events happen.
18588 @end table
18589
18590 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18591 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18592 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18593 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18594 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18595 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18596 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18597 not.
18598
18599 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18600 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18601 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18602 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18603 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18604
18605 @table @code
18606 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18607 @cindex system root, alternate
18608 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18609 @kindex set sysroot
18610 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18611 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18612 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18613 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18614 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18615 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18616 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18617 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18618 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18619 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18620 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18621 @var{path}.
18622
18623 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18624 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18625 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18626 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18627 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18628 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18629 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18630 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18631 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18632 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18633 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18634 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18635 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18636 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18637
18638 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18639 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18640 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18641 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18642 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18643
18644 @smallexample
18645 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18646 @end smallexample
18647
18648 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18649 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18650 system:
18651
18652 @smallexample
18653 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18654 @end smallexample
18655
18656 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18657 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18658 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18659 colons:
18660
18661 @smallexample
18662 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18663 @end smallexample
18664
18665 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18666 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18667 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18668 @samp{z}):
18669
18670 @smallexample
18671 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18672 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18673 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18674 @end smallexample
18675
18676 @noindent
18677 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18678 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18679 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18680
18681 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18682 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18683
18684 @smallexample
18685 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18686 @end smallexample
18687
18688 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18689 if you don't want or need to.
18690
18691 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18692 sysroot}.
18693
18694 @cindex default system root
18695 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18696 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18697 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18698 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18699 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18700 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18701 location.
18702
18703 @kindex show sysroot
18704 @item show sysroot
18705 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18706
18707 @kindex set solib-search-path
18708 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18709 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18710 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18711 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18712 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18713 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18714 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18715 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18716 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18717 of shared library symbols.
18718
18719 @kindex show solib-search-path
18720 @item show solib-search-path
18721 Display the current shared library search path.
18722
18723 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18724 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18725 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18726 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18727 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18728
18729 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18730 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18731 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18732 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18733 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18734 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18735 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18736 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18737 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18738 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18739 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18740 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18741 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18742 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18743 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18744 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18745 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18746 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18747 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18748 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18749 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18750 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18751
18752 @table @code
18753 @item unix
18754 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18755 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18756 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18757 the forward slash.
18758
18759 @item dos-based
18760 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18761 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18762 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18763 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18764 considered directory separators.
18765
18766 @item auto
18767 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18768 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18769 This is the default.
18770 @end table
18771 @end table
18772
18773 @cindex file name canonicalization
18774 @cindex base name differences
18775 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18776 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18777 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18778 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18779 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18780 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18781 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18782 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18783 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18784 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18785 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18786 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18787 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18788 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18789 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18790
18791 @table @code
18792 @item set basenames-may-differ
18793 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18794 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18795
18796 @item show basenames-may-differ
18797 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18798 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18799 @end table
18800
18801 @node File Caching
18802 @section File Caching
18803 @cindex caching of opened files
18804 @cindex caching of bfd objects
18805
18806 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
18807 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
18808 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
18809 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
18810
18811 @table @code
18812 @kindex maint info bfds
18813 @item maint info bfds
18814 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
18815 @value{GDBN}.
18816
18817 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
18818 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
18819 @kindex bfd caching
18820 @item maint set bfd-sharing
18821 @item maint show bfd-sharing
18822 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
18823 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
18824 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
18825 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
18826 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
18827 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
18828 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
18829
18830 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18831 @kindex bfd caching
18832 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18833 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
18834
18835 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
18836 @kindex bfd caching
18837 @item show debug bfd-cache
18838 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
18839 @end table
18840
18841 @node Separate Debug Files
18842 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18843 @cindex separate debugging information files
18844 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18845 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18846 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18847 @cindex global debugging information directories
18848 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18849 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18850
18851 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18852 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18853 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18854 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18855 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18856 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18857 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18858
18859 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18860 file:
18861
18862 @itemize @bullet
18863 @item
18864 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18865 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18866 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18867 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18868 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18869 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18870 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18871 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18872
18873 @item
18874 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18875 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18876 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
18877 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18878 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18879 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18880 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18881 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18882 below.
18883 @end itemize
18884
18885 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18886 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18887
18888 @itemize @bullet
18889 @item
18890 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18891 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18892 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18893 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18894 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18895
18896 @item
18897 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18898 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18899 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18900 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18901 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18902 hex characters, not 10.)
18903 @end itemize
18904
18905 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18906 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18907 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18908 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18909 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18910 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18911
18912 @itemize @minus
18913 @item
18914 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18915 @item
18916 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18917 @item
18918 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18919 @item
18920 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18921 @end itemize
18922
18923 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18924 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18925 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18926 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18927 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18928
18929 @table @code
18930
18931 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18932 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18933 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18934 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18935 concatenating them by a path separator.
18936
18937 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18938 @item show debug-file-directory
18939 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18940 information files.
18941
18942 @end table
18943
18944 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18945 @cindex debug link sections
18946 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18947 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18948
18949 @itemize
18950 @item
18951 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18952 a zero byte,
18953 @item
18954 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18955 boundary within the section, and
18956 @item
18957 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18958 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18959 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18960 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18961 @end itemize
18962
18963 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18964 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18965 described above.
18966
18967 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18968 @cindex build ID sections
18969 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18970 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18971 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18972 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18973 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18974 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18975 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18976 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18977 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18978
18979 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18980 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18981 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18982 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18983 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18984 in an ordinary executable.
18985
18986 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18987 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18988 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18989 following commands:
18990
18991 @smallexample
18992 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18993 @kbd{strip -g foo}
18994 @end smallexample
18995
18996 @noindent
18997 These commands remove the debugging
18998 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18999 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19000 two files:
19001
19002 @itemize @bullet
19003 @item
19004 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19005 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19006
19007 @smallexample
19008 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19009 @end smallexample
19010
19011 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19012 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19013 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19014 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19015
19016 @item
19017 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19018 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19019 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19020 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19021 @end itemize
19022
19023 @noindent
19024
19025 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19026 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19027 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19028
19029 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19030 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19031 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19032 @c different ways!
19033 @ifhtml
19034 @display
19035 @html
19036 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19037 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19038 @end html
19039 @end display
19040 @end ifhtml
19041 @ifnothtml
19042 @display
19043 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19044 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19045 @end display
19046 @end ifnothtml
19047
19048 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19049 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19050 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19051 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19052 CRC.
19053
19054 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19055 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19056 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19057 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19058 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19059
19060 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19061 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19062 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19063 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19064 @code{0xffffffff}.
19065
19066 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19067 @smallexample
19068 unsigned long
19069 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19070 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19071 @{
19072 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19073 @{
19074 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19075 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19076 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19077 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19078 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19079 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19080 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19081 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19082 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19083 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19084 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19085 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19086 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19087 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19088 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19089 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19090 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19091 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19092 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19093 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19094 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19095 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19096 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19097 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19098 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19099 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19100 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19101 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19102 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19103 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19104 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19105 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19106 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19107 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19108 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19109 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19110 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19111 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19112 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19113 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19114 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19115 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19116 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19117 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19118 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19119 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19120 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19121 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19122 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19123 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19124 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19125 0x2d02ef8d
19126 @};
19127 unsigned char *end;
19128
19129 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19130 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19131 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19132 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19133 @}
19134 @end smallexample
19135
19136 @noindent
19137 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19138
19139 @node MiniDebugInfo
19140 @section Debugging information in a special section
19141 @cindex separate debug sections
19142 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19143
19144 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19145 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19146 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19147 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19148
19149 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19150 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19151 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19152 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19153 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19154 debugging information might be included in the section.
19155
19156 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19157 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19158 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19159
19160 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19161 standard utilities:
19162
19163 @smallexample
19164 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19165 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19166 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19167 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19168
19169 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19170 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19171 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19172 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19173 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19174 | sort > funcsyms
19175
19176 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19177 # table.
19178 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19179
19180 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19181 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19182
19183 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19184 # removing some unnecessary sections.
19185 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19186 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19187
19188 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19189 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19190
19191 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19192 # original binary.
19193 xz mini_debuginfo
19194 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19195 @end smallexample
19196
19197 @node Index Files
19198 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19199 @cindex index files
19200 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19201
19202 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19203 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
19204 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19205 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19206 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19207 startup.
19208
19209 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
19210 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19211 using @command{objcopy}.
19212
19213 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19214
19215 @table @code
19216 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
19217 @kindex save gdb-index
19218 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
19219 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
19220 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
19221 @var{directory}.
19222 @end table
19223
19224 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19225 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19226
19227 @smallexample
19228 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19229 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19230 @end smallexample
19231
19232 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19233 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
19234 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19235 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19236 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19237 The default is @code{off}.
19238 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19239 @xref{Index Section Format}.
19240
19241 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19242 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
19243
19244 @smallexample
19245 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19246 @end smallexample
19247
19248 Instead you must do, for example,
19249
19250 @smallexample
19251 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19252 @end smallexample
19253
19254 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19255 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19256 currently work for programs using Ada.
19257
19258 @node Symbol Errors
19259 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19260
19261 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19262 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19263 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19264 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19265 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19266 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19267 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19268 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19269 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19270 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19271 Messages}).
19272
19273 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19274
19275 @table @code
19276 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19277
19278 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19279 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19280 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19281 in its outer scope blocks.
19282
19283 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19284 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19285 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19286 function.
19287
19288 @item block at @var{address} out of order
19289
19290 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19291 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19292 do so.
19293
19294 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19295 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19296 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19297 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19298 Messages}.)
19299
19300 @item bad block start address patched
19301
19302 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19303 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19304 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19305
19306 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19307 starting on the previous source line.
19308
19309 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19310
19311 @cindex foo
19312 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19313 larger than the size of the string table.
19314
19315 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19316 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19317 with this name.
19318
19319 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19320
19321 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19322 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19323 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19324
19325 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19326 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19327 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19328 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19329 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19330 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19331
19332 @item stub type has NULL name
19333
19334 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19335
19336 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19337 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19338 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19339 it.
19340
19341 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19342
19343 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19344
19345 @end table
19346
19347 @node Data Files
19348 @section GDB Data Files
19349
19350 @cindex prefix for data files
19351 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19352 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19353
19354 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19355 is currently using.
19356
19357 @table @code
19358 @kindex set data-directory
19359 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
19360 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19361 to @var{directory}.
19362
19363 @kindex show data-directory
19364 @item show data-directory
19365 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19366 @end table
19367
19368 @cindex default data directory
19369 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19370 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19371 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19372 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19373 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19374 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19375 location.
19376
19377 The data directory may also be specified with the
19378 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
19379 @xref{Mode Options}.
19380
19381 @node Targets
19382 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19383
19384 @cindex debugging target
19385 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19386
19387 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19388 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19389 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19390 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19391 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19392 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19393 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19394 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19395
19396 @cindex target architecture
19397 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19398 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19399 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19400 command.
19401
19402 @table @code
19403 @kindex set architecture
19404 @kindex show architecture
19405 @item set architecture @var{arch}
19406 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19407 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19408 supported architectures.
19409
19410 @item show architecture
19411 Show the current target architecture.
19412
19413 @item set processor
19414 @itemx processor
19415 @kindex set processor
19416 @kindex show processor
19417 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19418 and @code{show architecture}.
19419 @end table
19420
19421 @menu
19422 * Active Targets:: Active targets
19423 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19424 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19425 @end menu
19426
19427 @node Active Targets
19428 @section Active Targets
19429
19430 @cindex stacking targets
19431 @cindex active targets
19432 @cindex multiple targets
19433
19434 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19435 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19436 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19437 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19438 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19439 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19440 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19441 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19442 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19443
19444 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19445 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19446 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19447 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19448
19449 @node Target Commands
19450 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19451
19452 @table @code
19453 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19454 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19455 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19456 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19457 protocol of the target machine.
19458
19459 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19460 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19461 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19462
19463 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19464 after executing the command.
19465
19466 @kindex help target
19467 @item help target
19468 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19469 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19470 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19471
19472 @item help target @var{name}
19473 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19474 select it.
19475
19476 @kindex set gnutarget
19477 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19478 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19479 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19480 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19481 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19482 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19483
19484 @quotation
19485 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19486 you must know the actual BFD name.
19487 @end quotation
19488
19489 @noindent
19490 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19491
19492 @kindex show gnutarget
19493 @item show gnutarget
19494 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19495 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19496 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19497 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19498 @end table
19499
19500 @cindex common targets
19501 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19502 configuration):
19503
19504 @table @code
19505 @kindex target
19506 @item target exec @var{program}
19507 @cindex executable file target
19508 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19509 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19510
19511 @item target core @var{filename}
19512 @cindex core dump file target
19513 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19514 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19515
19516 @item target remote @var{medium}
19517 @cindex remote target
19518 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19519 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19520 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19521
19522 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19523 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19524
19525 @smallexample
19526 target remote /dev/ttya
19527 @end smallexample
19528
19529 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19530 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19531 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19532 clobbered by the download.
19533
19534 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19535 @cindex built-in simulator target
19536 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19537 In general,
19538 @smallexample
19539 target sim
19540 load
19541 run
19542 @end smallexample
19543 @noindent
19544 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19545 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19546 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19547 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19548 Processors}.
19549
19550 @item target native
19551 @cindex native target
19552 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19553 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19554 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19555 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19556
19557 @end table
19558
19559 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19560 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19561
19562 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19563 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19564 various aspects of this process.
19565
19566 @table @code
19567
19568 @item set hash
19569 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19570 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19571 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19572 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19573 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19574 monitor.
19575
19576 @item show hash
19577 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19578 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19579
19580 @item set debug monitor
19581 @kindex set debug monitor
19582 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19583 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19584 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19585
19586 @item show debug monitor
19587 @kindex show debug monitor
19588 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19589 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19590 @end table
19591
19592 @table @code
19593
19594 @kindex load @var{filename}
19595 @item load @var{filename}
19596 @anchor{load}
19597 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19598 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19599 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19600 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19601 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19602 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19603
19604 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19605 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19606 target is @dots{}}''
19607
19608 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19609 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19610 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19611 specifies a fixed address.
19612 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19613
19614 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19615 load programs into flash memory.
19616
19617 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19618 @end table
19619
19620 @node Byte Order
19621 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19622
19623 @cindex choosing target byte order
19624 @cindex target byte order
19625
19626 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19627 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19628 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19629 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19630 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19631 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19632
19633 @table @code
19634 @kindex set endian
19635 @item set endian big
19636 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19637
19638 @item set endian little
19639 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19640
19641 @item set endian auto
19642 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19643 executable.
19644
19645 @item show endian
19646 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19647
19648 @end table
19649
19650 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19651 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19652 target system.
19653
19654
19655 @node Remote Debugging
19656 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19657 @cindex remote debugging
19658
19659 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19660 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19661 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19662 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19663 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19664
19665 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19666 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19667 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19668 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19669 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19670 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19671
19672 Other remote targets may be available in your
19673 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19674
19675 @menu
19676 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19677 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19678 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19679 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19680 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19681 @end menu
19682
19683 @node Connecting
19684 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19685 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
19686 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19687 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19688 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19689 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19690 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19691
19692 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19693 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19694 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19695 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19696
19697 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
19698
19699 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19700 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
19701 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
19702 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19703
19704 @table @asis
19705
19706 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19707 @item Result of detach or program exit
19708 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19709 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
19710 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19711
19712 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19713 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19714 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
19715 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19716
19717 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19718 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
19719 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19720 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19721
19722 @item Specifying the program to debug
19723 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19724 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19725 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19726 target.
19727
19728 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19729 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19730 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19731
19732 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19733 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19734 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19735 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19736
19737 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19738 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19739 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19740 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19741 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19742 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
19743 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19744 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
19745 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19746
19747 @item The @code{run} command
19748 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19749 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19750 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
19751 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19752 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19753
19754 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19755 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19756 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19757 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
19758 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19759
19760 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19761 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19762 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19763 @code{target remote} mode.
19764
19765 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
19766 @item Attaching
19767 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
19768 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
19769 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19770
19771 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
19772 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
19773 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
19774 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
19775 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19776
19777 @end table
19778
19779 @anchor{Host and target files}
19780 @subsection Host and Target Files
19781 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
19782 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
19783
19784 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
19785 information for your program running on the target. This requires
19786 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
19787 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
19788 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
19789
19790 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
19791 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
19792 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
19793 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
19794 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
19795
19796 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
19797 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19798 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19799 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
19800 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
19801 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
19802 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
19803 target libraries.
19804
19805 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19806 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19807 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19808 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19809 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19810 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19811 programs.
19812
19813 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
19814 @cindex remote connection commands
19815 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19816 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
19817 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19818 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
19819 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
19820 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
19821 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
19822
19823 @table @code
19824
19825 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
19826 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
19827 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
19828 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
19829 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
19830
19831 @smallexample
19832 target remote /dev/ttyb
19833 @end smallexample
19834
19835 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
19836 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
19837 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
19838 @code{target} command.
19839
19840 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19841 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19842 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19843 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19844 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
19845 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
19846 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
19847 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
19848 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
19849 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
19850 target.
19851
19852 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19853 @code{manyfarms}:
19854
19855 @smallexample
19856 target remote manyfarms:2828
19857 @end smallexample
19858
19859 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19860 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19861 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19862 port 1234 on your local machine:
19863
19864 @smallexample
19865 target remote :1234
19866 @end smallexample
19867 @noindent
19868
19869 Note that the colon is still required here.
19870
19871 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19872 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19873 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19874 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19875 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19876
19877 @smallexample
19878 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19879 @end smallexample
19880
19881 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19882 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19883 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19884 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19885
19886 @item target remote | @var{command}
19887 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
19888 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19889 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19890 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19891 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19892 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19893 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19894 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19895 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19896
19897 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19898 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19899 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19900
19901 @end table
19902
19903 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19904 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19905 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19906 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19907 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19908 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19909 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19910
19911 @smallexample
19912 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19913 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19914 @end smallexample
19915
19916 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
19917 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
19918 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
19919 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
19920
19921 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
19922 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
19923
19924 @table @code
19925 @kindex detach (remote)
19926 @item detach
19927 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19928 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19929 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19930 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19931 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
19932 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
19933 still connected to the target.
19934
19935 @kindex disconnect
19936 @item disconnect
19937 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
19938 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19939 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19940 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19941 another target.
19942
19943 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19944 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19945 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19946 @kindex monitor
19947 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19948 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19949 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19950 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19951 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19952 and implement.
19953 @end table
19954
19955 @node File Transfer
19956 @section Sending files to a remote system
19957 @cindex remote target, file transfer
19958 @cindex file transfer
19959 @cindex sending files to remote systems
19960
19961 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
19962 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
19963 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
19964 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
19965 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
19966 the only way to upload or download files.
19967
19968 Not all remote targets support these commands.
19969
19970 @table @code
19971 @kindex remote put
19972 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
19973 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
19974 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
19975
19976 @kindex remote get
19977 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
19978 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
19979 on the host system.
19980
19981 @kindex remote delete
19982 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
19983 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
19984
19985 @end table
19986
19987 @node Server
19988 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
19989
19990 @kindex gdbserver
19991 @cindex remote connection without stubs
19992 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
19993 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
19994 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
19995 linking in the usual debugging stub.
19996
19997 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
19998 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
19999 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
20000 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
20001 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
20002 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
20003 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
20004 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
20005 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
20006 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
20007 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
20008 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
20009 choice for debugging.
20010
20011 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20012 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20013 protocol.
20014
20015 @quotation
20016 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20017 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20018 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20019 target system with the same privileges as the user running
20020 @code{gdbserver}.
20021 @end quotation
20022
20023 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
20024 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20025 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20026 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20027
20028 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20029 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20030 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20031 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20032 system does all the symbol handling.
20033
20034 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20035 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20036 syntax is:
20037
20038 @smallexample
20039 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20040 @end smallexample
20041
20042 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20043 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20044 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20045 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20046 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20047 @file{/dev/com1}:
20048
20049 @smallexample
20050 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20051 @end smallexample
20052
20053 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20054 with it.
20055
20056 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20057
20058 @smallexample
20059 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20060 @end smallexample
20061
20062 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20063 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20064 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20065 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20066 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
20067 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20068 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20069 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20070 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20071 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20072 @code{target remote} command.
20073
20074 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20075 with ssh:
20076
20077 @smallexample
20078 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20079 @end smallexample
20080
20081 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20082 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
20083 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20084 You could elide it if you want to.
20085
20086 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20087 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20088 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20089 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20090
20091 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
20092 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20093 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20094 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20095
20096 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
20097 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
20098
20099 @smallexample
20100 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
20101 @end smallexample
20102
20103 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
20104 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
20105
20106 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
20107 @value{GDBN} attach command
20108 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
20109
20110 @pindex pidof
20111 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
20112 @code{pidof} utility:
20113
20114 @smallexample
20115 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
20116 @end smallexample
20117
20118 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
20119 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
20120 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
20121
20122 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
20123
20124 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
20125 port.
20126
20127 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
20128 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
20129 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
20130 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
20131 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
20132 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
20133 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
20134 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
20135
20136 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
20137 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
20138 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
20139
20140 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
20141 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
20142 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
20143 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
20144 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
20145 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
20146 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20147 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20148 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
20149 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20150 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20151 instance closes its port after the first connection.
20152
20153 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20154 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20155
20156 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20157 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
20158 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20159 program. For more information,
20160 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20161
20162 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20163 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20164 status information about the debugging process.
20165 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20166 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20167 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
20168 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20169
20170 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20171 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20172 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20173 Possible options are:
20174
20175 @table @code
20176 @item none
20177 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20178 @item all
20179 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20180 @item timestamps
20181 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20182 @end table
20183
20184 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20185 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20186
20187 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20188 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20189 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
20190 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20191 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20192
20193 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20194 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20195 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
20196 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20197
20198 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20199 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
20200 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
20201 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20202
20203 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20204 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20205 environment:
20206
20207 @smallexample
20208 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20209 @end smallexample
20210
20211 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20212
20213 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20214 @itemize
20215
20216 @item
20217 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20218
20219 @item
20220 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20221 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
20222 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20223 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20224 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20225 @code{--with-sysroot}).
20226
20227 @item
20228 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20229 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20230 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
20231 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20232 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
20233 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20234 program is already on the target.
20235
20236 @end itemize
20237
20238 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20239 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20240 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20241
20242 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20243 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20244 Here are the available commands.
20245
20246 @table @code
20247 @item monitor help
20248 List the available monitor commands.
20249
20250 @item monitor set debug 0
20251 @itemx monitor set debug 1
20252 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20253
20254 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
20255 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20256 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20257 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20258
20259 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20260 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20261 Possible options are:
20262
20263 @table @code
20264 @item none
20265 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20266 @item all
20267 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20268 @item timestamps
20269 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20270 @end table
20271
20272 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20273 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20274
20275 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20276 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20277 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20278 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20279 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20280 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20281
20282 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20283 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20284
20285 @item monitor exit
20286 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20287 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20288 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20289 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20290 of a multi-process mode debug session.
20291
20292 @end table
20293
20294 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20295 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20296
20297 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20298 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20299
20300 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20301 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20302 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20303 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20304 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20305 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20306 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20307 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20308 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20309 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20310 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20311 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20312
20313 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20314
20315 @table @code
20316 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20317
20318 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20319 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20320 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20321
20322 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20323
20324 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20325 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
20326 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
20327 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20328 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20329 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
20330
20331 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20332
20333 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20334 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20335 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20336 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20337 command for that. For example:
20338
20339 @smallexample
20340 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20341 @end smallexample
20342
20343 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20344 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20345 @end table
20346
20347 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20348 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20349 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20350 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20351 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20352 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20353 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20354 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20355 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20356 @code{gdbserver} like so:
20357
20358 @smallexample
20359 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20360 @end smallexample
20361
20362 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20363
20364 @smallexample
20365 $ gdb myprogram
20366 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
20367 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20368 (@value{GDBP}) b main
20369 (@value{GDBP}) continue
20370 @end smallexample
20371
20372 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20373 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20374 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20375 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20376 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20377 tracing.
20378
20379 @node Remote Configuration
20380 @section Remote Configuration
20381
20382 @kindex set remote
20383 @kindex show remote
20384 This section documents the configuration options available when
20385 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20386 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20387 system-call-allowed}.
20388
20389 @table @code
20390 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20391 @cindex address size for remote targets
20392 @cindex bits in remote address
20393 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20394 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20395 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20396 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20397
20398 @item show remoteaddresssize
20399 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20400
20401 @item set serial baud @var{n}
20402 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
20403 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20404 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20405 remote targets.
20406
20407 @item show serial baud
20408 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20409
20410 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
20411 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20412 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20413
20414 @item show serial parity
20415 Show the current parity of the serial port.
20416
20417 @item set remotebreak
20418 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20419 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20420 @anchor{set remotebreak}
20421 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20422 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20423 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20424 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20425 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20426
20427 @item show remotebreak
20428 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20429 interrupt the remote program.
20430
20431 @item set remoteflow on
20432 @itemx set remoteflow off
20433 @kindex set remoteflow
20434 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20435 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20436
20437 @item show remoteflow
20438 @kindex show remoteflow
20439 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20440
20441 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20442 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20443 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20444 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20445 @code{ascii}.
20446
20447 @item show remotelogbase
20448 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20449 protocol.
20450
20451 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20452 @cindex record serial communications on file
20453 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20454 default is not to record at all.
20455
20456 @item show remotelogfile.
20457 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20458 serial communications.
20459
20460 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20461 @cindex timeout for serial communications
20462 @cindex remote timeout
20463 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20464 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20465
20466 @item show remotetimeout
20467 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20468 responses.
20469
20470 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20471 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20472 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20473 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20474 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20475 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20476 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20477 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20478
20479 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20480 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20481 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20482 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20483 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20484 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20485 as unlimited.
20486
20487 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20488 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20489 a remote hardware watchpoint.
20490
20491 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20492 @itemx show remote exec-file
20493 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
20494 @cindex executable file, for remote target
20495 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20496 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20497 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20498 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20499
20500 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
20501 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20502 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20503 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20504 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
20505 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20506 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20507 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20508 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20509 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20510
20511 @item show interrupt-sequence
20512 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20513 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20514 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20515 also known as Magic SysRq g.
20516
20517 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20518 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20519 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20520 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20521 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20522 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20523
20524 @item show interrupt-on-connect
20525 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20526 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20527
20528 @kindex set tcp
20529 @kindex show tcp
20530 @item set tcp auto-retry on
20531 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20532 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20533 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20534 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20535 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20536 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20537 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20538 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20539
20540 @item set tcp auto-retry off
20541 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20542
20543 @item show tcp auto-retry
20544 Show the current auto-retry setting.
20545
20546 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20547 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20548 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20549 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20550 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20551 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20552 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20553 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20554 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20555 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20556 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20557
20558 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20559 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20560 @end table
20561
20562 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20563 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20564 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20565 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20566 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20567 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20568 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20569 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20570 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20571
20572 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20573 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20574 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20575 @value{GDBN} developers.
20576
20577 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20578 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20579 are:
20580
20581 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20582 @item Command Name
20583 @tab Remote Packet
20584 @tab Related Features
20585
20586 @item @code{fetch-register}
20587 @tab @code{p}
20588 @tab @code{info registers}
20589
20590 @item @code{set-register}
20591 @tab @code{P}
20592 @tab @code{set}
20593
20594 @item @code{binary-download}
20595 @tab @code{X}
20596 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20597
20598 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20599 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20600 @tab @code{info auxv}
20601
20602 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20603 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20604 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20605
20606 @item @code{attach}
20607 @tab @code{vAttach}
20608 @tab @code{attach}
20609
20610 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20611 @tab @code{vCont}
20612 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20613
20614 @item @code{run}
20615 @tab @code{vRun}
20616 @tab @code{run}
20617
20618 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20619 @tab @code{Z0}
20620 @tab @code{break}
20621
20622 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20623 @tab @code{Z1}
20624 @tab @code{hbreak}
20625
20626 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20627 @tab @code{Z2}
20628 @tab @code{watch}
20629
20630 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20631 @tab @code{Z3}
20632 @tab @code{rwatch}
20633
20634 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20635 @tab @code{Z4}
20636 @tab @code{awatch}
20637
20638 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20639 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20640 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20641
20642 @item @code{target-features}
20643 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20644 @tab @code{set architecture}
20645
20646 @item @code{library-info}
20647 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20648 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20649
20650 @item @code{memory-map}
20651 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20652 @tab @code{info mem}
20653
20654 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20655 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20656 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20657
20658 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20659 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20660 @tab @code{info spu}
20661
20662 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20663 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20664 @tab @code{info spu}
20665
20666 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20667 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20668 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20669
20670 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20671 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20672 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20673
20674 @item @code{threads}
20675 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20676 @tab @code{info threads}
20677
20678 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20679 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20680 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20681
20682 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20683 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20684 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20685
20686 @item @code{search-memory}
20687 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20688 @tab @code{find}
20689
20690 @item @code{supported-packets}
20691 @tab @code{qSupported}
20692 @tab Remote communications parameters
20693
20694 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
20695 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20696 @tab @code{catch syscall}
20697
20698 @item @code{pass-signals}
20699 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20700 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20701
20702 @item @code{program-signals}
20703 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20704 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20705
20706 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20707 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20708 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20709
20710 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20711 @tab @code{vFile:open}
20712 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20713
20714 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20715 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
20716 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20717
20718 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20719 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20720 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20721
20722 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20723 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20724 @tab @code{remote delete}
20725
20726 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20727 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20728 @tab Host I/O
20729
20730 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20731 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20732 @tab Host I/O
20733
20734 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20735 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20736 @tab Host I/O
20737
20738 @item @code{noack-packet}
20739 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20740 @tab Packet acknowledgment
20741
20742 @item @code{osdata}
20743 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20744 @tab @code{info os}
20745
20746 @item @code{query-attached}
20747 @tab @code{qAttached}
20748 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
20749
20750 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20751 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20752 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20753
20754 @item @code{trace-status}
20755 @tab @code{qTStatus}
20756 @tab @code{tstatus}
20757
20758 @item @code{traceframe-info}
20759 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20760 @tab Traceframe info
20761
20762 @item @code{install-in-trace}
20763 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20764 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20765
20766 @item @code{disable-randomization}
20767 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20768 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20769
20770 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20771 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20772 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20773
20774 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
20775 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
20776 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
20777
20778 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
20779 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20780 @tab @code{break}
20781
20782 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20783 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20784 @tab @code{hbreak}
20785
20786 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
20787 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
20788 @tab @code{fork}
20789
20790 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20791 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20792 @tab @code{vfork}
20793
20794 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
20795 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
20796 @tab @code{exec}
20797
20798 @item @code{thread-events}
20799 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
20800 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20801
20802 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
20803 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
20804 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20805
20806 @end multitable
20807
20808 @node Remote Stub
20809 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
20810
20811 @cindex debugging stub, example
20812 @cindex remote stub, example
20813 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
20814 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
20815 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
20816 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
20817 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
20818 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
20819 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
20820 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
20821
20822 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
20823 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
20824 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
20825 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
20826 program, you need:
20827
20828 @enumerate
20829 @item
20830 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
20831 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
20832 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
20833
20834 @item
20835 A C subroutine library to support your program's
20836 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
20837
20838 @item
20839 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
20840 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
20841 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
20842 documentation.
20843 @end enumerate
20844
20845 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
20846 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
20847 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
20848
20849 @table @emph
20850 @item On the host,
20851 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
20852 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
20853 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20854
20855 @item On the target,
20856 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
20857 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
20858 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
20859
20860 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
20861 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
20862 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
20863 @end table
20864
20865 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
20866 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
20867 @sc{sparc} boards.
20868
20869 @cindex remote serial stub list
20870 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20871
20872 @table @code
20873
20874 @item i386-stub.c
20875 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20876 @cindex Intel
20877 @cindex i386
20878 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20879
20880 @item m68k-stub.c
20881 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20882 @cindex Motorola 680x0
20883 @cindex m680x0
20884 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20885
20886 @item sh-stub.c
20887 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20888 @cindex Renesas
20889 @cindex SH
20890 For Renesas SH architectures.
20891
20892 @item sparc-stub.c
20893 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20894 @cindex Sparc
20895 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20896
20897 @item sparcl-stub.c
20898 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20899 @cindex Fujitsu
20900 @cindex SparcLite
20901 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20902
20903 @end table
20904
20905 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20906 recently added stubs.
20907
20908 @menu
20909 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20910 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20911 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20912 @end menu
20913
20914 @node Stub Contents
20915 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20916
20917 @cindex remote serial stub
20918 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20919 subroutines:
20920
20921 @table @code
20922 @item set_debug_traps
20923 @findex set_debug_traps
20924 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20925 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20926 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20927 program's startup code.
20928
20929 @item handle_exception
20930 @findex handle_exception
20931 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20932 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20933 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20934 run when a trap is triggered.
20935
20936 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20937 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20938 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20939 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20940 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20941 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20942 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20943 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20944 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20945 machine.
20946
20947 @item breakpoint
20948 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20949 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20950 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20951 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
20952 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20953 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20954 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
20955 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
20956 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
20957 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
20958 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
20959
20960 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
20961 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
20962 start of your debugging session.
20963 @end table
20964
20965 @node Bootstrapping
20966 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
20967
20968 @cindex remote stub, support routines
20969 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
20970 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
20971 debugging target machine.
20972
20973 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
20974 serial port.
20975
20976 @table @code
20977 @item int getDebugChar()
20978 @findex getDebugChar
20979 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
20980 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
20981 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20982
20983 @item void putDebugChar(int)
20984 @findex putDebugChar
20985 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
20986 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
20987 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20988 @end table
20989
20990 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
20991 @cindex interrupting remote targets
20992 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
20993 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
20994 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
20995 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
20996 remote system to stop.
20997
20998 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
20999 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
21000 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
21001 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
21002
21003 Other routines you need to supply are:
21004
21005 @table @code
21006 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
21007 @findex exceptionHandler
21008 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
21009 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
21010 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
21011 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
21012 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
21013 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
21014 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
21015 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
21016 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
21017 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
21018 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
21019 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
21020 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
21021
21022 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
21023 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
21024 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
21025 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
21026 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
21027
21028 @item void flush_i_cache()
21029 @findex flush_i_cache
21030 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
21031 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
21032 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
21033
21034 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
21035 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
21036 @end table
21037
21038 @noindent
21039 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
21040
21041 @table @code
21042 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21043 @findex memset
21044 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21045 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
21046 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21047 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21048 @end table
21049
21050 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21051 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21052 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21053 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21054
21055
21056 @node Debug Session
21057 @subsection Putting it All Together
21058
21059 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
21060 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
21061 steps.
21062
21063 @enumerate
21064 @item
21065 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
21066 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
21067 @display
21068 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
21069 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
21070 @end display
21071
21072 @item
21073 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
21074 procedure is called:
21075
21076 @smallexample
21077 set_debug_traps();
21078 breakpoint();
21079 @end smallexample
21080
21081 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
21082 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
21083 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
21084 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
21085 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
21086 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
21087 progress.
21088
21089 @item
21090 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
21091 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
21092
21093 @smallexample
21094 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
21095 @end smallexample
21096
21097 @noindent
21098 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
21099 function in your program, that function is called when
21100 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
21101 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
21102 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
21103
21104 @item
21105 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
21106 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
21107
21108 @item
21109 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
21110 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
21111
21112 @item
21113 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
21114 @c document that. FIXME.
21115 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
21116 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
21117
21118 @item
21119 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
21120 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21121
21122 @end enumerate
21123
21124 @node Configurations
21125 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
21126
21127 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
21128 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
21129 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
21130
21131 There are three major categories of configurations: native
21132 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
21133 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
21134 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
21135 are quite different from each other.
21136
21137 @menu
21138 * Native::
21139 * Embedded OS::
21140 * Embedded Processors::
21141 * Architectures::
21142 @end menu
21143
21144 @node Native
21145 @section Native
21146
21147 This section describes details specific to particular native
21148 configurations.
21149
21150 @menu
21151 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21152 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
21153 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
21154 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
21155 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21156 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
21157 @end menu
21158
21159 @node BSD libkvm Interface
21160 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21161
21162 @cindex libkvm
21163 @cindex kernel memory image
21164 @cindex kernel crash dump
21165
21166 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21167 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21168 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
21169 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21170 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
21171 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
21172 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21173 @code{kvm} target:
21174
21175 @smallexample
21176 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21177 @end smallexample
21178
21179 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21180 argument:
21181
21182 @smallexample
21183 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21184 @end smallexample
21185
21186 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21187 available:
21188
21189 @table @code
21190 @kindex kvm
21191 @item kvm pcb
21192 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21193
21194 @item kvm proc
21195 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
21196 modern FreeBSD systems.
21197 @end table
21198
21199 @node SVR4 Process Information
21200 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
21201 @cindex /proc
21202 @cindex examine process image
21203 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21204
21205 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
21206 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
21207 process using file-system subroutines.
21208
21209 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
21210 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
21211 information about the process running your program, or about any
21212 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
21213 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
21214
21215 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
21216 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
21217
21218 @table @code
21219 @kindex info proc
21220 @cindex process ID
21221 @item info proc
21222 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21223 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
21224 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21225 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21226 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21227 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21228 executable file's absolute file name.
21229
21230 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21231 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21232 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21233 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21234 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21235 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21236
21237 @item info proc cmdline
21238 @cindex info proc cmdline
21239 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
21240 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21241
21242 @item info proc cwd
21243 @cindex info proc cwd
21244 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
21245 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21246
21247 @item info proc exe
21248 @cindex info proc exe
21249 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
21250 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21251
21252 @item info proc mappings
21253 @cindex memory address space mappings
21254 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21255 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21256 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21257 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21258 memory access rights to that range.
21259
21260 @item info proc stat
21261 @itemx info proc status
21262 @cindex process detailed status information
21263 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
21264 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21265 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21266 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21267 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21268 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21269 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21270
21271 @item info proc all
21272 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21273 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21274
21275 @ignore
21276 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21277 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21278 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21279 @kindex info proc times
21280 @item info proc times
21281 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21282 its children.
21283
21284 @kindex info proc id
21285 @item info proc id
21286 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21287 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21288 @end ignore
21289
21290 @item set procfs-trace
21291 @kindex set procfs-trace
21292 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21293 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21294
21295 @item show procfs-trace
21296 @kindex show procfs-trace
21297 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21298
21299 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
21300 @kindex set procfs-file
21301 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21302 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21303 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
21304 standard output.
21305
21306 @item show procfs-file
21307 @kindex show procfs-file
21308 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21309
21310 @item proc-trace-entry
21311 @itemx proc-trace-exit
21312 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
21313 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
21314 @kindex proc-trace-entry
21315 @kindex proc-trace-exit
21316 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
21317 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
21318 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21319 from the @code{syscall} interface.
21320
21321 @item info pidlist
21322 @kindex info pidlist
21323 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21324 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21325 processes and all the threads within each process.
21326
21327 @item info meminfo
21328 @kindex info meminfo
21329 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21330 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21331 @end table
21332
21333 @node DJGPP Native
21334 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21335 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21336 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21337 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21338
21339 @cindex DPMI
21340 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21341 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21342 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21343 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21344
21345 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21346 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21347 subsection describes those commands.
21348
21349 @table @code
21350 @kindex info dos
21351 @item info dos
21352 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21353 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21354
21355 @kindex sysinfo
21356 @cindex MS-DOS system info
21357 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21358 @item info dos sysinfo
21359 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21360 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21361 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21362
21363 @cindex GDT
21364 @cindex LDT
21365 @cindex IDT
21366 @cindex segment descriptor tables
21367 @cindex descriptor tables display
21368 @item info dos gdt
21369 @itemx info dos ldt
21370 @itemx info dos idt
21371 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21372 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21373 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21374 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21375 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21376 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21377 rights.
21378
21379 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21380 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21381 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21382 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21383 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21384
21385 @cindex garbled pointers
21386 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21387 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21388 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21389 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21390 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21391 debugged program's data segment:
21392
21393 @smallexample
21394 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21395 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21396 @end smallexample
21397
21398 @noindent
21399 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21400 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21401
21402 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21403 @item info dos pde
21404 @itemx info dos pte
21405 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21406 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
21407 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21408 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
21409 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21410 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
21411 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21412 that is currently in use.
21413
21414 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21415 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21416 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21417 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21418 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21419 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21420 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21421
21422 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21423 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21424 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21425 controller.
21426
21427 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21428
21429 @cindex physical address from linear address
21430 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21431 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21432 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21433 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21434 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21435 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21436 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21437
21438 @smallexample
21439 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21440 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21441 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21442 @end smallexample
21443
21444 @noindent
21445 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21446 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21447 attributes of that page.
21448
21449 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21450 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21451 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21452 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21453 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21454 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21455
21456 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21457 transfer buffer:
21458
21459 @smallexample
21460 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21461 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21462 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21463 @end smallexample
21464
21465 @noindent
21466 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
21467 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21468 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21469 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21470 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21471
21472 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21473 @end table
21474
21475 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21476 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21477 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21478 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21479
21480 @table @code
21481 @kindex set com1base
21482 @kindex set com1irq
21483 @kindex set com2base
21484 @kindex set com2irq
21485 @kindex set com3base
21486 @kindex set com3irq
21487 @kindex set com4base
21488 @kindex set com4irq
21489 @item set com1base @var{addr}
21490 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21491 port.
21492
21493 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
21494 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21495 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21496
21497 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21498 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21499 other 3 COM ports.
21500
21501 @kindex show com1base
21502 @kindex show com1irq
21503 @kindex show com2base
21504 @kindex show com2irq
21505 @kindex show com3base
21506 @kindex show com3irq
21507 @kindex show com4base
21508 @kindex show com4irq
21509 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21510 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21511 lines used by the COM ports.
21512
21513 @item info serial
21514 @kindex info serial
21515 @cindex DOS serial port status
21516 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21517 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21518 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21519 counts of various errors encountered so far.
21520 @end table
21521
21522
21523 @node Cygwin Native
21524 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21525 @cindex MS Windows debugging
21526 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
21527 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21528
21529 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21530 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21531
21532 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21533 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21534 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21535 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21536 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21537 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21538 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21539 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21540
21541 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21542 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21543 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21544
21545 @table @code
21546 @kindex info w32
21547 @item info w32
21548 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21549 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21550
21551 @item info w32 selector
21552 This command displays information returned by
21553 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21554 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21555 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21556 Without argument, this command displays information
21557 about the six segment registers.
21558
21559 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21560 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21561 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21562 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21563
21564 @kindex signal-event
21565 @item signal-event @var{id}
21566 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
21567 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
21568
21569 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
21570 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
21571 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
21572 (for x86_64 versions):
21573
21574 @itemize @minus
21575 @item
21576 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
21577 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
21578 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
21579
21580 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
21581 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
21582 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
21583 to attach.
21584
21585 @item
21586 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
21587 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
21588 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
21589 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
21590 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
21591 @end itemize
21592
21593 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21594 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21595 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21596 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21597 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21598 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21599 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21600 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21601 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21602 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21603 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21604
21605 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21606 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21607 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21608 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21609
21610 @kindex set new-console
21611 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21612 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21613 be started in a new console on next start.
21614 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21615 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21616
21617 @kindex show new-console
21618 @item show new-console
21619 Displays whether a new console is used
21620 when the debuggee is started.
21621
21622 @kindex set new-group
21623 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21624 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21625 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21626 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21627 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21628
21629 @kindex show new-group
21630 @item show new-group
21631 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21632
21633 @kindex set debugevents
21634 @item set debugevents
21635 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21636 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21637 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21638 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21639 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21640
21641 @kindex set debugexec
21642 @item set debugexec
21643 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21644 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21645
21646 @kindex set debugexceptions
21647 @item set debugexceptions
21648 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21649 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21650
21651 @kindex set debugmemory
21652 @item set debugmemory
21653 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21654 and writes by the debugger.
21655
21656 @kindex set shell
21657 @item set shell
21658 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21659 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21660
21661 @kindex show shell
21662 @item show shell
21663 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21664
21665 @end table
21666
21667 @menu
21668 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21669 @end menu
21670
21671 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21672 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21673 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21674 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21675
21676 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21677 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21678 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21679 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21680 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21681 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21682 ``minimal symbols''.
21683
21684 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21685 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21686 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21687 program run once to completion.
21688
21689 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21690
21691 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21692 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21693 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21694 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21695 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21696 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21697 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21698 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21699 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21700
21701 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21702 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21703 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21704 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21705 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21706 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21707
21708 @smallexample
21709 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21710 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21711
21712 Non-debugging symbols:
21713 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
21714 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21715 @end smallexample
21716
21717 @smallexample
21718 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
21719 All functions matching regular expression "!":
21720
21721 Non-debugging symbols:
21722 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
21723 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
21724 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21725 [etc...]
21726 @end smallexample
21727
21728 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21729
21730 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21731 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21732 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21733 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21734 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21735 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21736 a function within a DLL without a running program.
21737
21738 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21739 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21740 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21741 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21742 problem:
21743
21744 @smallexample
21745 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21746 $1 = 268572168
21747 @end smallexample
21748
21749 @smallexample
21750 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
21751 0x10021610: "\230y\""
21752 @end smallexample
21753
21754 And two possible solutions:
21755
21756 @smallexample
21757 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21758 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21759 @end smallexample
21760
21761 @smallexample
21762 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
21763 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
21764 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
21765 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
21766 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
21767 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21768 @end smallexample
21769
21770 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
21771 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
21772 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
21773 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
21774 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
21775
21776 @smallexample
21777 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
21778 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
21779 @end smallexample
21780
21781 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
21782 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
21783 safe.
21784
21785 @node Hurd Native
21786 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
21787 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
21788
21789 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
21790 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
21791
21792 @table @code
21793 @item set signals
21794 @itemx set sigs
21795 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
21796 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21797 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
21798 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
21799 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
21800 @code{signals}.
21801
21802 @item show signals
21803 @itemx show sigs
21804 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
21805 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21806 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
21807
21808 @item set signal-thread
21809 @itemx set sigthread
21810 @kindex set signal-thread
21811 @kindex set sigthread
21812 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
21813 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
21814 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
21815 signal-thread}.
21816
21817 @item show signal-thread
21818 @itemx show sigthread
21819 @kindex show signal-thread
21820 @kindex show sigthread
21821 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
21822 delivered a signal.
21823
21824 @item set stopped
21825 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21826 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
21827 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
21828 continued by delivering a signal to it.
21829
21830 @item show stopped
21831 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21832 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
21833 stopped.
21834
21835 @item set exceptions
21836 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21837 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
21838 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
21839 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
21840 trapping on.
21841
21842 @item show exceptions
21843 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21844 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
21845
21846 @item set task pause
21847 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
21848 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21849 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21850 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
21851 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
21852 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
21853 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
21854 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
21855 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
21856
21857 @item show task pause
21858 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
21859 Show the current state of task suspension.
21860
21861 @item set task detach-suspend-count
21862 @cindex task suspend count
21863 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21864 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
21865 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
21866
21867 @item show task detach-suspend-count
21868 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
21869
21870 @item set task exception-port
21871 @itemx set task excp
21872 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21873 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
21874 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
21875 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
21876
21877 @item set noninvasive
21878 @cindex noninvasive task options
21879 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
21880 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
21881 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
21882 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
21883
21884 @item info send-rights
21885 @itemx info receive-rights
21886 @itemx info port-rights
21887 @itemx info port-sets
21888 @itemx info dead-names
21889 @itemx info ports
21890 @itemx info psets
21891 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21892 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21893 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21894 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21895 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21896 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21897 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21898 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21899 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21900
21901 @item set thread pause
21902 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21903 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21904 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21905 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21906 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21907 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21908 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21909 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21910 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21911 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21912 only the current thread.
21913
21914 @item show thread pause
21915 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21916 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21917
21918 @item set thread run
21919 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21920
21921 @item show thread run
21922 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21923
21924 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21925 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21926 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21927 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21928 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21929 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21930 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21931
21932 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21933 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21934 detaching.
21935
21936 @item set thread exception-port
21937 @itemx set thread excp
21938 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21939 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21940 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21941
21942 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21943 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21944 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
21945 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21946
21947 @item set thread default
21948 @itemx show thread default
21949 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21950 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21951 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21952 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
21953 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21954 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21955 the non-default commands.
21956 @end table
21957
21958 @node Darwin
21959 @subsection Darwin
21960 @cindex Darwin
21961
21962 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
21963
21964 @table @code
21965 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
21966 @kindex set debug darwin
21967 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
21968 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
21969
21970 @item show debug darwin
21971 @kindex show debug darwin
21972 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
21973
21974 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
21975 @kindex set debug mach-o
21976 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
21977 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
21978 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
21979 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
21980 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
21981 usage.
21982
21983 @item show debug mach-o
21984 @kindex show debug mach-o
21985 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
21986
21987 @item set mach-exceptions on
21988 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
21989 @kindex set mach-exceptions
21990 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
21991 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
21992 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
21993 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
21994
21995 @item show mach-exceptions
21996 @kindex show mach-exceptions
21997 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
21998 @end table
21999
22000
22001 @node Embedded OS
22002 @section Embedded Operating Systems
22003
22004 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
22005 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
22006 architectures.
22007
22008 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
22009 various real-time operating systems.
22010
22011 @node Embedded Processors
22012 @section Embedded Processors
22013
22014 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
22015 configurations.
22016
22017 @cindex send command to simulator
22018 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
22019 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
22020
22021 @table @code
22022 @item sim @var{command}
22023 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
22024 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
22025 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
22026 acceptable commands.
22027 @end table
22028
22029
22030 @menu
22031 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
22032 * ARM:: ARM
22033 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
22034 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
22035 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
22036 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
22037 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
22038 * CRIS:: CRIS
22039 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
22040 @end menu
22041
22042 @node ARC
22043 @subsection Synopsys ARC
22044 @cindex Synopsys ARC
22045 @cindex ARC specific commands
22046 @cindex ARC600
22047 @cindex ARC700
22048 @cindex ARC EM
22049 @cindex ARC HS
22050
22051 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
22052
22053 @table @code
22054 @item set debug arc
22055 @kindex set debug arc
22056 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
22057 default) and 1 for debug messages. At present higher values offer no further
22058 messages.
22059
22060 @item show debug arc
22061 @kindex show debug arc
22062 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
22063
22064 @end table
22065
22066 @node ARM
22067 @subsection ARM
22068
22069 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
22070
22071 @table @code
22072 @item set arm disassembler
22073 @kindex set arm
22074 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
22075 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
22076
22077 @item show arm disassembler
22078 @kindex show arm
22079 Show the current disassembly style.
22080
22081 @item set arm apcs32
22082 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
22083 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
22084
22085 @item show arm apcs32
22086 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
22087
22088 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
22089 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
22090 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
22091
22092 @table @code
22093 @item auto
22094 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
22095 @item softfpa
22096 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
22097 processors.
22098 @item fpa
22099 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
22100 @item softvfp
22101 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
22102 @item vfp
22103 VFP co-processor.
22104 @end table
22105
22106 @item show arm fpu
22107 Show the current type of the FPU.
22108
22109 @item set arm abi
22110 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
22111
22112 @item show arm abi
22113 Show the currently used ABI.
22114
22115 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22116 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
22117 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
22118 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
22119 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
22120 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
22121 register).
22122
22123 @item show arm fallback-mode
22124 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
22125
22126 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22127 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
22128 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
22129 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
22130 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
22131
22132 @item show arm force-mode
22133 Show the current forced instruction mode.
22134
22135 @item set debug arm
22136 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
22137 target support subsystem.
22138
22139 @item show debug arm
22140 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22141 @end table
22142
22143 @table @code
22144 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22145 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
22146
22147 @table @code
22148 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
22149 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
22150 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
22151 The default value is @code{all}.
22152
22153 @table @code
22154 @item none
22155 @item demon
22156 @item angel
22157 @item redboot
22158 @item all
22159 @end table
22160 @end table
22161 @end table
22162
22163 @node M68K
22164 @subsection M68k
22165
22166 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
22167
22168 @node MicroBlaze
22169 @subsection MicroBlaze
22170 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22171 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22172
22173 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22174 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
22175 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22176 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22177 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22178 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22179 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22180 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
22181 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
22182 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22183 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22184
22185 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22186
22187 @table @code
22188 @item target remote :1234
22189 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22190 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22191
22192 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22193 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22194 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22195
22196 @item load
22197 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22198
22199 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22200 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22201
22202 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22203 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22204 @end table
22205
22206 @node MIPS Embedded
22207 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22208
22209 @noindent
22210 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22211
22212 @table @code
22213 @item set mipsfpu double
22214 @itemx set mipsfpu single
22215 @itemx set mipsfpu none
22216 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
22217 @itemx show mipsfpu
22218 @kindex set mipsfpu
22219 @kindex show mipsfpu
22220 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22221 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22222 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22223 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22224 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22225 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22226 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22227 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22228 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22229 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22230 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22231 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22232 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22233
22234 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22235 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22236 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22237
22238 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22239 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
22240 @end table
22241
22242 @node PowerPC Embedded
22243 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22244
22245 @cindex DVC register
22246 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22247 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22248
22249 @smallexample
22250 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22251 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22252 @end smallexample
22253
22254 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22255 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22256 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22257 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22258 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22259 or newer.
22260
22261 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22262 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22263 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22264 watching variables of scalar types.
22265
22266 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22267 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22268
22269 @smallexample
22270 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22271 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22272 @end smallexample
22273
22274 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22275 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22276
22277 @cindex ranged breakpoint
22278 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22279 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22280 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22281 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22282 use the @code{break-range} command.
22283
22284 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22285
22286 @table @code
22287 @kindex break-range
22288 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22289 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22290 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22291 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22292 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22293 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22294 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22295 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22296 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22297
22298 @kindex set powerpc
22299 @item set powerpc soft-float
22300 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
22301 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22302 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22303 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22304
22305 @item set powerpc vector-abi
22306 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22307 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22308 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22309 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22310 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22311 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22312 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22313
22314 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22315 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22316 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22317 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22318 address of its first byte.
22319
22320 @end table
22321
22322 @node AVR
22323 @subsection Atmel AVR
22324 @cindex AVR
22325
22326 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22327 following AVR-specific commands:
22328
22329 @table @code
22330 @item info io_registers
22331 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22332 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22333 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22334 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22335 @end table
22336
22337 @node CRIS
22338 @subsection CRIS
22339 @cindex CRIS
22340
22341 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22342 following CRIS-specific commands:
22343
22344 @table @code
22345 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22346 @cindex CRIS version
22347 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22348 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22349 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22350
22351 @item show cris-version
22352 Show the current CRIS version.
22353
22354 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22355 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22356 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22357 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22358 @code{R59}.
22359
22360 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22361 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22362
22363 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22364 @cindex CRIS mode
22365 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22366 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22367 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22368
22369 @item show cris-mode
22370 Show the current CRIS mode.
22371 @end table
22372
22373 @node Super-H
22374 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22375 @cindex Super-H
22376
22377 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22378 commands:
22379
22380 @table @code
22381 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22382 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22383 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22384 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22385 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22386 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22387 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22388 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22389 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22390 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22391 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22392 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22393
22394 @item show sh calling-convention
22395 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22396 Show the current calling convention setting.
22397
22398 @end table
22399
22400
22401 @node Architectures
22402 @section Architectures
22403
22404 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22405 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22406
22407 @menu
22408 * AArch64::
22409 * i386::
22410 * Alpha::
22411 * MIPS::
22412 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22413 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22414 * PowerPC::
22415 * Nios II::
22416 @end menu
22417
22418 @node AArch64
22419 @subsection AArch64
22420 @cindex AArch64 support
22421
22422 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22423 following special commands:
22424
22425 @table @code
22426 @item set debug aarch64
22427 @kindex set debug aarch64
22428 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22429 messages are to be displayed.
22430
22431 @item show debug aarch64
22432 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22433
22434 @end table
22435
22436 @node i386
22437 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22438
22439 @table @code
22440 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22441 @kindex set struct-convention
22442 @cindex struct return convention
22443 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22444 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22445 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22446 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22447 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22448 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22449 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22450 be returned in a register.
22451
22452 @item show struct-convention
22453 @kindex show struct-convention
22454 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22455 from functions.
22456 @end table
22457
22458
22459 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22460 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22461
22462 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22463 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22464 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22465 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22466 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22467 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22468 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22469
22470 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22471 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22472 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22473 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22474 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22475 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22476
22477 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22478 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22479 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22480
22481 @smallexample
22482 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22483 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22484 @end smallexample
22485
22486 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22487 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22488 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22489 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22490 the pointer.
22491
22492 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22493 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22494 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22495 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22496 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22497
22498 @table @code
22499 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22500 @kindex show mpx bound
22501 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22502
22503 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22504 @kindex set mpx bound
22505 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22506 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22507 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22508 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22509 @end table
22510
22511 @node Alpha
22512 @subsection Alpha
22513
22514 See the following section.
22515
22516 @node MIPS
22517 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22518
22519 @cindex stack on Alpha
22520 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22521 @cindex Alpha stack
22522 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22523 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22524 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22525 find the beginning of a function.
22526
22527 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22528 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22529 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22530 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22531 commands:
22532
22533 @table @code
22534 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22535 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22536 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22537 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22538 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22539 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22540 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22541 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22542
22543 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22544 Display the current limit.
22545 @end table
22546
22547 @noindent
22548 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22549 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22550
22551 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22552 programs:
22553
22554 @table @code
22555 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22556 @kindex set mips abi
22557 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22558 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22559 values of @var{arg} are:
22560
22561 @table @samp
22562 @item auto
22563 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22564 default).
22565 @item o32
22566 @item o64
22567 @item n32
22568 @item n64
22569 @item eabi32
22570 @item eabi64
22571 @end table
22572
22573 @item show mips abi
22574 @kindex show mips abi
22575 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22576
22577 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22578 @kindex set mips compression
22579 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22580 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22581 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22582 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22583 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22584 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22585 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22586 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22587 provided by the executable.
22588
22589 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22590 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22591 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22592 identified as such.
22593
22594 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22595 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22596 implicitly from an executable.
22597
22598 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22599 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22600 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22601 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22602 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22603
22604 @item show mips compression
22605 @kindex show mips compression
22606 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22607 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22608
22609 @item set mipsfpu
22610 @itemx show mipsfpu
22611 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22612
22613 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22614 @kindex set mips mask-address
22615 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22616 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22617 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22618 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22619 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22620
22621 @item show mips mask-address
22622 @kindex show mips mask-address
22623 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22624 not.
22625
22626 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22627 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22628 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22629 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22630 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22631 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22632
22633 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22634 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22635 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22636
22637 @item set debug mips
22638 @kindex set debug mips
22639 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22640 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22641
22642 @item show debug mips
22643 @kindex show debug mips
22644 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22645 @end table
22646
22647
22648 @node HPPA
22649 @subsection HPPA
22650 @cindex HPPA support
22651
22652 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22653 following special commands:
22654
22655 @table @code
22656 @item set debug hppa
22657 @kindex set debug hppa
22658 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22659 messages are to be displayed.
22660
22661 @item show debug hppa
22662 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22663
22664 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22665 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22666 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22667 given @var{address}.
22668
22669 @end table
22670
22671
22672 @node SPU
22673 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22674 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22675 @cindex SPU
22676
22677 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22678 it provides the following special commands:
22679
22680 @table @code
22681 @item info spu event
22682 @kindex info spu
22683 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22684 and pending event status.
22685
22686 @item info spu signal
22687 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22688 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22689 notification channels.
22690
22691 @item info spu mailbox
22692 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22693 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22694 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22695
22696 @item info spu dma
22697 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22698 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22699 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22700
22701 @item info spu proxydma
22702 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22703 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22704 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22705
22706 @end table
22707
22708 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22709 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22710 special commands:
22711
22712 @table @code
22713 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22714 @kindex set spu
22715 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22716 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22717 function. The default is @code{off}.
22718
22719 @item show spu stop-on-load
22720 @kindex show spu
22721 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22722
22723 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22724 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22725 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22726 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22727 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22728 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22729
22730 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22731 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22732
22733 @end table
22734
22735 @node PowerPC
22736 @subsection PowerPC
22737 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22738
22739 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22740 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22741 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22742 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22743 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22744
22745 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22746 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22747 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22748
22749 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22750 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22751
22752 @node Nios II
22753 @subsection Nios II
22754 @cindex Nios II architecture
22755
22756 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22757 it provides the following special commands:
22758
22759 @table @code
22760
22761 @item set debug nios2
22762 @kindex set debug nios2
22763 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22764 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22765
22766 @item show debug nios2
22767 @kindex show debug nios2
22768 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22769 @end table
22770
22771 @node Controlling GDB
22772 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22773
22774 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22775 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22776 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22777 described here.
22778
22779 @menu
22780 * Prompt:: Prompt
22781 * Editing:: Command editing
22782 * Command History:: Command history
22783 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22784 * Numbers:: Numbers
22785 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22786 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22787 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22788 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22789 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22790 @end menu
22791
22792 @node Prompt
22793 @section Prompt
22794
22795 @cindex prompt
22796
22797 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22798 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22799 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22800 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22801 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22802 which one you are talking to.
22803
22804 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22805 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22806 or a prompt that does not.
22807
22808 @table @code
22809 @kindex set prompt
22810 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22811 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22812
22813 @kindex show prompt
22814 @item show prompt
22815 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22816 @end table
22817
22818 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22819 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22820 are:
22821
22822 @table @code
22823 @kindex set extended-prompt
22824 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22825 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22826 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22827 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22828 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22829 is displayed.
22830
22831 For example:
22832
22833 @smallexample
22834 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22835 @end smallexample
22836
22837 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22838 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22839
22840 @kindex show extended-prompt
22841 @item show extended-prompt
22842 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22843 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22844 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22845 @end table
22846
22847 @node Editing
22848 @section Command Editing
22849 @cindex readline
22850 @cindex command line editing
22851
22852 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22853 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22854 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22855 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22856 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22857 debugging sessions.
22858
22859 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22860 command @code{set}.
22861
22862 @table @code
22863 @kindex set editing
22864 @cindex editing
22865 @item set editing
22866 @itemx set editing on
22867 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22868
22869 @item set editing off
22870 Disable command line editing.
22871
22872 @kindex show editing
22873 @item show editing
22874 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22875 @end table
22876
22877 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22878 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22879 @end ifset
22880 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22881 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22882 @end ifclear
22883 for more details about the Readline
22884 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22885 encouraged to read that chapter.
22886
22887 @node Command History
22888 @section Command History
22889 @cindex command history
22890
22891 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22892 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22893 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22894 history facility.
22895
22896 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22897 package, to provide the history facility.
22898 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22899 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22900 @end ifset
22901 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22902 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22903 @end ifclear
22904 for the detailed description of the History library.
22905
22906 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22907 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22908 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22909 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22910 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22911 pressed on a line by itself.
22912
22913 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22914 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22915 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22916 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22917
22918 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22919 history.
22920
22921 @table @code
22922 @cindex history substitution
22923 @cindex history file
22924 @kindex set history filename
22925 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22926 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22927 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22928 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22929 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22930 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22931 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22932 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22933 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22934 is not set.
22935
22936 @cindex save command history
22937 @kindex set history save
22938 @item set history save
22939 @itemx set history save on
22940 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22941 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22942
22943 @item set history save off
22944 Stop recording command history in a file.
22945
22946 @cindex history size
22947 @kindex set history size
22948 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
22949 @item set history size @var{size}
22950 @itemx set history size unlimited
22951 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22952 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
22953 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
22954 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
22955 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
22956 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
22957
22958 @cindex remove duplicate history
22959 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
22960 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
22961 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
22962 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
22963 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
22964 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
22965 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
22966 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
22967 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
22968
22969 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
22970 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
22971
22972 @end table
22973
22974 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22975 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22976 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22977 @end ifset
22978 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22979 @xref{Event Designators},
22980 @end ifclear
22981 for more details.
22982
22983 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22984 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22985 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22986 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22987 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22988 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22989 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22990 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22991
22992 The commands to control history expansion are:
22993
22994 @table @code
22995 @item set history expansion on
22996 @itemx set history expansion
22997 @kindex set history expansion
22998 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22999
23000 @item set history expansion off
23001 Disable history expansion.
23002
23003 @c @group
23004 @kindex show history
23005 @item show history
23006 @itemx show history filename
23007 @itemx show history save
23008 @itemx show history size
23009 @itemx show history expansion
23010 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
23011 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
23012 @c @end group
23013 @end table
23014
23015 @table @code
23016 @kindex show commands
23017 @cindex show last commands
23018 @cindex display command history
23019 @item show commands
23020 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
23021
23022 @item show commands @var{n}
23023 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
23024
23025 @item show commands +
23026 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
23027 @end table
23028
23029 @node Screen Size
23030 @section Screen Size
23031 @cindex size of screen
23032 @cindex screen size
23033 @cindex pagination
23034 @cindex page size
23035 @cindex pauses in output
23036
23037 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
23038 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
23039 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
23040 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
23041 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
23042 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
23043 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
23044 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
23045
23046 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
23047 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
23048 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
23049 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
23050 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
23051 width} commands:
23052
23053 @table @code
23054 @kindex set height
23055 @kindex set width
23056 @kindex show width
23057 @kindex show height
23058 @item set height @var{lpp}
23059 @itemx set height unlimited
23060 @itemx show height
23061 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
23062 @itemx set width unlimited
23063 @itemx show width
23064 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
23065 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
23066 commands display the current settings.
23067
23068 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
23069 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
23070 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
23071 buffer.
23072
23073 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
23074 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
23075
23076 @item set pagination on
23077 @itemx set pagination off
23078 @kindex set pagination
23079 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
23080 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
23081 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
23082 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
23083
23084 @item show pagination
23085 @kindex show pagination
23086 Show the current pagination mode.
23087 @end table
23088
23089 @node Numbers
23090 @section Numbers
23091 @cindex number representation
23092 @cindex entering numbers
23093
23094 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23095 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23096 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23097 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23098 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
23099 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23100 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
23101 both input and output with the commands described below.
23102
23103 @table @code
23104 @kindex set input-radix
23105 @item set input-radix @var{base}
23106 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
23107 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23108 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23109 example, any of
23110
23111 @smallexample
23112 set input-radix 012
23113 set input-radix 10.
23114 set input-radix 0xa
23115 @end smallexample
23116
23117 @noindent
23118 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23119 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23120 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23121 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23122 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23123 change the radix.
23124
23125 @kindex set output-radix
23126 @item set output-radix @var{base}
23127 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
23128 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23129 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23130
23131 @kindex show input-radix
23132 @item show input-radix
23133 Display the current default base for numeric input.
23134
23135 @kindex show output-radix
23136 @item show output-radix
23137 Display the current default base for numeric display.
23138
23139 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23140 @itemx show radix
23141 @kindex set radix
23142 @kindex show radix
23143 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23144 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23145 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23146 default value of 10.
23147
23148 @end table
23149
23150 @node ABI
23151 @section Configuring the Current ABI
23152
23153 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23154 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
23155 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23156 current ABI.
23157
23158 @cindex OS ABI
23159 @kindex set osabi
23160 @kindex show osabi
23161 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23162
23163 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23164 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23165 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23166 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23167 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23168 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23169 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23170 platform provides.
23171
23172 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23173 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23174 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23175 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23176
23177 @table @code
23178 @item show osabi
23179 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23180
23181 @item set osabi
23182 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23183
23184 @item set osabi @var{abi}
23185 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23186 @end table
23187
23188 @cindex float promotion
23189
23190 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23191 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
23192 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23193 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
23194 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23195 @code{double} and then passed.
23196
23197 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23198 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23199 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23200
23201 @table @code
23202 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23203 @item set coerce-float-to-double
23204 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23205 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23206 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23207
23208 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
23209 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23210 functions.
23211
23212 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23213 @item show coerce-float-to-double
23214 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23215 @end table
23216
23217 @kindex set cp-abi
23218 @kindex show cp-abi
23219 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23220 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23221 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23222 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23223 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23224 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23225 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23226 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23227 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23228 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23229 ``auto''.
23230
23231 @table @code
23232 @item show cp-abi
23233 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23234
23235 @item set cp-abi
23236 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23237
23238 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23239 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23240 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23241 @end table
23242
23243 @node Auto-loading
23244 @section Automatically loading associated files
23245 @cindex auto-loading
23246
23247 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23248 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23249 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23250 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23251 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23252 sources).
23253
23254 @menu
23255 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23256 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23257
23258 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23259 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23260 @end menu
23261
23262 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23263 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23264 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23265
23266 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23267 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23268 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23269
23270 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23271 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23272
23273 @table @code
23274 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23275 @kindex set auto-load off
23276 @item set auto-load off
23277 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23278 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23279 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23280 @smallexample
23281 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23282 @end smallexample
23283
23284 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23285 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23286 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23287 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23288 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23289 @code{set auto-load no}.
23290
23291 @anchor{show auto-load}
23292 @kindex show auto-load
23293 @item show auto-load
23294 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23295 or disabled.
23296
23297 @smallexample
23298 (gdb) show auto-load
23299 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23300 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23301 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23302 is on.
23303 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23304 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23305 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23306 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23307 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23308 @end smallexample
23309
23310 @anchor{info auto-load}
23311 @kindex info auto-load
23312 @item info auto-load
23313 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23314 not.
23315
23316 @smallexample
23317 (gdb) info auto-load
23318 gdb-scripts:
23319 Loaded Script
23320 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23321 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23322 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23323 loaded.
23324 python-scripts:
23325 Loaded Script
23326 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23327 @end smallexample
23328 @end table
23329
23330 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23331
23332 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23333 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23334 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23335 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23336 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23337 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23338 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23339 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23340 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23341 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23342 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23343 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23344 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23345 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23346 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23347 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23348 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23349 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23350 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23351 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23352 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23353 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23354 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23355 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23356 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23357 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23358 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23359 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23360 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23361 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23362 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23363 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23364 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23365 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23366 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23367 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23368 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23369 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23370 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23371 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23372 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23373 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23374 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23375 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23376 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23377 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23378 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23379 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23380 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23381 @end multitable
23382
23383 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23384 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23385 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23386
23387 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23388 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23389 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23390
23391 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23392 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23393
23394 @table @code
23395 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23396 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23397 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23398 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23399 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23400
23401 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23402 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23403 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23404 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23405 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23406
23407 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23408 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23409 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23410 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23411 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23412 @end table
23413
23414 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23415 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23416 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23417
23418 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23419
23420 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23421 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23422
23423 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23424 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23425 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23426 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23427 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23428 library.
23429
23430 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23431 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23432
23433 @table @code
23434 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23435 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23436 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23437 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23438
23439 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23440 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23441 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23442 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23443 enabled or disabled.
23444
23445 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23446 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23447 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23448 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23449 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23450 @end table
23451
23452 @node Auto-loading safe path
23453 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23454 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23455
23456 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23457 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23458 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23459 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23460 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23461
23462 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23463 get loaded:
23464
23465 @smallexample
23466 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23467 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23468 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23469 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23470 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23471 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23472 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23473 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23474 @end smallexample
23475
23476 @noindent
23477 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23478 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23479
23480 @smallexample
23481 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23482 @end smallexample
23483
23484 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23485
23486 @table @code
23487 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23488 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23489 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23490 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23491 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23492 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23493 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23494 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23495 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23496 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23497
23498 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23499 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23500 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23501
23502 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23503 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23504 @item show auto-load safe-path
23505 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23506 scripts.
23507
23508 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23509 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23510 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23511 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23512 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23513 by the host platform path separator in use.
23514 @end table
23515
23516 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23517 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23518 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23519 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23520 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23521
23522 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23523 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23524 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23525 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23526 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23527 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23528 init file in the current directory
23529 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23530
23531 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23532 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23533
23534 @table @asis
23535 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23536 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23537 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23538 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23539
23540 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23541 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23542 @value{GDBN} session.
23543
23544 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23545 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23546 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23547 from trusted sources.
23548
23549 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23550 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23551 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23552 trusted sources.
23553 @end table
23554
23555 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23556 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23557
23558 @table @asis
23559 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23560 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23561
23562 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23563 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23564 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23565 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23566 @end table
23567
23568 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23569 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23570 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23571 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23572 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23573 recommended to be entered.
23574
23575 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23576 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23577 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23578
23579 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23580 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23581 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23582 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23583 be printed.
23584
23585 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23586 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23587 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23588
23589 @smallexample
23590 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23591 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23592 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23593 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23594 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23595 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23596 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23597 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23598 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23599 @end smallexample
23600
23601 @table @code
23602 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23603 @kindex set debug auto-load
23604 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23605 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23606
23607 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23608 @kindex show debug auto-load
23609 @item show debug auto-load
23610 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23611 on or off.
23612 @end table
23613
23614 @node Messages/Warnings
23615 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23616
23617 @cindex verbose operation
23618 @cindex optional warnings
23619 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23620 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23621 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23622 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23623
23624 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23625 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23626 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23627
23628 @table @code
23629 @kindex set verbose
23630 @item set verbose on
23631 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23632
23633 @item set verbose off
23634 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23635
23636 @kindex show verbose
23637 @item show verbose
23638 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23639 @end table
23640
23641 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23642 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23643 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23644 Symbol Files}).
23645
23646 @table @code
23647
23648 @kindex set complaints
23649 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23650 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23651 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23652 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23653 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23654
23655 @kindex show complaints
23656 @item show complaints
23657 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23658
23659 @end table
23660
23661 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23662 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23663 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23664 you try to run a program which is already running:
23665
23666 @smallexample
23667 (@value{GDBP}) run
23668 The program being debugged has been started already.
23669 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23670 @end smallexample
23671
23672 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23673 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23674
23675 @table @code
23676
23677 @kindex set confirm
23678 @cindex flinching
23679 @cindex confirmation
23680 @cindex stupid questions
23681 @item set confirm off
23682 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23683 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23684 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23685
23686 @item set confirm on
23687 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23688
23689 @kindex show confirm
23690 @item show confirm
23691 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23692
23693 @end table
23694
23695 @cindex command tracing
23696 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23697 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23698 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23699 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23700
23701 @table @code
23702 @kindex set trace-commands
23703 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23704 @item set trace-commands on
23705 Enable command tracing.
23706 @item set trace-commands off
23707 Disable command tracing.
23708 @item show trace-commands
23709 Display the current state of command tracing.
23710 @end table
23711
23712 @node Debugging Output
23713 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23714 @cindex optional debugging messages
23715
23716 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23717 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23718 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23719 section documents those commands.
23720
23721 @table @code
23722 @kindex set exec-done-display
23723 @item set exec-done-display
23724 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23725 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23726 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23727 @kindex show exec-done-display
23728 @item show exec-done-display
23729 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23730 notification.
23731 @kindex set debug
23732 @cindex ARM AArch64
23733 @item set debug aarch64
23734 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23735 The default is off.
23736 @kindex show debug
23737 @item show debug aarch64
23738 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23739 ARM AArch64.
23740 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23741 @cindex architecture debugging info
23742 @item set debug arch
23743 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23744 @item show debug arch
23745 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23746 @item set debug aix-solib
23747 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23748 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23749 support module. The default is off.
23750 @item show debug aix-thread
23751 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23752 @item set debug aix-thread
23753 @cindex AIX threads
23754 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23755 module.
23756 @item show debug aix-thread
23757 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23758 @item set debug check-physname
23759 @cindex physname
23760 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23761 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23762 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23763 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23764 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23765 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23766 @item show debug check-physname
23767 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23768 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23769 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23770 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23771 exported symbols. The default is off.
23772 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23773 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23774 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23775 @item set debug dwarf-die
23776 @cindex DWARF DIEs
23777 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
23778 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23779 A value of zero turns off the display.
23780 @item show debug dwarf-die
23781 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
23782 @item set debug dwarf-line
23783 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
23784 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23785 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
23786 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23787 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23788 @item show debug dwarf-line
23789 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
23790 @item set debug dwarf-read
23791 @cindex DWARF Reading
23792 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23793 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23794 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23795 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23796 @item show debug dwarf-read
23797 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
23798 @item set debug displaced
23799 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23800 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23801 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23802 @item show debug displaced
23803 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23804 related to displaced stepping.
23805 @item set debug event
23806 @cindex event debugging info
23807 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23808 default is off.
23809 @item show debug event
23810 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23811 info.
23812 @item set debug expression
23813 @cindex expression debugging info
23814 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23815 expression parsing. The default is off.
23816 @item show debug expression
23817 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23818 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23819 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
23820 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
23821 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
23822 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
23823 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
23824 @item set debug frame
23825 @cindex frame debugging info
23826 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23827 default is off.
23828 @item show debug frame
23829 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23830 info.
23831 @item set debug gnu-nat
23832 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23833 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23834 @item show debug gnu-nat
23835 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23836 @item set debug infrun
23837 @cindex inferior debugging info
23838 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23839 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23840 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23841 @item show debug infrun
23842 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23843 @item set debug jit
23844 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23845 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23846 @item show debug jit
23847 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23848 @item set debug lin-lwp
23849 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23850 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23851 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23852 @item show debug lin-lwp
23853 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23854 @item set debug linux-namespaces
23855 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
23856 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
23857 @item show debug linux-namespaces
23858 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
23859 @item set debug mach-o
23860 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23861 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23862 processing. The default is off.
23863 @item show debug mach-o
23864 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23865 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23866 @item set debug notification
23867 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23868 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23869 The default is off.
23870 @item show debug notification
23871 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23872 @item set debug observer
23873 @cindex observer debugging info
23874 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23875 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23876 @item show debug observer
23877 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23878 @item set debug overload
23879 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23880 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23881 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23882 is off.
23883 @item show debug overload
23884 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23885 debugging info.
23886 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23887 @cindex debug expression parser
23888 @item set debug parser
23889 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23890 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23891 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23892 details. The default is off.
23893 @item show debug parser
23894 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23895 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23896 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23897 @cindex debug remote protocol
23898 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23899 @cindex display remote packets
23900 @item set debug remote
23901 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23902 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23903 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23904 @item show debug remote
23905 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23906 @item set debug serial
23907 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23908 default is off.
23909 @item show debug serial
23910 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23911 info.
23912 @item set debug solib-frv
23913 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23914 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23915 @item show debug solib-frv
23916 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23917 messages.
23918 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23919 @cindex symbol lookup
23920 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23921 The default is 0 (off).
23922 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23923 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23924 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23925 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23926 @item set debug symfile
23927 @cindex symbol file functions
23928 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23929 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23930 @item show debug symfile
23931 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23932 @item set debug symtab-create
23933 @cindex symbol table creation
23934 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23935 The default is 0 (off).
23936 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23937 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23938 @item show debug symtab-create
23939 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23940 @item set debug target
23941 @cindex target debugging info
23942 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23943 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23944 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23945 value of large memory transfers.
23946 @item show debug target
23947 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23948 info.
23949 @item set debug timestamp
23950 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23951 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23952 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23953 message.
23954 @item show debug timestamp
23955 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23956 debugging info.
23957 @item set debug varobj
23958 @cindex variable object debugging info
23959 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23960 info. The default is off.
23961 @item show debug varobj
23962 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23963 debugging info.
23964 @item set debug xml
23965 @cindex XML parser debugging
23966 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23967 @item show debug xml
23968 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23969 @end table
23970
23971 @node Other Misc Settings
23972 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23973 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23974
23975 @table @code
23976 @kindex set interactive-mode
23977 @item set interactive-mode
23978 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23979 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23980 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23981 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23982 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23983 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23984 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23985 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23986
23987 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23988 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23989 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23990 inside a cygwin window.
23991
23992 @kindex show interactive-mode
23993 @item show interactive-mode
23994 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23995 @end table
23996
23997 @node Extending GDB
23998 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23999 @cindex extending GDB
24000
24001 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
24002 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
24003 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
24004 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
24005 being debugged.
24006
24007 @menu
24008 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
24009 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
24010 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
24011 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
24012 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
24013 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
24014 @end menu
24015
24016 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
24017 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
24018 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
24019 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
24020 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24021 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
24022
24023 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
24024 setting:
24025
24026 @table @code
24027 @kindex set script-extension
24028 @kindex show script-extension
24029 @item set script-extension off
24030 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24031
24032 @item set script-extension soft
24033 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24034 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
24035 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
24036 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
24037
24038 @item set script-extension strict
24039 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24040 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
24041 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
24042
24043 @item show script-extension
24044 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
24045
24046 @end table
24047
24048 @node Sequences
24049 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
24050
24051 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
24052 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
24053 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
24054 files.
24055
24056 @menu
24057 * Define:: How to define your own commands
24058 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
24059 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
24060 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
24061 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
24062 @end menu
24063
24064 @node Define
24065 @subsection User-defined Commands
24066
24067 @cindex user-defined command
24068 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
24069 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
24070 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
24071 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
24072 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
24073 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
24074
24075 @smallexample
24076 define adder
24077 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24078 end
24079 @end smallexample
24080
24081 @noindent
24082 To execute the command use:
24083
24084 @smallexample
24085 adder 1 2 3
24086 @end smallexample
24087
24088 @noindent
24089 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24090 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24091 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24092 functions calls.
24093
24094 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24095 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24096 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24097 been passed.
24098
24099 @smallexample
24100 define adder
24101 if $argc == 2
24102 print $arg0 + $arg1
24103 end
24104 if $argc == 3
24105 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24106 end
24107 end
24108 @end smallexample
24109
24110 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
24111 to process a variable number of arguments:
24112
24113 @smallexample
24114 define adder
24115 set $i = 0
24116 set $sum = 0
24117 while $i < $argc
24118 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
24119 set $i = $i + 1
24120 end
24121 print $sum
24122 end
24123 @end smallexample
24124
24125 @table @code
24126
24127 @kindex define
24128 @item define @var{commandname}
24129 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
24130 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24131 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24132 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
24133 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24134 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24135
24136 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24137 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
24138 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24139
24140 @kindex document
24141 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24142 @item document @var{commandname}
24143 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24144 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
24145 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24146 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24147 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24148 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24149
24150 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24151 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
24152 does not change the documentation.
24153
24154 @kindex dont-repeat
24155 @cindex don't repeat command
24156 @item dont-repeat
24157 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24158 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24159 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24160
24161 @kindex help user-defined
24162 @item help user-defined
24163 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24164 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24165 included (if any).
24166
24167 @kindex show user
24168 @item show user
24169 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
24170 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24171 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24172 definitions for all user-defined commands.
24173 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24174
24175 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24176 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
24177 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
24178 @item show max-user-call-depth
24179 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
24180 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24181 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24182 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24183 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24184 @end table
24185
24186 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24187 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24188
24189 When user-defined commands are executed, the
24190 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
24191 stops execution of the user-defined command.
24192
24193 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24194 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
24195 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24196 messages when used in a user-defined command.
24197
24198 @node Hooks
24199 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24200 @cindex command hooks
24201 @cindex hooks, for commands
24202 @cindex hooks, pre-command
24203
24204 @kindex hook
24205 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24206 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24207 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24208 before that command.
24209
24210 @cindex hooks, post-command
24211 @kindex hookpost
24212 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24213 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24214 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24215 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24216 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24217
24218 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24219 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24220
24221 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24222 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24223
24224 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24225 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24226 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24227 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24228 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24229
24230 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24231 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24232 you could define:
24233
24234 @smallexample
24235 define hook-stop
24236 handle SIGALRM nopass
24237 end
24238
24239 define hook-run
24240 handle SIGALRM pass
24241 end
24242
24243 define hook-continue
24244 handle SIGALRM pass
24245 end
24246 @end smallexample
24247
24248 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24249 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24250 you could define:
24251
24252 @smallexample
24253 define hook-echo
24254 echo <<<---
24255 end
24256
24257 define hookpost-echo
24258 echo --->>>\n
24259 end
24260
24261 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24262 <<<---Hello World--->>>
24263 (@value{GDBP})
24264
24265 @end smallexample
24266
24267 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24268 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24269 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24270 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24271 @c or not?
24272 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24273 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24274 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24275
24276 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24277 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24278 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24279
24280 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24281 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24282
24283 @node Command Files
24284 @subsection Command Files
24285
24286 @cindex command files
24287 @cindex scripting commands
24288 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24289 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24290 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24291 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24292 terminal.
24293
24294 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24295 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24296 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24297 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24298 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24299
24300 @table @code
24301 @kindex source
24302 @cindex execute commands from a file
24303 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24304 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24305 @end table
24306
24307 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24308 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24309 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24310 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24311 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24312
24313 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24314 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24315 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24316 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24317 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24318 is not relevant to scripts.
24319
24320 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24321 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24322 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24323 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24324 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24325 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24326 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24327 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24328 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24329 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24330 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24331 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24332 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24333 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24334
24335 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24336 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24337 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24338
24339 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24340 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24341 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24342 when called from command files.
24343
24344 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24345 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24346 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24347 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24348 the next command.
24349
24350 @smallexample
24351 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24352 @end smallexample
24353
24354 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24355 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24356 would be directed to @file{log}.
24357
24358 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24359 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24360 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24361 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24362 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24363 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24364 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24365 conditionally, etc.
24366
24367 @table @code
24368 @kindex if
24369 @kindex else
24370 @item if
24371 @itemx else
24372 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24373 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24374 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24375 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24376 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24377 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24378 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24379
24380 @kindex while
24381 @item while
24382 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24383 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24384 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24385 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24386 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24387 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24388
24389 @kindex loop_break
24390 @item loop_break
24391 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24392 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24393 line.
24394
24395 @kindex loop_continue
24396 @item loop_continue
24397 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24398 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24399 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24400 the controlling expression.
24401
24402 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24403 @item end
24404 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24405 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24406 @end table
24407
24408
24409 @node Output
24410 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24411
24412 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24413 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24414 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24415 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24416 want.
24417
24418 @table @code
24419 @kindex echo
24420 @item echo @var{text}
24421 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24422 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24423 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24424 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24425 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24426 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24427 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24428 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24429 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24430 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24431 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24432
24433 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24434 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24435
24436 @smallexample
24437 echo This is some text\n\
24438 which is continued\n\
24439 onto several lines.\n
24440 @end smallexample
24441
24442 produces the same output as
24443
24444 @smallexample
24445 echo This is some text\n
24446 echo which is continued\n
24447 echo onto several lines.\n
24448 @end smallexample
24449
24450 @kindex output
24451 @item output @var{expression}
24452 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24453 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24454 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24455 on expressions.
24456
24457 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24458 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24459 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24460 Formats}, for more information.
24461
24462 @kindex printf
24463 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24464 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24465 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24466 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24467 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24468 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24469 executing the code below:
24470
24471 @smallexample
24472 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24473 @end smallexample
24474
24475 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24476 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24477 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24478 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24479 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24480 printed.
24481
24482 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24483
24484 @smallexample
24485 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24486 @end smallexample
24487
24488 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24489 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24490 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24491
24492 @itemize @bullet
24493 @item
24494 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24495
24496 @item
24497 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24498 width.
24499
24500 @item
24501 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24502 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24503
24504 @item
24505 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24506 supported.
24507
24508 @item
24509 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24510
24511 @item
24512 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24513 @end itemize
24514
24515 @noindent
24516 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24517 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24518 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24519 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24520
24521 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24522 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24523 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24524 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24525 supported.
24526
24527 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24528 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24529 together with a floating point specifier.
24530 letters:
24531
24532 @itemize @bullet
24533 @item
24534 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24535
24536 @item
24537 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24538
24539 @item
24540 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24541 @end itemize
24542
24543 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24544 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24545 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24546
24547 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24548 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24549
24550 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24551 @smallexample
24552 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24553 @end smallexample
24554
24555 @anchor{eval}
24556 @kindex eval
24557 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24558 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24559 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24560
24561 @end table
24562
24563 @node Auto-loading sequences
24564 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24565 @cindex native script auto-loading
24566
24567 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24568 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24569 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24570 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24571
24572 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24573 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24574
24575 @table @code
24576 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24577 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24578 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24579 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24580
24581 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24582 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24583 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24584 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24585 disabled.
24586
24587 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24588 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24589 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24590 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24591 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24592 auto-loaded.
24593 @end table
24594
24595 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24596 matching names are printed.
24597
24598 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24599 @include python.texi
24600
24601 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24602 @include guile.texi
24603
24604 @node Auto-loading extensions
24605 @section Auto-loading extensions
24606 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24607
24608 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24609 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24610 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24611 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24612 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24613
24614 @menu
24615 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24616 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24617 * Which flavor to choose?::
24618 @end menu
24619
24620 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24621 debugging commands and features.
24622
24623 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24624 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24625 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24626 for more information.
24627 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24628 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24629
24630 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24631 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24632
24633 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24634 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24635 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24636 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24637 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24638
24639 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24640 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24641 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24642 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24643
24644 @table @code
24645 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24646 GDB's own command language
24647 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24648 Python
24649 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24650 Guile
24651 @end table
24652
24653 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24654 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24655 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24656 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24657 script in the specified extension language.
24658
24659 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24660 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24661
24662 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24663 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24664
24665 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24666 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24667 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24668 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24669 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24670 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24671
24672 @table @code
24673 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24674 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24675 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24676 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24677 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24678 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24679
24680 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24681 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24682
24683 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24684 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24685 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24686 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24687
24688 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24689 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24690 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24691 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24692 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24693 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24694 platform.
24695
24696 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24697 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24698 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24699
24700 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24701 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24702 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24703 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24704
24705 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24706 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24707 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24708 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24709 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24710 @end table
24711
24712 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24713 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24714 @var{objfile} is opened.
24715 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24716 is evaluated more than once.
24717
24718 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24719 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24720 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24721
24722 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24723 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24724 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24725 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24726 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24727 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24728 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24729
24730 The following entries are supported:
24731
24732 @table @code
24733 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24734 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24735 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24736 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24737 @end table
24738
24739 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24740
24741 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24742 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24743 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24744 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24745 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24746
24747 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24748 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24749
24750 @example
24751 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24752 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24753 asm("\
24754 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24755 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24756 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24757 .popsection \n\
24758 ");
24759 @end example
24760
24761 @noindent
24762 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24763 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24764
24765 @example
24766 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24767 @end example
24768
24769 The script name may include directories if desired.
24770
24771 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24772 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24773
24774 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24775 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24776 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24777 will remove duplicates.
24778
24779 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24780
24781 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24782 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24783 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24784 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24785 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24786 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24787 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24788 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24789 on its name.
24790
24791 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24792 testsuite.
24793
24794 @example
24795 #include "symcat.h"
24796 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24797 asm(
24798 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24799 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24800 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24801 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24802 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24803 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24804 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24805 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24806 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24807 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24808 ".byte 0\n"
24809 ".popsection\n"
24810 );
24811 @end example
24812
24813 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24814 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24815 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24816 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24817
24818 @node Which flavor to choose?
24819 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24820
24821 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24822 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24823
24824 @noindent
24825 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24826
24827 @itemize @bullet
24828 @item
24829 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24830
24831 @item
24832 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24833
24834 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24835 in the source search path.
24836 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24837 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24838
24839 @item
24840 Doesn't require source code additions.
24841 @end itemize
24842
24843 @noindent
24844 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24845
24846 @itemize @bullet
24847 @item
24848 Works with static linking.
24849
24850 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24851 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24852 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24853 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24854 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24855
24856 @item
24857 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24858
24859 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24860 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24861
24862 @item
24863 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24864
24865 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24866 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24867 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24868 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24869 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24870 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24871 @end itemize
24872
24873 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24874 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24875
24876 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24877 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24878 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24879
24880 @subsection Python comes first
24881
24882 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24883 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24884 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24885 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24886 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24887 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24888 pretty-printed form of a value).
24889 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24890 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24891 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24892
24893 @node Aliases
24894 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24895 @cindex aliases for commands
24896
24897 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24898 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24899 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24900 that involves less typing.
24901
24902 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24903 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24904 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24905
24906 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24907 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24908 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24909
24910 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24911
24912 @table @code
24913
24914 @kindex alias
24915 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24916
24917 @end table
24918
24919 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24920 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24921 underscores.
24922
24923 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24924 that is being aliased.
24925
24926 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24927 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24928 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24929
24930 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24931 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24932
24933 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24934 of a command so that there is less to type.
24935 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24936 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24937 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24938 The following will accomplish this.
24939
24940 @smallexample
24941 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24942 @end smallexample
24943
24944 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24945 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24946 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24947 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24948
24949 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24950 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24951 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24952 of a command.
24953
24954 @smallexample
24955 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24956 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24957 (gdb) set p elms 20
24958 (gdb) show p elms
24959 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24960 @end smallexample
24961
24962 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24963 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24964 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24965
24966 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24967 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24968
24969 @smallexample
24970 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24971 @end smallexample
24972
24973 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24974 alias for a more complex command.
24975 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24976
24977 @smallexample
24978 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24979 (gdb) spe 20
24980 @end smallexample
24981
24982 @node Interpreters
24983 @chapter Command Interpreters
24984 @cindex command interpreters
24985
24986 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24987 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24988 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24989
24990 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24991 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24992 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24993 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24994
24995 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24996 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24997 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24998 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24999
25000 @table @code
25001 @item console
25002 @cindex console interpreter
25003 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
25004 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
25005 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
25006
25007 @item mi
25008 @cindex mi interpreter
25009 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
25010 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
25011 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
25012 Interface}.
25013
25014 @item mi2
25015 @cindex mi2 interpreter
25016 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
25017
25018 @item mi1
25019 @cindex mi1 interpreter
25020 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
25021
25022 @end table
25023
25024 @cindex invoke another interpreter
25025
25026 @kindex interpreter-exec
25027 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
25028 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
25029 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
25030
25031 @smallexample
25032 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
25033 @end smallexample
25034
25035 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
25036 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
25037
25038 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
25039 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
25040 permanently.
25041
25042 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
25043
25044 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
25045 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
25046 device (usually a tty).
25047
25048 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
25049 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
25050 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
25051 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
25052 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
25053 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
25054 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
25055 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
25056 the separate MI interpreter.
25057
25058 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
25059 @code{new-ui} command:
25060
25061 @kindex new-ui
25062 @cindex new user interface
25063 @smallexample
25064 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
25065 @end smallexample
25066
25067 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
25068 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
25069 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
25070 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
25071 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
25072 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
25073
25074 @smallexample
25075 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
25076 @end smallexample
25077
25078 @noindent
25079 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
25080
25081 @node TUI
25082 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
25083 @cindex TUI
25084 @cindex Text User Interface
25085
25086 @menu
25087 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
25088 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
25089 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
25090 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
25091 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
25092 @end menu
25093
25094 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
25095 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
25096 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
25097 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
25098 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
25099 is available.
25100
25101 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
25102 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
25103 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
25104 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
25105 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
25106 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
25107
25108 @node TUI Overview
25109 @section TUI Overview
25110
25111 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
25112
25113 @table @emph
25114 @item command
25115 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
25116 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
25117 managed using readline.
25118
25119 @item source
25120 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
25121 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
25122
25123 @item assembly
25124 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
25125
25126 @item register
25127 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
25128 when their values change.
25129 @end table
25130
25131 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
25132 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
25133 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
25134 indicates the breakpoint type:
25135
25136 @table @code
25137 @item B
25138 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25139
25140 @item b
25141 Breakpoint which was never hit.
25142
25143 @item H
25144 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25145
25146 @item h
25147 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25148 @end table
25149
25150 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25151
25152 @table @code
25153 @item +
25154 Breakpoint is enabled.
25155
25156 @item -
25157 Breakpoint is disabled.
25158 @end table
25159
25160 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25161 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25162 changes.
25163
25164 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
25165 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
25166 layouts:
25167
25168 @itemize @bullet
25169 @item
25170 source only,
25171
25172 @item
25173 assembly only,
25174
25175 @item
25176 source and assembly,
25177
25178 @item
25179 source and registers, or
25180
25181 @item
25182 assembly and registers.
25183 @end itemize
25184
25185 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25186
25187 @table @emph
25188 @item target
25189 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25190 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25191
25192 @item process
25193 Gives the current process or thread number.
25194 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25195
25196 @item function
25197 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25198 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25199 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25200 the string @code{??} is displayed.
25201
25202 @item line
25203 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25204 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25205
25206 @item pc
25207 Indicates the current program counter address.
25208 @end table
25209
25210 @node TUI Keys
25211 @section TUI Key Bindings
25212 @cindex TUI key bindings
25213
25214 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25215 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25216 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25217 @end ifset
25218 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25219 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25220 @end ifclear
25221 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25222 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
25223
25224 @table @kbd
25225 @kindex C-x C-a
25226 @item C-x C-a
25227 @kindex C-x a
25228 @itemx C-x a
25229 @kindex C-x A
25230 @itemx C-x A
25231 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25232 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25233 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25234 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25235 The screen is then refreshed.
25236
25237 @kindex C-x 1
25238 @item C-x 1
25239 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25240 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25241 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25242
25243 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25244
25245 @kindex C-x 2
25246 @item C-x 2
25247 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25248 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25249 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25250 previous layout and the new one.
25251
25252 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25253
25254 @kindex C-x o
25255 @item C-x o
25256 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25257 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25258 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25259
25260 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25261
25262 @kindex C-x s
25263 @item C-x s
25264 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25265 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25266 @end table
25267
25268 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25269
25270 @table @asis
25271 @kindex PgUp
25272 @item @key{PgUp}
25273 Scroll the active window one page up.
25274
25275 @kindex PgDn
25276 @item @key{PgDn}
25277 Scroll the active window one page down.
25278
25279 @kindex Up
25280 @item @key{Up}
25281 Scroll the active window one line up.
25282
25283 @kindex Down
25284 @item @key{Down}
25285 Scroll the active window one line down.
25286
25287 @kindex Left
25288 @item @key{Left}
25289 Scroll the active window one column left.
25290
25291 @kindex Right
25292 @item @key{Right}
25293 Scroll the active window one column right.
25294
25295 @kindex C-L
25296 @item @kbd{C-L}
25297 Refresh the screen.
25298 @end table
25299
25300 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25301 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25302 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25303 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25304 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25305
25306 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25307 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25308 @cindex TUI single key mode
25309
25310 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25311 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25312 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25313
25314 @table @kbd
25315 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25316 @item c
25317 continue
25318
25319 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25320 @item d
25321 down
25322
25323 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25324 @item f
25325 finish
25326
25327 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25328 @item n
25329 next
25330
25331 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25332 @item q
25333 exit the SingleKey mode.
25334
25335 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25336 @item r
25337 run
25338
25339 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25340 @item s
25341 step
25342
25343 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25344 @item u
25345 up
25346
25347 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25348 @item v
25349 info locals
25350
25351 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25352 @item w
25353 where
25354 @end table
25355
25356 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25357 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25358 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25359 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25360 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25361 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25362
25363
25364 @node TUI Commands
25365 @section TUI-specific Commands
25366 @cindex TUI commands
25367
25368 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25369 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25370 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25371 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25372
25373 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25374 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25375 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25376 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25377 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25378
25379 @table @code
25380 @item tui enable
25381 @kindex tui enable
25382 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25383 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25384 otherwise a default layout is used.
25385
25386 @item tui disable
25387 @kindex tui disable
25388 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25389
25390 @item info win
25391 @kindex info win
25392 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25393
25394 @item layout @var{name}
25395 @kindex layout
25396 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25397 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25398 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25399
25400 @table @code
25401 @item next
25402 Display the next layout.
25403
25404 @item prev
25405 Display the previous layout.
25406
25407 @item src
25408 Display the source and command windows.
25409
25410 @item asm
25411 Display the assembly and command windows.
25412
25413 @item split
25414 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25415
25416 @item regs
25417 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25418 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25419 register, assembler, and command windows.
25420 @end table
25421
25422 @item focus @var{name}
25423 @kindex focus
25424 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25425 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25426
25427 @table @code
25428 @item next
25429 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25430
25431 @item prev
25432 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25433
25434 @item src
25435 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25436
25437 @item asm
25438 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25439
25440 @item regs
25441 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25442
25443 @item cmd
25444 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25445 @end table
25446
25447 @item refresh
25448 @kindex refresh
25449 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25450
25451 @item tui reg @var{group}
25452 @kindex tui reg
25453 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25454 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25455 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25456 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25457 following groups are available on most targets:
25458 @table @code
25459 @item next
25460 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25461 through all of the available register groups.
25462
25463 @item prev
25464 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25465 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25466 @var{next}.
25467
25468 @item general
25469 Display the general registers.
25470 @item float
25471 Display the floating point registers.
25472 @item system
25473 Display the system registers.
25474 @item vector
25475 Display the vector registers.
25476 @item all
25477 Display all registers.
25478 @end table
25479
25480 @item update
25481 @kindex update
25482 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25483
25484 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25485 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25486 @kindex winheight
25487 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25488 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25489 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25490 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25491 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25492
25493 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25494 @kindex tabset
25495 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25496 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25497 assembly windows.
25498 @end table
25499
25500 @node TUI Configuration
25501 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25502 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25503
25504 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25505
25506 @table @code
25507 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25508 @kindex set tui border-kind
25509 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25510 The possible values are the following:
25511 @table @code
25512 @item space
25513 Use a space character to draw the border.
25514
25515 @item ascii
25516 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25517
25518 @item acs
25519 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25520 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25521 @end table
25522
25523 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25524 @kindex set tui border-mode
25525 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25526 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25527 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25528 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25529 @table @code
25530 @item normal
25531 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25532
25533 @item standout
25534 Use standout mode.
25535
25536 @item reverse
25537 Use reverse video mode.
25538
25539 @item half
25540 Use half bright mode.
25541
25542 @item half-standout
25543 Use half bright and standout mode.
25544
25545 @item bold
25546 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25547
25548 @item bold-standout
25549 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25550 @end table
25551 @end table
25552
25553 @node Emacs
25554 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25555
25556 @cindex Emacs
25557 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25558 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25559 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25560 @value{GDBN}.
25561
25562 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25563 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25564 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25565 created Emacs buffer.
25566 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25567
25568 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25569 things:
25570
25571 @itemize @bullet
25572 @item
25573 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25574 the GUD buffer.
25575
25576 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25577 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25578
25579 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25580 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25581 in this way.
25582
25583 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25584 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25585 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25586 stop.
25587
25588 @item
25589 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25590
25591 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25592 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25593 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25594 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25595 and the source.
25596
25597 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25598 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25599 @end itemize
25600
25601 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25602 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25603 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25604 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25605
25606 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25607 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25608 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25609 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25610 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25611 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25612 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25613 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25614 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25615
25616 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25617 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25618 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25619 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25620
25621 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25622 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25623 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25624 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25625 one you want.
25626
25627 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25628 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25629
25630 @table @kbd
25631 @item C-h m
25632 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25633
25634 @item C-c C-s
25635 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25636 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25637
25638 @item C-c C-n
25639 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25640 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25641 to show the current file and location.
25642
25643 @item C-c C-i
25644 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25645 display window accordingly.
25646
25647 @item C-c C-f
25648 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25649 @code{finish} command.
25650
25651 @item C-c C-r
25652 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25653 command.
25654
25655 @item C-c <
25656 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25657 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25658 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25659
25660 @item C-c >
25661 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25662 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25663 @end table
25664
25665 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25666 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25667
25668 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25669 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25670 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25671 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25672 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25673 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25674 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25675
25676 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25677 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25678 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25679 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25680 frame.
25681
25682 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25683 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25684 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25685 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25686 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25687 to correspond properly with the code.
25688
25689 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25690 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25691 Emacs Manual}).
25692
25693 @node GDB/MI
25694 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25695
25696 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25697
25698 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25699 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25700 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25701 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25702 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25703 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25704
25705 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25706 in the form of a reference manual.
25707
25708 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25709 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25710 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25711
25712 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25713
25714 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25715 This chapter uses the following notation:
25716
25717 @itemize @bullet
25718 @item
25719 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25720
25721 @item
25722 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25723 it may or may not be given.
25724
25725 @item
25726 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25727 may repeat zero or more times.
25728
25729 @item
25730 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25731 may repeat one or more times.
25732
25733 @item
25734 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25735 @end itemize
25736
25737 @ignore
25738 @heading Dependencies
25739 @end ignore
25740
25741 @menu
25742 * GDB/MI General Design::
25743 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25744 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25745 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25746 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25747 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25748 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25749 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25750 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25751 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25752 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25753 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25754 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25755 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25756 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25757 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25758 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25759 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25760 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25761 @ignore
25762 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25763 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25764 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25765 @end ignore
25766 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25767 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25768 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25769 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25770 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25771 @end menu
25772
25773 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25774 @node GDB/MI General Design
25775 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25776 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25777
25778 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25779 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25780 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25781 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25782 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25783 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25784 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25785 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25786 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25787 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25788
25789 The important examples of notifications are:
25790 @itemize @bullet
25791
25792 @item
25793 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25794 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25795 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25796 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25797 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25798 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25799 command itself was successfully executed.
25800
25801 @item
25802 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25803 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25804 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25805 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25806 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25807 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25808
25809 @item
25810 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25811 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25812 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25813 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25814 orthogonal frontend design.
25815
25816 @end itemize
25817
25818 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25819 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25820 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25821 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25822 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25823 the user interface.
25824
25825
25826 @menu
25827 * Context management::
25828 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25829 * Thread groups::
25830 @end menu
25831
25832 @node Context management
25833 @subsection Context management
25834
25835 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25836
25837 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25838 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25839 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25840 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25841 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25842 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25843 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25844 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25845 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25846
25847 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25848 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25849 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25850 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25851 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25852 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25853 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25854 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25855 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25856 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
25857 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
25858
25859 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25860 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25861 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25862 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
25863 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
25864 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
25865 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
25866 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
25867 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
25868 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25869
25870 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25871 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25872 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25873 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25874 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25875 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25876 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25877 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25878 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25879 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25880 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25881 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25882 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25883 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25884 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25885 @samp{--frame} options.
25886
25887 @subsubsection Language
25888
25889 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25890 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25891 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25892 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25893 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25894 For instance:
25895
25896 @smallexample
25897 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25898 ^done,value="4"
25899 (gdb)
25900 @end smallexample
25901
25902 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25903 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25904 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25905
25906 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25907 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25908
25909 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25910 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25911 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25912 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25913 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25914 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25915 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25916 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25917 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25918
25919 @table @code
25920 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25921 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25922 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25923
25924 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25925 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25926 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25927
25928 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25929 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25930 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25931 MI commands even while the target is running.
25932
25933 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25934 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25935 @end table
25936
25937 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25938 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25939 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25940 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25941 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25942 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25943
25944 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25945 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25946 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25947 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25948 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25949 are running.
25950
25951 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25952 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25953 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25954 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25955 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25956 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25957 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25958 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25959 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25960 @samp{--thread} option).
25961
25962 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25963 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25964 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25965 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25966
25967 @node Thread groups
25968 @subsection Thread groups
25969 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25970 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25971 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25972 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25973 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25974
25975 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25976 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25977 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25978 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25979 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25980 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25981 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25982 into processes.
25983
25984 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25985 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25986 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25987 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25988 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25989 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25990 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25991 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25992 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25993 the members of specific thread group.
25994
25995 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25996 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25997 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25998 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25999 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
26000 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
26001 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
26002 after attaching to that thread group.
26003
26004 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
26005 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
26006 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
26007 such thread groups.
26008
26009 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26010 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
26011 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
26012
26013 @menu
26014 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
26015 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
26016 @end menu
26017
26018 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
26019 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
26020
26021 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
26022 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
26023 @table @code
26024 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
26025 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
26026
26027 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
26028 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
26029 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
26030
26031 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
26032 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
26033 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
26034
26035 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26036 "any sequence of digits"
26037
26038 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
26039 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
26040
26041 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
26042 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
26043
26044 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
26045 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
26046
26047 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
26048 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
26049 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
26050
26051 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
26052 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
26053
26054 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26055 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26056 @end table
26057
26058 @noindent
26059 Notes:
26060
26061 @itemize @bullet
26062 @item
26063 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
26064 output is described below.
26065
26066 @item
26067 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
26068 finishes.
26069
26070 @item
26071 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
26072 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
26073 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
26074 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
26075 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
26076 @end itemize
26077
26078 Pragmatics:
26079
26080 @itemize @bullet
26081 @item
26082 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
26083
26084 @item
26085 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
26086 @end itemize
26087
26088 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
26089 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
26090
26091 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
26092 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
26093 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
26094 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
26095 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
26096 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
26097
26098 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
26099 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
26100 @var{token}.
26101
26102 @table @code
26103 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
26104 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
26105
26106 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
26107 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
26108
26109 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
26110 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
26111
26112 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
26113 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
26114
26115 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
26116 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
26117
26118 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
26119 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
26120
26121 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
26122 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
26123
26124 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
26125 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
26126
26127 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
26128 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
26129
26130 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
26131 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
26132 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
26133
26134 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
26135 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
26136
26137 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
26138 @code{ @var{string} }
26139
26140 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
26141 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
26142
26143 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
26144 @code{@var{c-string}}
26145
26146 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26147 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26148
26149 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
26150 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26151 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26152
26153 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26154 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26155
26156 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26157 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26158
26159 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26160 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26161
26162 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26163 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26164
26165 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26166 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26167
26168 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26169 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
26170 @end table
26171
26172 @noindent
26173 Notes:
26174
26175 @itemize @bullet
26176 @item
26177 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26178
26179 @item
26180 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
26181 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26182 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26183 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
26184 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26185 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26186 prior command.
26187
26188 @item
26189 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26190 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26191 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
26192 prefixed by @samp{+}.
26193
26194 @item
26195 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26196 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26197 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
26198 @samp{*}.
26199
26200 @item
26201 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26202 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26203 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
26204 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26205
26206 @item
26207 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26208 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26209 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
26210 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26211
26212 @item
26213 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26214 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26215 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26216
26217 @item
26218 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26219 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26220 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
26221 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26222
26223 @item
26224 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26225 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26226 @var{values}.
26227
26228
26229 @end itemize
26230
26231 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26232 details about the various output records.
26233
26234 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26235 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26236 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26237
26238 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26239 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26240
26241 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26242 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
26243 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26244 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26245 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26246 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26247
26248 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26249 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26250 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26251
26252 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26253 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26254 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26255 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26256
26257 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26258 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26259
26260 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26261 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26262 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26263 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26264 might change.
26265
26266 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26267 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26268 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26269 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26270
26271 @itemize @bullet
26272 @item
26273 New MI commands may be added.
26274
26275 @item
26276 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26277
26278 @item
26279 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26280 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26281
26282 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26283 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26284
26285 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26286 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26287 @end itemize
26288
26289 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26290 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26291 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26292 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26293 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26294
26295 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26296 @c version?
26297
26298 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26299 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26300 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26301 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26302 @cindex mailing lists
26303
26304 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26305 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26306 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26307
26308 @menu
26309 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26310 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26311 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26312 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26313 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26314 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26315 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26316 @end menu
26317
26318 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26319 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26320
26321 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26322 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26323 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26324 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26325
26326 @table @code
26327 @findex ^done
26328 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26329 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26330 values.
26331
26332 @item "^running"
26333 @findex ^running
26334 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26335 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26336 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26337 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26338 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26339 which threads are resumed.
26340
26341 @item "^connected"
26342 @findex ^connected
26343 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26344
26345 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26346 @findex ^error
26347 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26348 the corresponding error message.
26349
26350 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26351 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26352 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26353
26354 @table @samp
26355 @item "undefined-command"
26356 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26357 @end table
26358
26359 @item "^exit"
26360 @findex ^exit
26361 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26362
26363 @end table
26364
26365 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26366 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26367
26368 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26369 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26370 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26371 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26372 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26373
26374 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26375 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26376 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26377 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26378 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26379
26380 @table @code
26381 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26382 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26383 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26384
26385 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26386 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26387 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26388 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26389
26390 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26391 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26392 internals.
26393 @end table
26394
26395 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26396 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26397
26398 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26399 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26400 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26401 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26402 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26403 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26404
26405 The following is the list of possible async records:
26406
26407 @table @code
26408
26409 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26410 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
26411 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26412 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
26413 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26414 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
26415 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
26416 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26417 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26418 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26419 it run freely.
26420
26421 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26422 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26423 following values:
26424
26425 @table @code
26426 @item breakpoint-hit
26427 A breakpoint was reached.
26428 @item watchpoint-trigger
26429 A watchpoint was triggered.
26430 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26431 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26432 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26433 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26434 @item function-finished
26435 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26436 @item location-reached
26437 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26438 @item watchpoint-scope
26439 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26440 @item end-stepping-range
26441 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26442 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26443 @item exited-signalled
26444 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26445 @item exited
26446 The inferior exited.
26447 @item exited-normally
26448 The inferior exited normally.
26449 @item signal-received
26450 A signal was received by the inferior.
26451 @item solib-event
26452 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26453 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26454 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26455 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26456 @item fork
26457 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26458 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26459 @item vfork
26460 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26461 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26462 @item syscall-entry
26463 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26464 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26465 @item syscall-return
26466 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26467 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26468 @item exec
26469 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26470 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26471 @end table
26472
26473 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26474 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26475 Depending on whether all-stop
26476 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26477 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26478 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26479 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26480 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26481 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26482 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26483 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26484 if such information is not available.
26485
26486 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26487 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26488 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26489 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26490 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26491 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26492 cannot be used in any way.
26493
26494 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26495 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26496 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26497 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26498 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26499 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26500
26501 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26502 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26503 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26504 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26505 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26506 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26507
26508 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26509 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26510 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26511 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26512 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26513
26514 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
26515 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
26516 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
26517 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
26518 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
26519 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
26520 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
26521 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
26522 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
26523
26524 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
26525 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
26526
26527 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26528 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26529 that thread.
26530
26531 @item =library-loaded,...
26532 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26533 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26534 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26535 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26536 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26537 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26538 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26539 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26540 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26541 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26542 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26543 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26544 thread groups.
26545
26546 @item =library-unloaded,...
26547 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26548 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26549 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26550 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26551 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26552 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26553 thread groups.
26554
26555 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26556 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26557 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26558 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26559 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26560
26561 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26562 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26563 initial value @var{initial}.
26564
26565 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26566 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26567 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26568 trace state variables are deleted.
26569
26570 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26571 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26572 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26573 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26574 value of trace state variable is known.
26575
26576 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26577 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26578 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26579 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26580 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26581 user.
26582
26583 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26584 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26585 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26586
26587 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26588 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26589
26590 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
26591 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26592 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26593 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26594 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26595
26596 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
26597 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
26598 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
26599 for existing method and format values.
26600
26601 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26602 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26603 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26604 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26605 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26606 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26607
26608 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26609 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26610 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26611 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26612 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26613 executable code.
26614 @end table
26615
26616 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26617 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26618
26619 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26620 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26621 following fields:
26622
26623 @table @code
26624 @item number
26625 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26626 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26627 @samp{1.2}.
26628
26629 @item type
26630 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26631 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26632
26633 @item catch-type
26634 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26635 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26636
26637 @item disp
26638 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26639 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26640 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26641
26642 @item enabled
26643 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26644 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26645 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26646
26647 @item addr
26648 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26649 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26650 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26651 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26652 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26653
26654 @item func
26655 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26656 If not known, this field is not present.
26657
26658 @item filename
26659 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26660 If not known, this field is not present.
26661
26662 @item fullname
26663 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26664 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26665
26666 @item line
26667 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26668 If not known, this field is not present.
26669
26670 @item at
26671 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26672 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26673 by a symbol name.
26674
26675 @item pending
26676 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26677 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26678
26679 @item evaluated-by
26680 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26681 @samp{target}.
26682
26683 @item thread
26684 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26685 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26686
26687 @item task
26688 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26689 field will hold the task identifier.
26690
26691 @item cond
26692 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26693
26694 @item ignore
26695 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26696
26697 @item enable
26698 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26699
26700 @item traceframe-usage
26701 FIXME.
26702
26703 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26704 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26705
26706 @item mask
26707 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26708
26709 @item pass
26710 A tracepoint's pass count.
26711
26712 @item original-location
26713 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26714 This field is optional.
26715
26716 @item times
26717 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26718
26719 @item installed
26720 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26721 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26722 is not.
26723
26724 @item what
26725 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26726
26727 @end table
26728
26729 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26730 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26731
26732 @smallexample
26733 -> -break-insert main
26734 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26735 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26736 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26737 times="0"@}
26738 <- (gdb)
26739 @end smallexample
26740
26741 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26742 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26743
26744 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26745 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26746 fields:
26747
26748 @table @code
26749 @item level
26750 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26751 zero. This field is always present.
26752
26753 @item func
26754 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26755 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26756
26757 @item addr
26758 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26759
26760 @item file
26761 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26762 address. This field may be absent.
26763
26764 @item line
26765 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26766 may be absent.
26767
26768 @item from
26769 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26770 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26771
26772 @end table
26773
26774 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26775 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26776
26777 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26778 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26779
26780 @table @code
26781 @item id
26782 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26783 always present.
26784
26785 @item target-id
26786 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26787
26788 @item details
26789 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26790 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26791 frontend. This field is optional.
26792
26793 @item state
26794 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26795 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26796
26797 @item core
26798 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26799 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26800 @end table
26801
26802 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26803 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26804
26805 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26806 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26807 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26808 the @code{exception-name} field.
26809
26810 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26811 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26812 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26813 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26814
26815 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26816 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26817 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26818 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26819
26820 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26821 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26822
26823 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26824
26825 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26826 information of the breakpoint.
26827
26828 @smallexample
26829 -> -break-insert main
26830 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26831 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26832 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26833 times="0"@}
26834 <- (gdb)
26835 @end smallexample
26836
26837 @subheading Program Execution
26838
26839 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26840 reason that execution stopped.
26841
26842 @smallexample
26843 -> -exec-run
26844 <- ^running
26845 <- (gdb)
26846 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26847 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26848 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26849 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26850 <- (gdb)
26851 -> -exec-continue
26852 <- ^running
26853 <- (gdb)
26854 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26855 <- (gdb)
26856 @end smallexample
26857
26858 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26859
26860 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26861
26862 @smallexample
26863 -> (gdb)
26864 <- -gdb-exit
26865 <- ^exit
26866 @end smallexample
26867
26868 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26869 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26870 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26871 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26872 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26873 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26874
26875 @subheading A Bad Command
26876
26877 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26878
26879 @smallexample
26880 -> -rubbish
26881 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26882 <- (gdb)
26883 @end smallexample
26884
26885
26886 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26887 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26888 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26889
26890 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26891 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26892
26893 @subheading Motivation
26894
26895 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26896
26897 @subheading Introduction
26898
26899 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26900
26901 @subheading Commands
26902
26903 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26904
26905 @subsubheading Synopsis
26906
26907 @smallexample
26908 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26909 @end smallexample
26910
26911 @subsubheading Result
26912
26913 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26914
26915 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26916
26917 @subsubheading Example
26918
26919 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26920 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26921
26922
26923 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26924 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26925 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26926
26927 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26928 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26929 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26930 breakpoints.
26931
26932 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26933 @findex -break-after
26934
26935 @subsubheading Synopsis
26936
26937 @smallexample
26938 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26939 @end smallexample
26940
26941 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26942 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26943 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26944 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26945
26946 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26947
26948 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26949
26950 @subsubheading Example
26951
26952 @smallexample
26953 (gdb)
26954 -break-insert main
26955 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26956 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26957 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26958 times="0"@}
26959 (gdb)
26960 -break-after 1 3
26961 ~
26962 ^done
26963 (gdb)
26964 -break-list
26965 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26966 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26967 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26968 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26969 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26970 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26971 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26972 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26973 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26974 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26975 (gdb)
26976 @end smallexample
26977
26978 @ignore
26979 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26980 @findex -break-catch
26981 @end ignore
26982
26983 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26984 @findex -break-commands
26985
26986 @subsubheading Synopsis
26987
26988 @smallexample
26989 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26990 @end smallexample
26991
26992 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26993 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26994 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26995 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26996 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26997 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26998
26999 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27000
27001 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
27002
27003 @subsubheading Example
27004
27005 @smallexample
27006 (gdb)
27007 -break-insert main
27008 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27009 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27010 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27011 times="0"@}
27012 (gdb)
27013 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
27014 ^done
27015 (gdb)
27016 @end smallexample
27017
27018 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
27019 @findex -break-condition
27020
27021 @subsubheading Synopsis
27022
27023 @smallexample
27024 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
27025 @end smallexample
27026
27027 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
27028 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
27029 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
27030 command below).
27031
27032 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27033
27034 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
27035
27036 @subsubheading Example
27037
27038 @smallexample
27039 (gdb)
27040 -break-condition 1 1
27041 ^done
27042 (gdb)
27043 -break-list
27044 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27045 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27046 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27047 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27048 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27049 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27050 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27051 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27052 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27053 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27054 (gdb)
27055 @end smallexample
27056
27057 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
27058 @findex -break-delete
27059
27060 @subsubheading Synopsis
27061
27062 @smallexample
27063 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27064 @end smallexample
27065
27066 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
27067 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
27068
27069 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27070
27071 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
27072
27073 @subsubheading Example
27074
27075 @smallexample
27076 (gdb)
27077 -break-delete 1
27078 ^done
27079 (gdb)
27080 -break-list
27081 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27082 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27083 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27084 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27085 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27086 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27087 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27088 body=[]@}
27089 (gdb)
27090 @end smallexample
27091
27092 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
27093 @findex -break-disable
27094
27095 @subsubheading Synopsis
27096
27097 @smallexample
27098 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27099 @end smallexample
27100
27101 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
27102 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
27103
27104 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27105
27106 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
27107
27108 @subsubheading Example
27109
27110 @smallexample
27111 (gdb)
27112 -break-disable 2
27113 ^done
27114 (gdb)
27115 -break-list
27116 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27117 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27118 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27119 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27120 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27121 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27122 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27123 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27124 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27125 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27126 (gdb)
27127 @end smallexample
27128
27129 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
27130 @findex -break-enable
27131
27132 @subsubheading Synopsis
27133
27134 @smallexample
27135 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27136 @end smallexample
27137
27138 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
27139
27140 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27141
27142 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
27143
27144 @subsubheading Example
27145
27146 @smallexample
27147 (gdb)
27148 -break-enable 2
27149 ^done
27150 (gdb)
27151 -break-list
27152 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27153 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27154 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27155 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27156 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27157 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27158 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27159 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27160 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27161 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27162 (gdb)
27163 @end smallexample
27164
27165 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27166 @findex -break-info
27167
27168 @subsubheading Synopsis
27169
27170 @smallexample
27171 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27172 @end smallexample
27173
27174 @c REDUNDANT???
27175 Get information about a single breakpoint.
27176
27177 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27178 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27179 table.
27180
27181 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27182
27183 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27184
27185 @subsubheading Example
27186 N.A.
27187
27188 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27189 @findex -break-insert
27190 @anchor{-break-insert}
27191
27192 @subsubheading Synopsis
27193
27194 @smallexample
27195 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27196 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27197 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27198 @end smallexample
27199
27200 @noindent
27201 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27202
27203 @table @var
27204 @item linespec location
27205 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27206
27207 @item explicit location
27208 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27209 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27210 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27211
27212 @table @samp
27213 @item --source @var{filename}
27214 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
27215 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27216
27217 @item --function @var{function}
27218 The name of a function or method.
27219
27220 @item --label @var{label}
27221 The name of a label.
27222
27223 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
27224 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27225 @end table
27226
27227 @item address location
27228 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
27229 @end table
27230
27231 @noindent
27232 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27233
27234 @table @samp
27235 @item -t
27236 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27237 @item -h
27238 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27239 @item -f
27240 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27241 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27242 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27243 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27244 cannot be parsed.
27245 @item -d
27246 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27247 @item -a
27248 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
27249 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27250 @item -c @var{condition}
27251 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27252 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27253 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27254 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27255 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27256 @var{thread-id}.
27257 @end table
27258
27259 @subsubheading Result
27260
27261 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27262 resulting breakpoint.
27263
27264 Note: this format is open to change.
27265 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27266
27267 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27268
27269 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27270 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27271
27272 @subsubheading Example
27273
27274 @smallexample
27275 (gdb)
27276 -break-insert main
27277 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27278 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27279 times="0"@}
27280 (gdb)
27281 -break-insert -t foo
27282 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27283 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27284 times="0"@}
27285 (gdb)
27286 -break-list
27287 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27288 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27289 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27290 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27291 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27292 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27293 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27294 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27295 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27296 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27297 times="0"@},
27298 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27299 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27300 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27301 times="0"@}]@}
27302 (gdb)
27303 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
27304 @c ~int foo(int, int);
27305 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27306 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27307 @c times="0"@}
27308 @c (gdb)
27309 @end smallexample
27310
27311 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27312 @findex -dprintf-insert
27313
27314 @subsubheading Synopsis
27315
27316 @smallexample
27317 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27318 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27319 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27320 [ @var{argument} ]
27321 @end smallexample
27322
27323 @noindent
27324 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27325 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27326
27327 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27328
27329 @table @samp
27330 @item -t
27331 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27332 @item -f
27333 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27334 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27335 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27336 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27337 cannot be parsed.
27338 @item -d
27339 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27340 @item -c @var{condition}
27341 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27342 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27343 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27344 to @var{ignore-count}.
27345 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27346 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27347 @var{thread-id}.
27348 @end table
27349
27350 @subsubheading Result
27351
27352 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27353 resulting breakpoint.
27354
27355 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27356
27357 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27358
27359 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27360
27361 @subsubheading Example
27362
27363 @smallexample
27364 (gdb)
27365 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27366 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27367 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27368 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27369 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27370 original-location="foo"@}
27371 (gdb)
27372 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27373 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27374 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27375 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27376 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27377 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27378 (gdb)
27379 @end smallexample
27380
27381 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27382 @findex -break-list
27383
27384 @subsubheading Synopsis
27385
27386 @smallexample
27387 -break-list
27388 @end smallexample
27389
27390 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27391
27392 @table @samp
27393 @item Number
27394 number of the breakpoint
27395 @item Type
27396 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27397 @item Disposition
27398 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27399 or @samp{nokeep}
27400 @item Enabled
27401 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27402 @item Address
27403 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27404 @item What
27405 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27406 name, line number
27407 @item Thread-groups
27408 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27409 @item Times
27410 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27411 @end table
27412
27413 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27414 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27415
27416 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27417
27418 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27419
27420 @subsubheading Example
27421
27422 @smallexample
27423 (gdb)
27424 -break-list
27425 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27426 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27427 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27428 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27429 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27430 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27431 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27432 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27433 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27434 times="0"@},
27435 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27436 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27437 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27438 (gdb)
27439 @end smallexample
27440
27441 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27442
27443 @smallexample
27444 (gdb)
27445 -break-list
27446 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27447 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27448 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27449 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27450 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27451 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27452 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27453 body=[]@}
27454 (gdb)
27455 @end smallexample
27456
27457 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27458 @findex -break-passcount
27459
27460 @subsubheading Synopsis
27461
27462 @smallexample
27463 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27464 @end smallexample
27465
27466 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27467 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27468 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27469 command @samp{passcount}.
27470
27471 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27472 @findex -break-watch
27473
27474 @subsubheading Synopsis
27475
27476 @smallexample
27477 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27478 @end smallexample
27479
27480 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27481 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27482 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27483 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27484 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27485 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27486 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27487 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27488
27489 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27490 breakpoints inserted.
27491
27492 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27493
27494 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27495 @samp{rwatch}.
27496
27497 @subsubheading Example
27498
27499 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27500
27501 @smallexample
27502 (gdb)
27503 -break-watch x
27504 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27505 (gdb)
27506 -exec-continue
27507 ^running
27508 (gdb)
27509 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27510 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27511 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27512 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27513 (gdb)
27514 @end smallexample
27515
27516 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27517 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27518 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27519
27520 @smallexample
27521 (gdb)
27522 -break-watch C
27523 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27524 (gdb)
27525 -exec-continue
27526 ^running
27527 (gdb)
27528 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27529 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27530 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27531 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27532 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27533 (gdb)
27534 -exec-continue
27535 ^running
27536 (gdb)
27537 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27538 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27539 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27540 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27541 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27542 (gdb)
27543 @end smallexample
27544
27545 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27546 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27547 deleted.
27548
27549 @smallexample
27550 (gdb)
27551 -break-watch C
27552 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27553 (gdb)
27554 -break-list
27555 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27556 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27557 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27558 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27559 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27560 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27561 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27562 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27563 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27564 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27565 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27566 times="1"@},
27567 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27568 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27569 (gdb)
27570 -exec-continue
27571 ^running
27572 (gdb)
27573 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27574 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27575 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27576 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27577 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27578 (gdb)
27579 -break-list
27580 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27581 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27582 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27583 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27584 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27585 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27586 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27587 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27588 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27589 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27590 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27591 times="1"@},
27592 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27593 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27594 (gdb)
27595 -exec-continue
27596 ^running
27597 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27598 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27599 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27600 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27601 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27602 (gdb)
27603 -break-list
27604 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27605 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27606 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27607 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27608 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27609 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27610 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27611 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27612 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27613 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27614 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27615 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27616 (gdb)
27617 @end smallexample
27618
27619
27620 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27621 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27622 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27623
27624 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27625 catchpoints.
27626
27627 @menu
27628 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27629 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27630 @end menu
27631
27632 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27633 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27634
27635 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27636 @findex -catch-load
27637
27638 @subsubheading Synopsis
27639
27640 @smallexample
27641 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27642 @end smallexample
27643
27644 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27645 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27646 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27647 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27648 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27649
27650
27651 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27652
27653 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27654
27655 @subsubheading Example
27656
27657 @smallexample
27658 -catch-load -t foo.so
27659 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27660 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27661 (gdb)
27662 @end smallexample
27663
27664
27665 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27666 @findex -catch-unload
27667
27668 @subsubheading Synopsis
27669
27670 @smallexample
27671 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27672 @end smallexample
27673
27674 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27675 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27676 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27677 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27678 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27679
27680 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27681
27682 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27683
27684 @subsubheading Example
27685
27686 @smallexample
27687 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27688 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27689 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27690 (gdb)
27691 @end smallexample
27692
27693 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27694 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27695
27696 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27697 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27698
27699 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27700 @findex -catch-assert
27701
27702 @subsubheading Synopsis
27703
27704 @smallexample
27705 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27706 @end smallexample
27707
27708 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27709
27710 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27711
27712 @table @samp
27713 @item -c @var{condition}
27714 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27715 @item -d
27716 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27717 @item -t
27718 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27719 @end table
27720
27721 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27722
27723 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27724
27725 @subsubheading Example
27726
27727 @smallexample
27728 -catch-assert
27729 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27730 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27731 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27732 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27733 (gdb)
27734 @end smallexample
27735
27736 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27737 @findex -catch-exception
27738
27739 @subsubheading Synopsis
27740
27741 @smallexample
27742 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27743 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27744 @end smallexample
27745
27746 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27747 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27748 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27749 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27750 catchpoints.
27751
27752 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27753
27754 @table @samp
27755 @item -c @var{condition}
27756 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27757 @item -d
27758 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27759 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27760 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27761 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27762 @item -t
27763 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27764 @item -u
27765 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27766 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27767 @end table
27768
27769 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27770
27771 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27772 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27773
27774 @subsubheading Example
27775
27776 @smallexample
27777 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27778 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27779 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27780 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27781 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27782 (gdb)
27783 @end smallexample
27784
27785 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27786 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27787 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27788
27789 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27790 @findex -exec-arguments
27791
27792
27793 @subsubheading Synopsis
27794
27795 @smallexample
27796 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27797 @end smallexample
27798
27799 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27800 @samp{-exec-run}.
27801
27802 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27803
27804 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27805
27806 @subsubheading Example
27807
27808 @smallexample
27809 (gdb)
27810 -exec-arguments -v word
27811 ^done
27812 (gdb)
27813 @end smallexample
27814
27815
27816 @ignore
27817 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27818 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27819
27820 @subsubheading Synopsis
27821
27822 @smallexample
27823 -exec-show-arguments
27824 @end smallexample
27825
27826 Print the arguments of the program.
27827
27828 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27829
27830 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27831
27832 @subsubheading Example
27833 N.A.
27834 @end ignore
27835
27836
27837 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27838 @findex -environment-cd
27839
27840 @subsubheading Synopsis
27841
27842 @smallexample
27843 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27844 @end smallexample
27845
27846 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27847
27848 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27849
27850 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27851
27852 @subsubheading Example
27853
27854 @smallexample
27855 (gdb)
27856 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27857 ^done
27858 (gdb)
27859 @end smallexample
27860
27861
27862 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27863 @findex -environment-directory
27864
27865 @subsubheading Synopsis
27866
27867 @smallexample
27868 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27869 @end smallexample
27870
27871 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27872 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27873 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27874 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27875 occurs as normal.
27876 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27877 multiple directories in a single command
27878 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27879 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27880 If blanks are needed as
27881 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27882 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27883 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27884 character must not be used
27885 in any directory name.
27886 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27887
27888 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27889
27890 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27891
27892 @subsubheading Example
27893
27894 @smallexample
27895 (gdb)
27896 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27897 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27898 (gdb)
27899 -environment-directory ""
27900 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27901 (gdb)
27902 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27903 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27904 (gdb)
27905 -environment-directory -r
27906 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27907 (gdb)
27908 @end smallexample
27909
27910
27911 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27912 @findex -environment-path
27913
27914 @subsubheading Synopsis
27915
27916 @smallexample
27917 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27918 @end smallexample
27919
27920 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27921 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27922 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27923 supplied in addition to the
27924 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27925 occurs as normal.
27926 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27927 multiple directories in a single command
27928 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27929 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27930 If blanks are needed as
27931 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27932 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27933 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27934 character must not be used
27935 in any directory name.
27936 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27937
27938
27939 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27940
27941 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27942
27943 @subsubheading Example
27944
27945 @smallexample
27946 (gdb)
27947 -environment-path
27948 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27949 (gdb)
27950 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27951 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27952 (gdb)
27953 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27954 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27955 (gdb)
27956 @end smallexample
27957
27958
27959 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27960 @findex -environment-pwd
27961
27962 @subsubheading Synopsis
27963
27964 @smallexample
27965 -environment-pwd
27966 @end smallexample
27967
27968 Show the current working directory.
27969
27970 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27971
27972 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27973
27974 @subsubheading Example
27975
27976 @smallexample
27977 (gdb)
27978 -environment-pwd
27979 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27980 (gdb)
27981 @end smallexample
27982
27983 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27984 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27985 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27986
27987
27988 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27989 @findex -thread-info
27990
27991 @subsubheading Synopsis
27992
27993 @smallexample
27994 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27995 @end smallexample
27996
27997 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
27998 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
27999 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
28000 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
28001 current thread.
28002
28003 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28004
28005 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
28006 about all threads.
28007
28008 @subsubheading Result
28009
28010 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
28011 defined for a given thread:
28012
28013 @table @samp
28014 @item current
28015 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28016
28017 @item id
28018 The global identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
28019
28020 @item target-id
28021 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
28022
28023 @item details
28024 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
28025 field is optional.
28026
28027 @item name
28028 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
28029 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
28030 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
28031 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
28032 field is omitted.
28033
28034 @item frame
28035 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
28036
28037 @item state
28038 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
28039 values:
28040
28041 @table @code
28042 @item stopped
28043 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
28044 threads.
28045
28046 @item running
28047 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
28048 threads.
28049
28050 @end table
28051
28052 @item core
28053 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
28054 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
28055
28056 @end table
28057
28058 @subsubheading Example
28059
28060 @smallexample
28061 -thread-info
28062 ^done,threads=[
28063 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28064 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
28065 args=[]@},state="running"@},
28066 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28067 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
28068 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28069 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
28070 state="running"@}],
28071 current-thread-id="1"
28072 (gdb)
28073 @end smallexample
28074
28075 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
28076 @findex -thread-list-ids
28077
28078 @subsubheading Synopsis
28079
28080 @smallexample
28081 -thread-list-ids
28082 @end smallexample
28083
28084 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
28085 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
28086 threads.
28087
28088 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
28089 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
28090
28091 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28092
28093 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
28094
28095 @subsubheading Example
28096
28097 @smallexample
28098 (gdb)
28099 -thread-list-ids
28100 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28101 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
28102 (gdb)
28103 @end smallexample
28104
28105
28106 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
28107 @findex -thread-select
28108
28109 @subsubheading Synopsis
28110
28111 @smallexample
28112 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
28113 @end smallexample
28114
28115 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
28116 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
28117 topmost frame for that thread.
28118
28119 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
28120 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
28121
28122 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28123
28124 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
28125
28126 @subsubheading Example
28127
28128 @smallexample
28129 (gdb)
28130 -exec-next
28131 ^running
28132 (gdb)
28133 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
28134 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
28135 (gdb)
28136 -thread-list-ids
28137 ^done,
28138 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28139 number-of-threads="3"
28140 (gdb)
28141 -thread-select 3
28142 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
28143 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
28144 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
28145 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
28146 (gdb)
28147 @end smallexample
28148
28149 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28150 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
28151 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28152
28153 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28154 @findex -ada-task-info
28155
28156 @subsubheading Synopsis
28157
28158 @smallexample
28159 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28160 @end smallexample
28161
28162 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28163 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28164
28165 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28166
28167 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28168 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28169
28170 @subsubheading Result
28171
28172 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
28173 defined for each Ada task:
28174
28175 @table @samp
28176 @item current
28177 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28178
28179 @item id
28180 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28181
28182 @item task-id
28183 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28184
28185 @item thread-id
28186 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
28187 task.
28188
28189 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28190 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28191 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28192
28193 @item parent-id
28194 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28195 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28196
28197 @item priority
28198 The base priority of the task.
28199
28200 @item state
28201 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28202 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28203
28204 @item name
28205 The name of the task.
28206
28207 @end table
28208
28209 @subsubheading Example
28210
28211 @smallexample
28212 -ada-task-info
28213 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28214 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28215 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28216 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28217 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28218 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28219 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28220 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28221 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28222 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28223 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28224 (gdb)
28225 @end smallexample
28226
28227 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28228 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
28229 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28230
28231 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28232 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28233 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28234 other cases.
28235
28236 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28237 @findex -exec-continue
28238
28239 @subsubheading Synopsis
28240
28241 @smallexample
28242 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28243 @end smallexample
28244
28245 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28246 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
28247 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28248 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
28249 @itemize @bullet
28250 @item
28251 breakpoints or watchpoints
28252 @item
28253 signals or exceptions
28254 @item
28255 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28256 @item
28257 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28258 @end itemize
28259 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28260 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28261 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
28262 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
28263 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28264 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28265
28266 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28267
28268 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28269
28270 @subsubheading Example
28271
28272 @smallexample
28273 -exec-continue
28274 ^running
28275 (gdb)
28276 @@Hello world
28277 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28278 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28279 line="13"@}
28280 (gdb)
28281 @end smallexample
28282
28283
28284 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28285 @findex -exec-finish
28286
28287 @subsubheading Synopsis
28288
28289 @smallexample
28290 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28291 @end smallexample
28292
28293 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28294 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28295 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28296 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28297 function was called.
28298
28299 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28300
28301 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28302
28303 @subsubheading Example
28304
28305 Function returning @code{void}.
28306
28307 @smallexample
28308 -exec-finish
28309 ^running
28310 (gdb)
28311 @@hello from foo
28312 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28313 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28314 (gdb)
28315 @end smallexample
28316
28317 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28318 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28319 value itself.
28320
28321 @smallexample
28322 -exec-finish
28323 ^running
28324 (gdb)
28325 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28326 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28327 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28328 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28329 (gdb)
28330 @end smallexample
28331
28332
28333 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28334 @findex -exec-interrupt
28335
28336 @subsubheading Synopsis
28337
28338 @smallexample
28339 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28340 @end smallexample
28341
28342 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28343 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28344 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28345 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28346 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28347
28348 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28349 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28350 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28351 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28352
28353 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28354 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28355 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28356 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28357
28358 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28359
28360 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28361
28362 @subsubheading Example
28363
28364 @smallexample
28365 (gdb)
28366 111-exec-continue
28367 111^running
28368
28369 (gdb)
28370 222-exec-interrupt
28371 222^done
28372 (gdb)
28373 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28374 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28375 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28376 (gdb)
28377
28378 (gdb)
28379 -exec-interrupt
28380 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28381 (gdb)
28382 @end smallexample
28383
28384 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28385 @findex -exec-jump
28386
28387 @subsubheading Synopsis
28388
28389 @smallexample
28390 -exec-jump @var{location}
28391 @end smallexample
28392
28393 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28394 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28395 different forms of @var{location}.
28396
28397 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28398
28399 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28400
28401 @subsubheading Example
28402
28403 @smallexample
28404 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28405 *running,thread-id="all"
28406 ^running
28407 @end smallexample
28408
28409
28410 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28411 @findex -exec-next
28412
28413 @subsubheading Synopsis
28414
28415 @smallexample
28416 -exec-next [--reverse]
28417 @end smallexample
28418
28419 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28420 of the next source line is reached.
28421
28422 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28423 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28424 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28425 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28426 source line where the function was called.
28427
28428
28429 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28430
28431 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28432
28433 @subsubheading Example
28434
28435 @smallexample
28436 -exec-next
28437 ^running
28438 (gdb)
28439 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28440 (gdb)
28441 @end smallexample
28442
28443
28444 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28445 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28446
28447 @subsubheading Synopsis
28448
28449 @smallexample
28450 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28451 @end smallexample
28452
28453 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28454 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28455 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28456 printed as well.
28457
28458 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28459 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28460 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28461 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28462 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28463
28464 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28465
28466 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28467
28468 @subsubheading Example
28469
28470 @smallexample
28471 (gdb)
28472 -exec-next-instruction
28473 ^running
28474
28475 (gdb)
28476 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28477 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28478 (gdb)
28479 @end smallexample
28480
28481
28482 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28483 @findex -exec-return
28484
28485 @subsubheading Synopsis
28486
28487 @smallexample
28488 -exec-return
28489 @end smallexample
28490
28491 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28492 Displays the new current frame.
28493
28494 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28495
28496 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28497
28498 @subsubheading Example
28499
28500 @smallexample
28501 (gdb)
28502 200-break-insert callee4
28503 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28504 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28505 (gdb)
28506 000-exec-run
28507 000^running
28508 (gdb)
28509 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28510 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28511 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28512 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28513 (gdb)
28514 205-break-delete
28515 205^done
28516 (gdb)
28517 111-exec-return
28518 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28519 args=[@{name="strarg",
28520 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28521 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28522 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28523 (gdb)
28524 @end smallexample
28525
28526
28527 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28528 @findex -exec-run
28529
28530 @subsubheading Synopsis
28531
28532 @smallexample
28533 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28534 @end smallexample
28535
28536 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28537 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28538 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28539 the program has exited exceptionally.
28540
28541 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28542 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28543 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28544 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28545 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28546
28547 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28548 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28549 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28550 (@pxref{Starting}).
28551
28552 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28553
28554 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28555
28556 @subsubheading Examples
28557
28558 @smallexample
28559 (gdb)
28560 -break-insert main
28561 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28562 (gdb)
28563 -exec-run
28564 ^running
28565 (gdb)
28566 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28567 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28568 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28569 (gdb)
28570 @end smallexample
28571
28572 @noindent
28573 Program exited normally:
28574
28575 @smallexample
28576 (gdb)
28577 -exec-run
28578 ^running
28579 (gdb)
28580 x = 55
28581 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28582 (gdb)
28583 @end smallexample
28584
28585 @noindent
28586 Program exited exceptionally:
28587
28588 @smallexample
28589 (gdb)
28590 -exec-run
28591 ^running
28592 (gdb)
28593 x = 55
28594 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28595 (gdb)
28596 @end smallexample
28597
28598 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28599 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28600
28601 @smallexample
28602 (gdb)
28603 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28604 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28605 @end smallexample
28606
28607
28608 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28609
28610
28611 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28612 @findex -exec-step
28613
28614 @subsubheading Synopsis
28615
28616 @smallexample
28617 -exec-step [--reverse]
28618 @end smallexample
28619
28620 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28621 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28622 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28623 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28624 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28625 previously executed source line.
28626
28627 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28628
28629 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28630
28631 @subsubheading Example
28632
28633 Stepping into a function:
28634
28635 @smallexample
28636 -exec-step
28637 ^running
28638 (gdb)
28639 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28640 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28641 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28642 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28643 (gdb)
28644 @end smallexample
28645
28646 Regular stepping:
28647
28648 @smallexample
28649 -exec-step
28650 ^running
28651 (gdb)
28652 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28653 (gdb)
28654 @end smallexample
28655
28656
28657 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28658 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28659
28660 @subsubheading Synopsis
28661
28662 @smallexample
28663 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28664 @end smallexample
28665
28666 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28667 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28668 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28669 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28670 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28671 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28672 as well.
28673
28674 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28675
28676 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28677
28678 @subsubheading Example
28679
28680 @smallexample
28681 (gdb)
28682 -exec-step-instruction
28683 ^running
28684
28685 (gdb)
28686 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28687 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28688 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28689 (gdb)
28690 -exec-step-instruction
28691 ^running
28692
28693 (gdb)
28694 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28695 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28696 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28697 (gdb)
28698 @end smallexample
28699
28700
28701 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28702 @findex -exec-until
28703
28704 @subsubheading Synopsis
28705
28706 @smallexample
28707 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28708 @end smallexample
28709
28710 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28711 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28712 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28713 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28714
28715 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28716
28717 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28718
28719 @subsubheading Example
28720
28721 @smallexample
28722 (gdb)
28723 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28724 ^running
28725 (gdb)
28726 x = 55
28727 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28728 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28729 (gdb)
28730 @end smallexample
28731
28732 @ignore
28733 @subheading -file-clear
28734 Is this going away????
28735 @end ignore
28736
28737 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28738 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28739 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28740
28741 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28742 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28743
28744 @smallexample
28745 -enable-frame-filters
28746 @end smallexample
28747
28748 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28749 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28750 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28751 request that this functionality be enabled.
28752
28753 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28754
28755 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28756 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28757
28758 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28759 @findex -stack-info-frame
28760
28761 @subsubheading Synopsis
28762
28763 @smallexample
28764 -stack-info-frame
28765 @end smallexample
28766
28767 Get info on the selected frame.
28768
28769 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28770
28771 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28772 (without arguments).
28773
28774 @subsubheading Example
28775
28776 @smallexample
28777 (gdb)
28778 -stack-info-frame
28779 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28780 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28781 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28782 (gdb)
28783 @end smallexample
28784
28785 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28786 @findex -stack-info-depth
28787
28788 @subsubheading Synopsis
28789
28790 @smallexample
28791 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28792 @end smallexample
28793
28794 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28795 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28796
28797 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28798
28799 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28800
28801 @subsubheading Example
28802
28803 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28804
28805 @smallexample
28806 (gdb)
28807 -stack-info-depth
28808 ^done,depth="12"
28809 (gdb)
28810 -stack-info-depth 4
28811 ^done,depth="4"
28812 (gdb)
28813 -stack-info-depth 12
28814 ^done,depth="12"
28815 (gdb)
28816 -stack-info-depth 11
28817 ^done,depth="11"
28818 (gdb)
28819 -stack-info-depth 13
28820 ^done,depth="12"
28821 (gdb)
28822 @end smallexample
28823
28824 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28825 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28826 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28827
28828 @subsubheading Synopsis
28829
28830 @smallexample
28831 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28832 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28833 @end smallexample
28834
28835 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28836 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28837 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28838 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28839 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28840 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28841 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28842 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28843
28844 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28845 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28846 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28847 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28848 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28849 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28850
28851 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28852 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28853 are still displayed, however.
28854
28855 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28856 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28857
28858 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28859
28860 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28861 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28862 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28863
28864 @subsubheading Example
28865
28866 @smallexample
28867 (gdb)
28868 -stack-list-frames
28869 ^done,
28870 stack=[
28871 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28872 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28873 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28874 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28875 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28876 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28877 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28878 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28879 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28880 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28881 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28882 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28883 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28884 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28885 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28886 (gdb)
28887 -stack-list-arguments 0
28888 ^done,
28889 stack-args=[
28890 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28891 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28892 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28893 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28894 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28895 (gdb)
28896 -stack-list-arguments 1
28897 ^done,
28898 stack-args=[
28899 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28900 frame=@{level="1",
28901 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28902 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28903 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28904 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28905 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28906 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28907 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28908 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28909 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28910 (gdb)
28911 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28912 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28913 (gdb)
28914 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28915 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28916 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28917 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28918 (gdb)
28919 @end smallexample
28920
28921 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28922
28923
28924 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28925 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28926 @findex -stack-list-frames
28927
28928 @subsubheading Synopsis
28929
28930 @smallexample
28931 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28932 @end smallexample
28933
28934 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28935 following info:
28936
28937 @table @samp
28938 @item @var{level}
28939 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28940 @item @var{addr}
28941 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28942 @item @var{func}
28943 Function name.
28944 @item @var{file}
28945 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28946 @item @var{fullname}
28947 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28948 @item @var{line}
28949 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28950 @item @var{from}
28951 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28952 if the frame's function is not known.
28953 @end table
28954
28955 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28956 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28957 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28958 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28959 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28960 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28961 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28962 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28963 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28964
28965 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28966
28967 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28968
28969 @subsubheading Example
28970
28971 Full stack backtrace:
28972
28973 @smallexample
28974 (gdb)
28975 -stack-list-frames
28976 ^done,stack=
28977 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28978 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28979 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28980 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28981 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28982 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28983 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28984 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28985 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28986 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28987 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28988 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28989 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28990 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28991 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28992 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28993 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28994 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28995 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28996 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28997 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28998 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28999 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
29000 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
29001 (gdb)
29002 @end smallexample
29003
29004 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
29005
29006 @smallexample
29007 (gdb)
29008 -stack-list-frames 3 5
29009 ^done,stack=
29010 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29011 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29012 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29013 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29014 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29015 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29016 (gdb)
29017 @end smallexample
29018
29019 Show a single frame:
29020
29021 @smallexample
29022 (gdb)
29023 -stack-list-frames 3 3
29024 ^done,stack=
29025 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29026 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29027 (gdb)
29028 @end smallexample
29029
29030
29031 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
29032 @findex -stack-list-locals
29033 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
29034
29035 @subsubheading Synopsis
29036
29037 @smallexample
29038 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29039 @end smallexample
29040
29041 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
29042 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29043 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29044 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29045 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29046 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
29047 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
29048 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
29049 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29050 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29051
29052 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29053 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
29054 variables are still displayed, however.
29055
29056 This command is deprecated in favor of the
29057 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29058
29059 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29060
29061 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
29062
29063 @subsubheading Example
29064
29065 @smallexample
29066 (gdb)
29067 -stack-list-locals 0
29068 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
29069 (gdb)
29070 -stack-list-locals --all-values
29071 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
29072 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
29073 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
29074 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
29075 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
29076 (gdb)
29077 @end smallexample
29078
29079 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
29080 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
29081 @findex -stack-list-variables
29082
29083 @subsubheading Synopsis
29084
29085 @smallexample
29086 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29087 @end smallexample
29088
29089 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
29090 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29091 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29092 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29093 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29094 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29095 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29096
29097 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29098 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
29099 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
29100
29101 @subsubheading Example
29102
29103 @smallexample
29104 (gdb)
29105 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
29106 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
29107 (gdb)
29108 @end smallexample
29109
29110
29111 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
29112 @findex -stack-select-frame
29113
29114 @subsubheading Synopsis
29115
29116 @smallexample
29117 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
29118 @end smallexample
29119
29120 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
29121 the stack.
29122
29123 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
29124 option to every command.
29125
29126 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29127
29128 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
29129 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
29130
29131 @subsubheading Example
29132
29133 @smallexample
29134 (gdb)
29135 -stack-select-frame 2
29136 ^done
29137 (gdb)
29138 @end smallexample
29139
29140 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29141 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
29142 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
29143
29144 @ignore
29145
29146 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29147
29148 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
29149 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
29150 used by @code{Insight}.
29151
29152 The two main reasons for that are:
29153
29154 @enumerate 1
29155 @item
29156 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29157
29158 @item
29159 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29160 now).
29161 @end enumerate
29162
29163 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29164 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
29165 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29166 hints about their use.
29167
29168 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29169 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29170 least, the following operations:
29171
29172 @itemize @bullet
29173 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29174 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29175 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29176 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29177 @end itemize
29178
29179 @end ignore
29180
29181 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29182
29183 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29184
29185 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29186 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29187 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29188 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
29189 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
29190 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
29191 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29192 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
29193 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29194 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29195 object, or to change display format.
29196
29197 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
29198 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29199 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29200 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29201 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29202 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29203 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29204 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29205 child will be created.
29206
29207 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29208 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29209 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29210 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29211 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29212
29213 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29214 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29215 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29216 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29217 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29218 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29219 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29220 variables that frontend has created.
29221
29222 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29223 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29224 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
29225 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29226 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29227 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
29228 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
29229 implicitly updated.
29230
29231 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
29232 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29233 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29234 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
29235 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29236 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29237 frame. Consider this example:
29238
29239 @smallexample
29240 void do_work(...)
29241 @{
29242 struct work_state state;
29243
29244 if (...)
29245 do_work(...);
29246 @}
29247 @end smallexample
29248
29249 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29250 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29251 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29252 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
29253 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29254
29255 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29256 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29257 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
29258 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29259 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29260 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29261
29262 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29263 access this functionality:
29264
29265 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29266 @item @strong{Operation}
29267 @tab @strong{Description}
29268
29269 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29270 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29271 @item @code{-var-create}
29272 @tab create a variable object
29273 @item @code{-var-delete}
29274 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29275 @item @code{-var-set-format}
29276 @tab set the display format of this variable
29277 @item @code{-var-show-format}
29278 @tab show the display format of this variable
29279 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29280 @tab tells how many children this object has
29281 @item @code{-var-list-children}
29282 @tab return a list of the object's children
29283 @item @code{-var-info-type}
29284 @tab show the type of this variable object
29285 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
29286 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29287 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29288 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29289 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29290 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29291 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29292 @tab get the value of this variable
29293 @item @code{-var-assign}
29294 @tab set the value of this variable
29295 @item @code{-var-update}
29296 @tab update the variable and its children
29297 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29298 @tab set frozeness attribute
29299 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29300 @tab set range of children to display on update
29301 @end multitable
29302
29303 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29304 how it can be used.
29305
29306 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29307
29308 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29309 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
29310
29311 @smallexample
29312 -enable-pretty-printing
29313 @end smallexample
29314
29315 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29316 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29317 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29318 request that this functionality be enabled.
29319
29320 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29321
29322 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29323 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29324
29325 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29326 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29327
29328 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29329 @findex -var-create
29330
29331 @subsubheading Synopsis
29332
29333 @smallexample
29334 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29335 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29336 @end smallexample
29337
29338 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29339 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29340 register.
29341
29342 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29343 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29344 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29345 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29346 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29347
29348 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29349 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29350 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29351 object must be created.
29352
29353 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29354 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29355
29356 @itemize @bullet
29357 @item
29358 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29359
29360 @item
29361 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29362
29363 @item
29364 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29365 @end itemize
29366
29367 @cindex dynamic varobj
29368 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29369 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29370 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29371 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29372 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29373 compatibility for existing clients.
29374
29375 @subsubheading Result
29376
29377 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29378 are:
29379
29380 @table @samp
29381 @item name
29382 The name of the varobj.
29383
29384 @item numchild
29385 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29386 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29387 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29388
29389 @item value
29390 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29391 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29392 will not be interesting.
29393
29394 @item type
29395 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29396 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29397 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29398 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29399 @emph{declared} one.
29400
29401 @item thread-id
29402 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29403 thread's global identifier.
29404
29405 @item has_more
29406 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29407 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29408
29409 @item dynamic
29410 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29411 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29412 then this attribute will not be present.
29413
29414 @item displayhint
29415 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29416 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29417 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29418 @end table
29419
29420 Typical output will look like this:
29421
29422 @smallexample
29423 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29424 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29425 @end smallexample
29426
29427
29428 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29429 @findex -var-delete
29430
29431 @subsubheading Synopsis
29432
29433 @smallexample
29434 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29435 @end smallexample
29436
29437 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29438 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29439
29440 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29441
29442
29443 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29444 @findex -var-set-format
29445
29446 @subsubheading Synopsis
29447
29448 @smallexample
29449 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29450 @end smallexample
29451
29452 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29453 @var{format-spec}.
29454
29455 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29456 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29457
29458 @smallexample
29459 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29460 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29461 @end smallexample
29462
29463 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29464 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29465 for pointers, etc.).
29466
29467 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29468 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29469 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29470 zero-hexadecimal format.
29471
29472 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29473 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29474
29475 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29476 @findex -var-show-format
29477
29478 @subsubheading Synopsis
29479
29480 @smallexample
29481 -var-show-format @var{name}
29482 @end smallexample
29483
29484 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29485
29486 @smallexample
29487 @var{format} @expansion{}
29488 @var{format-spec}
29489 @end smallexample
29490
29491
29492 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29493 @findex -var-info-num-children
29494
29495 @subsubheading Synopsis
29496
29497 @smallexample
29498 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29499 @end smallexample
29500
29501 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29502
29503 @smallexample
29504 numchild=@var{n}
29505 @end smallexample
29506
29507 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29508 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29509 be available.
29510
29511
29512 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29513 @findex -var-list-children
29514
29515 @subsubheading Synopsis
29516
29517 @smallexample
29518 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29519 @end smallexample
29520 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29521
29522 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29523 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29524 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29525 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29526 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29527 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29528 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29529 and unions.
29530
29531 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29532 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29533 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29534 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29535 reported.
29536
29537 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29538 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29539 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29540 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29541 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29542 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29543 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29544 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29545 the visible items.
29546
29547 For each child the following results are returned:
29548
29549 @table @var
29550
29551 @item name
29552 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29553
29554 @item exp
29555 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29556 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29557
29558 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29559 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29560
29561 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29562 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29563 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29564 type and value are not present.
29565
29566 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29567 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29568 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29569
29570 @item numchild
29571 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29572 0.
29573
29574 @item type
29575 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29576 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29577 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29578 @emph{declared} one.
29579
29580 @item value
29581 If values were requested, this is the value.
29582
29583 @item thread-id
29584 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29585 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
29586
29587 @item frozen
29588 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29589
29590 @item displayhint
29591 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29592 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29593 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29594
29595 @item dynamic
29596 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29597 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29598 then this attribute will not be present.
29599
29600 @end table
29601
29602 The result may have its own attributes:
29603
29604 @table @samp
29605 @item displayhint
29606 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29607 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29608 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29609
29610 @item has_more
29611 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29612 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29613 @end table
29614
29615 @subsubheading Example
29616
29617 @smallexample
29618 (gdb)
29619 -var-list-children n
29620 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29621 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29622 (gdb)
29623 -var-list-children --all-values n
29624 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29625 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29626 @end smallexample
29627
29628
29629 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29630 @findex -var-info-type
29631
29632 @subsubheading Synopsis
29633
29634 @smallexample
29635 -var-info-type @var{name}
29636 @end smallexample
29637
29638 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29639 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29640 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29641
29642 @smallexample
29643 type=@var{typename}
29644 @end smallexample
29645
29646
29647 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29648 @findex -var-info-expression
29649
29650 @subsubheading Synopsis
29651
29652 @smallexample
29653 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29654 @end smallexample
29655
29656 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29657 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29658 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29659
29660 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29661 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29662
29663 @smallexample
29664 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29665 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29666 @end smallexample
29667
29668 @noindent
29669 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29670 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29671
29672 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29673 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29674 is of limited use.
29675
29676 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29677 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29678
29679 @subsubheading Synopsis
29680
29681 @smallexample
29682 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29683 @end smallexample
29684
29685 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29686 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29687 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29688 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29689 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29690 watchpoint from a variable object.
29691
29692 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29693 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29694
29695 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29696 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29697 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29698 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29699 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29700 @smallexample
29701 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29702 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29703 @end smallexample
29704
29705 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29706 @findex -var-show-attributes
29707
29708 @subsubheading Synopsis
29709
29710 @smallexample
29711 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29712 @end smallexample
29713
29714 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29715
29716 @smallexample
29717 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29718 @end smallexample
29719
29720 @noindent
29721 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29722
29723 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29724 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29725
29726 @subsubheading Synopsis
29727
29728 @smallexample
29729 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29730 @end smallexample
29731
29732 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29733 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29734 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29735 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29736 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29737 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29738 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29739
29740 @smallexample
29741 value=@var{value}
29742 @end smallexample
29743
29744 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29745 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29746
29747 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29748 @findex -var-assign
29749
29750 @subsubheading Synopsis
29751
29752 @smallexample
29753 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29754 @end smallexample
29755
29756 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29757 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29758 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29759 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29760
29761 @subsubheading Example
29762
29763 @smallexample
29764 (gdb)
29765 -var-assign var1 3
29766 ^done,value="3"
29767 (gdb)
29768 -var-update *
29769 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29770 (gdb)
29771 @end smallexample
29772
29773 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29774 @findex -var-update
29775
29776 @subsubheading Synopsis
29777
29778 @smallexample
29779 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29780 @end smallexample
29781
29782 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29783 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29784 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29785 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29786 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29787 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29788 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29789 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29790 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29791 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29792 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29793 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29794 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29795
29796 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29797 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29798 diagnostic.
29799
29800 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29801 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29802
29803 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29804 @samp{changelist}.
29805
29806 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29807
29808 @table @samp
29809 @item name
29810 The name of the varobj.
29811
29812 @item value
29813 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29814 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29815
29816 @item in_scope
29817 @anchor{-var-update}
29818 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29819
29820 @table @code
29821 @item "true"
29822 The variable object's current value is valid.
29823
29824 @item "false"
29825 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29826 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29827 scope.
29828
29829 @item "invalid"
29830 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29831 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29832 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29833 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29834 objects.
29835 @end table
29836
29837 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29838 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29839
29840 @item type_changed
29841 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29842 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29843 be @samp{false}.
29844
29845 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29846 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29847 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29848 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29849 unset.
29850
29851 @item new_type
29852 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29853 hold the new type.
29854
29855 @item new_num_children
29856 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29857 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29858
29859 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29860 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29861 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29862 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29863 children which may be available.
29864
29865 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29866 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29867 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29868 only happen at the end of the update range).
29869
29870 @item displayhint
29871 The display hint, if any.
29872
29873 @item has_more
29874 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29875 available outside the varobj's update range.
29876
29877 @item dynamic
29878 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29879 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29880 then this attribute will not be present.
29881
29882 @item new_children
29883 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29884 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29885 be listed in this attribute.
29886 @end table
29887
29888 @subsubheading Example
29889
29890 @smallexample
29891 (gdb)
29892 -var-assign var1 3
29893 ^done,value="3"
29894 (gdb)
29895 -var-update --all-values var1
29896 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29897 type_changed="false"@}]
29898 (gdb)
29899 @end smallexample
29900
29901 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29902 @findex -var-set-frozen
29903 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29904
29905 @subsubheading Synopsis
29906
29907 @smallexample
29908 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29909 @end smallexample
29910
29911 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29912 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29913 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29914 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29915 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29916 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29917 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29918 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29919 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29920 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29921 @code{-var-update} does.
29922
29923 @subsubheading Example
29924
29925 @smallexample
29926 (gdb)
29927 -var-set-frozen V 1
29928 ^done
29929 (gdb)
29930 @end smallexample
29931
29932 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29933 @findex -var-set-update-range
29934 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29935
29936 @subsubheading Synopsis
29937
29938 @smallexample
29939 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29940 @end smallexample
29941
29942 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29943 @code{-var-update}.
29944
29945 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29946 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29947 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29948 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29949
29950 @subsubheading Example
29951
29952 @smallexample
29953 (gdb)
29954 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29955 ^done
29956 @end smallexample
29957
29958 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29959 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29960 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29961
29962 @subsubheading Synopsis
29963
29964 @smallexample
29965 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29966 @end smallexample
29967
29968 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29969
29970 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29971 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29972
29973 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29974 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29975 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29976 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29977 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29978 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29979 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29980
29981 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29982 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29983 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29984 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29985
29986 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29987 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29988 can be used to check this.
29989
29990 @subsubheading Example
29991
29992 Resetting the visualizer:
29993
29994 @smallexample
29995 (gdb)
29996 -var-set-visualizer V None
29997 ^done
29998 @end smallexample
29999
30000 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
30001
30002 @smallexample
30003 (gdb)
30004 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
30005 ^done
30006 @end smallexample
30007
30008 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
30009 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
30010
30011 @smallexample
30012 (gdb)
30013 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
30014 ^done
30015 @end smallexample
30016
30017 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30018 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
30019 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
30020
30021 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
30022 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
30023 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
30024 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
30025
30026 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
30027 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
30028
30029 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
30030 @c @subheading -data-assign
30031 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
30032 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
30033 @c set variable
30034 @c @subsubheading Example
30035 @c N.A.
30036
30037 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
30038 @findex -data-disassemble
30039
30040 @subsubheading Synopsis
30041
30042 @smallexample
30043 -data-disassemble
30044 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
30045 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
30046 -- @var{mode}
30047 @end smallexample
30048
30049 @noindent
30050 Where:
30051
30052 @table @samp
30053 @item @var{start-addr}
30054 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
30055 @item @var{end-addr}
30056 is the end address
30057 @item @var{filename}
30058 is the name of the file to disassemble
30059 @item @var{linenum}
30060 is the line number to disassemble around
30061 @item @var{lines}
30062 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
30063 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
30064 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
30065 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
30066 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
30067 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
30068 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
30069 are displayed.
30070 @item @var{mode}
30071 is one of:
30072 @itemize @bullet
30073 @item 0 disassembly only
30074 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
30075 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
30076 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
30077 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
30078 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
30079 @end itemize
30080
30081 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
30082 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
30083 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
30084 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
30085 @end table
30086
30087 @subsubheading Result
30088
30089 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
30090 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
30091 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
30092
30093 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
30094 following fields:
30095
30096 @table @code
30097 @item address
30098 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
30099
30100 @item func-name
30101 The name of the function this instruction is within.
30102
30103 @item offset
30104 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
30105
30106 @item inst
30107 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
30108
30109 @item opcodes
30110 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
30111 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
30112
30113 @end table
30114
30115 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
30116 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
30117
30118 @table @code
30119 @item line
30120 The line number within @samp{file}.
30121
30122 @item file
30123 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
30124 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
30125 used.
30126
30127 @item fullname
30128 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
30129 using the source file search path
30130 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
30131 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
30132
30133 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
30134 present in the debug information.
30135
30136 @item line_asm_insn
30137 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
30138 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
30139 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
30140 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
30141 @samp{opcodes}.
30142
30143 @end table
30144
30145 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
30146 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
30147 adjust its format.
30148
30149 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30150
30151 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30152
30153 @subsubheading Example
30154
30155 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30156
30157 @smallexample
30158 (gdb)
30159 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30160 ^done,
30161 asm_insns=[
30162 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30163 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30164 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30165 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30166 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30167 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30168 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30169 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30170 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30171 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30172 (gdb)
30173 @end smallexample
30174
30175 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
30176 @code{main}.
30177
30178 @smallexample
30179 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30180 ^done,asm_insns=[
30181 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30182 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30183 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30184 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30185 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30186 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30187 [@dots{}]
30188 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30189 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30190 (gdb)
30191 @end smallexample
30192
30193 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30194
30195 @smallexample
30196 (gdb)
30197 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30198 ^done,asm_insns=[
30199 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30200 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30201 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30202 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30203 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30204 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30205 (gdb)
30206 @end smallexample
30207
30208 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30209
30210 @smallexample
30211 (gdb)
30212 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30213 ^done,asm_insns=[
30214 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30215 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30216 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30217 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30218 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30219 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30220 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30221 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30222 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30223 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30224 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30225 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30226 (gdb)
30227 @end smallexample
30228
30229
30230 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30231 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
30232
30233 @subsubheading Synopsis
30234
30235 @smallexample
30236 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30237 @end smallexample
30238
30239 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
30240 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
30241 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30242
30243 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30244
30245 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30246 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30247 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
30248
30249 @subsubheading Example
30250
30251 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30252 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30253 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30254 output.
30255
30256 @smallexample
30257 211-data-evaluate-expression A
30258 211^done,value="1"
30259 (gdb)
30260 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30261 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30262 (gdb)
30263 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30264 411^done,value="4"
30265 (gdb)
30266 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30267 511^done,value="4"
30268 (gdb)
30269 @end smallexample
30270
30271
30272 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30273 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
30274
30275 @subsubheading Synopsis
30276
30277 @smallexample
30278 -data-list-changed-registers
30279 @end smallexample
30280
30281 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30282
30283 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30284
30285 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30286 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30287
30288 @subsubheading Example
30289
30290 On a PPC MBX board:
30291
30292 @smallexample
30293 (gdb)
30294 -exec-continue
30295 ^running
30296
30297 (gdb)
30298 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30299 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30300 line="5"@}
30301 (gdb)
30302 -data-list-changed-registers
30303 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30304 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30305 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30306 (gdb)
30307 @end smallexample
30308
30309
30310 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30311 @findex -data-list-register-names
30312
30313 @subsubheading Synopsis
30314
30315 @smallexample
30316 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30317 @end smallexample
30318
30319 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30320 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30321 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30322 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30323 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30324 include empty register names.
30325
30326 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30327
30328 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30329 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30330 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30331
30332 @subsubheading Example
30333
30334 For the PPC MBX board:
30335 @smallexample
30336 (gdb)
30337 -data-list-register-names
30338 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30339 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30340 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30341 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30342 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30343 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30344 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30345 (gdb)
30346 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30347 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30348 (gdb)
30349 @end smallexample
30350
30351 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30352 @findex -data-list-register-values
30353
30354 @subsubheading Synopsis
30355
30356 @smallexample
30357 -data-list-register-values
30358 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30359 @end smallexample
30360
30361 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30362 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30363 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30364 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30365 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30366 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30367
30368 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30369
30370 @table @code
30371 @item x
30372 Hexadecimal
30373 @item o
30374 Octal
30375 @item t
30376 Binary
30377 @item d
30378 Decimal
30379 @item r
30380 Raw
30381 @item N
30382 Natural
30383 @end table
30384
30385 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30386
30387 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30388 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30389
30390 @subsubheading Example
30391
30392 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30393 don't appear in the actual output):
30394
30395 @smallexample
30396 (gdb)
30397 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30398 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30399 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30400 (gdb)
30401 -data-list-register-values x
30402 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30403 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30404 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30405 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30406 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30407 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30408 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30409 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30410 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30411 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30412 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30413 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30414 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30415 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30416 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30417 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30418 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30419 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30420 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30421 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30422 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30423 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30424 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30425 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30426 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30427 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30428 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30429 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30430 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30431 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30432 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30433 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30434 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30435 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30436 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30437 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30438 (gdb)
30439 @end smallexample
30440
30441
30442 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30443 @findex -data-read-memory
30444
30445 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30446
30447 @subsubheading Synopsis
30448
30449 @smallexample
30450 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30451 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30452 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30453 @end smallexample
30454
30455 @noindent
30456 where:
30457
30458 @table @samp
30459 @item @var{address}
30460 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30461 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30462 quoted using the C convention.
30463
30464 @item @var{word-format}
30465 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30466 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30467 ,Output Formats}).
30468
30469 @item @var{word-size}
30470 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30471
30472 @item @var{nr-rows}
30473 The number of rows in the output table.
30474
30475 @item @var{nr-cols}
30476 The number of columns in the output table.
30477
30478 @item @var{aschar}
30479 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30480 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30481 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30482 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30483
30484 @item @var{byte-offset}
30485 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30486 @end table
30487
30488 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30489 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30490 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30491 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30492 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30493 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30494 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30495 @samp{addr}.
30496
30497 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30498 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30499 @samp{prev-page}.
30500
30501 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30502
30503 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30504 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30505
30506 @subsubheading Example
30507
30508 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30509 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30510 word. Display each word in hex.
30511
30512 @smallexample
30513 (gdb)
30514 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30515 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30516 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30517 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30518 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30519 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30520 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30521 (gdb)
30522 @end smallexample
30523
30524 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30525 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30526
30527 @smallexample
30528 (gdb)
30529 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30530 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30531 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30532 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30533 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30534 (gdb)
30535 @end smallexample
30536
30537 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30538 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30539 used as the non-printable character.
30540
30541 @smallexample
30542 (gdb)
30543 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30544 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30545 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30546 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30547 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30548 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30549 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30550 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30551 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30552 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30553 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30554 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30555 (gdb)
30556 @end smallexample
30557
30558 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30559 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30560
30561 @subsubheading Synopsis
30562
30563 @smallexample
30564 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30565 @var{address} @var{count}
30566 @end smallexample
30567
30568 @noindent
30569 where:
30570
30571 @table @samp
30572 @item @var{address}
30573 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30574 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30575 quoted using the C convention.
30576
30577 @item @var{count}
30578 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30579 literal.
30580
30581 @item @var{offset}
30582 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30583 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30584 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30585 arithmetics itself.
30586
30587 @end table
30588
30589 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30590 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30591 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30592 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30593 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30594 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30595
30596 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30597 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30598 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30599 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30600 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30601 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30602 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30603 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30604
30605 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30606 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30607 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30608 and has the following fields:
30609
30610 @table @code
30611 @item begin
30612 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30613
30614 @item end
30615 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30616
30617 @item offset
30618 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30619 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30620
30621 @item contents
30622 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30623
30624 @end table
30625
30626
30627
30628 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30629
30630 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30631
30632 @subsubheading Example
30633
30634 @smallexample
30635 (gdb)
30636 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30637 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30638 end="0xbffff15e",
30639 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30640 (gdb)
30641 @end smallexample
30642
30643
30644 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30645 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30646
30647 @subsubheading Synopsis
30648
30649 @smallexample
30650 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30651 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30652 @end smallexample
30653
30654 @noindent
30655 where:
30656
30657 @table @samp
30658 @item @var{address}
30659 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30660 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30661 be quoted using the C convention.
30662
30663 @item @var{contents}
30664 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
30665 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30666
30667 @item @var{count}
30668 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30669 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30670 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30671 @var{count} memory units.
30672
30673 @end table
30674
30675 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30676
30677 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30678
30679 @subsubheading Example
30680
30681 @smallexample
30682 (gdb)
30683 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30684 ^done
30685 (gdb)
30686 @end smallexample
30687
30688 @smallexample
30689 (gdb)
30690 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30691 ^done
30692 (gdb)
30693 @end smallexample
30694
30695 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30696 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30697 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30698
30699 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30700 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30701
30702 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30703 @findex -trace-find
30704
30705 @subsubheading Synopsis
30706
30707 @smallexample
30708 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30709 @end smallexample
30710
30711 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30712 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30713 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30714
30715 @table @samp
30716
30717 @item none
30718 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30719
30720 @item frame-number
30721 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30722 that index.
30723
30724 @item tracepoint-number
30725 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30726 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30727
30728 @item pc
30729 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30730 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30731 address.
30732
30733 @item pc-inside-range
30734 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30735 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30736 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30737
30738 @item pc-outside-range
30739 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30740 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30741 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30742
30743 @item line
30744 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30745 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30746 the specified location.
30747
30748 @end table
30749
30750 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30751 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30752
30753 @table @samp
30754 @item found
30755 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30756 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30757
30758 @item traceframe
30759 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30760 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30761
30762 @item tracepoint
30763 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30764 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30765
30766 @item frame
30767 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30768 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30769 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30770
30771 @end table
30772
30773 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30774
30775 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30776
30777 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30778 @findex -trace-define-variable
30779
30780 @subsubheading Synopsis
30781
30782 @smallexample
30783 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30784 @end smallexample
30785
30786 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30787 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30788 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30789 with the @samp{$} character.
30790
30791 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30792
30793 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30794
30795 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30796 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30797
30798 @subsubheading Synopsis
30799
30800 @smallexample
30801 -trace-frame-collected
30802 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30803 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30804 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30805 [--memory-contents]
30806 @end smallexample
30807
30808 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30809 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30810 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30811 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30812 See the output description table below for more details.
30813
30814 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30815 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30816 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30817 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30818 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30819
30820 For instance, if the actions were
30821 @smallexample
30822 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30823 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30824 @end smallexample
30825
30826 @noindent
30827 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30828 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30829 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30830 objects would be computed expressions.
30831
30832 An example output would be:
30833
30834 @smallexample
30835 (gdb)
30836 -trace-frame-collected
30837 ^done,
30838 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30839 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30840 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30841 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30842 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30843 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30844 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30845 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30846 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30847 ...
30848 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30849 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30850 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30851 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30852 (gdb)
30853 @end smallexample
30854
30855 Where:
30856
30857 @table @code
30858 @item explicit-variables
30859 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30860 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30861 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30862 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30863 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30864 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30865 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30866 arrays, structures and unions.
30867
30868 @item computed-expressions
30869 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30870 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30871 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30872 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30873
30874 @item registers
30875 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30876 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30877 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30878 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30879 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30880
30881 @item tvars
30882 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30883 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30884 current value are returned.
30885
30886 @item memory
30887 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30888 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30889 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30890
30891 @table @code
30892 @item address
30893 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30894
30895 @item length
30896 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30897
30898 @item contents
30899 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30900 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30901
30902 @end table
30903
30904 @end table
30905
30906 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30907
30908 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30909
30910 @subsubheading Example
30911
30912 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30913 @findex -trace-list-variables
30914
30915 @subsubheading Synopsis
30916
30917 @smallexample
30918 -trace-list-variables
30919 @end smallexample
30920
30921 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30922 table has the following fields:
30923
30924 @table @samp
30925 @item name
30926 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30927
30928 @item initial
30929 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30930 field is always present.
30931
30932 @item current
30933 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30934 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30935 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30936 presently running.
30937
30938 @end table
30939
30940 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30941
30942 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30943
30944 @subsubheading Example
30945
30946 @smallexample
30947 (gdb)
30948 -trace-list-variables
30949 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30950 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30951 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30952 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30953 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30954 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30955 (gdb)
30956 @end smallexample
30957
30958 @subheading -trace-save
30959 @findex -trace-save
30960
30961 @subsubheading Synopsis
30962
30963 @smallexample
30964 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
30965 @end smallexample
30966
30967 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30968 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30969 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30970 to perform the save.
30971
30972 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
30973 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
30974 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
30975
30976 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30977
30978 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30979
30980
30981 @subheading -trace-start
30982 @findex -trace-start
30983
30984 @subsubheading Synopsis
30985
30986 @smallexample
30987 -trace-start
30988 @end smallexample
30989
30990 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
30991 have any fields.
30992
30993 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30994
30995 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30996
30997 @subheading -trace-status
30998 @findex -trace-status
30999
31000 @subsubheading Synopsis
31001
31002 @smallexample
31003 -trace-status
31004 @end smallexample
31005
31006 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
31007 the following fields:
31008
31009 @table @samp
31010
31011 @item supported
31012 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
31013 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
31014 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
31015 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
31016 started. This field is always present.
31017
31018 @item running
31019 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
31020 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
31021 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31022
31023 @item stop-reason
31024 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
31025 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
31026 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
31027 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
31028 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
31029 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
31030 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
31031 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
31032 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31033
31034 @item stopping-tracepoint
31035 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
31036 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
31037 @samp{passcount}.
31038
31039 @item frames
31040 @itemx frames-created
31041 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
31042 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
31043 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
31044 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
31045
31046 @item buffer-size
31047 @itemx buffer-free
31048 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
31049 remaining space. These fields are optional.
31050
31051 @item circular
31052 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
31053 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
31054 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
31055 and may fill up.
31056
31057 @item disconnected
31058 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
31059 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
31060 that the trace run will stop.
31061
31062 @item trace-file
31063 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
31064 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
31065
31066 @end table
31067
31068 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31069
31070 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
31071
31072 @subheading -trace-stop
31073 @findex -trace-stop
31074
31075 @subsubheading Synopsis
31076
31077 @smallexample
31078 -trace-stop
31079 @end smallexample
31080
31081 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
31082 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
31083 @samp{running} fields are not output.
31084
31085 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31086
31087 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
31088
31089
31090 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31091 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
31092 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
31093
31094
31095 @ignore
31096 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
31097 @findex -symbol-info-address
31098
31099 @subsubheading Synopsis
31100
31101 @smallexample
31102 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
31103 @end smallexample
31104
31105 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
31106
31107 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31108
31109 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
31110
31111 @subsubheading Example
31112 N.A.
31113
31114
31115 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
31116 @findex -symbol-info-file
31117
31118 @subsubheading Synopsis
31119
31120 @smallexample
31121 -symbol-info-file
31122 @end smallexample
31123
31124 Show the file for the symbol.
31125
31126 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31127
31128 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
31129 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
31130
31131 @subsubheading Example
31132 N.A.
31133
31134
31135 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
31136 @findex -symbol-info-function
31137
31138 @subsubheading Synopsis
31139
31140 @smallexample
31141 -symbol-info-function
31142 @end smallexample
31143
31144 Show which function the symbol lives in.
31145
31146 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31147
31148 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
31149
31150 @subsubheading Example
31151 N.A.
31152
31153
31154 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
31155 @findex -symbol-info-line
31156
31157 @subsubheading Synopsis
31158
31159 @smallexample
31160 -symbol-info-line
31161 @end smallexample
31162
31163 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31164
31165 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31166
31167 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31168 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31169
31170 @subsubheading Example
31171 N.A.
31172
31173
31174 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31175 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
31176
31177 @subsubheading Synopsis
31178
31179 @smallexample
31180 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31181 @end smallexample
31182
31183 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31184
31185 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31186
31187 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31188
31189 @subsubheading Example
31190 N.A.
31191
31192
31193 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31194 @findex -symbol-list-functions
31195
31196 @subsubheading Synopsis
31197
31198 @smallexample
31199 -symbol-list-functions
31200 @end smallexample
31201
31202 List the functions in the executable.
31203
31204 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31205
31206 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31207 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31208
31209 @subsubheading Example
31210 N.A.
31211 @end ignore
31212
31213
31214 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31215 @findex -symbol-list-lines
31216
31217 @subsubheading Synopsis
31218
31219 @smallexample
31220 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31221 @end smallexample
31222
31223 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31224 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
31225 ascending PC order.
31226
31227 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31228
31229 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31230
31231 @subsubheading Example
31232 @smallexample
31233 (gdb)
31234 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
31235 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31236 (gdb)
31237 @end smallexample
31238
31239
31240 @ignore
31241 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31242 @findex -symbol-list-types
31243
31244 @subsubheading Synopsis
31245
31246 @smallexample
31247 -symbol-list-types
31248 @end smallexample
31249
31250 List all the type names.
31251
31252 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31253
31254 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31255 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31256
31257 @subsubheading Example
31258 N.A.
31259
31260
31261 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31262 @findex -symbol-list-variables
31263
31264 @subsubheading Synopsis
31265
31266 @smallexample
31267 -symbol-list-variables
31268 @end smallexample
31269
31270 List all the global and static variable names.
31271
31272 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31273
31274 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31275
31276 @subsubheading Example
31277 N.A.
31278
31279
31280 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31281 @findex -symbol-locate
31282
31283 @subsubheading Synopsis
31284
31285 @smallexample
31286 -symbol-locate
31287 @end smallexample
31288
31289 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31290
31291 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31292
31293 @subsubheading Example
31294 N.A.
31295
31296
31297 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31298 @findex -symbol-type
31299
31300 @subsubheading Synopsis
31301
31302 @smallexample
31303 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31304 @end smallexample
31305
31306 Show type of @var{variable}.
31307
31308 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31309
31310 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31311 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31312
31313 @subsubheading Example
31314 N.A.
31315 @end ignore
31316
31317
31318 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31319 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31320 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31321
31322 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31323 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31324
31325 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31326 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31327
31328 @subsubheading Synopsis
31329
31330 @smallexample
31331 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31332 @end smallexample
31333
31334 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31335 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31336 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31337 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31338 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31339 notification.
31340
31341 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31342
31343 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31344
31345 @subsubheading Example
31346
31347 @smallexample
31348 (gdb)
31349 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31350 ^done
31351 (gdb)
31352 @end smallexample
31353
31354
31355 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31356 @findex -file-exec-file
31357
31358 @subsubheading Synopsis
31359
31360 @smallexample
31361 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31362 @end smallexample
31363
31364 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31365 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31366 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31367 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31368 notification.
31369
31370 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31371
31372 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31373
31374 @subsubheading Example
31375
31376 @smallexample
31377 (gdb)
31378 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31379 ^done
31380 (gdb)
31381 @end smallexample
31382
31383
31384 @ignore
31385 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31386 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31387
31388 @subsubheading Synopsis
31389
31390 @smallexample
31391 -file-list-exec-sections
31392 @end smallexample
31393
31394 List the sections of the current executable file.
31395
31396 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31397
31398 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31399 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31400 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31401
31402 @subsubheading Example
31403 N.A.
31404 @end ignore
31405
31406
31407 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31408 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31409
31410 @subsubheading Synopsis
31411
31412 @smallexample
31413 -file-list-exec-source-file
31414 @end smallexample
31415
31416 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31417 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31418 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31419 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31420
31421 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31422
31423 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31424
31425 @subsubheading Example
31426
31427 @smallexample
31428 (gdb)
31429 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31430 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31431 (gdb)
31432 @end smallexample
31433
31434
31435 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31436 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31437
31438 @subsubheading Synopsis
31439
31440 @smallexample
31441 -file-list-exec-source-files
31442 @end smallexample
31443
31444 List the source files for the current executable.
31445
31446 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31447 name) of a source file.
31448
31449 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31450
31451 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31452 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31453
31454 @subsubheading Example
31455 @smallexample
31456 (gdb)
31457 -file-list-exec-source-files
31458 ^done,files=[
31459 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31460 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31461 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31462 (gdb)
31463 @end smallexample
31464
31465 @ignore
31466 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31467 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31468
31469 @subsubheading Synopsis
31470
31471 @smallexample
31472 -file-list-shared-libraries
31473 @end smallexample
31474
31475 List the shared libraries in the program.
31476
31477 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31478
31479 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
31480
31481 @subsubheading Example
31482 N.A.
31483
31484
31485 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31486 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31487
31488 @subsubheading Synopsis
31489
31490 @smallexample
31491 -file-list-symbol-files
31492 @end smallexample
31493
31494 List symbol files.
31495
31496 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31497
31498 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31499
31500 @subsubheading Example
31501 N.A.
31502 @end ignore
31503
31504
31505 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31506 @findex -file-symbol-file
31507
31508 @subsubheading Synopsis
31509
31510 @smallexample
31511 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31512 @end smallexample
31513
31514 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31515 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31516 produced, except for a completion notification.
31517
31518 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31519
31520 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31521
31522 @subsubheading Example
31523
31524 @smallexample
31525 (gdb)
31526 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31527 ^done
31528 (gdb)
31529 @end smallexample
31530
31531 @ignore
31532 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31533 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31534 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31535
31536 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31537
31538 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31539
31540 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31541
31542 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31543
31544 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31545
31546 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31547
31548 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31549
31550 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31551
31552 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31553 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31554 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31555
31556 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31557
31558 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31559
31560 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31561
31562 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31563 @end ignore
31564
31565
31566 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31567 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31568 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31569
31570
31571 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31572 @findex -target-attach
31573
31574 @subsubheading Synopsis
31575
31576 @smallexample
31577 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31578 @end smallexample
31579
31580 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31581 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31582 group, the id previously returned by
31583 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31584
31585 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31586
31587 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31588
31589 @subsubheading Example
31590 @smallexample
31591 (gdb)
31592 -target-attach 34
31593 =thread-created,id="1"
31594 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31595 ^done
31596 (gdb)
31597 @end smallexample
31598
31599 @ignore
31600 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31601 @findex -target-compare-sections
31602
31603 @subsubheading Synopsis
31604
31605 @smallexample
31606 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31607 @end smallexample
31608
31609 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31610 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31611
31612 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31613
31614 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31615
31616 @subsubheading Example
31617 N.A.
31618 @end ignore
31619
31620
31621 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31622 @findex -target-detach
31623
31624 @subsubheading Synopsis
31625
31626 @smallexample
31627 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31628 @end smallexample
31629
31630 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31631 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31632 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31633
31634 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31635
31636 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31637
31638 @subsubheading Example
31639
31640 @smallexample
31641 (gdb)
31642 -target-detach
31643 ^done
31644 (gdb)
31645 @end smallexample
31646
31647
31648 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31649 @findex -target-disconnect
31650
31651 @subsubheading Synopsis
31652
31653 @smallexample
31654 -target-disconnect
31655 @end smallexample
31656
31657 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31658 generally not resumed.
31659
31660 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31661
31662 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31663
31664 @subsubheading Example
31665
31666 @smallexample
31667 (gdb)
31668 -target-disconnect
31669 ^done
31670 (gdb)
31671 @end smallexample
31672
31673
31674 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31675 @findex -target-download
31676
31677 @subsubheading Synopsis
31678
31679 @smallexample
31680 -target-download
31681 @end smallexample
31682
31683 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31684 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31685
31686 @table @samp
31687 @item section
31688 The name of the section.
31689 @item section-sent
31690 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31691 @item section-size
31692 The size of the section.
31693 @item total-sent
31694 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31695 @item total-size
31696 The size of the overall executable to download.
31697 @end table
31698
31699 @noindent
31700 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31701 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31702
31703 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31704 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31705
31706 @table @samp
31707 @item section
31708 The name of the section.
31709 @item section-size
31710 The size of the section.
31711 @item total-size
31712 The size of the overall executable to download.
31713 @end table
31714
31715 @noindent
31716 At the end, a summary is printed.
31717
31718 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31719
31720 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31721
31722 @subsubheading Example
31723
31724 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31725 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31726
31727 @smallexample
31728 (gdb)
31729 -target-download
31730 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31731 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31732 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31733 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31734 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31735 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31736 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31737 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31738 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31739 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31740 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31741 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31742 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31743 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31744 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31745 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31746 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31747 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31748 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31749 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31750 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31751 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31752 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31753 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31754 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31755 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31756 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31757 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31758 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31759 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31760 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31761 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31762 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31763 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31764 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31765 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31766 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31767 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31768 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31769 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31770 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31771 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31772 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31773 write-rate="429"
31774 (gdb)
31775 @end smallexample
31776
31777
31778 @ignore
31779 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31780 @findex -target-exec-status
31781
31782 @subsubheading Synopsis
31783
31784 @smallexample
31785 -target-exec-status
31786 @end smallexample
31787
31788 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31789 not, for instance).
31790
31791 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31792
31793 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31794
31795 @subsubheading Example
31796 N.A.
31797
31798
31799 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31800 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31801
31802 @subsubheading Synopsis
31803
31804 @smallexample
31805 -target-list-available-targets
31806 @end smallexample
31807
31808 List the possible targets to connect to.
31809
31810 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31811
31812 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31813
31814 @subsubheading Example
31815 N.A.
31816
31817
31818 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31819 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31820
31821 @subsubheading Synopsis
31822
31823 @smallexample
31824 -target-list-current-targets
31825 @end smallexample
31826
31827 Describe the current target.
31828
31829 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31830
31831 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31832 other things).
31833
31834 @subsubheading Example
31835 N.A.
31836
31837
31838 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31839 @findex -target-list-parameters
31840
31841 @subsubheading Synopsis
31842
31843 @smallexample
31844 -target-list-parameters
31845 @end smallexample
31846
31847 @c ????
31848 @end ignore
31849
31850 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31851
31852 No equivalent.
31853
31854 @subsubheading Example
31855 N.A.
31856
31857
31858 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31859 @findex -target-select
31860
31861 @subsubheading Synopsis
31862
31863 @smallexample
31864 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31865 @end smallexample
31866
31867 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31868
31869 @table @samp
31870 @item @var{type}
31871 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31872 @item @var{parameters}
31873 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31874 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31875 @end table
31876
31877 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31878 which the target program is, in the following form:
31879
31880 @smallexample
31881 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31882 args=[@var{arg list}]
31883 @end smallexample
31884
31885 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31886
31887 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31888
31889 @subsubheading Example
31890
31891 @smallexample
31892 (gdb)
31893 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31894 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31895 (gdb)
31896 @end smallexample
31897
31898 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31899 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31900 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31901
31902
31903 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31904 @findex -target-file-put
31905
31906 @subsubheading Synopsis
31907
31908 @smallexample
31909 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31910 @end smallexample
31911
31912 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31913 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31914
31915 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31916
31917 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31918
31919 @subsubheading Example
31920
31921 @smallexample
31922 (gdb)
31923 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31924 ^done
31925 (gdb)
31926 @end smallexample
31927
31928
31929 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31930 @findex -target-file-get
31931
31932 @subsubheading Synopsis
31933
31934 @smallexample
31935 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31936 @end smallexample
31937
31938 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31939 on the host system.
31940
31941 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31942
31943 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31944
31945 @subsubheading Example
31946
31947 @smallexample
31948 (gdb)
31949 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31950 ^done
31951 (gdb)
31952 @end smallexample
31953
31954
31955 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31956 @findex -target-file-delete
31957
31958 @subsubheading Synopsis
31959
31960 @smallexample
31961 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31962 @end smallexample
31963
31964 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31965
31966 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31967
31968 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31969
31970 @subsubheading Example
31971
31972 @smallexample
31973 (gdb)
31974 -target-file-delete remotefile
31975 ^done
31976 (gdb)
31977 @end smallexample
31978
31979
31980 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31981 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31982 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31983
31984 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31985 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
31986
31987 @subsubheading Synopsis
31988
31989 @smallexample
31990 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31991 @end smallexample
31992
31993 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31994 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31995 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31996
31997 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31998
31999 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
32000
32001 @subsubheading Result
32002
32003 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
32004 defined for each exception:
32005
32006 @table @samp
32007 @item name
32008 The name of the exception.
32009
32010 @item address
32011 The address of the exception.
32012
32013 @end table
32014
32015 @subsubheading Example
32016
32017 @smallexample
32018 -info-ada-exceptions aint
32019 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
32020 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32021 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
32022 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
32023 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
32024 @end smallexample
32025
32026 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
32027
32028 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
32029 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
32030 Catchpoint Commands}.
32031
32032
32033 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32034 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
32035 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
32036
32037 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
32038 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
32039 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
32040 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
32041
32042 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
32043 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
32044 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
32045
32046 @subsubheading Synopsis
32047
32048 @smallexample
32049 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
32050 @end smallexample
32051
32052 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
32053
32054 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
32055 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
32056 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
32057 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
32058 dash.
32059
32060 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32061
32062 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32063
32064 @subsubheading Result
32065
32066 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
32067
32068 @table @samp
32069 @item exists
32070 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
32071 @code{"false"} otherwise.
32072
32073 @end table
32074
32075 @subsubheading Example
32076
32077 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
32078
32079 @smallexample
32080 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
32081 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
32082 @end smallexample
32083
32084 @noindent
32085 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
32086 to the debugger:
32087
32088 @smallexample
32089 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
32090 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
32091 @end smallexample
32092
32093 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
32094 @findex -list-features
32095 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
32096
32097 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
32098 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
32099 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
32100 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
32101 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
32102 startup.
32103
32104 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
32105 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
32106 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
32107 is given below.
32108
32109 Example output:
32110
32111 @smallexample
32112 (gdb) -list-features
32113 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
32114 @end smallexample
32115
32116 The current list of features is:
32117
32118 @ftable @samp
32119 @item frozen-varobjs
32120 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
32121 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
32122 of @code{-varobj-create}.
32123 @item pending-breakpoints
32124 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
32125 command.
32126 @item python
32127 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
32128 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
32129 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
32130 @item thread-info
32131 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
32132 @item data-read-memory-bytes
32133 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
32134 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
32135 @item breakpoint-notifications
32136 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
32137 CLI will be announced via async records.
32138 @item ada-task-info
32139 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
32140 @item language-option
32141 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
32142 option (@pxref{Context management}).
32143 @item info-gdb-mi-command
32144 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
32145 @item undefined-command-error-code
32146 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
32147 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
32148 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
32149 @item exec-run-start-option
32150 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
32151 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
32152 @end ftable
32153
32154 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
32155 @findex -list-target-features
32156
32157 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32158 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32159 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32160 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
32161 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32162 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32163 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32164 Example output:
32165
32166 @smallexample
32167 (gdb) -list-target-features
32168 ^done,result=["async"]
32169 @end smallexample
32170
32171 The current list of features is:
32172
32173 @table @samp
32174 @item async
32175 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32176 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32177 while the target is running.
32178
32179 @item reverse
32180 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32181 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32182
32183 @end table
32184
32185 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32186 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32187 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32188
32189 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
32190
32191 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32192 @findex -gdb-exit
32193
32194 @subsubheading Synopsis
32195
32196 @smallexample
32197 -gdb-exit
32198 @end smallexample
32199
32200 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32201
32202 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32203
32204 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32205
32206 @subsubheading Example
32207
32208 @smallexample
32209 (gdb)
32210 -gdb-exit
32211 ^exit
32212 @end smallexample
32213
32214
32215 @ignore
32216 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32217 @findex -exec-abort
32218
32219 @subsubheading Synopsis
32220
32221 @smallexample
32222 -exec-abort
32223 @end smallexample
32224
32225 Kill the inferior running program.
32226
32227 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32228
32229 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32230
32231 @subsubheading Example
32232 N.A.
32233 @end ignore
32234
32235
32236 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32237 @findex -gdb-set
32238
32239 @subsubheading Synopsis
32240
32241 @smallexample
32242 -gdb-set
32243 @end smallexample
32244
32245 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32246 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32247
32248 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32249
32250 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32251
32252 @subsubheading Example
32253
32254 @smallexample
32255 (gdb)
32256 -gdb-set $foo=3
32257 ^done
32258 (gdb)
32259 @end smallexample
32260
32261
32262 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32263 @findex -gdb-show
32264
32265 @subsubheading Synopsis
32266
32267 @smallexample
32268 -gdb-show
32269 @end smallexample
32270
32271 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32272
32273 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32274
32275 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32276
32277 @subsubheading Example
32278
32279 @smallexample
32280 (gdb)
32281 -gdb-show annotate
32282 ^done,value="0"
32283 (gdb)
32284 @end smallexample
32285
32286 @c @subheading -gdb-source
32287
32288
32289 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32290 @findex -gdb-version
32291
32292 @subsubheading Synopsis
32293
32294 @smallexample
32295 -gdb-version
32296 @end smallexample
32297
32298 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32299
32300 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32301
32302 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32303 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32304
32305 @subsubheading Example
32306
32307 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32308 @c box in TeX.
32309 @smallexample
32310 (gdb)
32311 -gdb-version
32312 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32313 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32314 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32315 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32316 ~ certain conditions.
32317 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32318 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32319 ~ details.
32320 ~This GDB was configured as
32321 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32322 ^done
32323 (gdb)
32324 @end smallexample
32325
32326 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32327 @findex -list-thread-groups
32328
32329 @subheading Synopsis
32330
32331 @smallexample
32332 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32333 @end smallexample
32334
32335 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32336 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32337 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32338 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32339 top-level thread groups.
32340
32341 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32342 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32343 available on the target.
32344
32345 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32346 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32347 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32348 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32349 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32350 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32351 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32352 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32353
32354 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32355 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32356 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32357 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32358 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32359 @samp{threads} field.
32360
32361 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32362 the following caveats:
32363
32364 @itemize @bullet
32365 @item
32366 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32367 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32368 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32369
32370 @item
32371 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32372 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32373 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32374 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32375 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32376 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32377
32378 @end itemize
32379
32380 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32381 have the following fields:
32382
32383 @table @code
32384 @item id
32385 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32386 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32387 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32388
32389 @item type
32390 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32391 valid type.
32392
32393 @item pid
32394 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32395 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32396
32397 @item exit-code
32398 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32399 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32400 only if the process is not running.
32401
32402 @item num_children
32403 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32404 absent for an available thread group.
32405
32406 @item threads
32407 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32408 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32409 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32410
32411 @item cores
32412 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32413 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32414 such information is not available.
32415
32416 @item executable
32417 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32418 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32419 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32420
32421 @end table
32422
32423 @subheading Example
32424
32425 @smallexample
32426 @value{GDBP}
32427 -list-thread-groups
32428 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32429 -list-thread-groups 17
32430 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32431 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32432 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32433 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32434 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32435 -list-thread-groups --available
32436 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32437 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32438 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32439 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32440 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32441 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32442 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32443 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32444 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32445 @end smallexample
32446
32447 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32448 @findex -info-os
32449
32450 @subsubheading Synopsis
32451
32452 @smallexample
32453 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32454 @end smallexample
32455
32456 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32457 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32458 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32459 of data of that type.
32460
32461 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32462 system.
32463
32464 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32465
32466 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32467
32468 @subsubheading Example
32469
32470 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32471 like this:
32472
32473 @smallexample
32474 @value{GDBP}
32475 -info-os
32476 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32477 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32478 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32479 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32480 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32481 col2="CPUs"@},
32482 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32483 col2="File descriptors"@},
32484 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32485 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32486 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32487 col2="Message queues"@},
32488 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32489 col2="Processes"@},
32490 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32491 col2="Process groups"@},
32492 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32493 col2="Semaphores"@},
32494 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32495 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32496 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32497 col2="Sockets"@},
32498 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32499 col2="Threads"@}]
32500 @value{GDBP}
32501 -info-os processes
32502 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32503 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32504 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32505 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32506 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32507 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32508 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32509 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32510 ...
32511 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32512 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32513 (gdb)
32514 @end smallexample
32515
32516 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32517 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32518 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32519 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32520 @code{info os} omits it.)
32521
32522 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32523 @findex -add-inferior
32524
32525 @subheading Synopsis
32526
32527 @smallexample
32528 -add-inferior
32529 @end smallexample
32530
32531 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32532 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32533 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32534 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32535 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32536 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32537
32538 @subheading Example
32539
32540 @smallexample
32541 @value{GDBP}
32542 -add-inferior
32543 ^done,inferior="i3"
32544 @end smallexample
32545
32546 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32547 @findex -interpreter-exec
32548
32549 @subheading Synopsis
32550
32551 @smallexample
32552 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32553 @end smallexample
32554 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32555
32556 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32557
32558 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32559
32560 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32561
32562 @subheading Example
32563
32564 @smallexample
32565 (gdb)
32566 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32567 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32568 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32569 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32570 ^done
32571 (gdb)
32572 @end smallexample
32573
32574 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32575 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32576
32577 @subheading Synopsis
32578
32579 @smallexample
32580 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32581 @end smallexample
32582
32583 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32584
32585 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32586
32587 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32588
32589 @subheading Example
32590
32591 @smallexample
32592 (gdb)
32593 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32594 ^done
32595 (gdb)
32596 @end smallexample
32597
32598 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32599 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32600
32601 @subheading Synopsis
32602
32603 @smallexample
32604 -inferior-tty-show
32605 @end smallexample
32606
32607 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32608
32609 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32610
32611 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32612
32613 @subheading Example
32614
32615 @smallexample
32616 (gdb)
32617 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32618 ^done
32619 (gdb)
32620 -inferior-tty-show
32621 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32622 (gdb)
32623 @end smallexample
32624
32625 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32626 @findex -enable-timings
32627
32628 @subheading Synopsis
32629
32630 @smallexample
32631 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32632 @end smallexample
32633
32634 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32635 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32636 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32637 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32638
32639 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32640
32641 No equivalent.
32642
32643 @subheading Example
32644
32645 @smallexample
32646 (gdb)
32647 -enable-timings
32648 ^done
32649 (gdb)
32650 -break-insert main
32651 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32652 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32653 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32654 times="0"@},
32655 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32656 (gdb)
32657 -enable-timings no
32658 ^done
32659 (gdb)
32660 -exec-run
32661 ^running
32662 (gdb)
32663 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32664 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32665 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32666 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32667 (gdb)
32668 @end smallexample
32669
32670 @node Annotations
32671 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32672
32673 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32674 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32675 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32676 relatively high level.
32677
32678 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32679 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32680
32681 @ignore
32682 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32683 @end ignore
32684
32685 @menu
32686 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32687 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32688 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32689 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32690 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32691 * Annotations for Running::
32692 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32693 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32694 @end menu
32695
32696 @node Annotations Overview
32697 @section What is an Annotation?
32698 @cindex annotations
32699
32700 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32701 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32702 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32703 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32704 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32705 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32706 cannot contain newline characters.
32707
32708 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32709 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32710 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32711 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32712 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32713 means those three characters as output.
32714
32715 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32716 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32717 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32718 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32719 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32720 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32721 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32722 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32723 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32724
32725 @table @code
32726 @kindex set annotate
32727 @item set annotate @var{level}
32728 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32729 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32730
32731 @item show annotate
32732 @kindex show annotate
32733 Show the current annotation level.
32734 @end table
32735
32736 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32737
32738 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32739
32740 @smallexample
32741 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32742 GNU gdb 6.0
32743 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32744 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32745 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32746 under certain conditions.
32747 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32748 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32749 for details.
32750 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32751
32752 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32753 (@value{GDBP})
32754 ^Z^Zprompt
32755 @kbd{quit}
32756
32757 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32758 $
32759 @end smallexample
32760
32761 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32762 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32763 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32764 output from @value{GDBN}.
32765
32766 @node Server Prefix
32767 @section The Server Prefix
32768 @cindex server prefix
32769
32770 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32771 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32772 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32773 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32774 a transparent manner.
32775
32776 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32777 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32778 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32779 @code{print} command.
32780
32781 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32782 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32783
32784 @node Prompting
32785 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32786
32787 @cindex annotations for prompts
32788 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32789 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32790 over, etc.
32791
32792 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32793 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32794 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32795 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32796 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32797 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32798 features the following annotations:
32799
32800 @smallexample
32801 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32802 ^Z^Zprompt
32803 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32804 @end smallexample
32805
32806 The input types are
32807
32808 @table @code
32809 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32810 @findex prompt annotation
32811 @findex post-prompt annotation
32812 @item prompt
32813 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32814
32815 @findex pre-commands annotation
32816 @findex commands annotation
32817 @findex post-commands annotation
32818 @item commands
32819 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32820 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32821
32822 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32823 @findex overload-choice annotation
32824 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32825 @item overload-choice
32826 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32827
32828 @findex pre-query annotation
32829 @findex query annotation
32830 @findex post-query annotation
32831 @item query
32832 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32833
32834 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32835 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32836 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32837 @item prompt-for-continue
32838 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32839 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32840 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32841 presence of annotations.
32842 @end table
32843
32844 @node Errors
32845 @section Errors
32846 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32847
32848 @findex quit annotation
32849 @smallexample
32850 ^Z^Zquit
32851 @end smallexample
32852
32853 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32854
32855 @findex error annotation
32856 @smallexample
32857 ^Z^Zerror
32858 @end smallexample
32859
32860 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32861
32862 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32863 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32864 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32865 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32866 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32867 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32868 to the top level.
32869
32870 @findex error-begin annotation
32871 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32872
32873 @smallexample
32874 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32875 @end smallexample
32876
32877 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32878 message.
32879
32880 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32881 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32882 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32883
32884 @node Invalidation
32885 @section Invalidation Notices
32886
32887 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32888 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32889 changed.
32890
32891 @table @code
32892 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32893 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32894
32895 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32896 have changed.
32897
32898 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32899 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32900
32901 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32902 deleted a breakpoint.
32903 @end table
32904
32905 @node Annotations for Running
32906 @section Running the Program
32907 @cindex annotations for running programs
32908
32909 @findex starting annotation
32910 @findex stopping annotation
32911 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32912 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32913
32914 @smallexample
32915 ^Z^Zstarting
32916 @end smallexample
32917
32918 is output. When the program stops,
32919
32920 @smallexample
32921 ^Z^Zstopped
32922 @end smallexample
32923
32924 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32925 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32926
32927 @table @code
32928 @findex exited annotation
32929 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32930 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32931 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32932
32933 @findex signalled annotation
32934 @findex signal-name annotation
32935 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32936 @findex signal-string annotation
32937 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32938 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32939 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32940 annotation continues:
32941
32942 @smallexample
32943 @var{intro-text}
32944 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32945 @var{name}
32946 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32947 @var{middle-text}
32948 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32949 @var{string}
32950 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32951 @var{end-text}
32952 @end smallexample
32953
32954 @noindent
32955 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32956 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32957 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
32958 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32959 user's benefit and have no particular format.
32960
32961 @findex signal annotation
32962 @item ^Z^Zsignal
32963 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32964 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32965 terminated with it.
32966
32967 @findex breakpoint annotation
32968 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32969 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32970
32971 @findex watchpoint annotation
32972 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32973 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32974 @end table
32975
32976 @node Source Annotations
32977 @section Displaying Source
32978 @cindex annotations for source display
32979
32980 @findex source annotation
32981 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32982
32983 @smallexample
32984 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32985 @end smallexample
32986
32987 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32988 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32989 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32990 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32991 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32992 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32993 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32994 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32995 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32996 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32997 depend on the language).
32998
32999 @node JIT Interface
33000 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
33001 @cindex just-in-time compilation
33002 @cindex JIT compilation interface
33003
33004 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
33005 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
33006 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
33007 performance while maintaining platform independence.
33008
33009 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
33010 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
33011 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
33012 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
33013 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
33014 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
33015
33016 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
33017 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
33018 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
33019 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
33020 LLVM JIT.
33021
33022 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
33023 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
33024 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
33025 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
33026 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
33027 out about additional code.
33028
33029 @menu
33030 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
33031 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
33032 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
33033 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
33034 @end menu
33035
33036 @node Declarations
33037 @section JIT Declarations
33038
33039 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
33040 implement the interface:
33041
33042 @smallexample
33043 typedef enum
33044 @{
33045 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
33046 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
33047 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
33048 @} jit_actions_t;
33049
33050 struct jit_code_entry
33051 @{
33052 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
33053 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
33054 const char *symfile_addr;
33055 uint64_t symfile_size;
33056 @};
33057
33058 struct jit_descriptor
33059 @{
33060 uint32_t version;
33061 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
33062 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
33063 uint32_t action_flag;
33064 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
33065 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
33066 @};
33067
33068 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
33069 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
33070
33071 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
33072 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
33073 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
33074 @end smallexample
33075
33076 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
33077 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
33078 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
33079
33080 @node Registering Code
33081 @section Registering Code
33082
33083 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
33084
33085 @itemize @bullet
33086 @item
33087 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
33088 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
33089
33090 @item
33091 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
33092 file.
33093
33094 @item
33095 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
33096
33097 @item
33098 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
33099
33100 @item
33101 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
33102 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33103 @end itemize
33104
33105 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
33106 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
33107 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
33108 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
33109
33110 @node Unregistering Code
33111 @section Unregistering Code
33112
33113 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
33114
33115 @itemize @bullet
33116 @item
33117 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
33118
33119 @item
33120 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
33121
33122 @item
33123 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
33124 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33125 @end itemize
33126
33127 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
33128 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
33129
33130 @node Custom Debug Info
33131 @section Custom Debug Info
33132 @cindex custom JIT debug info
33133 @cindex JIT debug info reader
33134
33135 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
33136 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
33137 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
33138 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
33139 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
33140 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
33141 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
33142 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
33143 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
33144
33145 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
33146 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
33147 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
33148 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
33149 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
33150 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
33151 compiler.
33152
33153 @menu
33154 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
33155 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
33156 @end menu
33157
33158 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33159 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33160 @kindex jit-reader-load
33161 @kindex jit-reader-unload
33162
33163 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33164 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33165
33166 @table @code
33167 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33168 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33169 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
33170 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33171 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33172 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33173 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
33174
33175 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33176 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33177 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33178 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33179 @code{jit-reader-load}.
33180
33181 @item jit-reader-unload
33182 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33183
33184 @end table
33185
33186 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33187 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33188 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33189
33190 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33191 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33192
33193 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33194 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
33195 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33196 the system include directory.
33197
33198 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
33199 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33200 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33201
33202 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33203 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33204
33205 @findex gdb_init_reader
33206 @smallexample
33207 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33208 @end smallexample
33209
33210 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33211
33212 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33213 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
33214 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33215 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33216 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
33217 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
33218
33219 @smallexample
33220 struct gdb_reader_funcs
33221 @{
33222 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
33223 int reader_version;
33224
33225 /* For use by the reader. */
33226 void *priv_data;
33227
33228 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33229 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33230 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33231 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33232 @};
33233 @end smallexample
33234
33235 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33236 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33237
33238 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33239 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33240 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33241 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33242 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33243 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
33244 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33245 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33246 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33247 target's address space.
33248
33249 @node In-Process Agent
33250 @chapter In-Process Agent
33251 @cindex debugging agent
33252 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33253 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
33254 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33255 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33256 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33257 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33258 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
33259 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33260 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33261 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33262 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33263 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33264 behavior without interrupting it.
33265
33266 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33267 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33268 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33269 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33270 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33271 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33272 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33273 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33274 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33275
33276 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33277 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33278 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33279 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33280
33281 @anchor{Control Agent}
33282 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33283 debugging with the following commands:
33284
33285 @table @code
33286 @kindex set agent on
33287 @item set agent on
33288 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33289 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33290 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33291 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33292 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33293 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33294
33295 @kindex set agent off
33296 @item set agent off
33297 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33298 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33299
33300 @kindex show agent
33301 @item show agent
33302 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33303 the in-process agent.
33304 @end table
33305
33306 @menu
33307 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33308 @end menu
33309
33310 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33311 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33312 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33313
33314 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33315 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33316 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33317 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33318 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33319 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33320 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33321 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33322 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33323
33324 @menu
33325 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33326 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33327 @end menu
33328
33329 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33330 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33331 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33332
33333 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33334 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33335
33336 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33337 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33338 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33339 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33340
33341 @enumerate
33342 @item
33343 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33344 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33345 @item
33346 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33347 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33348 the other one.
33349 @end enumerate
33350
33351 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33352
33353 @enumerate
33354 @item
33355 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33356 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33357 @anchor{agent expression object}
33358 @item
33359 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33360 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33361 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33362 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33363 @item
33364 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33365 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33366
33367 @end enumerate
33368
33369 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33370 object:
33371
33372 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33373 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33374 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33375 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33376 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33377 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33378 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33379 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33380 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33381 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33382 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33383 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33384 memory address for collecting.
33385 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33386 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33387 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33388 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33389 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33390 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33391 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33392 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33393 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33394 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33395 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33396 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33397 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33398 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33399 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33400 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33401 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33402 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33403 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33404 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33405 @ref{agent expression object}
33406 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33407 @ref{agent expression object}
33408 @item actions @tab variable
33409 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33410 @end multitable
33411
33412 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33413 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33414 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33415
33416 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33417 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33418
33419 @table @samp
33420
33421 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33422 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33423 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33424 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33425 in IPA finally.
33426
33427 Replies:
33428 @table @samp
33429 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33430 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33431 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33432 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33433 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33434 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33435 @item E @var{NN}
33436 for an error
33437
33438 @end table
33439
33440 @item close
33441 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33442 is about to kill inferiors.
33443
33444 @item qTfSTM
33445 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33446 @item qTsSTM
33447 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33448 @item qTSTMat
33449 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33450 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33451 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33452
33453 Replies:
33454 @table @samp
33455 @item E @var{NN}
33456 for an error
33457 @end table
33458 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33459 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33460 @end table
33461
33462 @node GDB Bugs
33463 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33464 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33465 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33466
33467 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33468
33469 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33470 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33471 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33472 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33473
33474 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33475 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33476
33477 @menu
33478 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33479 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33480 @end menu
33481
33482 @node Bug Criteria
33483 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33484 @cindex bug criteria
33485
33486 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33487
33488 @itemize @bullet
33489 @cindex fatal signal
33490 @cindex debugger crash
33491 @cindex crash of debugger
33492 @item
33493 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33494 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33495
33496 @cindex error on valid input
33497 @item
33498 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33499 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33500 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33501
33502 @cindex invalid input
33503 @item
33504 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33505 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33506 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33507 for traditional practice''.
33508
33509 @item
33510 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33511 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33512 @end itemize
33513
33514 @node Bug Reporting
33515 @section How to Report Bugs
33516 @cindex bug reports
33517 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33518
33519 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33520 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33521 contact that organization first.
33522
33523 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33524 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33525 distribution.
33526 @c should add a web page ref...
33527
33528 @ifset BUGURL
33529 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33530 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33531 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33532 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33533 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33534 be used.
33535
33536 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33537 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33538 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33539 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33540
33541 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33542 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33543 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33544 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33545 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33546 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33547 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33548 bug reports to the mailing list.
33549 @end ifset
33550 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33551 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33552 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33553 @end ifclear
33554 @end ifset
33555
33556 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33557 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33558 fact or leave it out, state it!
33559
33560 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33561 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33562 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33563 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33564 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33565 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33566 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33567 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33568 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33569
33570 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33571 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33572 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33573 self-contained.
33574
33575 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33576 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33577 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33578 bugs properly.
33579
33580 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33581
33582 @itemize @bullet
33583 @item
33584 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33585 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33586 version}.
33587
33588 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33589 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33590
33591 @item
33592 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33593 version number.
33594
33595 @item
33596 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33597 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33598 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33599 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33600
33601 @item
33602 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33603 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33604
33605 @item
33606 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33607 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33608 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33609 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33610 those compilers.
33611
33612 @item
33613 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33614 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33615 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33616 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33617
33618 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33619 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33620
33621 @item
33622 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33623 reproduce the bug.
33624
33625 @item
33626 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33627 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33628
33629 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33630 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33631 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33632 a chance to make a mistake.
33633
33634 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33635 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33636 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33637 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33638 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33639 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33640 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33641 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33642
33643 @pindex script
33644 @cindex recording a session script
33645 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33646 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33647 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33648 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33649
33650 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33651 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33652
33653 @item
33654 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33655 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33656 it by context, not by line number.
33657
33658 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33659 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33660
33661 @end itemize
33662
33663 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33664
33665 @itemize @bullet
33666 @item
33667 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33668
33669 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33670 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33671 changes will not affect it.
33672
33673 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33674 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33675 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33676 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33677
33678 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33679 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33680 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33681 less time, and so on.
33682
33683 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33684 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33685
33686 @item
33687 A patch for the bug.
33688
33689 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33690 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33691 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33692 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33693
33694 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33695 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33696 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33697 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33698
33699 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33700 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33701 help us to understand.
33702
33703 @item
33704 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33705
33706 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33707 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33708 @end itemize
33709
33710 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33711 @c and consists of the two following files:
33712 @c rluser.texi
33713 @c hsuser.texi
33714 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33715 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33716 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33717 @include rluser.texi
33718 @include hsuser.texi
33719 @end ifclear
33720
33721 @node In Memoriam
33722 @appendix In Memoriam
33723
33724 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33725 contributors:
33726
33727 @table @code
33728 @item Fred Fish
33729 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33730 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33731 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33732
33733 @item Michael Snyder
33734 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33735 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33736 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33737 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33738 @end table
33739
33740 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33741 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33742
33743 @node Formatting Documentation
33744 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33745
33746 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33747 @cindex reference card
33748 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33749 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33750 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33751 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33752 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33753 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33754
33755 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33756 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33757
33758 @smallexample
33759 make refcard.dvi
33760 @end smallexample
33761
33762 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33763 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33764 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33765 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33766 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33767
33768 @cindex documentation
33769
33770 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33771 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33772 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33773 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33774 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33775 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33776
33777 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33778 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33779 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33780 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33781 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33782 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33783 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33784 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33785
33786 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33787 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33788 @code{makeinfo}.
33789
33790 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33791 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33792 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33793
33794 @smallexample
33795 cd gdb
33796 make gdb.info
33797 @end smallexample
33798
33799 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33800 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33801 Texinfo definitions file.
33802
33803 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33804 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33805 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33806 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33807 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33808 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33809 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33810
33811 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33812 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33813 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33814 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33815 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33816 directory.
33817
33818 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33819 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33820 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33821 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33822
33823 @smallexample
33824 make gdb.dvi
33825 @end smallexample
33826
33827 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33828
33829 @node Installing GDB
33830 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33831 @cindex installation
33832
33833 @menu
33834 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33835 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33836 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33837 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33838 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33839 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33840 @end menu
33841
33842 @node Requirements
33843 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33844 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33845
33846 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33847 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33848
33849 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33850 @table @asis
33851 @item ISO C90 compiler
33852 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33853 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33854
33855 @end table
33856
33857 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33858 @table @asis
33859 @item Expat
33860 @anchor{Expat}
33861 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33862 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33863 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33864 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33865 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33866 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33867
33868 Expat is used for:
33869
33870 @itemize @bullet
33871 @item
33872 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33873 @item
33874 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33875 @item
33876 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33877 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33878 @item
33879 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33880 @item
33881 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33882 @item
33883 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33884 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33885 @end itemize
33886
33887 @item zlib
33888 @cindex compressed debug sections
33889 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33890 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33891 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33892 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33893 information in such binaries.
33894
33895 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33896 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33897 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33898
33899 @item iconv
33900 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33901 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33902 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33903 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33904
33905 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33906 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33907 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33908 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33909
33910 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33911 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33912 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33913
33914 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33915 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33916 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33917 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33918 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33919 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33920 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33921 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33922 @end table
33923
33924 @node Running Configure
33925 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33926 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33927 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33928 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33929 build the @code{gdb} program.
33930 @iftex
33931 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33932 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33933 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33934 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33935 @end iftex
33936
33937 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33938 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33939 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33940
33941 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33942 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33943
33944 @table @code
33945 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33946 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33947
33948 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33949 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33950
33951 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33952 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33953
33954 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33955 @sc{gnu} include files
33956
33957 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33958 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33959
33960 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33961 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33962
33963 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33964 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33965
33966 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33967 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33968
33969 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33970 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33971 @end table
33972
33973 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33974 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33975 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33976
33977 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33978 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
33979 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33980 argument.
33981
33982 For example:
33983
33984 @smallexample
33985 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33986 ./configure @var{host}
33987 make
33988 @end smallexample
33989
33990 @noindent
33991 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33992 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33993 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33994 correct value by examining your system.)
33995
33996 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33997 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33998 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
33999 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
34000
34001 @need 750
34002 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
34003 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
34004 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
34005
34006 @smallexample
34007 sh configure @var{host}
34008 @end smallexample
34009
34010 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
34011 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
34012 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
34013 @file{configure}
34014 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
34015 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
34016
34017 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
34018 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
34019 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
34020 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
34021 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
34022 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
34023 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
34024 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
34025 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34026
34027 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
34028 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
34029 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
34030 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
34031 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
34032
34033 @node Separate Objdir
34034 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
34035
34036 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
34037 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
34038 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
34039 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
34040 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
34041 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
34042 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
34043 program specified there.
34044
34045 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
34046 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
34047 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
34048 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
34049 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
34050 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
34051
34052 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
34053 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
34054
34055 @smallexample
34056 @group
34057 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34058 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
34059 cd ../gdb-sun4
34060 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
34061 make
34062 @end group
34063 @end smallexample
34064
34065 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
34066 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
34067 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
34068 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
34069 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
34070 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
34071
34072 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
34073 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
34074 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
34075 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
34076 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34077
34078 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
34079 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
34080 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
34081 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
34082 You specify a cross-debugging target by
34083 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
34084
34085 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
34086 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
34087 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
34088
34089 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
34090 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
34091 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
34092 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
34093 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
34094
34095 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
34096 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
34097 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
34098 with each other.
34099
34100 @node Config Names
34101 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
34102
34103 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
34104 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
34105 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
34106 of information in the following pattern:
34107
34108 @smallexample
34109 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
34110 @end smallexample
34111
34112 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
34113 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
34114 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
34115
34116 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
34117 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
34118 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
34119 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
34120 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
34121 abbreviations---for example:
34122
34123 @smallexample
34124 % sh config.sub i386-linux
34125 i386-pc-linux-gnu
34126 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
34127 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
34128 % sh config.sub hp9k700
34129 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
34130 % sh config.sub sun4
34131 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
34132 % sh config.sub sun3
34133 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
34134 % sh config.sub i986v
34135 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
34136 @end smallexample
34137
34138 @noindent
34139 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
34140 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
34141
34142 @node Configure Options
34143 @section @file{configure} Options
34144
34145 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
34146 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
34147 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
34148 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
34149
34150 @smallexample
34151 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
34152 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34153 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34154 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
34155 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34156 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34157 @var{host}
34158 @end smallexample
34159
34160 @noindent
34161 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34162 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34163 @samp{--}.
34164
34165 @table @code
34166 @item --help
34167 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34168
34169 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
34170 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34171 @file{@var{dir}}.
34172
34173 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34174 Configure the source to install programs under directory
34175 @file{@var{dir}}.
34176
34177 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34178 @need 2000
34179 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34180 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34181 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34182 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34183 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
34184 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34185 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34186 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34187 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
34188 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34189 @var{dirname}.
34190
34191 @item --norecursion
34192 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34193 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34194
34195 @item --target=@var{target}
34196 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34197 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34198 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34199
34200 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34201
34202 @item @var{host} @dots{}
34203 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34204
34205 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34206 @end table
34207
34208 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34209 needed for special purposes only.
34210
34211 @node System-wide configuration
34212 @section System-wide configuration and settings
34213 @cindex system-wide init file
34214
34215 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34216 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34217 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34218
34219 Here is the corresponding configure option:
34220
34221 @table @code
34222 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34223 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34224 @var{file}.
34225 @end table
34226
34227 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34228 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
34229
34230 @itemize @bullet
34231 @item
34232 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34233 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
34234 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34235 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34236 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34237 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34238
34239 @item
34240 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34241 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34242 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34243 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34244 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34245 @end itemize
34246
34247 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34248 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34249 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34250 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34251 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34252 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34253 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34254 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34255 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34256 reread.
34257
34258 @menu
34259 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34260 @end menu
34261
34262 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34263 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34264 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34265
34266 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34267 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34268 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
34269 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34270 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
34271 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34272
34273 The following scripts are currently available:
34274 @itemize @bullet
34275
34276 @item @file{elinos.py}
34277 @pindex elinos.py
34278 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34279 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34280 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34281 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34282 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34283 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34284
34285 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34286 @pindex wrs-linux.py
34287 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34288 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34289 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34290 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34291
34292 @end itemize
34293
34294 @node Maintenance Commands
34295 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34296 @cindex maintenance commands
34297 @cindex internal commands
34298
34299 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34300 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34301 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34302 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34303 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34304
34305 @table @code
34306 @kindex maint agent
34307 @kindex maint agent-eval
34308 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34309 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34310 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34311 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34312 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34313 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34314 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34315 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34316 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34317 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34318 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34319 addition and return the sum.
34320 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34321 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34322
34323 @kindex maint agent-printf
34324 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34325 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34326 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34327 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34328 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34329
34330 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34331 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34332 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34333 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34334 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34335 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34336 is shown:
34337
34338 @table @code
34339 @item breakpoint
34340 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34341
34342 @item watchpoint
34343 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34344
34345 @item longjmp
34346 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34347 @code{longjmp} calls.
34348
34349 @item longjmp resume
34350 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34351
34352 @item until
34353 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34354
34355 @item finish
34356 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34357
34358 @item shlib events
34359 Shared library events.
34360
34361 @end table
34362
34363 @kindex maint info btrace
34364 @item maint info btrace
34365 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34366
34367 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34368 @item maint btrace packet-history
34369 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34370 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34371 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34372 recording format.
34373
34374 @table @code
34375 @item bts
34376 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34377 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34378
34379 @table @asis
34380 @item Block number
34381 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34382 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34383 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34384 @end table
34385
34386 @item pt
34387 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34388 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34389 information is printed:
34390
34391 @table @asis
34392 @item Packet number
34393 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34394 @item Trace offset
34395 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34396 @item Packet opcode and payload
34397 @end table
34398 @end table
34399
34400 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34401 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34402 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34403 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34404 needed.
34405
34406 @kindex maint btrace clear
34407 @item maint btrace clear
34408 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34409 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34410
34411 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34412 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34413 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34414 buffer.
34415
34416 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34417 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34418 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34419 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34420 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34421 packet history.
34422
34423 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34424 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34425 @cindex displaced stepping support
34426 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34427 @item set displaced-stepping
34428 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34429 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34430 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34431 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34432 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34433 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34434
34435 @table @code
34436 @item set displaced-stepping on
34437 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34438 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34439
34440 @item set displaced-stepping off
34441 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34442 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34443
34444 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34445 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34446 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34447 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34448 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34449 @end table
34450
34451 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34452 @item maint check-psymtabs
34453 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34454 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34455
34456 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34457 @item maint check-symtabs
34458 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34459
34460 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34461 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34462 Expand symbol tables.
34463 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34464 names matching @var{regexp}.
34465
34466 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34467 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34468 @cindex demangler crashes
34469 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34470 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34471 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34472 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34473 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34474 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34475 option to terminate the current session.
34476
34477 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34478 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34479 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34480
34481 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34482 @item maint cplus namespace
34483 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34484
34485 @kindex maint deprecate
34486 @kindex maint undeprecate
34487 @cindex deprecated commands
34488 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34489 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34490 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34491 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34492 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34493 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34494 the replacement as part of the warning.
34495
34496 @kindex maint dump-me
34497 @item maint dump-me
34498 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34499 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34500 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34501 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34502
34503 @kindex maint internal-error
34504 @kindex maint internal-warning
34505 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34506 @cindex demangler crashes
34507 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34508 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34509 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34510
34511 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34512 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34513 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34514 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34515 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34516 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34517 @value{GDBN} session.
34518
34519 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34520 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34521
34522 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34523
34524 @smallexample
34525 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34526 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34527 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34528 debugging may prove unreliable.
34529 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34530 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34531 (@value{GDBP})
34532 @end smallexample
34533
34534 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34535 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34536 @cindex demangler crashes
34537
34538 @kindex maint set internal-error
34539 @kindex maint show internal-error
34540 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34541 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34542 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34543 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34544 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34545 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34546 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34547 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34548 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34549 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34550 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34551 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34552 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34553 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34554 described in the table below.
34555
34556 @table @samp
34557 @item quit
34558 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34559 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34560
34561 @item corefile
34562 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34563 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34564 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34565 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34566 disabled.
34567 @end table
34568
34569 @kindex maint packet
34570 @item maint packet @var{text}
34571 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34572 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34573 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34574 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34575 checksum.
34576
34577 @kindex maint print architecture
34578 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34579 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34580 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34581
34582 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
34583 @item maint print c-tdesc
34584 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34585 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
34586 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
34587
34588 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34589 @item maint print dummy-frames
34590 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34591
34592 @smallexample
34593 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34594 @dots{}
34595 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34596 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34597 58 return (a + b);
34598 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34599 @dots{}
34600 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34601 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34602 (@value{GDBP})
34603 @end smallexample
34604
34605 Takes an optional file parameter.
34606
34607 @kindex maint print registers
34608 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34609 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34610 @kindex maint print register-groups
34611 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34612 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34613 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34614 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34615 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34616 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34617 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34618
34619 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34620 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34621 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34622 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34623 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34624 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34625 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34626 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34627
34628 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34629 write the information.
34630
34631 @kindex maint print reggroups
34632 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34633 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34634 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34635 information.
34636
34637 The register groups info looks like this:
34638
34639 @smallexample
34640 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34641 Group Type
34642 general user
34643 float user
34644 all user
34645 vector user
34646 system user
34647 save internal
34648 restore internal
34649 @end smallexample
34650
34651 @kindex flushregs
34652 @item flushregs
34653 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34654
34655 @kindex maint print objfiles
34656 @cindex info for known object files
34657 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34658 Print a dump of all known object files.
34659 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34660 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34661 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34662
34663 @kindex maint print user-registers
34664 @cindex user registers
34665 @item maint print user-registers
34666 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34667 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34668 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34669 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34670 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34671 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34672 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34673
34674 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34675 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34676 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34677 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34678 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34679 matching @var{regexp}.
34680 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34681 and the full path if known.
34682 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34683
34684 @kindex maint print statistics
34685 @cindex bcache statistics
34686 @item maint print statistics
34687 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34688 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34689 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34690 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34691 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34692 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34693 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34694 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34695 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34696 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34697 lengths.
34698
34699 @kindex maint print target-stack
34700 @cindex target stack description
34701 @item maint print target-stack
34702 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34703 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34704 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34705 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34706 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34707 address.
34708
34709 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34710 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34711
34712 @kindex maint print type
34713 @cindex type chain of a data type
34714 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34715 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34716 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34717 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34718 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34719 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34720
34721 @kindex maint selftest
34722 @cindex self tests
34723 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
34724 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
34725
34726 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34727 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34728 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34729 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34730 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34731 information.
34732
34733 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34734 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34735 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34736 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34737 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34738 always see the disassembly form.
34739
34740 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34741
34742 @smallexample
34743 (gdb) info addr argc
34744 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34745 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34746 @end smallexample
34747
34748 For more information on these expressions, see
34749 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34750
34751 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34752 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34753 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34754 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34755 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
34756
34757 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
34758 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34759 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
34760 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34761 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34762 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34763 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34764 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34765 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34766
34767 @kindex maint set profile
34768 @kindex maint show profile
34769 @cindex profiling GDB
34770 @item maint set profile
34771 @itemx maint show profile
34772 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34773
34774 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34775 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34776 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34777 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34778 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34779 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34780 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34781
34782 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34783 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34784
34785 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34786 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34787 @cindex hardware debug registers
34788 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34789 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34790 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34791 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34792 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34793 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34794 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34795
34796 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34797 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34798 @item maint set show-all-tib
34799 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34800 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34801 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34802 command.
34803
34804 @kindex maint set target-async
34805 @kindex maint show target-async
34806 @item maint set target-async
34807 @itemx maint show target-async
34808 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34809 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34810 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34811 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34812
34813 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
34814 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
34815 @item maint set target-non-stop
34816 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
34817
34818 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
34819 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
34820 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
34821 if supported by the target.
34822
34823 @table @code
34824 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
34825 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
34826 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
34827
34828 @item maint set target-non-stop on
34829 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
34830 does not indicate support.
34831
34832 @item maint set target-non-stop off
34833 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
34834 target supports it.
34835 @end table
34836
34837 @kindex maint set per-command
34838 @kindex maint show per-command
34839 @item maint set per-command
34840 @itemx maint show per-command
34841 @cindex resources used by commands
34842
34843 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34844 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34845
34846 @table @code
34847 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34848 @itemx maint show per-command space
34849 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34850 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34851 took, following the command's own output.
34852 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34853 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34854
34855 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34856 @itemx maint show per-command time
34857 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34858 for each command.
34859 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34860 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34861 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34862 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34863 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34864 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34865 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34866 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34867 spent by the program been debugged.
34868 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34869 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34870
34871 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34872 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34873 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34874 for each command.
34875 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34876
34877 @enumerate a
34878 @item
34879 number of symbol tables
34880 @item
34881 number of primary symbol tables
34882 @item
34883 number of blocks in the blockvector
34884 @end enumerate
34885 @end table
34886
34887 @kindex maint space
34888 @cindex memory used by commands
34889 @item maint space @var{value}
34890 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34891 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34892
34893 @kindex maint time
34894 @cindex time of command execution
34895 @item maint time @var{value}
34896 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34897 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34898
34899 @kindex maint translate-address
34900 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34901 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34902 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34903 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34904 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34905 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34906 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34907
34908 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34909 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34910 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34911
34912 @end table
34913
34914 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34915 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34916
34917 @table @code
34918 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34919 @kindex set watchdog
34920 @cindex watchdog timer
34921 @cindex timeout for commands
34922 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34923 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34924 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34925
34926 @item show watchdog
34927 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34928 @end table
34929
34930 @node Remote Protocol
34931 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34932
34933 @menu
34934 * Overview::
34935 * Packets::
34936 * Stop Reply Packets::
34937 * General Query Packets::
34938 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34939 * Tracepoint Packets::
34940 * Host I/O Packets::
34941 * Interrupts::
34942 * Notification Packets::
34943 * Remote Non-Stop::
34944 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34945 * Examples::
34946 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34947 * Library List Format::
34948 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34949 * Memory Map Format::
34950 * Thread List Format::
34951 * Traceframe Info Format::
34952 * Branch Trace Format::
34953 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34954 @end menu
34955
34956 @node Overview
34957 @section Overview
34958
34959 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34960 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34961 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34962 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34963
34964 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34965 transmitted and received data, respectively.
34966
34967 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34968 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34969 @cindex remote serial protocol
34970 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34971 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34972 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34973 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34974 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34975
34976 @smallexample
34977 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34978 @end smallexample
34979 @noindent
34980
34981 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34982 @noindent
34983 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34984 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34985 eight bit unsigned checksum).
34986
34987 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34988 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34989
34990 @smallexample
34991 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34992 @end smallexample
34993
34994 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34995 @noindent
34996 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
34997 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
34998 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34999
35000 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
35001 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
35002 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
35003 retransmission):
35004
35005 @smallexample
35006 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35007 <- @code{+}
35008 @end smallexample
35009 @noindent
35010
35011 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
35012 once a connection is established.
35013 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
35014
35015 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
35016 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
35017 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
35018 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
35019 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
35020 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
35021 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
35022
35023 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
35024 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
35025 exceptions).
35026
35027 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
35028 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
35029 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
35030 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
35031
35032 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
35033 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
35034 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
35035
35036 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
35037 @anchor{Binary Data}
35038 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
35039 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
35040 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
35041 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
35042 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
35043 binary data.
35044
35045 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
35046 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
35047 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
35048 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
35049 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
35050 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
35051 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
35052 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
35053 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
35054 (described next).
35055
35056 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
35057 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
35058 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
35059 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
35060 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
35061 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
35062 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
35063 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
35064 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
35065 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
35066 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
35067 3}} more times.
35068
35069 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
35070 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
35071 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
35072 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
35073 @samp{0*"00}.
35074
35075 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
35076 error number. That number is not well defined.
35077
35078 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
35079 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
35080 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
35081 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
35082 on that response.
35083
35084 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
35085 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
35086 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
35087 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
35088 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
35089 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
35090
35091 @node Packets
35092 @section Packets
35093
35094 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
35095 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
35096 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
35097 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
35098
35099 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
35100 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
35101 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
35102 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
35103 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
35104 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
35105 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
35106 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
35107 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
35108 @var{baz}.
35109
35110 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
35111 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
35112 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
35113 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
35114 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
35115 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
35116 pick any thread.
35117
35118 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
35119 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
35120 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
35121 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
35122 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
35123 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
35124 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
35125 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
35126 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
35127 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
35128 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
35129 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
35130 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
35131
35132 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
35133 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
35134 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
35135 more information.
35136
35137 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
35138 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
35139
35140 Here are the packet descriptions.
35141
35142 @table @samp
35143
35144 @item !
35145 @cindex @samp{!} packet
35146 @anchor{extended mode}
35147 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
35148 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
35149 debugged.
35150
35151 Reply:
35152 @table @samp
35153 @item OK
35154 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
35155 @end table
35156
35157 @item ?
35158 @cindex @samp{?} packet
35159 @anchor{? packet}
35160 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
35161 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
35162 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35163
35164 Reply:
35165 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35166
35167 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
35168 @cindex @samp{A} packet
35169 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
35170 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
35171 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
35172
35173 Reply:
35174 @table @samp
35175 @item OK
35176 The arguments were set.
35177 @item E @var{NN}
35178 An error occurred.
35179 @end table
35180
35181 @item b @var{baud}
35182 @cindex @samp{b} packet
35183 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35184 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35185
35186 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
35187 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
35188 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35189
35190 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35191 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35192 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35193 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35194 of view, nothing actually happened.}
35195
35196 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35197 @cindex @samp{B} packet
35198 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35199 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35200
35201 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35202 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35203
35204 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
35205 @anchor{bc}
35206 @item bc
35207 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
35208 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35209
35210 Reply:
35211 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35212
35213 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
35214 @anchor{bs}
35215 @item bs
35216 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
35217 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35218
35219 Reply:
35220 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35221
35222 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35223 @cindex @samp{c} packet
35224 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
35225 is omitted, resume at current address.
35226
35227 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35228 packet}.
35229
35230 Reply:
35231 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35232
35233 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35234 @cindex @samp{C} packet
35235 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
35236 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35237
35238 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35239 packet}.
35240
35241 Reply:
35242 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35243
35244 @item d
35245 @cindex @samp{d} packet
35246 Toggle debug flag.
35247
35248 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35249 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35250
35251 @item D
35252 @itemx D;@var{pid}
35253 @cindex @samp{D} packet
35254 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35255 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
35256 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35257
35258 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35259 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35260 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
35261 big-endian hex string.
35262
35263 Reply:
35264 @table @samp
35265 @item OK
35266 for success
35267 @item E @var{NN}
35268 for an error
35269 @end table
35270
35271 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35272 @cindex @samp{F} packet
35273 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35274 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35275 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35276
35277 @item g
35278 @anchor{read registers packet}
35279 @cindex @samp{g} packet
35280 Read general registers.
35281
35282 Reply:
35283 @table @samp
35284 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35285 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35286 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35287 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35288 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35289 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
35290
35291 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35292 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35293 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35294 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35295 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
35296 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35297 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35298 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35299
35300 @smallexample
35301 -> @code{g}
35302 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35303 @end smallexample
35304
35305 @item E @var{NN}
35306 for an error.
35307 @end table
35308
35309 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35310 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35311 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35312 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35313
35314 Reply:
35315 @table @samp
35316 @item OK
35317 for success
35318 @item E @var{NN}
35319 for an error
35320 @end table
35321
35322 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35323 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35324 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35325 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35326 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35327 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35328 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35329 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35330 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35331
35332 Reply:
35333 @table @samp
35334 @item OK
35335 for success
35336 @item E @var{NN}
35337 for an error
35338 @end table
35339
35340 @c FIXME: JTC:
35341 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35342 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35343 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35344 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35345 @c described. For example:
35346 @c
35347 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35348 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35349 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35350 @c
35351 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35352 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35353 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35354
35355 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35356 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35357 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35358 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35359 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35360 step starting at that address.
35361
35362 @item I
35363 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35364 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35365 step packet}.
35366
35367 @item k
35368 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35369 Kill request.
35370
35371 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35372
35373 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35374 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35375
35376 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35377
35378 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35379 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35380 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35381
35382 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35383 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35384 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35385
35386 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35387 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35388 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35389 (@pxref{? packet}).
35390
35391 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35392 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35393 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35394 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35395 any particular boundary.
35396
35397 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35398 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35399 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35400 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35401 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35402 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35403 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35404 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35405
35406 Reply:
35407 @table @samp
35408 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35409 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35410 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35411 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35412 @item E @var{NN}
35413 @var{NN} is errno
35414 @end table
35415
35416 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35417 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35418 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35419 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35420 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35421
35422 Reply:
35423 @table @samp
35424 @item OK
35425 for success
35426 @item E @var{NN}
35427 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35428 written).
35429 @end table
35430
35431 @item p @var{n}
35432 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35433 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35434 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35435 register value is encoded.
35436
35437 Reply:
35438 @table @samp
35439 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35440 the register's value
35441 @item E @var{NN}
35442 for an error
35443 @item @w{}
35444 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35445 @end table
35446
35447 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35448 @anchor{write register packet}
35449 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35450 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35451 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35452 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35453
35454 Reply:
35455 @table @samp
35456 @item OK
35457 for success
35458 @item E @var{NN}
35459 for an error
35460 @end table
35461
35462 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35463 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35464 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35465 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35466 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35467 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35468
35469 @item r
35470 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35471 Reset the entire system.
35472
35473 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35474
35475 @item R @var{XX}
35476 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35477 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35478 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35479
35480 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35481
35482 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35483 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35484 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35485 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35486
35487 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35488 packet}.
35489
35490 Reply:
35491 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35492
35493 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35494 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35495 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35496 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35497 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35498
35499 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35500 packet}.
35501
35502 Reply:
35503 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35504
35505 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35506 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35507 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35508 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35509 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35510
35511 @item T @var{thread-id}
35512 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35513 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35514
35515 Reply:
35516 @table @samp
35517 @item OK
35518 thread is still alive
35519 @item E @var{NN}
35520 thread is dead
35521 @end table
35522
35523 @item v
35524 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35525 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35526
35527 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35528 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35529 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35530 The process ID is a
35531 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35532 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35533 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35534
35535 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35536 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35537 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35538 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35539 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35540 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35541 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35542 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35543
35544 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35545
35546 Reply:
35547 @table @samp
35548 @item E @var{nn}
35549 for an error
35550 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35551 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35552 @item OK
35553 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35554 @end table
35555
35556 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35557 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35558 @anchor{vCont packet}
35559 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35560
35561 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
35562 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
35563 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
35564 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
35565 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
35566 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
35567 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
35568 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
35569 error.
35570
35571 Currently supported actions are:
35572
35573 @table @samp
35574 @item c
35575 Continue.
35576 @item C @var{sig}
35577 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35578 @item s
35579 Step.
35580 @item S @var{sig}
35581 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35582 @item t
35583 Stop.
35584 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35585 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35586 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35587 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35588 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35589 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35590
35591 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35592 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35593 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35594 jumps to @var{start}).
35595
35596 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35597 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35598 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35599
35600 @end table
35601
35602 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35603 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35604 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35605
35606 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35607 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35608 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35609 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35610 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35611 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35612 as an implementation detail.
35613
35614 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
35615 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
35616 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
35617 stopped.
35618
35619 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
35620 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
35621 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
35622
35623 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35624 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
35625
35626 Reply:
35627 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35628
35629 @item vCont?
35630 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35631 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35632
35633 Reply:
35634 @table @samp
35635 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35636 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
35637 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35638 @item @w{}
35639 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35640 @end table
35641
35642 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
35643 @item vCtrlC
35644 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
35645 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
35646 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
35647 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
35648 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
35649 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
35650 variant.
35651
35652 Reply:
35653 @table @samp
35654 @item E @var{nn}
35655 for an error
35656 @item OK
35657 for success
35658 @end table
35659
35660 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35661 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35662 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
35663 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35664
35665 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35666 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35667 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35668 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35669 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35670 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35671 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35672 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35673 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35674 packet is received.
35675
35676 Reply:
35677 @table @samp
35678 @item OK
35679 for success
35680 @item E @var{NN}
35681 for an error
35682 @end table
35683
35684 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35685 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35686 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35687 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35688 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35689 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35690 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35691 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35692 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35693 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35694 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35695 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35696
35697
35698 Reply:
35699 @table @samp
35700 @item OK
35701 for success
35702 @item E.memtype
35703 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35704 @item E @var{NN}
35705 for an error
35706 @end table
35707
35708 @item vFlashDone
35709 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35710 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35711 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35712 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35713 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35714 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35715 request is completed.
35716
35717 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35718 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35719 @anchor{vKill packet}
35720 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35721 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35722 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35723 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35724
35725 Reply:
35726 @table @samp
35727 @item E @var{nn}
35728 for an error
35729 @item OK
35730 for success
35731 @end table
35732
35733 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35734 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35735 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35736 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35737 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35738 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35739 state.
35740
35741 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35742
35743 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35744
35745 Reply:
35746 @table @samp
35747 @item E @var{nn}
35748 for an error
35749 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35750 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35751 @end table
35752
35753 @item vStopped
35754 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35755 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35756
35757 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35758 @anchor{X packet}
35759 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35760 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35761 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
35762 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
35763 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35764
35765 Reply:
35766 @table @samp
35767 @item OK
35768 for success
35769 @item E @var{NN}
35770 for an error
35771 @end table
35772
35773 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35774 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35775 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35776 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35777 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35778 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35779 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35780
35781 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35782 separately.
35783
35784 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35785 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35786 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35787 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35788 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35789 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35790
35791 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35792 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35793 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35794 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35795 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
35796 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35797
35798 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35799 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35800 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
35801 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
35802 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35803 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
35804 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
35805 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
35806 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
35807 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
35808 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
35809 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
35810 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35811
35812 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35813 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35814
35815 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35816 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35817
35818 @table @samp
35819
35820 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35821 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35822 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35823
35824 @end table
35825
35826 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35827 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35828 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35829 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35830 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35831 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35832 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35833
35834 @table @samp
35835
35836 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35837 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35838 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35839
35840 @end table
35841
35842 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35843 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35844 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35845 target, is not defined.}
35846
35847 Reply:
35848 @table @samp
35849 @item OK
35850 success
35851 @item @w{}
35852 not supported
35853 @item E @var{NN}
35854 for an error
35855 @end table
35856
35857 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35858 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35859 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35860 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35861 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35862 address @var{addr}.
35863
35864 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35865 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
35866 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
35867 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35868
35869 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35870 movement.}
35871
35872 Reply:
35873 @table @samp
35874 @item OK
35875 success
35876 @item @w{}
35877 not supported
35878 @item E @var{NN}
35879 for an error
35880 @end table
35881
35882 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35883 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35884 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35885 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35886 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35887 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35888
35889 Reply:
35890 @table @samp
35891 @item OK
35892 success
35893 @item @w{}
35894 not supported
35895 @item E @var{NN}
35896 for an error
35897 @end table
35898
35899 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35900 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35901 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35902 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35903 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35904 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35905
35906 Reply:
35907 @table @samp
35908 @item OK
35909 success
35910 @item @w{}
35911 not supported
35912 @item E @var{NN}
35913 for an error
35914 @end table
35915
35916 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35917 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35918 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35919 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35920 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35921 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35922
35923 Reply:
35924 @table @samp
35925 @item OK
35926 success
35927 @item @w{}
35928 not supported
35929 @item E @var{NN}
35930 for an error
35931 @end table
35932
35933 @end table
35934
35935 @node Stop Reply Packets
35936 @section Stop Reply Packets
35937 @cindex stop reply packets
35938
35939 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35940 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35941 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35942 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35943 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35944 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35945 @value{GDBN} source code.
35946
35947 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
35948 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
35949 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35950
35951 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35952 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35953 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35954 components.
35955
35956 @table @samp
35957
35958 @item S @var{AA}
35959 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35960 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35961 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35962
35963 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35964 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35965 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35966 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35967 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35968 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35969 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35970 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35971
35972 @itemize @bullet
35973 @item
35974 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35975 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
35976 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35977 two-digit hex number.
35978
35979 @item
35980 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35981 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35982
35983 @item
35984 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35985 the core on which the stop event was detected.
35986
35987 @item
35988 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35989 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
35990 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35991 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
35992
35993 @item
35994 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35995 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35996 future.
35997 @end itemize
35998
35999 The currently defined stop reasons are:
36000
36001 @table @samp
36002 @item watch
36003 @itemx rwatch
36004 @itemx awatch
36005 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
36006 hex.
36007
36008 @item syscall_entry
36009 @itemx syscall_return
36010 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
36011 syscall number, in hex.
36012
36013 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
36014 @item library
36015 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
36016 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
36017 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
36018
36019 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
36020 @item replaylog
36021 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
36022 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
36023 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
36024 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
36025 for more information.
36026
36027 @item swbreak
36028 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
36029 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
36030 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
36031 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
36032 part must be left empty.
36033
36034 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
36035 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
36036 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
36037 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
36038 address.
36039
36040 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36041 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36042 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36043 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36044 indicating support.
36045
36046 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
36047
36048 @item hwbreak
36049 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
36050 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
36051
36052 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
36053 apply.
36054
36055 @cindex fork events, remote reply
36056 @item fork
36057 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
36058 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36059 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36060 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36061 fork events.
36062
36063 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36064 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36065 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36066 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36067 indicating support.
36068
36069 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
36070 @item vfork
36071 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
36072 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36073 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36074 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36075 vfork events.
36076
36077 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36078 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36079 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36080 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36081 indicating support.
36082
36083 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
36084 @item vforkdone
36085 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
36086 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
36087 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
36088 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
36089 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
36090
36091 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36092 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36093 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36094 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36095 indicating support.
36096
36097 @cindex exec events, remote reply
36098 @item exec
36099 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
36100 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
36101 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
36102
36103 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36104 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36105 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36106 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36107 indicating support.
36108
36109 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
36110 @anchor{thread create event}
36111 @item create
36112 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
36113 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
36114 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
36115 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
36116 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
36117 @var{r} part is ignored.
36118
36119 @end table
36120
36121 @item W @var{AA}
36122 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36123 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
36124 applicable to certain targets.
36125
36126 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36127 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36128 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36129 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36130 hex strings.
36131
36132 @item X @var{AA}
36133 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36134 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
36135
36136 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36137 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36138 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36139 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36140 hex strings.
36141
36142 @anchor{thread exit event}
36143 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
36144 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
36145
36146 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
36147 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
36148 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
36149 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36150
36151 @item N
36152 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
36153 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
36154 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
36155 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
36156 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
36157 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
36158 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
36159 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
36160 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
36161 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
36162 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
36163 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
36164 support.
36165
36166 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
36167 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
36168 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
36169 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
36170 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
36171
36172 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
36173 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
36174 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
36175 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
36176 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
36177 system calls.
36178
36179 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
36180 this very system call.
36181
36182 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
36183 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
36184 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
36185 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36186 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
36187 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
36188
36189 @end table
36190
36191 @node General Query Packets
36192 @section General Query Packets
36193 @cindex remote query requests
36194
36195 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
36196 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
36197 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
36198 sending information to and from the stub.
36199
36200 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
36201 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
36202 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
36203 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
36204 conventions:
36205
36206 @itemize @bullet
36207 @item
36208 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
36209 @item
36210 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
36211 letter.
36212 @item
36213 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
36214 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
36215 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
36216 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
36217 @end itemize
36218
36219 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
36220 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
36221 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
36222 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
36223 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
36224 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
36225 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
36226 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
36227 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36228 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36229 packet.}.
36230
36231 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36232 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36233 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
36234 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
36235 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36236
36237 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36238
36239 @table @samp
36240
36241 @item QAgent:1
36242 @itemx QAgent:0
36243 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36244 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36245
36246 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36247 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36248 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36249 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36250 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36251 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36252 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36253 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36254 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
36255 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36256 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36257
36258 @item qC
36259 @cindex current thread, remote request
36260 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
36261 Return the current thread ID.
36262
36263 Reply:
36264 @table @samp
36265 @item QC @var{thread-id}
36266 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36267 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36268 @item @r{(anything else)}
36269 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36270 @end table
36271
36272 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36273 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36274 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36275 @anchor{qCRC packet}
36276 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36277 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36278 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
36279 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36280
36281 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36282 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36283 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
36284 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36285 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36286 detect trailing zeros.
36287
36288 Reply:
36289 @table @samp
36290 @item E @var{NN}
36291 An error (such as memory fault)
36292 @item C @var{crc32}
36293 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36294 @end table
36295
36296 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36297 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36298 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36299 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36300 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36301 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36302 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36303 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36304 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36305 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36306 randomization.
36307
36308 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36309
36310 Reply:
36311 @table @samp
36312 @item OK
36313 The request succeeded.
36314
36315 @item E @var{nn}
36316 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36317
36318 @item @w{}
36319 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36320 by the stub.
36321 @end table
36322
36323 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36324 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36325 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36326 address space randomization.
36327
36328 @item qfThreadInfo
36329 @itemx qsThreadInfo
36330 @cindex list active threads, remote request
36331 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36332 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36333 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36334 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36335 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36336 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36337 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36338 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36339
36340 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36341
36342 Reply:
36343 @table @samp
36344 @item m @var{thread-id}
36345 A single thread ID
36346 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36347 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36348 @item l
36349 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36350 @end table
36351
36352 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36353 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36354 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36355 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36356 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36357 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36358 fields.
36359
36360 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36361 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36362 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36363 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36364 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36365
36366 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36367 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36368 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36369 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36370 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36371
36372 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36373 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36374
36375 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36376 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
36377 information associated with the variable.)
36378
36379 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36380 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
36381 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36382 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36383 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36384 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36385
36386 Reply:
36387 @table @samp
36388 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36389 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36390 local storage requested.
36391
36392 @item E @var{nn}
36393 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36394
36395 @item @w{}
36396 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36397 @end table
36398
36399 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36400 @cindex get thread information block address
36401 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36402 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36403
36404 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36405
36406 Reply:
36407 @table @samp
36408 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36409 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36410 thread information block.
36411
36412 @item E @var{nn}
36413 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36414 address could not be retrieved.
36415
36416 @item @w{}
36417 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36418 @end table
36419
36420 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
36421 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
36422 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
36423 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
36424 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36425 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36426 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36427
36428 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36429
36430 Reply:
36431 @table @samp
36432 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36433 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36434 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36435 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36436 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36437 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
36438 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36439 @end table
36440
36441 @item qOffsets
36442 @cindex section offsets, remote request
36443 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36444 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36445 image.
36446
36447 Reply:
36448 @table @samp
36449 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36450 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36451 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36452 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36453 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36454 segments by the supplied offsets.
36455
36456 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36457 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36458 to the @code{Bss} section.}
36459
36460 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36461 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36462 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
36463 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36464 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36465 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36466 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36467 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
36468 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36469 @end table
36470
36471 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36472 @cindex thread information, remote request
36473 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
36474 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36475 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36476 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36477
36478 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36479 (see below).
36480
36481 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36482
36483 @item QNonStop:1
36484 @itemx QNonStop:0
36485 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36486 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36487 @anchor{QNonStop}
36488 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36489 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36490
36491 Reply:
36492 @table @samp
36493 @item OK
36494 The request succeeded.
36495
36496 @item E @var{nn}
36497 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36498
36499 @item @w{}
36500 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
36501 the stub.
36502 @end table
36503
36504 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36505 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36506 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
36507 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
36508
36509 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
36510 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
36511 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
36512 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
36513 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
36514 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
36515 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
36516
36517 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
36518 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
36519 is listed, every system call should be reported.
36520
36521 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
36522 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
36523 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
36524 report the requested syscalls.
36525
36526 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
36527 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36528
36529 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
36530 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
36531 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
36532 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
36533
36534 Reply:
36535 @table @samp
36536 @item OK
36537 The request succeeded.
36538
36539 @item E @var{nn}
36540 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36541
36542 @item @w{}
36543 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
36544 the stub.
36545 @end table
36546
36547 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
36548 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
36549 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36550 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36551
36552 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36553 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
36554 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36555 @anchor{QPassSignals}
36556 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
36557 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36558 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36559 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
36560 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
36561 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
36562 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
36563 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
36564 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
36565
36566 Reply:
36567 @table @samp
36568 @item OK
36569 The request succeeded.
36570
36571 @item E @var{nn}
36572 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36573
36574 @item @w{}
36575 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
36576 the stub.
36577 @end table
36578
36579 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
36580 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
36581 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36582 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36583
36584 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36585 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
36586 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
36587 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
36588 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
36589 Others should be silently discarded.
36590
36591 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
36592 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
36593 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
36594 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
36595 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
36596 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
36597 signals.
36598
36599 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
36600 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
36601
36602 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36603 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36604 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
36605 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
36606 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36607
36608 Reply:
36609 @table @samp
36610 @item OK
36611 The request succeeded.
36612
36613 @item E @var{nn}
36614 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36615
36616 @item @w{}
36617 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
36618 by the stub.
36619 @end table
36620
36621 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
36622 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
36623 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36624 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36625
36626 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
36627 @item QThreadEvents:1
36628 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
36629 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
36630 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
36631
36632 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
36633 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
36634 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
36635 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
36636 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
36637 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
36638 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
36639 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
36640 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
36641 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36642
36643 Reply:
36644 @table @samp
36645 @item OK
36646 The request succeeded.
36647
36648 @item E @var{nn}
36649 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36650
36651 @item @w{}
36652 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
36653 the stub.
36654 @end table
36655
36656 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
36657 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
36658
36659 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
36660 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
36661 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
36662 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
36663 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
36664 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
36665 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
36666 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
36667 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
36668
36669 Reply:
36670 @table @samp
36671 @item OK
36672 A command response with no output.
36673 @item @var{OUTPUT}
36674 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
36675 @item E @var{NN}
36676 Indicate a badly formed request.
36677 @item @w{}
36678 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
36679 @end table
36680
36681 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
36682 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36683 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36684 packets.)
36685
36686 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
36687 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
36688 @ifnotinfo
36689 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
36690 @end ifnotinfo
36691 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
36692 @anchor{qSearch memory}
36693 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36694 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
36695 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
36696
36697 Reply:
36698 @table @samp
36699 @item 0
36700 The pattern was not found.
36701 @item 1,address
36702 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36703 @item E @var{NN}
36704 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36705 @item @w{}
36706 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36707 @end table
36708
36709 @item QStartNoAckMode
36710 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36711 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36712 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36713 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36714
36715 Reply:
36716 @table @samp
36717 @item OK
36718 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36719 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36720 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36721 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36722 @item @w{}
36723 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36724 @end table
36725
36726 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36727 @cindex supported packets, remote query
36728 @cindex features of the remote protocol
36729 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36730 @anchor{qSupported}
36731 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36732 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
36733 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36734 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36735 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36736 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36737 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
36738 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36739 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
36740 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
36741 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
36742 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36743 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36744 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
36745
36746 Reply:
36747 @table @samp
36748 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
36749 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
36750 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
36751 possible forms).
36752 @item @w{}
36753 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
36754 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
36755 @end table
36756
36757 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
36758 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
36759 are:
36760
36761 @table @samp
36762 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
36763 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
36764 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
36765 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
36766 @item @var{name}+
36767 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
36768 need an associated value.
36769 @item @var{name}-
36770 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
36771 @item @var{name}?
36772 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
36773 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
36774 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
36775 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
36776 @end table
36777
36778 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
36779 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
36780 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
36781 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
36782 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
36783
36784 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
36785 are defined:
36786
36787 @table @samp
36788 @item multiprocess
36789 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
36790 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36791 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36792 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36793 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
36794
36795 @item xmlRegisters
36796 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
36797 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
36798 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
36799 description.
36800
36801 @item qRelocInsn
36802 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
36803 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36804 instruction reply packet}).
36805
36806 @item swbreak
36807 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
36808 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36809
36810 @item hwbreak
36811 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
36812 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36813
36814 @item fork-events
36815 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
36816 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36817 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36818 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36819
36820 @item vfork-events
36821 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
36822 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36823 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36824 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36825
36826 @item exec-events
36827 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
36828 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36829 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36830 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36831
36832 @item vContSupported
36833 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
36834 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
36835 @end table
36836
36837 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
36838 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
36839 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
36840 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
36841 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
36842 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
36843 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
36844 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
36845 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
36846 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
36847 all the features it supports.
36848
36849 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
36850 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
36851
36852 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
36853 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
36854 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
36855 form response.
36856
36857 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
36858 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
36859 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
36860 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
36861
36862 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
36863 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
36864 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
36865 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
36866 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
36867
36868 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36869
36870 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36871 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36872 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36873 @item Feature Name
36874 @tab Value Required
36875 @tab Default
36876 @tab Probe Allowed
36877
36878 @item @samp{PacketSize}
36879 @tab Yes
36880 @tab @samp{-}
36881 @tab No
36882
36883 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36884 @tab No
36885 @tab @samp{-}
36886 @tab Yes
36887
36888 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36889 @tab No
36890 @tab @samp{-}
36891 @tab Yes
36892
36893 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36894 @tab No
36895 @tab @samp{-}
36896 @tab Yes
36897
36898 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
36899 @tab No
36900 @tab @samp{-}
36901 @tab Yes
36902
36903 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36904 @tab No
36905 @tab @samp{-}
36906 @tab Yes
36907
36908 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36909 @tab No
36910 @tab @samp{-}
36911 @tab Yes
36912
36913 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
36914 @tab No
36915 @tab @samp{-}
36916 @tab Yes
36917
36918 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
36919 @tab No
36920 @tab @samp{-}
36921 @tab No
36922
36923 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36924 @tab No
36925 @tab @samp{-}
36926 @tab Yes
36927
36928 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36929 @tab No
36930 @tab @samp{-}
36931 @tab Yes
36932
36933 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36934 @tab No
36935 @tab @samp{-}
36936 @tab Yes
36937
36938 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36939 @tab No
36940 @tab @samp{-}
36941 @tab Yes
36942
36943 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36944 @tab No
36945 @tab @samp{-}
36946 @tab Yes
36947
36948 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36949 @tab No
36950 @tab @samp{-}
36951 @tab Yes
36952
36953 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36954 @tab No
36955 @tab @samp{-}
36956 @tab Yes
36957
36958 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36959 @tab No
36960 @tab @samp{-}
36961 @tab Yes
36962
36963 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36964 @tab No
36965 @tab @samp{-}
36966 @tab Yes
36967
36968 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36969 @tab No
36970 @tab @samp{-}
36971 @tab Yes
36972
36973 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
36974 @tab Yes
36975 @tab @samp{-}
36976 @tab Yes
36977
36978 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
36979 @tab Yes
36980 @tab @samp{-}
36981 @tab Yes
36982
36983 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
36984 @tab Yes
36985 @tab @samp{-}
36986 @tab Yes
36987
36988 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
36989 @tab Yes
36990 @tab @samp{-}
36991 @tab Yes
36992
36993 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
36994 @tab Yes
36995 @tab @samp{-}
36996 @tab Yes
36997
36998 @item @samp{QNonStop}
36999 @tab No
37000 @tab @samp{-}
37001 @tab Yes
37002
37003 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
37004 @tab No
37005 @tab @samp{-}
37006 @tab Yes
37007
37008 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
37009 @tab No
37010 @tab @samp{-}
37011 @tab Yes
37012
37013 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
37014 @tab No
37015 @tab @samp{-}
37016 @tab Yes
37017
37018 @item @samp{multiprocess}
37019 @tab No
37020 @tab @samp{-}
37021 @tab No
37022
37023 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
37024 @tab No
37025 @tab @samp{-}
37026 @tab No
37027
37028 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
37029 @tab No
37030 @tab @samp{-}
37031 @tab No
37032
37033 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
37034 @tab No
37035 @tab @samp{-}
37036 @tab No
37037
37038 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
37039 @tab No
37040 @tab @samp{-}
37041 @tab No
37042
37043 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
37044 @tab No
37045 @tab @samp{-}
37046 @tab No
37047
37048 @item @samp{QAgent}
37049 @tab No
37050 @tab @samp{-}
37051 @tab No
37052
37053 @item @samp{QAllow}
37054 @tab No
37055 @tab @samp{-}
37056 @tab No
37057
37058 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
37059 @tab No
37060 @tab @samp{-}
37061 @tab No
37062
37063 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
37064 @tab No
37065 @tab @samp{-}
37066 @tab No
37067
37068 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
37069 @tab No
37070 @tab @samp{-}
37071 @tab No
37072
37073 @item @samp{tracenz}
37074 @tab No
37075 @tab @samp{-}
37076 @tab No
37077
37078 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
37079 @tab No
37080 @tab @samp{-}
37081 @tab No
37082
37083 @item @samp{swbreak}
37084 @tab No
37085 @tab @samp{-}
37086 @tab No
37087
37088 @item @samp{hwbreak}
37089 @tab No
37090 @tab @samp{-}
37091 @tab No
37092
37093 @item @samp{fork-events}
37094 @tab No
37095 @tab @samp{-}
37096 @tab No
37097
37098 @item @samp{vfork-events}
37099 @tab No
37100 @tab @samp{-}
37101 @tab No
37102
37103 @item @samp{exec-events}
37104 @tab No
37105 @tab @samp{-}
37106 @tab No
37107
37108 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
37109 @tab No
37110 @tab @samp{-}
37111 @tab No
37112
37113 @item @samp{no-resumed}
37114 @tab No
37115 @tab @samp{-}
37116 @tab No
37117
37118 @end multitable
37119
37120 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
37121
37122 @table @samp
37123 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
37124 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
37125 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
37126 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
37127 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
37128 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
37129 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
37130 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
37131 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
37132 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
37133
37134 @item qXfer:auxv:read
37135 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
37136 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
37137
37138 @item qXfer:btrace:read
37139 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37140 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
37141
37142 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
37143 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37144 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
37145
37146 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
37147 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
37148 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
37149
37150 @item qXfer:features:read
37151 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
37152 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
37153
37154 @item qXfer:libraries:read
37155 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
37156 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
37157
37158 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
37159 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37160 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37161
37162 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
37163 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
37164 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37165 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37166
37167 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
37168 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
37169 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
37170
37171 @item qXfer:sdata:read
37172 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
37173 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
37174
37175 @item qXfer:spu:read
37176 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
37177 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
37178
37179 @item qXfer:spu:write
37180 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
37181 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
37182
37183 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
37184 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
37185 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
37186
37187 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
37188 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
37189 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
37190
37191 @item qXfer:threads:read
37192 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37193 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
37194
37195 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
37196 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37197 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
37198
37199 @item qXfer:uib:read
37200 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37201 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
37202
37203 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
37204 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37205 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
37206
37207 @item QNonStop
37208 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
37209 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
37210
37211 @item QCatchSyscalls
37212 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37213 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
37214
37215 @item QPassSignals
37216 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37217 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
37218
37219 @item QStartNoAckMode
37220 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
37221 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
37222
37223 @item multiprocess
37224 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
37225 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
37226 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
37227 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
37228 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
37229 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
37230 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
37231 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
37232 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
37233 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
37234 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
37235
37236 @item qXfer:osdata:read
37237 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
37238 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
37239
37240 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
37241 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
37242 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
37243 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
37244
37245 @item ConditionalTracepoints
37246 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37247 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37248
37249 @item ReverseContinue
37250 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37251 (@pxref{bc}).
37252
37253 @item ReverseStep
37254 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37255 (@pxref{bs}).
37256
37257 @item TracepointSource
37258 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37259 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37260
37261 @item QAgent
37262 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37263
37264 @item QAllow
37265 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37266
37267 @item QDisableRandomization
37268 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37269
37270 @item StaticTracepoint
37271 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37272 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37273
37274 @item InstallInTrace
37275 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37276 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37277
37278 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
37279 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
37280 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
37281 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
37282
37283 @item QTBuffer:size
37284 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
37285 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
37286
37287 @item tracenz
37288 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37289 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37290 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37291
37292 @item BreakpointCommands
37293 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37294 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37295 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37296
37297 @item Qbtrace:off
37298 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
37299
37300 @item Qbtrace:bts
37301 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
37302
37303 @item Qbtrace:pt
37304 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
37305
37306 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
37307 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
37308
37309 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
37310 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
37311
37312 @item swbreak
37313 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
37314 breakpoints.
37315
37316 @item hwbreak
37317 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37318 breakpoints.
37319
37320 @item fork-events
37321 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37322
37323 @item vfork-events
37324 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37325 and vforkdone events.
37326
37327 @item exec-events
37328 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37329
37330 @item vContSupported
37331 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37332 @samp{vCont?} packet.
37333
37334 @item QThreadEvents
37335 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37336
37337 @item no-resumed
37338 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37339
37340 @end table
37341
37342 @item qSymbol::
37343 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37344 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37345 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37346 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37347
37348 Reply:
37349 @table @samp
37350 @item OK
37351 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37352 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37353 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37354 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37355 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37356 below.
37357 @end table
37358
37359 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37360 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37361
37362 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37363 target has previously requested.
37364
37365 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
37366 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37367 will be empty.
37368
37369 Reply:
37370 @table @samp
37371 @item OK
37372 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37373 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37374 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37375 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37376 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37377 @end table
37378
37379 @item qTBuffer
37380 @itemx QTBuffer
37381 @itemx QTDisconnected
37382 @itemx QTDP
37383 @itemx QTDPsrc
37384 @itemx QTDV
37385 @itemx qTfP
37386 @itemx qTfV
37387 @itemx QTFrame
37388 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
37389
37390 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37391
37392 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37393 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37394 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37395 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37396 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37397 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
37398 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37399 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
37400 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
37401 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37402 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37403
37404 Reply:
37405 @table @samp
37406 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37407 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37408 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37409 the thread's attributes.
37410 @end table
37411
37412 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37413 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37414 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37415 packets.)
37416
37417 @item QTNotes
37418 @itemx qTP
37419 @itemx QTSave
37420 @itemx qTsP
37421 @itemx qTsV
37422 @itemx QTStart
37423 @itemx QTStop
37424 @itemx QTEnable
37425 @itemx QTDisable
37426 @itemx QTinit
37427 @itemx QTro
37428 @itemx qTStatus
37429 @itemx qTV
37430 @itemx qTfSTM
37431 @itemx qTsSTM
37432 @itemx qTSTMat
37433 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37434
37435 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37436 @cindex read special object, remote request
37437 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37438 @anchor{qXfer read}
37439 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37440 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
37441 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
37442 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37443 additional details about what data to access.
37444
37445 Reply:
37446 @table @samp
37447 @item m @var{data}
37448 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37449 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37450 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37451 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37452 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37453 request.
37454
37455 @item l @var{data}
37456 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37457 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
37458 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37459
37460 @item l
37461 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37462 There is no more data to be read.
37463
37464 @item E00
37465 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37466
37467 @item E @var{nn}
37468 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37469 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37470
37471 @item @w{}
37472 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37473 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37474 @end table
37475
37476 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
37477 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37478 formats, listed above.
37479
37480 @table @samp
37481 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37482 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
37483 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
37484 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
37485
37486 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37487 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37488
37489 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37490 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
37491
37492 Return a description of the current branch trace.
37493 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
37494 packet may have one of the following values:
37495
37496 @table @code
37497 @item all
37498 Returns all available branch trace.
37499
37500 @item new
37501 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
37502 the last read request.
37503
37504 @item delta
37505 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
37506 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
37507 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
37508 used to stitch traces together.
37509
37510 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
37511 @end table
37512
37513 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37514 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37515
37516 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37517 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
37518
37519 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
37520 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
37521
37522 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37523 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37524
37525 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37526 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
37527 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
37528 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
37529 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
37530 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
37531 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
37532
37533 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37534 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37535
37536 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37537 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
37538 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
37539 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
37540 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
37541
37542 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37543 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37544
37545 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37546 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
37547 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
37548 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37549 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37550
37551 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
37552 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
37553 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
37554
37555 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37556 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37557
37558 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37559 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
37560 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
37561 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
37562 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
37563 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
37564 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37565 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
37566
37567 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
37568 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
37569
37570 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37571 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37572
37573 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
37574 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
37575 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
37576 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
37577
37578 @table @code
37579 @item start=@var{address}
37580 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37581 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
37582 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
37583 chosen as the starting point.
37584
37585 @item prev=@var{address}
37586 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37587 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
37588 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
37589 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
37590 exists prior to the starting point.
37591
37592 @end table
37593
37594 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
37595 ignored.
37596
37597 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37598 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
37599 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
37600 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37601 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37602
37603 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37604 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37605
37606 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37607 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
37608
37609 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
37610 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
37611 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
37612 Action Lists}.
37613
37614 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37615 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37616 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37617
37618 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37619 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
37620 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
37621 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37622 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37623
37624 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37625 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37626 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37627
37628 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37629 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
37630 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37631 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
37632 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37633 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37634 in that context to be accessed.
37635
37636 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37637 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37638 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37639
37640 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37641 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
37642 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
37643 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37644 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37645
37646 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37647 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37648
37649 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37650 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
37651
37652 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
37653 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
37654 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37655
37656 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37657 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37658
37659 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37660 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
37661
37662 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
37663 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
37664
37665 This packet is not probed by default.
37666
37667 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37668 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
37669 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
37670 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
37671 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
37672
37673 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37674 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37675
37676 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37677 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
37678 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
37679 @xref{Operating System Information}.
37680
37681 @end table
37682
37683 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37684 @cindex write data into object, remote request
37685 @anchor{qXfer write}
37686 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
37687 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
37688 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
37689 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
37690 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
37691 to access.
37692
37693 Reply:
37694 @table @samp
37695 @item @var{nn}
37696 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
37697 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
37698
37699 @item E00
37700 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37701
37702 @item E @var{nn}
37703 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
37704 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37705
37706 @item @w{}
37707 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
37708 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
37709 @end table
37710
37711 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
37712 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37713 formats, listed above.
37714
37715 @table @samp
37716 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37717 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
37718 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
37719 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37720 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
37721
37722 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37723 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37724 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37725
37726 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37727 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
37728 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37729 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
37730 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37731 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37732 in that context to be accessed.
37733
37734 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37735 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37736 @end table
37737
37738 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
37739 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
37740 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
37741 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
37742 must respond with an empty packet.
37743
37744 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
37745 @cindex query attached, remote request
37746 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
37747 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
37748 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
37749 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
37750 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
37751 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
37752 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
37753
37754 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
37755 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
37756 the @code{quit} command.
37757
37758 Reply:
37759 @table @samp
37760 @item 1
37761 The remote server attached to an existing process.
37762 @item 0
37763 The remote server created a new process.
37764 @item E @var{NN}
37765 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37766 @end table
37767
37768 @item Qbtrace:bts
37769 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
37770
37771 Reply:
37772 @table @samp
37773 @item OK
37774 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37775 @item E.errtext
37776 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37777 @end table
37778
37779 @item Qbtrace:pt
37780 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
37781
37782 Reply:
37783 @table @samp
37784 @item OK
37785 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37786 @item E.errtext
37787 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37788 @end table
37789
37790 @item Qbtrace:off
37791 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
37792
37793 Reply:
37794 @table @samp
37795 @item OK
37796 Branch tracing has been disabled.
37797 @item E.errtext
37798 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37799 @end table
37800
37801 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
37802 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37803 btrace recording method in bts format.
37804
37805 Reply:
37806 @table @samp
37807 @item OK
37808 The ring buffer size has been set.
37809 @item E.errtext
37810 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37811 @end table
37812
37813 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
37814 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37815 btrace recording method in pt format.
37816
37817 Reply:
37818 @table @samp
37819 @item OK
37820 The ring buffer size has been set.
37821 @item E.errtext
37822 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37823 @end table
37824
37825 @end table
37826
37827 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37828 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37829
37830 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
37831 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
37832 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
37833
37834 @menu
37835 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
37836 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
37837 @end menu
37838
37839 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
37840 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
37841
37842 @menu
37843 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
37844 @end menu
37845
37846 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
37847 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
37848 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
37849
37850 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37851
37852 @table @r
37853
37854 @item 2
37855 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
37856
37857 @item 3
37858 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
37859
37860 @item 4
37861 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
37862
37863 @end table
37864
37865 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
37866 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
37867
37868 @menu
37869 * MIPS Register packet Format::
37870 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
37871 @end menu
37872
37873 @node MIPS Register packet Format
37874 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
37875 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
37876
37877 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
37878 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
37879 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
37880 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
37881 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
37882 most-significant -- least-significant.
37883
37884 @table @r
37885
37886 @item MIPS32
37887 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
37888 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
37889 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
37890
37891 @item MIPS64
37892 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
37893 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
37894 as @code{MIPS32}.
37895
37896 @end table
37897
37898 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
37899 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
37900 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
37901
37902 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37903
37904 @table @r
37905
37906 @item 2
37907 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
37908
37909 @item 3
37910 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37911
37912 @item 4
37913 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
37914
37915 @item 5
37916 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37917
37918 @end table
37919
37920 @node Tracepoint Packets
37921 @section Tracepoint Packets
37922 @cindex tracepoint packets
37923 @cindex packets, tracepoint
37924
37925 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
37926 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
37927
37928 @table @samp
37929
37930 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
37931 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
37932 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
37933 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
37934 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
37935 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
37936 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
37937 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
37938 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
37939 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
37940 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
37941 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
37942 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
37943 actions.
37944
37945 Replies:
37946 @table @samp
37947 @item OK
37948 The packet was understood and carried out.
37949 @item qRelocInsn
37950 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37951 @item @w{}
37952 The packet was not recognized.
37953 @end table
37954
37955 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
37956 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
37957 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
37958 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
37959 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
37960 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
37961 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
37962
37963 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
37964 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
37965 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
37966 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
37967 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
37968 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
37969 tracepoint actions.
37970
37971 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
37972 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
37973 following forms:
37974
37975 @table @samp
37976
37977 @item R @var{mask}
37978 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
37979 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
37980 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
37981 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
37982 not fit in a 32-bit word.
37983
37984 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
37985 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
37986 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
37987 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
37988 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
37989 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
37990 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
37991
37992 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37993 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
37994 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
37995 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
37996 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
37997 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
37998 packet).
37999
38000 @end table
38001
38002 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
38003 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
38004 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
38005 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
38006 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
38007 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
38008 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
38009 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
38010
38011 Replies:
38012 @table @samp
38013 @item OK
38014 The packet was understood and carried out.
38015 @item qRelocInsn
38016 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38017 @item @w{}
38018 The packet was not recognized.
38019 @end table
38020
38021 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
38022 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
38023 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
38024 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
38025 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
38026 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
38027 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
38028 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
38029
38030 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
38031 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
38032 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
38033 fit in a single packet.
38034 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
38035 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
38036
38037 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
38038 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
38039 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
38040 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
38041
38042 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
38043 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
38044 query packets.
38045
38046 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
38047 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
38048 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
38049 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
38050 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
38051 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
38052 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
38053 be found.
38054
38055 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
38056 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
38057 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
38058 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
38059 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
38060 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
38061 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
38062 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
38063 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
38064 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
38065 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
38066 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
38067 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
38068 variable.
38069
38070 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
38071 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
38072 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
38073 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
38074 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
38075
38076 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
38077 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
38078 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
38079 one of the following forms:
38080
38081 @table @samp
38082 @item F @var{f}
38083 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
38084 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
38085 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
38086
38087 @item T @var{t}
38088 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
38089 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
38090
38091 @end table
38092
38093 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
38094 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38095 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
38096 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
38097
38098 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
38099 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38100 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
38101 is a hexadecimal number.
38102
38103 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
38104 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38105 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
38106 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
38107 numbers.
38108
38109 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
38110 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
38111 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
38112
38113 @item qTMinFTPILen
38114 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
38115 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
38116 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
38117 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
38118 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
38119 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
38120 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
38121 arrange for that.
38122
38123 Replies:
38124
38125 @table @samp
38126 @item 0
38127 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
38128 @item @var{length}
38129 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
38130 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
38131 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
38132 regardless of size.
38133 @item E
38134 An error has occurred.
38135 @item @w{}
38136 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
38137 @end table
38138
38139 @item QTStart
38140 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
38141 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
38142 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
38143 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38144 instruction reply packet}).
38145
38146 @item QTStop
38147 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
38148 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
38149
38150 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38151 @anchor{QTEnable}
38152 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
38153 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38154 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
38155 of data from it will resume.
38156
38157 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38158 @anchor{QTDisable}
38159 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
38160 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38161 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
38162 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
38163
38164 @item QTinit
38165 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
38166 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
38167
38168 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
38169 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
38170 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
38171 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
38172 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
38173
38174 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
38175 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
38176 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
38177 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
38178
38179 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
38180 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
38181 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
38182 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
38183 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
38184 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
38185
38186 @item qTStatus
38187 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
38188 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
38189
38190 The reply has the form:
38191
38192 @table @samp
38193
38194 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
38195 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
38196 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
38197 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
38198
38199 @end table
38200
38201 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
38202 explanations as one of the optional fields:
38203
38204 @table @samp
38205
38206 @item tnotrun:0
38207 No trace has been run yet.
38208
38209 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
38210 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
38211 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
38212 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
38213 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
38214
38215 @item tfull:0
38216 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
38217
38218 @item tdisconnected:0
38219 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
38220
38221 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
38222 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
38223
38224 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
38225 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
38226 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
38227 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
38228 is hex encoded.
38229
38230 @item tunknown:0
38231 The trace stopped for some other reason.
38232
38233 @end table
38234
38235 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
38236 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
38237 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
38238 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
38239 trace.
38240
38241 @table @samp
38242
38243 @item tframes:@var{n}
38244 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
38245
38246 @item tcreated:@var{n}
38247 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
38248 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
38249
38250 @item tsize:@var{n}
38251 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
38252
38253 @item tfree:@var{n}
38254 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
38255
38256 @item circular:@var{n}
38257 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
38258 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
38259 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
38260 and may fill up.
38261
38262 @item disconn:@var{n}
38263 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
38264 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
38265 that the trace run will stop.
38266
38267 @end table
38268
38269 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
38270 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
38271 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
38272 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
38273 address @var{addr}.
38274
38275 Replies:
38276 @table @samp
38277 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
38278 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
38279 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
38280 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
38281 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
38282
38283 @end table
38284
38285 @item qTV:@var{var}
38286 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
38287 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
38288 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
38289
38290 Replies:
38291 @table @samp
38292 @item V@var{value}
38293 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
38294 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
38295 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
38296 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
38297 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
38298 program is running.
38299
38300 @item U
38301 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
38302 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
38303 was not collected.
38304 @end table
38305
38306 @item qTfP
38307 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
38308 @itemx qTsP
38309 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
38310 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
38311 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
38312 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
38313 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
38314 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
38315
38316 @item qTfV
38317 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38318 @itemx qTsV
38319 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38320 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38321 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38322 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
38323 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38324 trace state variables.
38325
38326 @item qTfSTM
38327 @itemx qTsSTM
38328 @anchor{qTfSTM}
38329 @anchor{qTsSTM}
38330 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38331 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38332 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38333 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38334 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38335 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
38336
38337 Reply:
38338 @table @samp
38339 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38340 A single marker
38341 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38342 a comma-separated list of markers
38343 @item l
38344 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38345 @item E @var{nn}
38346 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38347 @item @w{}
38348 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38349 stub.
38350 @end table
38351
38352 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
38353 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
38354
38355 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38356 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
38357 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
38358 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
38359 @dfn{last}).
38360
38361 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
38362 @anchor{qTSTMat}
38363 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
38364 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
38365 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
38366 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
38367 tracepoint markers.
38368
38369 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
38370 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
38371 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
38372 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
38373 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
38374 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
38375
38376 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
38377 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
38378 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
38379 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
38380 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38381 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38382 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38383 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38384 available.
38385
38386 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38387 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38388 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38389
38390 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38391 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38392 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38393 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38394 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38395 use whatever size it prefers.
38396
38397 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38398 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38399 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
38400 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
38401 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
38402
38403 @end table
38404
38405 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
38406 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
38407 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
38408 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
38409 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
38410 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
38411 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
38412 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
38413 it had executed in the original location.
38414
38415 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
38416 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
38417 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
38418 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
38419 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
38420 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
38421 format of the request is:
38422
38423 @table @samp
38424 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
38425
38426 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
38427 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
38428 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
38429 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
38430 memory starting at @var{to}.
38431 @end table
38432
38433 Replies:
38434 @table @samp
38435 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
38436 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
38437 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38438 @item E @var{NN}
38439 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38440 relocating the instruction.
38441 @end table
38442
38443 @node Host I/O Packets
38444 @section Host I/O Packets
38445 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38446 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38447
38448 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38449 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
38450 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38451 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38452 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
38453 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
38454 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38455 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38456 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38457 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38458
38459 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38460 its arguments. They have this format:
38461
38462 @table @samp
38463
38464 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
38465 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
38466 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
38467 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
38468 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
38469 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
38470 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
38471 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
38472 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38473
38474 @end table
38475
38476 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
38477
38478 @table @samp
38479
38480 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
38481 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
38482 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
38483 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
38484 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
38485 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
38486 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
38487 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
38488 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
38489 @var{attachment}.
38490
38491 @item @w{}
38492 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
38493
38494 @end table
38495
38496 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
38497
38498 @table @samp
38499 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
38500 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
38501 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
38502 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
38503 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
38504 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
38505 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
38506
38507 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
38508 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
38509 -1 if an error occurs.
38510
38511 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
38512 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
38513 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
38514 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
38515 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
38516 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
38517 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
38518 @var{count} was zero.
38519
38520 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38521 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38522 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38523 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38524 some characters were escaped.
38525
38526 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
38527 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
38528 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
38529 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
38530 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
38531 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
38532 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
38533 error occurred.
38534
38535 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
38536 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
38537 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
38538 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
38539 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
38540 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
38541
38542 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
38543 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
38544 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
38545
38546 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
38547 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
38548 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
38549
38550 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38551 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38552 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38553 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38554 some characters were escaped.
38555
38556 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
38557 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
38558 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
38559 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
38560 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
38561 inferior(s).
38562
38563 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
38564 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
38565 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
38566 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
38567 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
38568 operation.
38569
38570 @end table
38571
38572 @node Interrupts
38573 @section Interrupts
38574 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
38575 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
38576
38577 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
38578 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
38579 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
38580 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
38581
38582 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
38583 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
38584 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
38585 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
38586 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
38587
38588 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
38589 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
38590 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
38591 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
38592 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
38593 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
38594 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
38595 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
38596
38597 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
38598 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
38599 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
38600
38601 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
38602 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
38603 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
38604 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
38605 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
38606 @code{0x03}.
38607
38608 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
38609 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
38610 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
38611 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
38612 currently-executing threads and processes.
38613 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
38614 running program, it should send one of the stop
38615 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
38616 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
38617 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
38618 Interrupts received while the
38619 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
38620 it is resumed next time.
38621
38622 @node Notification Packets
38623 @section Notification Packets
38624 @cindex notification packets
38625 @cindex packets, notification
38626
38627 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
38628 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
38629 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
38630 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
38631 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
38632 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
38633 is not a problem.
38634
38635 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
38636 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
38637 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
38638 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
38639 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
38640 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
38641 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
38642
38643 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
38644 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
38645
38646 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
38647 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
38648 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
38649 not they understand it.
38650
38651 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
38652 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
38653 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
38654 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
38655 recipients.
38656
38657 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
38658 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
38659 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
38660 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
38661 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
38662
38663 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
38664 @table @samp
38665 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
38666 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
38667 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
38668 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
38669 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
38670 @item @var{ack}
38671 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
38672 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
38673 @end table
38674
38675 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
38676 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
38677
38678 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
38679 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
38680 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
38681 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
38682 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
38683 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
38684 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
38685 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
38686 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
38687 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
38688
38689 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
38690 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
38691 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
38692 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
38693 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
38694 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
38695
38696 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
38697 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
38698 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
38699 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
38700 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
38701
38702 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
38703 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
38704 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
38705 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
38706 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
38707 normally.
38708
38709 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
38710 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
38711 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
38712 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
38713 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
38714 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
38715 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
38716 the process shall be repeated.
38717
38718 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
38719 following example:
38720 @smallexample
38721 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
38722 @code{...}
38723 -> @code{vStopped}
38724 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
38725 -> @code{vStopped}
38726 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
38727 -> @code{vStopped}
38728 <- @code{OK}
38729 @end smallexample
38730
38731 The following notifications are defined:
38732 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
38733
38734 @item Notification
38735 @tab Ack
38736 @tab Event
38737 @tab Description
38738
38739 @item Stop
38740 @tab vStopped
38741 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
38742 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
38743 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
38744 @value{GDBN}.
38745 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
38746
38747 @end multitable
38748
38749 @node Remote Non-Stop
38750 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
38751
38752 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
38753 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
38754 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
38755 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38756
38757 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
38758 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
38759 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
38760 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
38761 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
38762 probe the target state after a mode change.
38763
38764 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
38765 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
38766 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
38767 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
38768 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
38769 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
38770 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
38771 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
38772 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
38773 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
38774 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
38775
38776 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
38777 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
38778 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
38779 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
38780 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
38781 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
38782 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
38783 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
38784 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
38785 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
38786 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
38787 @samp{OK}.
38788
38789 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
38790 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
38791 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
38792 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
38793 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
38794 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
38795 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
38796 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
38797 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
38798 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
38799 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
38800 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
38801 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
38802
38803 @node Packet Acknowledgment
38804 @section Packet Acknowledgment
38805
38806 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38807 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38808 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
38809 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38810 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
38811 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
38812 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
38813
38814 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
38815 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
38816 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
38817 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
38818 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
38819
38820 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
38821 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
38822 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
38823 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
38824
38825 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
38826 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
38827 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
38828 @pxref{qSupported}.
38829 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
38830 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
38831 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
38832 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
38833 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
38834 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
38835 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
38836
38837 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
38838 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
38839 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
38840 connection.
38841 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
38842 new connection is established,
38843 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
38844 for the current connection, once disabled.
38845
38846 @node Examples
38847 @section Examples
38848
38849 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
38850 does not get any direct output:
38851
38852 @smallexample
38853 -> @code{R00}
38854 <- @code{+}
38855 @emph{target restarts}
38856 -> @code{?}
38857 <- @code{+}
38858 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38859 -> @code{+}
38860 @end smallexample
38861
38862 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
38863
38864 @smallexample
38865 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
38866 <- @code{+}
38867 -> @code{s}
38868 <- @code{+}
38869 @emph{time passes}
38870 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38871 -> @code{+}
38872 -> @code{g}
38873 <- @code{+}
38874 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
38875 -> @code{+}
38876 @end smallexample
38877
38878 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38879 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38880 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
38881
38882 @menu
38883 * File-I/O Overview::
38884 * Protocol Basics::
38885 * The F Request Packet::
38886 * The F Reply Packet::
38887 * The Ctrl-C Message::
38888 * Console I/O::
38889 * List of Supported Calls::
38890 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
38891 * Constants::
38892 * File-I/O Examples::
38893 @end menu
38894
38895 @node File-I/O Overview
38896 @subsection File-I/O Overview
38897 @cindex file-i/o overview
38898
38899 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
38900 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
38901 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
38902 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
38903 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
38904 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
38905
38906 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
38907 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
38908 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
38909 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
38910 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
38911
38912 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
38913 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38914 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
38915 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
38916 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
38917 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
38918 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
38919
38920 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
38921 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
38922 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
38923 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
38924 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
38925
38926 @smallexample
38927 (@value{GDBP}) continue
38928 <- target requests 'system call X'
38929 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
38930 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
38931 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
38932 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
38933 @end smallexample
38934
38935 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
38936 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
38937 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
38938 system are not supported by this protocol.
38939
38940 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
38941
38942 @node Protocol Basics
38943 @subsection Protocol Basics
38944 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
38945
38946 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
38947 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
38948 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
38949 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
38950 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
38951 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
38952 to call the appropriate host system call:
38953
38954 @itemize @bullet
38955 @item
38956 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
38957
38958 @item
38959 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
38960 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
38961 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
38962 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
38963
38964 @end itemize
38965
38966 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
38967
38968 @itemize @bullet
38969 @item
38970 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
38971 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
38972 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
38973 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
38974 packet.
38975
38976 @item
38977 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
38978 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
38979
38980 @item
38981 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
38982
38983 @item
38984 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
38985
38986 @item
38987 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
38988 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
38989 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
38990 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
38991 packet.
38992
38993 @end itemize
38994
38995 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
38996 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
38997
38998 @itemize @bullet
38999 @item
39000 Return value.
39001
39002 @item
39003 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
39004
39005 @item
39006 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
39007
39008 @end itemize
39009
39010 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
39011 the latest continue or step action.
39012
39013 @node The F Request Packet
39014 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
39015 @cindex file-i/o request packet
39016 @cindex @code{F} request packet
39017
39018 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
39019
39020 @table @samp
39021 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
39022
39023 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
39024 This is just the name of the function.
39025
39026 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
39027 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
39028 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
39029 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
39030 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
39031 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
39032 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
39033
39034 @end table
39035
39036
39037
39038 @node The F Reply Packet
39039 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
39040 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
39041 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
39042
39043 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
39044
39045 @table @samp
39046
39047 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
39048
39049 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
39050
39051 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
39052 representation.
39053 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
39054
39055 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
39056 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
39057 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
39058
39059 @smallexample
39060 F0,0,C
39061 @end smallexample
39062
39063 @noindent
39064 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
39065
39066 @smallexample
39067 F-1,4,C
39068 @end smallexample
39069
39070 @noindent
39071 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
39072
39073 @end table
39074
39075
39076 @node The Ctrl-C Message
39077 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
39078 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
39079
39080 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
39081 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
39082 the target should behave as if it had
39083 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
39084 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
39085 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
39086 packet.
39087
39088 It's important for the target to know in which
39089 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
39090
39091 @itemize @bullet
39092 @item
39093 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
39094
39095 @item
39096 The system call on the host has been finished.
39097
39098 @end itemize
39099
39100 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
39101 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
39102 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
39103 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
39104 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
39105 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
39106
39107 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
39108 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
39109 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
39110 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
39111 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
39112 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
39113 or the full action has been completed.
39114
39115 @node Console I/O
39116 @subsection Console I/O
39117 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
39118
39119 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
39120 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
39121 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
39122 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
39123 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
39124 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
39125 conditions is met:
39126
39127 @itemize @bullet
39128 @item
39129 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
39130 @code{read}
39131 system call is treated as finished.
39132
39133 @item
39134 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
39135 newline.
39136
39137 @item
39138 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
39139 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
39140
39141 @end itemize
39142
39143 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
39144 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
39145 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
39146 is stopped at the user's request.
39147
39148
39149 @node List of Supported Calls
39150 @subsection List of Supported Calls
39151 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
39152
39153 @menu
39154 * open::
39155 * close::
39156 * read::
39157 * write::
39158 * lseek::
39159 * rename::
39160 * unlink::
39161 * stat/fstat::
39162 * gettimeofday::
39163 * isatty::
39164 * system::
39165 @end menu
39166
39167 @node open
39168 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
39169 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
39170
39171 @table @asis
39172 @item Synopsis:
39173 @smallexample
39174 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
39175 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
39176 @end smallexample
39177
39178 @item Request:
39179 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
39180
39181 @noindent
39182 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39183
39184 @table @code
39185 @item O_CREAT
39186 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
39187 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
39188 are concerned.
39189
39190 @item O_EXCL
39191 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
39192 an error and open() fails.
39193
39194 @item O_TRUNC
39195 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
39196 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
39197 truncated to zero length.
39198
39199 @item O_APPEND
39200 The file is opened in append mode.
39201
39202 @item O_RDONLY
39203 The file is opened for reading only.
39204
39205 @item O_WRONLY
39206 The file is opened for writing only.
39207
39208 @item O_RDWR
39209 The file is opened for reading and writing.
39210 @end table
39211
39212 @noindent
39213 Other bits are silently ignored.
39214
39215
39216 @noindent
39217 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39218
39219 @table @code
39220 @item S_IRUSR
39221 User has read permission.
39222
39223 @item S_IWUSR
39224 User has write permission.
39225
39226 @item S_IRGRP
39227 Group has read permission.
39228
39229 @item S_IWGRP
39230 Group has write permission.
39231
39232 @item S_IROTH
39233 Others have read permission.
39234
39235 @item S_IWOTH
39236 Others have write permission.
39237 @end table
39238
39239 @noindent
39240 Other bits are silently ignored.
39241
39242
39243 @item Return value:
39244 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
39245 occurred.
39246
39247 @item Errors:
39248
39249 @table @code
39250 @item EEXIST
39251 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
39252
39253 @item EISDIR
39254 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
39255
39256 @item EACCES
39257 The requested access is not allowed.
39258
39259 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39260 @var{pathname} was too long.
39261
39262 @item ENOENT
39263 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39264
39265 @item ENODEV
39266 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
39267
39268 @item EROFS
39269 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
39270 write access was requested.
39271
39272 @item EFAULT
39273 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
39274
39275 @item ENOSPC
39276 No space on device to create the file.
39277
39278 @item EMFILE
39279 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
39280
39281 @item ENFILE
39282 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
39283 has been reached.
39284
39285 @item EINTR
39286 The call was interrupted by the user.
39287 @end table
39288
39289 @end table
39290
39291 @node close
39292 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
39293 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
39294
39295 @table @asis
39296 @item Synopsis:
39297 @smallexample
39298 int close(int fd);
39299 @end smallexample
39300
39301 @item Request:
39302 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
39303
39304 @item Return value:
39305 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
39306
39307 @item Errors:
39308
39309 @table @code
39310 @item EBADF
39311 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
39312
39313 @item EINTR
39314 The call was interrupted by the user.
39315 @end table
39316
39317 @end table
39318
39319 @node read
39320 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
39321 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
39322
39323 @table @asis
39324 @item Synopsis:
39325 @smallexample
39326 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39327 @end smallexample
39328
39329 @item Request:
39330 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39331
39332 @item Return value:
39333 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39334 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
39335 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
39336
39337 @item Errors:
39338
39339 @table @code
39340 @item EBADF
39341 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39342 reading.
39343
39344 @item EFAULT
39345 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39346
39347 @item EINTR
39348 The call was interrupted by the user.
39349 @end table
39350
39351 @end table
39352
39353 @node write
39354 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
39355 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
39356
39357 @table @asis
39358 @item Synopsis:
39359 @smallexample
39360 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
39361 @end smallexample
39362
39363 @item Request:
39364 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39365
39366 @item Return value:
39367 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
39368 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
39369 is returned.
39370
39371 @item Errors:
39372
39373 @table @code
39374 @item EBADF
39375 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39376 writing.
39377
39378 @item EFAULT
39379 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39380
39381 @item EFBIG
39382 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
39383 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
39384
39385 @item ENOSPC
39386 No space on device to write the data.
39387
39388 @item EINTR
39389 The call was interrupted by the user.
39390 @end table
39391
39392 @end table
39393
39394 @node lseek
39395 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39396 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39397
39398 @table @asis
39399 @item Synopsis:
39400 @smallexample
39401 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
39402 @end smallexample
39403
39404 @item Request:
39405 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
39406
39407 @var{flag} is one of:
39408
39409 @table @code
39410 @item SEEK_SET
39411 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
39412
39413 @item SEEK_CUR
39414 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
39415 bytes.
39416
39417 @item SEEK_END
39418 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
39419 bytes.
39420 @end table
39421
39422 @item Return value:
39423 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
39424 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
39425 value of -1 is returned.
39426
39427 @item Errors:
39428
39429 @table @code
39430 @item EBADF
39431 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
39432
39433 @item ESPIPE
39434 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
39435
39436 @item EINVAL
39437 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
39438
39439 @item EINTR
39440 The call was interrupted by the user.
39441 @end table
39442
39443 @end table
39444
39445 @node rename
39446 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
39447 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
39448
39449 @table @asis
39450 @item Synopsis:
39451 @smallexample
39452 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
39453 @end smallexample
39454
39455 @item Request:
39456 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
39457
39458 @item Return value:
39459 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39460
39461 @item Errors:
39462
39463 @table @code
39464 @item EISDIR
39465 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
39466 directory.
39467
39468 @item EEXIST
39469 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
39470
39471 @item EBUSY
39472 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
39473 process.
39474
39475 @item EINVAL
39476 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
39477 of itself.
39478
39479 @item ENOTDIR
39480 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
39481 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
39482 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
39483
39484 @item EFAULT
39485 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
39486
39487 @item EACCES
39488 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39489
39490 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39491
39492 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
39493
39494 @item ENOENT
39495 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
39496
39497 @item EROFS
39498 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39499
39500 @item ENOSPC
39501 The device containing the file has no room for the new
39502 directory entry.
39503
39504 @item EINTR
39505 The call was interrupted by the user.
39506 @end table
39507
39508 @end table
39509
39510 @node unlink
39511 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
39512 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
39513
39514 @table @asis
39515 @item Synopsis:
39516 @smallexample
39517 int unlink(const char *pathname);
39518 @end smallexample
39519
39520 @item Request:
39521 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
39522
39523 @item Return value:
39524 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39525
39526 @item Errors:
39527
39528 @table @code
39529 @item EACCES
39530 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39531
39532 @item EPERM
39533 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
39534
39535 @item EBUSY
39536 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
39537 being used by another process.
39538
39539 @item EFAULT
39540 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39541
39542 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39543 @var{pathname} was too long.
39544
39545 @item ENOENT
39546 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39547
39548 @item ENOTDIR
39549 A component of the path is not a directory.
39550
39551 @item EROFS
39552 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39553
39554 @item EINTR
39555 The call was interrupted by the user.
39556 @end table
39557
39558 @end table
39559
39560 @node stat/fstat
39561 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
39562 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
39563 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
39564
39565 @table @asis
39566 @item Synopsis:
39567 @smallexample
39568 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
39569 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
39570 @end smallexample
39571
39572 @item Request:
39573 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
39574 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
39575
39576 @item Return value:
39577 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39578
39579 @item Errors:
39580
39581 @table @code
39582 @item EBADF
39583 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
39584
39585 @item ENOENT
39586 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
39587 path is an empty string.
39588
39589 @item ENOTDIR
39590 A component of the path is not a directory.
39591
39592 @item EFAULT
39593 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39594
39595 @item EACCES
39596 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39597
39598 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39599 @var{pathname} was too long.
39600
39601 @item EINTR
39602 The call was interrupted by the user.
39603 @end table
39604
39605 @end table
39606
39607 @node gettimeofday
39608 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
39609 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
39610
39611 @table @asis
39612 @item Synopsis:
39613 @smallexample
39614 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
39615 @end smallexample
39616
39617 @item Request:
39618 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
39619
39620 @item Return value:
39621 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
39622
39623 @item Errors:
39624
39625 @table @code
39626 @item EINVAL
39627 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
39628
39629 @item EFAULT
39630 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39631 @end table
39632
39633 @end table
39634
39635 @node isatty
39636 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
39637 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
39638
39639 @table @asis
39640 @item Synopsis:
39641 @smallexample
39642 int isatty(int fd);
39643 @end smallexample
39644
39645 @item Request:
39646 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
39647
39648 @item Return value:
39649 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
39650
39651 @item Errors:
39652
39653 @table @code
39654 @item EINTR
39655 The call was interrupted by the user.
39656 @end table
39657
39658 @end table
39659
39660 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
39661 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
39662 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
39663 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
39664 needed.
39665
39666
39667 @node system
39668 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
39669 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
39670
39671 @table @asis
39672 @item Synopsis:
39673 @smallexample
39674 int system(const char *command);
39675 @end smallexample
39676
39677 @item Request:
39678 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
39679
39680 @item Return value:
39681 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
39682 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
39683 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
39684 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
39685 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
39686 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
39687 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
39688
39689 @item Errors:
39690
39691 @table @code
39692 @item EINTR
39693 The call was interrupted by the user.
39694 @end table
39695
39696 @end table
39697
39698 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
39699 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
39700 the host is simplified before it's returned
39701 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
39702 is discarded, and the return value consists
39703 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
39704
39705 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
39706 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
39707 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
39708
39709 @table @code
39710 @item set remote system-call-allowed
39711 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
39712 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
39713 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
39714
39715 @item show remote system-call-allowed
39716 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
39717 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
39718 protocol.
39719 @end table
39720
39721 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39722 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39723 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39724
39725 @menu
39726 * Integral Datatypes::
39727 * Pointer Values::
39728 * Memory Transfer::
39729 * struct stat::
39730 * struct timeval::
39731 @end menu
39732
39733 @node Integral Datatypes
39734 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
39735 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39736
39737 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
39738 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
39739 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
39740
39741 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
39742 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
39743
39744 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
39745
39746 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
39747 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
39748
39749 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
39750
39751 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
39752 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
39753 byte order.
39754
39755 @node Pointer Values
39756 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
39757 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
39758
39759 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
39760 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
39761 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
39762 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
39763
39764 @smallexample
39765 @code{1aaf/12}
39766 @end smallexample
39767
39768 @noindent
39769 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
39770 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
39771 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
39772 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
39773
39774 @smallexample
39775 @code{123456/d}
39776 @end smallexample
39777
39778 @node Memory Transfer
39779 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
39780 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
39781
39782 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
39783 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
39784 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
39785 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
39786 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
39787 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
39788 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
39789
39790
39791 @node struct stat
39792 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
39793 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
39794
39795 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
39796 is defined as follows:
39797
39798 @smallexample
39799 struct stat @{
39800 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
39801 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
39802 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
39803 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
39804 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
39805 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
39806 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
39807 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
39808 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
39809 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
39810 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
39811 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
39812 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
39813 @};
39814 @end smallexample
39815
39816 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39817 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39818 structure is of size 64 bytes.
39819
39820 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
39821 range of values.
39822
39823 @table @code
39824
39825 @item st_dev
39826 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
39827
39828 @item st_ino
39829 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39830
39831 @item st_mode
39832 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
39833 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
39834
39835 @item st_uid
39836 @itemx st_gid
39837 @itemx st_rdev
39838 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39839
39840 @item st_atime
39841 @itemx st_mtime
39842 @itemx st_ctime
39843 These values have a host and file system dependent
39844 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
39845 support exact timing values.
39846 @end table
39847
39848 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
39849 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
39850 continuing.
39851
39852 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
39853 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
39854 get truncated on the target.
39855
39856 @node struct timeval
39857 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
39858 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
39859
39860 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
39861 is defined as follows:
39862
39863 @smallexample
39864 struct timeval @{
39865 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
39866 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
39867 @};
39868 @end smallexample
39869
39870 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39871 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39872 structure is of size 8 bytes.
39873
39874 @node Constants
39875 @subsection Constants
39876 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
39877
39878 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
39879 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
39880 values before and after the call as needed.
39881
39882 @menu
39883 * Open Flags::
39884 * mode_t Values::
39885 * Errno Values::
39886 * Lseek Flags::
39887 * Limits::
39888 @end menu
39889
39890 @node Open Flags
39891 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
39892 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
39893
39894 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
39895
39896 @smallexample
39897 O_RDONLY 0x0
39898 O_WRONLY 0x1
39899 O_RDWR 0x2
39900 O_APPEND 0x8
39901 O_CREAT 0x200
39902 O_TRUNC 0x400
39903 O_EXCL 0x800
39904 @end smallexample
39905
39906 @node mode_t Values
39907 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
39908 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
39909
39910 All values are given in octal representation.
39911
39912 @smallexample
39913 S_IFREG 0100000
39914 S_IFDIR 040000
39915 S_IRUSR 0400
39916 S_IWUSR 0200
39917 S_IXUSR 0100
39918 S_IRGRP 040
39919 S_IWGRP 020
39920 S_IXGRP 010
39921 S_IROTH 04
39922 S_IWOTH 02
39923 S_IXOTH 01
39924 @end smallexample
39925
39926 @node Errno Values
39927 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
39928 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
39929
39930 All values are given in decimal representation.
39931
39932 @smallexample
39933 EPERM 1
39934 ENOENT 2
39935 EINTR 4
39936 EBADF 9
39937 EACCES 13
39938 EFAULT 14
39939 EBUSY 16
39940 EEXIST 17
39941 ENODEV 19
39942 ENOTDIR 20
39943 EISDIR 21
39944 EINVAL 22
39945 ENFILE 23
39946 EMFILE 24
39947 EFBIG 27
39948 ENOSPC 28
39949 ESPIPE 29
39950 EROFS 30
39951 ENAMETOOLONG 91
39952 EUNKNOWN 9999
39953 @end smallexample
39954
39955 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
39956 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
39957
39958 @node Lseek Flags
39959 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
39960 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
39961
39962 @smallexample
39963 SEEK_SET 0
39964 SEEK_CUR 1
39965 SEEK_END 2
39966 @end smallexample
39967
39968 @node Limits
39969 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
39970 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
39971
39972 All values are given in decimal representation.
39973
39974 @smallexample
39975 INT_MIN -2147483648
39976 INT_MAX 2147483647
39977 UINT_MAX 4294967295
39978 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
39979 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
39980 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
39981 @end smallexample
39982
39983 @node File-I/O Examples
39984 @subsection File-I/O Examples
39985 @cindex file-i/o examples
39986
39987 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39988 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
39989
39990 @smallexample
39991 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
39992 @emph{request memory read from target}
39993 -> @code{m1234,6}
39994 <- XXXXXX
39995 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
39996 -> @code{F6}
39997 @end smallexample
39998
39999 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40000 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
40001
40002 @smallexample
40003 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40004 @emph{request memory write to target}
40005 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40006 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
40007 -> @code{F6}
40008 @end smallexample
40009
40010 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
40011 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
40012
40013 @smallexample
40014 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40015 -> @code{F-1,9}
40016 @end smallexample
40017
40018 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
40019 host is called:
40020
40021 @smallexample
40022 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40023 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
40024 <- @code{T02}
40025 @end smallexample
40026
40027 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
40028 host is called:
40029
40030 @smallexample
40031 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40032 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40033 <- @code{T02}
40034 @end smallexample
40035
40036 @node Library List Format
40037 @section Library List Format
40038 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40039
40040 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
40041 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
40042 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
40043 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
40044 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
40045 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
40046 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
40047 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
40048 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
40049 are loaded.
40050
40051 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
40052 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
40053 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
40054 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
40055
40056 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
40057 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
40058 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
40059 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
40060 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
40061 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
40062
40063 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40064 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40065
40066 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
40067 offset, looks like this:
40068
40069 @smallexample
40070 <library-list>
40071 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
40072 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
40073 </library>
40074 </library-list>
40075 @end smallexample
40076
40077 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
40078 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
40079
40080 @smallexample
40081 <library-list>
40082 <library name="sharedlib.o">
40083 <section address="0x10000000"/>
40084 <section address="0x20000000"/>
40085 <section address="0x30000000"/>
40086 </library>
40087 </library-list>
40088 @end smallexample
40089
40090 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
40091
40092 @smallexample
40093 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
40094 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
40095 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40096 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
40097 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40098 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
40099 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40100 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
40101 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40102 @end smallexample
40103
40104 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
40105 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
40106 section for each library.
40107
40108 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40109 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40110 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40111
40112 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
40113 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
40114 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
40115 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
40116
40117 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
40118 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
40119 target, the following parameters are reported:
40120
40121 @itemize @minus
40122 @item
40123 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
40124 @code{struct link_map}.
40125 @item
40126 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
40127 (Thread Local Storage) access.
40128 @item
40129 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
40130 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
40131 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
40132 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
40133 @item
40134 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
40135 @end itemize
40136
40137 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
40138 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
40139 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
40140
40141 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40142 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40143
40144 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
40145 looks like this:
40146
40147 @smallexample
40148 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
40149 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
40150 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
40151 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
40152 l_ld="0x152350"/>
40153 </library-list-svr>
40154 @end smallexample
40155
40156 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
40157
40158 @smallexample
40159 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
40160 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
40161 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40162 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
40163 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
40164 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40165 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
40166 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
40167 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
40168 @end smallexample
40169
40170 @node Memory Map Format
40171 @section Memory Map Format
40172 @cindex memory map format
40173
40174 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
40175 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
40176 memory map.
40177
40178 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40179 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
40180 lists memory regions.
40181
40182 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40183 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
40184
40185 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40186
40187 @smallexample
40188 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40189 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
40190 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40191 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
40192 <memory-map>
40193 region...
40194 </memory-map>
40195 @end smallexample
40196
40197 Each region can be either:
40198
40199 @itemize
40200
40201 @item
40202 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
40203 bytes from there:
40204
40205 @smallexample
40206 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40207 @end smallexample
40208
40209
40210 @item
40211 A region of read-only memory:
40212
40213 @smallexample
40214 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40215 @end smallexample
40216
40217
40218 @item
40219 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
40220 bytes in length:
40221
40222 @smallexample
40223 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
40224 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
40225 </memory>
40226 @end smallexample
40227
40228 @end itemize
40229
40230 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
40231 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
40232 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
40233
40234 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
40235
40236 @smallexample
40237 <!-- ................................................... -->
40238 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
40239 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
40240 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
40241 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
40242 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
40243 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
40244 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
40245 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
40246 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
40247 and its type, or device. -->
40248 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
40249 start CDATA #REQUIRED
40250 length CDATA #REQUIRED
40251 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
40252 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
40253 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
40254 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40255 @end smallexample
40256
40257 @node Thread List Format
40258 @section Thread List Format
40259 @cindex thread list format
40260
40261 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
40262 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40263 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
40264 the following structure:
40265
40266 @smallexample
40267 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40268 <threads>
40269 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
40270 ... description ...
40271 </thread>
40272 </threads>
40273 @end smallexample
40274
40275 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
40276 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
40277 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
40278 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
40279 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
40280 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
40281 auxiliary information.
40282
40283 @node Traceframe Info Format
40284 @section Traceframe Info Format
40285 @cindex traceframe info format
40286
40287 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
40288 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
40289 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
40290 collected in a traceframe.
40291
40292 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40293 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
40294
40295 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40296 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40297
40298 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40299
40300 @smallexample
40301 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40302 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
40303 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40304 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
40305 <traceframe-info>
40306 block...
40307 </traceframe-info>
40308 @end smallexample
40309
40310 Each traceframe block can be either:
40311
40312 @itemize
40313
40314 @item
40315 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40316 @var{length} bytes from there:
40317
40318 @smallexample
40319 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40320 @end smallexample
40321
40322 @item
40323 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40324 collected:
40325
40326 @smallexample
40327 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40328 @end smallexample
40329
40330 @end itemize
40331
40332 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40333
40334 @smallexample
40335 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
40336 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40337
40338 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
40339 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
40340 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40341 <!ELEMENT tvar>
40342 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
40343 @end smallexample
40344
40345 @node Branch Trace Format
40346 @section Branch Trace Format
40347 @cindex branch trace format
40348
40349 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
40350 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
40351 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
40352 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
40353
40354 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40355 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
40356
40357 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40358 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40359
40360 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40361
40362 @smallexample
40363 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40364 <!DOCTYPE btrace
40365 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
40366 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
40367 <btrace>
40368 block...
40369 </btrace>
40370 @end smallexample
40371
40372 @itemize
40373
40374 @item
40375 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
40376 and ending at @var{end}:
40377
40378 @smallexample
40379 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
40380 @end smallexample
40381
40382 @end itemize
40383
40384 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
40385
40386 @smallexample
40387 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
40388 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40389
40390 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
40391 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
40392 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
40393
40394 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40395
40396 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40397
40398 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
40399 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
40400 family CDATA #REQUIRED
40401 model CDATA #REQUIRED
40402 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
40403
40404 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
40405 @end smallexample
40406
40407 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
40408 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
40409 @cindex branch trace configuration format
40410
40411 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
40412 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40413 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
40414
40415 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
40416 settings for that format. The following information is described:
40417
40418 @table @code
40419 @item bts
40420 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
40421 @table @code
40422 @item size
40423 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
40424 @end table
40425 @item pt
40426 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
40427 PT}) format.
40428 @table @code
40429 @item size
40430 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
40431 @end table
40432 @end table
40433
40434 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40435 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40436
40437 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
40438
40439 @smallexample
40440 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
40441 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40442
40443 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
40444 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40445
40446 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
40447 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40448 @end smallexample
40449
40450 @include agentexpr.texi
40451
40452 @node Target Descriptions
40453 @appendix Target Descriptions
40454 @cindex target descriptions
40455
40456 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
40457 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
40458 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
40459 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
40460 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
40461 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
40462 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
40463
40464 @itemize @bullet
40465 @item
40466 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
40467 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
40468 @item
40469 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
40470 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
40471 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
40472 @item
40473 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
40474 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
40475 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
40476 @end itemize
40477
40478 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
40479 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
40480 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
40481 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
40482 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
40483
40484 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40485 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
40486
40487 @menu
40488 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
40489 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
40490 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
40491 descriptions.
40492 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
40493 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
40494 @end menu
40495
40496 @node Retrieving Descriptions
40497 @section Retrieving Descriptions
40498
40499 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
40500 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
40501 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
40502 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
40503 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
40504 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
40505 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
40506 Format}.
40507
40508 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
40509 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
40510 specify a file are:
40511
40512 @table @code
40513 @cindex set tdesc filename
40514 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
40515 Read the target description from @var{path}.
40516
40517 @cindex unset tdesc filename
40518 @item unset tdesc filename
40519 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
40520 will use the description supplied by the current target.
40521
40522 @cindex show tdesc filename
40523 @item show tdesc filename
40524 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
40525 @end table
40526
40527
40528 @node Target Description Format
40529 @section Target Description Format
40530 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
40531
40532 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
40533 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
40534 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
40535 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
40536 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
40537 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
40538 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
40539
40540 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
40541 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
40542 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
40543 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
40544 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
40545
40546 Here is a simple target description:
40547
40548 @smallexample
40549 <target version="1.0">
40550 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
40551 </target>
40552 @end smallexample
40553
40554 @noindent
40555 This minimal description only says that the target uses
40556 the x86-64 architecture.
40557
40558 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
40559 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
40560 are explained further below.
40561
40562 @smallexample
40563 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40564 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
40565 <target version="1.0">
40566 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
40567 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
40568 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
40569 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
40570 </target>
40571 @end smallexample
40572
40573 @noindent
40574 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
40575 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
40576 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
40577 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
40578 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
40579 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
40580 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
40581 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
40582 the version mismatch.
40583
40584 @subsection Inclusion
40585 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
40586 @cindex XInclude
40587 @ifnotinfo
40588 @cindex <xi:include>
40589 @end ifnotinfo
40590
40591 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
40592 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
40593 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
40594 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
40595 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
40596
40597 @smallexample
40598 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
40599 @end smallexample
40600
40601 @noindent
40602 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
40603 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
40604 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
40605 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
40606 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
40607 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
40608 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
40609 original description.
40610
40611 @subsection Architecture
40612 @cindex <architecture>
40613
40614 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
40615
40616 @smallexample
40617 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
40618 @end smallexample
40619
40620 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40621 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40622
40623 @subsection OS ABI
40624 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
40625
40626 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40627 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40628
40629 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
40630
40631 @smallexample
40632 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
40633 @end smallexample
40634
40635 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
40636 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
40637
40638 @subsection Compatible Architecture
40639 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
40640
40641 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40642 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40643
40644 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
40645
40646 @smallexample
40647 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
40648 @end smallexample
40649
40650 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40651 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40652
40653 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
40654 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
40655 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
40656 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
40657 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
40658 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
40659 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
40660
40661 @smallexample
40662 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
40663 <compatible>spu</compatible>
40664 @end smallexample
40665
40666 @subsection Features
40667 @cindex <feature>
40668
40669 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
40670 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
40671 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
40672 has this form:
40673
40674 @smallexample
40675 <feature name="@var{name}">
40676 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
40677 @var{reg}@dots{}
40678 </feature>
40679 @end smallexample
40680
40681 @noindent
40682 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
40683 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
40684 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
40685 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
40686
40687 @subsection Types
40688
40689 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
40690 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
40691 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
40692 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
40693 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
40694 and enum types.
40695
40696 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
40697 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
40698 Types must be defined before they are used.
40699
40700 @cindex <vector>
40701 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
40702 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
40703 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
40704 @var{count}:
40705
40706 @smallexample
40707 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
40708 @end smallexample
40709
40710 @cindex <union>
40711 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
40712 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
40713 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
40714 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
40715
40716 @smallexample
40717 <union id="@var{id}">
40718 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40719 @dots{}
40720 </union>
40721 @end smallexample
40722
40723 @cindex <struct>
40724 @cindex <flags>
40725 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
40726 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
40727 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
40728 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
40729 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
40730 specified.
40731
40732 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
40733
40734 @smallexample
40735 <struct id="@var{id}">
40736 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40737 @dots{}
40738 </struct>
40739 @end smallexample
40740
40741 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
40742 No implicit padding is added.
40743
40744 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
40745
40746 @smallexample
40747 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40748 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
40749 @dots{}
40750 </struct>
40751 @end smallexample
40752
40753 @smallexample
40754 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40755 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
40756 @dots{}
40757 </flags>
40758 @end smallexample
40759
40760 The @var{name} value is required.
40761 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
40762 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
40763 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
40764
40765 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
40766 is optional.
40767 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
40768 and zero represents the least significant bit.
40769
40770 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
40771 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
40772
40773 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
40774
40775 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
40776 defining them with @samp{struct}:
40777
40778 @itemize @bullet
40779 @item
40780 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
40781 @item
40782 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
40783 @end itemize
40784
40785 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
40786 defining them with @samp{flags}:
40787
40788 @itemize @bullet
40789 @item
40790 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
40791
40792 @smallexample
40793 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
40794 $1 = 42
40795 @end smallexample
40796
40797 @end itemize
40798
40799 @subsection Registers
40800 @cindex <reg>
40801
40802 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
40803
40804 @smallexample
40805 <reg name="@var{name}"
40806 bitsize="@var{size}"
40807 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
40808 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
40809 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
40810 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
40811 @end smallexample
40812
40813 @noindent
40814 The components are as follows:
40815
40816 @table @var
40817
40818 @item name
40819 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
40820
40821 @item bitsize
40822 The register's size, in bits.
40823
40824 @item regnum
40825 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
40826 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
40827 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
40828 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
40829 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
40830 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
40831 in order of increasing register number.
40832
40833 @item save-restore
40834 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
40835 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
40836 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
40837 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
40838 ABI.
40839
40840 @item type
40841 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
40842 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
40843 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
40844 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
40845 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
40846 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
40847
40848 @item group
40849 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
40850 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
40851 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
40852 in @code{info registers}.
40853
40854 @end table
40855
40856 @node Predefined Target Types
40857 @section Predefined Target Types
40858 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
40859
40860 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
40861 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
40862 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
40863 types. The currently supported types are:
40864
40865 @table @code
40866
40867 @item bool
40868 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
40869
40870 @item int8
40871 @itemx int16
40872 @itemx int32
40873 @itemx int64
40874 @itemx int128
40875 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40876
40877 @item uint8
40878 @itemx uint16
40879 @itemx uint32
40880 @itemx uint64
40881 @itemx uint128
40882 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40883
40884 @item code_ptr
40885 @itemx data_ptr
40886 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
40887 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
40888 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
40889 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
40890 may be marked as data pointers.
40891
40892 @item ieee_single
40893 Single precision IEEE floating point.
40894
40895 @item ieee_double
40896 Double precision IEEE floating point.
40897
40898 @item arm_fpa_ext
40899 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
40900
40901 @item i387_ext
40902 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
40903
40904 @item i386_eflags
40905 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
40906
40907 @item i386_mxcsr
40908 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
40909
40910 @end table
40911
40912 @node Enum Target Types
40913 @section Enum Target Types
40914 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
40915
40916 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
40917 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
40918
40919 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
40920
40921 @smallexample
40922 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40923 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
40924 @dots{}
40925 </enum>
40926 @end smallexample
40927
40928 Enums must be defined before they are used.
40929
40930 @smallexample
40931 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
40932 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
40933 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
40934 </enum>
40935 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
40936 <field name="X" start="0"/>
40937 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
40938 </flags>
40939 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
40940 @end smallexample
40941
40942 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
40943 would be printed as:
40944
40945 @smallexample
40946 (gdb) info register flags
40947 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
40948 @end smallexample
40949
40950 @node Standard Target Features
40951 @section Standard Target Features
40952 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
40953
40954 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
40955 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
40956 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
40957 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
40958 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
40959 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
40960 can recognize them.
40961
40962 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
40963 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
40964 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
40965 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
40966 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
40967 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
40968 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
40969 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
40970
40971 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
40972 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
40973 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
40974
40975 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
40976 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
40977 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
40978 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
40979
40980 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
40981 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
40982 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
40983
40984 @menu
40985 * AArch64 Features::
40986 * ARC Features::
40987 * ARM Features::
40988 * i386 Features::
40989 * MicroBlaze Features::
40990 * MIPS Features::
40991 * M68K Features::
40992 * NDS32 Features::
40993 * Nios II Features::
40994 * PowerPC Features::
40995 * S/390 and System z Features::
40996 * TIC6x Features::
40997 @end menu
40998
40999
41000 @node AArch64 Features
41001 @subsection AArch64 Features
41002 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
41003
41004 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
41005 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
41006 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41007
41008 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41009 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
41010 and @samp{fpcr}.
41011
41012 @node ARC Features
41013 @subsection ARC Features
41014 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
41015
41016 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
41017 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
41018 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
41019 that one of the core registers features is present.
41020 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
41021
41022 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
41023 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41024 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41025 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
41026 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41027 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
41028 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
41029
41030 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
41031 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
41032 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
41033 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
41034 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
41035 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41036
41037 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
41038 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41039 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41040 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
41041 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
41042 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
41043 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
41044 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
41045 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
41046 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
41047
41048 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
41049 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
41050
41051 @node ARM Features
41052 @subsection ARM Features
41053 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
41054
41055 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
41056 ARM targets.
41057 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
41058 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41059
41060 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
41061 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
41062 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
41063 and @samp{xpsr}.
41064
41065 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
41066 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
41067
41068 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
41069 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
41070 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
41071 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
41072
41073 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
41074 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
41075 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
41076 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
41077 halves of the double-precision registers.
41078
41079 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
41080 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
41081 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
41082 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
41083 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
41084 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
41085
41086 @node i386 Features
41087 @subsection i386 Features
41088 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
41089
41090 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
41091 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41092
41093 @itemize @minus
41094 @item
41095 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
41096 @item
41097 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
41098 @item
41099 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
41100 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
41101 @item
41102 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
41103 @item
41104 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
41105 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
41106 @end itemize
41107
41108 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
41109
41110 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
41111 describe registers:
41112
41113 @itemize @minus
41114 @item
41115 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
41116 @item
41117 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
41118 @item
41119 @samp{mxcsr}
41120 @end itemize
41121
41122 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
41123 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
41124 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
41125
41126 @itemize @minus
41127 @item
41128 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
41129 @item
41130 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
41131 @end itemize
41132
41133 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
41134 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
41135
41136 @itemize @minus
41137 @item
41138 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
41139 @item
41140 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
41141 @end itemize
41142
41143 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
41144 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
41145
41146 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
41147 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
41148 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
41149
41150 @itemize @minus
41151 @item
41152 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41153 @end itemize
41154
41155 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
41156
41157 @itemize @minus
41158 @item
41159 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41160 @end itemize
41161
41162 It should
41163 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
41164
41165 @itemize @minus
41166 @item
41167 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
41168 @item
41169 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
41170 @end itemize
41171
41172 It should
41173 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
41174
41175 @itemize @minus
41176 @item
41177 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41178 @end itemize
41179
41180 @node MicroBlaze Features
41181 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
41182 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
41183
41184 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
41185 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41186 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
41187 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
41188 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
41189
41190 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
41191 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
41192
41193 @node MIPS Features
41194 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
41195 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
41196
41197 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
41198 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
41199 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
41200 on the target.
41201
41202 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
41203 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
41204 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41205
41206 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
41207 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
41208 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
41209 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41210
41211 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
41212 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
41213 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
41214 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41215
41216 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
41217 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
41218 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
41219
41220 @node M68K Features
41221 @subsection M68K Features
41222 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
41223
41224 @table @code
41225 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
41226 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
41227 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
41228 One of those features must be always present.
41229 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
41230 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
41231 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
41232 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
41233
41234 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
41235 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
41236 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
41237 @samp{fpiaddr}.
41238 @end table
41239
41240 @node NDS32 Features
41241 @subsection NDS32 Features
41242 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
41243
41244 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
41245 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
41246 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
41247 and @samp{pc}.
41248
41249 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41250 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
41251 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
41252 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
41253
41254 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
41255 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
41256 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
41257 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
41258 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
41259 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
41260 support to it could be totally removed some day.
41261
41262 @node Nios II Features
41263 @subsection Nios II Features
41264 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
41265
41266 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
41267 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
41268 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
41269 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
41270 @samp{mpuacc}).
41271
41272 @node PowerPC Features
41273 @subsection PowerPC Features
41274 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
41275
41276 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
41277 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41278 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
41279 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41280
41281 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
41282 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
41283
41284 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
41285 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
41286 and @samp{vrsave}.
41287
41288 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
41289 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
41290 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
41291 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
41292 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
41293 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
41294
41295 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
41296 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
41297 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
41298 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
41299 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
41300 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
41301 user.
41302
41303 @node S/390 and System z Features
41304 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
41305 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
41306 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
41307
41308 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
41309 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
41310 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
41311 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
41312 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
41313 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
41314 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
41315 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
41316 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
41317
41318 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
41319 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
41320 @samp{fpc}.
41321
41322 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
41323 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
41324
41325 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
41326 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
41327 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
41328 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
41329 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
41330 32-bit wide.
41331
41332 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
41333 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
41334 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
41335
41336 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
41337 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
41338 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
41339 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
41340 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
41341 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
41342 @samp{v31}.
41343
41344 @node TIC6x Features
41345 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
41346 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
41347 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
41348 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
41349 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
41350 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
41351
41352 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
41353 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
41354 through @samp{B31}.
41355
41356 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
41357 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
41358
41359 @node Operating System Information
41360 @appendix Operating System Information
41361 @cindex operating system information
41362
41363 @menu
41364 * Process list::
41365 @end menu
41366
41367 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
41368 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
41369 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
41370 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
41371 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
41372 on a different aspect of target.
41373
41374 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
41375 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
41376 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
41377 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
41378
41379 @node Process list
41380 @appendixsection Process list
41381 @cindex operating system information, process list
41382
41383 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
41384 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
41385 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
41386 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
41387
41388 An example document is:
41389
41390 @smallexample
41391 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41392 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
41393 <osdata type="processes">
41394 <item>
41395 <column name="pid">1</column>
41396 <column name="user">root</column>
41397 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
41398 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
41399 </item>
41400 </osdata>
41401 @end smallexample
41402
41403 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
41404 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
41405 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
41406 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
41407 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
41408 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
41409 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
41410
41411 @node Trace File Format
41412 @appendix Trace File Format
41413 @cindex trace file format
41414
41415 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
41416 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
41417
41418 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
41419 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
41420 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
41421 in the future.
41422
41423 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
41424 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
41425 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
41426 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
41427 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
41428 of this section.
41429
41430 @table @code
41431 @item R @var{size}
41432 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
41433 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
41434 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
41435 a single trace file.
41436
41437 @item status @var{status}
41438 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
41439 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
41440 file.
41441
41442 @item tp @var{payload}
41443 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41444 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
41445 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41446 reply packets.
41447
41448 @item tsv @var{payload}
41449 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
41450 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
41451 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41452 reply packets.
41453
41454 @item tdesc @var{payload}
41455 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
41456 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
41457 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
41458 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
41459 file. Includes are not allowed.
41460
41461 @end table
41462
41463 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
41464 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
41465 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
41466 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
41467 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
41468 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
41469 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
41470 endianness.
41471
41472 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
41473
41474 @table @code
41475 @item R @var{bytes}
41476 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
41477 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
41478 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
41479
41480 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
41481 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
41482 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
41483 @var{length} bytes.
41484
41485 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
41486 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
41487 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
41488
41489 @end table
41490
41491 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
41492 of blocks.
41493
41494 @node Index Section Format
41495 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
41496 @cindex .gdb_index section format
41497 @cindex index section format
41498
41499 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
41500 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
41501 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
41502 description.
41503
41504 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
41505 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
41506 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
41507 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
41508 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
41509 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
41510
41511 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
41512
41513 @enumerate
41514 @item
41515 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
41516 unless otherwise noted:
41517
41518 @enumerate
41519 @item
41520 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
41521 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
41522 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
41523 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
41524 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
41525 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
41526 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
41527
41528 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
41529 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
41530 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
41531 currently not flagged as deprecated.
41532
41533 @item
41534 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
41535
41536 @item
41537 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
41538 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
41539 to the next offset.
41540
41541 @item
41542 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
41543
41544 @item
41545 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
41546
41547 @item
41548 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
41549 @end enumerate
41550
41551 @item
41552 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
41553 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
41554 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
41555 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
41556 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
41557 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
41558 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
41559 CU indices.
41560
41561 @item
41562 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
41563 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
41564 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
41565 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
41566
41567 @item
41568 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
41569 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
41570
41571 @enumerate
41572 @item
41573 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
41574
41575 @item
41576 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
41577 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
41578
41579 @item
41580 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
41581 @end enumerate
41582
41583 @item
41584 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
41585 the hash table is always a power of 2.
41586
41587 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
41588 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
41589 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
41590 constant pool.
41591
41592 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
41593 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
41594 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
41595
41596 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
41597 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
41598 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
41599 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
41600 index version:
41601
41602 @table @asis
41603 @item Version 4
41604 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
41605
41606 @item Versions 5 to 7
41607 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
41608 @end table
41609
41610 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
41611
41612 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
41613 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
41614 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
41615 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
41616 collision.
41617
41618 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
41619 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
41620 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
41621 the code.
41622
41623 @item
41624 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
41625 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
41626 strings.
41627
41628 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
41629 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
41630 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
41631 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
41632 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
41633 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
41634
41635 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
41636 @end enumerate
41637
41638 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
41639 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
41640 CU index+attributes value for each use.
41641
41642 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
41643 (bit 0 = LSB):
41644
41645 @table @asis
41646
41647 @item Bits 0-23
41648 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
41649 @item Bits 24-27
41650 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
41651 @item Bits 28-30
41652 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
41653
41654 @table @asis
41655 @item 0
41656 This value is reserved and should not be used.
41657 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
41658 with previous versions of the index.
41659 @item 1
41660 The symbol is a type.
41661 @item 2
41662 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
41663 @item 3
41664 The symbol is a function.
41665 @item 4
41666 Any other kind of symbol.
41667 @item 5,6,7
41668 These values are reserved.
41669 @end table
41670
41671 @item Bit 31
41672 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
41673
41674 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
41675 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
41676 @value{GDBN} sources.
41677
41678 @end table
41679
41680 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
41681 global/static attributes in the index.
41682
41683 @smallexample
41684 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
41685 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
41686 switch (die->tag)
41687 @{
41688 case DW_TAG_typedef:
41689 case DW_TAG_base_type:
41690 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
41691 kind = TYPE;
41692 is_static = 1;
41693 break;
41694 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
41695 kind = VARIABLE;
41696 is_static = language != CPLUS;
41697 break;
41698 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
41699 kind = FUNCTION;
41700 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
41701 break;
41702 case DW_TAG_constant:
41703 kind = VARIABLE;
41704 is_static = ! is_external;
41705 break;
41706 case DW_TAG_variable:
41707 kind = VARIABLE;
41708 is_static = ! is_external;
41709 break;
41710 case DW_TAG_namespace:
41711 kind = TYPE;
41712 is_static = 0;
41713 break;
41714 case DW_TAG_class_type:
41715 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
41716 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
41717 case DW_TAG_union_type:
41718 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
41719 kind = TYPE;
41720 is_static = language != CPLUS;
41721 break;
41722 default:
41723 assert (0);
41724 @}
41725 @end smallexample
41726
41727 @node Man Pages
41728 @appendix Manual pages
41729 @cindex Man pages
41730
41731 @menu
41732 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
41733 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
41734 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
41735 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
41736 @end menu
41737
41738 @node gdb man
41739 @heading gdb man
41740
41741 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
41742
41743 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
41744 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
41745 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
41746 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
41747 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
41748 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
41749 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
41750 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
41751 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
41752 @c man end
41753
41754 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
41755 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
41756 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
41757 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
41758
41759 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
41760 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
41761
41762 @itemize @bullet
41763 @item
41764 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
41765
41766 @item
41767 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
41768
41769 @item
41770 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
41771
41772 @item
41773 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
41774 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
41775 @end itemize
41776
41777 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
41778 Modula-2.
41779
41780 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
41781 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
41782 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
41783 by using the command @code{help}.
41784
41785 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
41786 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
41787 executable program as the argument:
41788
41789 @smallexample
41790 gdb program
41791 @end smallexample
41792
41793 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
41794
41795 @smallexample
41796 gdb program core
41797 @end smallexample
41798
41799 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
41800 to debug a running process:
41801
41802 @smallexample
41803 gdb program 1234
41804 gdb -p 1234
41805 @end smallexample
41806
41807 @noindent
41808 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
41809 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
41810 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
41811
41812 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
41813
41814 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
41815 @table @env
41816 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41817 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
41818
41819 @item run [@var{arglist}]
41820 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
41821
41822 @item bt
41823 Backtrace: display the program stack.
41824
41825 @item print @var{expr}
41826 Display the value of an expression.
41827
41828 @item c
41829 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
41830
41831 @item next
41832 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
41833 function calls in the line.
41834
41835 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41836 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
41837
41838 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41839 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
41840
41841 @item step
41842 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
41843 function calls in the line.
41844
41845 @item help [@var{name}]
41846 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
41847 about using @value{GDBN}.
41848
41849 @item quit
41850 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
41851 @end table
41852
41853 @ifset man
41854 For full details on @value{GDBN},
41855 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41856 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
41857 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
41858 @end ifset
41859 @c man end
41860
41861 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
41862 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
41863 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
41864 encountered with no
41865 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
41866 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
41867 Many options have
41868 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
41869 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
41870 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
41871 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
41872 more usual convention.)
41873
41874 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
41875 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
41876 option is used.
41877
41878 @table @env
41879 @item -help
41880 @itemx -h
41881 List all options, with brief explanations.
41882
41883 @item -symbols=@var{file}
41884 @itemx -s @var{file}
41885 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
41886
41887 @item -write
41888 Enable writing into executable and core files.
41889
41890 @item -exec=@var{file}
41891 @itemx -e @var{file}
41892 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
41893 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
41894 dump.
41895
41896 @item -se=@var{file}
41897 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
41898 file.
41899
41900 @item -core=@var{file}
41901 @itemx -c @var{file}
41902 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
41903
41904 @item -command=@var{file}
41905 @itemx -x @var{file}
41906 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
41907
41908 @item -ex @var{command}
41909 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
41910
41911 @item -directory=@var{directory}
41912 @itemx -d @var{directory}
41913 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
41914
41915 @item -nh
41916 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
41917
41918 @item -nx
41919 @itemx -n
41920 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
41921
41922 @item -quiet
41923 @itemx -q
41924 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
41925 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
41926
41927 @item -batch
41928 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
41929 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
41930 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
41931 commands in the command files.
41932
41933 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
41934 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
41935 more useful, the message
41936
41937 @smallexample
41938 Program exited normally.
41939 @end smallexample
41940
41941 @noindent
41942 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
41943 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
41944
41945 @item -cd=@var{directory}
41946 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
41947 instead of the current directory.
41948
41949 @item -fullname
41950 @itemx -f
41951 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
41952 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
41953 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
41954 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
41955 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
41956 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
41957 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
41958 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
41959
41960 @item -b @var{bps}
41961 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
41962 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
41963
41964 @item -tty=@var{device}
41965 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
41966 @end table
41967 @c man end
41968
41969 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
41970 @ifset man
41971 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41972 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41973 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41974
41975 @smallexample
41976 info gdb
41977 @end smallexample
41978
41979 @noindent
41980 should give you access to the complete manual.
41981
41982 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41983 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41984 @end ifset
41985 @c man end
41986
41987 @node gdbserver man
41988 @heading gdbserver man
41989
41990 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
41991 @format
41992 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
41993 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41994
41995 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41996
41997 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41998 @c man end
41999 @end format
42000
42001 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
42002 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
42003 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
42004
42005 @ifclear man
42006 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
42007 @end ifclear
42008 @ifset man
42009 Usage (server (target) side):
42010 @end ifset
42011
42012 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
42013 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
42014 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
42015 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
42016
42017 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
42018 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
42019 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
42020
42021 @smallexample
42022 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
42023 @end smallexample
42024
42025 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
42026
42027 @smallexample
42028 @ifset man
42029 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
42030 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
42031 @end ifset
42032 @ifclear man
42033 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
42034 @end ifclear
42035 @end smallexample
42036
42037 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
42038 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
42039 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
42040
42041 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
42042
42043 @smallexample
42044 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
42045 @end smallexample
42046
42047 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
42048 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
42049 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
42050 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
42051 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
42052 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
42053 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
42054 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
42055 print an error message and exit.
42056
42057 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
42058 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
42059
42060 @smallexample
42061 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42062 @end smallexample
42063
42064 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42065 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42066
42067 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42068 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
42069 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
42070 the program you want to debug.
42071
42072 @smallexample
42073 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42074 @end smallexample
42075
42076 @ifclear man
42077 @subheading Usage (host side)
42078 @end ifclear
42079 @ifset man
42080 Usage (host side):
42081 @end ifset
42082
42083 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
42084 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
42085 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
42086 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
42087 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
42088 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
42089 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
42090 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
42091 descriptor. For example:
42092
42093 @smallexample
42094 @ifset man
42095 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
42096 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
42097 @end ifset
42098 @ifclear man
42099 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
42100 @end ifclear
42101 @end smallexample
42102
42103 @noindent
42104 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
42105
42106 @smallexample
42107 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
42108 @end smallexample
42109
42110 @noindent
42111 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
42112 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
42113 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
42114 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
42115 `Connection refused'.
42116
42117 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
42118 described in
42119 @ifset man
42120 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
42121 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
42122 @end ifset
42123 @ifclear man
42124 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
42125 @end ifclear
42126 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
42127
42128 @smallexample
42129 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
42130 @end smallexample
42131
42132 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
42133 case.
42134 @c man end
42135
42136 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
42137 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
42138
42139 @itemize @bullet
42140
42141 @item
42142 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
42143
42144 @smallexample
42145 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42146 @end smallexample
42147
42148 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
42149 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
42150 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
42151 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
42152 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
42153 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
42154 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42155
42156 @item
42157 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
42158 program:
42159
42160 @smallexample
42161 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42162 @end smallexample
42163
42164 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
42165 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
42166 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
42167 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42168
42169 @item
42170 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
42171
42172 @smallexample
42173 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42174 @end smallexample
42175
42176 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
42177 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
42178 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
42179 debug several processes in the same session.
42180 @end itemize
42181
42182 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
42183
42184 @table @env
42185
42186 @item --help
42187 List all options, with brief explanations.
42188
42189 @item --version
42190 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
42191
42192 @item --attach
42193 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
42194
42195 @smallexample
42196 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42197 @end smallexample
42198
42199 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42200 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42201
42202 @item --multi
42203 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42204 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
42205 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
42206 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
42207
42208 @smallexample
42209 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42210 @end smallexample
42211
42212 @item --debug
42213 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
42214 process.
42215 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42216 the developers.
42217
42218 @item --remote-debug
42219 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
42220 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42221 the developers.
42222
42223 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
42224 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
42225 of debugging output.
42226 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
42227
42228 @item --wrapper
42229 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
42230 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
42231 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
42232 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
42233
42234 @item --once
42235 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
42236 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
42237 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
42238 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
42239
42240 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
42241
42242 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
42243 @c QDisableRandomization.
42244
42245 @end table
42246 @c man end
42247
42248 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
42249 @ifset man
42250 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42251 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42252 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42253
42254 @smallexample
42255 info gdb
42256 @end smallexample
42257
42258 should give you access to the complete manual.
42259
42260 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42261 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42262 @end ifset
42263 @c man end
42264
42265 @node gcore man
42266 @heading gcore
42267
42268 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
42269
42270 @format
42271 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
42272 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
42273 @c man end
42274 @end format
42275
42276 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
42277 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
42278 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
42279 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
42280 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
42281 running without any change.
42282 @c man end
42283
42284 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
42285 @table @env
42286 @item -o @var{filename}
42287 The optional argument
42288 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
42289 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
42290 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
42291 @end table
42292 @c man end
42293
42294 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
42295 @ifset man
42296 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42297 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42298 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42299
42300 @smallexample
42301 info gdb
42302 @end smallexample
42303
42304 @noindent
42305 should give you access to the complete manual.
42306
42307 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42308 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42309 @end ifset
42310 @c man end
42311
42312 @node gdbinit man
42313 @heading gdbinit
42314
42315 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
42316
42317 @format
42318 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
42319 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42320 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42321 @end ifset
42322
42323 ~/.gdbinit
42324
42325 ./.gdbinit
42326 @c man end
42327 @end format
42328
42329 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
42330 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
42331 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
42332 described in
42333 @ifset man
42334 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
42335 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
42336 @end ifset
42337 @ifclear man
42338 @ref{Sequences}.
42339 @end ifclear
42340
42341 Please read more in
42342 @ifset man
42343 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
42344 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
42345 @end ifset
42346 @ifclear man
42347 @ref{Startup}.
42348 @end ifclear
42349
42350 @table @env
42351 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42352 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42353 @end ifset
42354 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42355 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
42356 @end ifclear
42357 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42358 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
42359 See more in
42360 @ifset man
42361 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
42362 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
42363 @end ifset
42364 @ifclear man
42365 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
42366 @end ifclear
42367
42368 @item ~/.gdbinit
42369 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42370 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
42371
42372 @item ./.gdbinit
42373 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
42374 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
42375 See more in
42376 @ifset man
42377 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
42378 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
42379 @end ifset
42380 @ifclear man
42381 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
42382 @end ifclear
42383 @end table
42384 @c man end
42385
42386 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
42387 @ifset man
42388 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
42389
42390 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42391 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42392 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42393
42394 @smallexample
42395 info gdb
42396 @end smallexample
42397
42398 should give you access to the complete manual.
42399
42400 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42401 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42402 @end ifset
42403 @c man end
42404
42405 @include gpl.texi
42406
42407 @node GNU Free Documentation License
42408 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
42409 @include fdl.texi
42410
42411 @node Concept Index
42412 @unnumbered Concept Index
42413
42414 @printindex cp
42415
42416 @node Command and Variable Index
42417 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
42418
42419 @printindex fn
42420
42421 @tex
42422 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
42423 % meantime:
42424 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
42425 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
42426 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
42427 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
42428 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
42429 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
42430 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
42431 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
42432 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
42433 \page\colophon
42434 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
42435 @end tex
42436
42437 @bye
This page took 1.119348 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.